Ms_v00_mpc2030_mpc2050_mpc2530_mpc2550.pdf

  • Uploaded by: Manuel Flores
  • 0
  • 0
  • November 2019
  • PDF

This document was uploaded by user and they confirmed that they have the permission to share it. If you are author or own the copyright of this book, please report to us by using this DMCA report form. Report DMCA


Overview

Download & View Ms_v00_mpc2030_mpc2050_mpc2530_mpc2550.pdf as PDF for free.

More details

  • Words: 182,995
  • Pages: 1,169
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL 003980MIU

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL

003980MIU

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

It is the reader's responsibility when discussing the information contained within this document to maintain a level of confidentiality that is in the best interest of Ricoh Americas Corporation and its member companies. NO PART OF THIS DOCUMENT MAY BE REPRODUCED IN ANY FASHION AND DISTRIBUTED WITHOUT THE PRIOR PERMISSION OF RICOH AMERICAS CORPORATION. All product names, domain names or product illustrations, including desktop images, used in this document are trademarks, registered trademarks or the property of their respective companies. They are used throughout this book in an informational or editorial fashion only and for the benefit of such companies. No such use, or the use of any trade name, or web site is intended to convey endorsement or other affiliation with Ricoh products.

© 2008 RICOH Americas Corporation. All rights reserved.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

WARNING The Service Manual contains information regarding service techniques, procedures, processes and spare parts of office equipment distributed by Ricoh Americas Corporation. Users of this manual should be either service trained or certified by successfully completing a Ricoh Technical Training Program. Untrained and uncertified users utilizing information contained in this service manual to repair or modify Ricoh equipment risk personal injury, damage to property or loss of warranty protection.

Ricoh Americas Corporation

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

LEGEND PRODUCT CODE D037 D038 D040 D041

GESTETNER MP C2030 MP C2050 MP C2530 MP C2550

COMPANY LANIER RICOH LD520CL Aficio MP C2030 LD520C Aficio MP C2050 LD525CL Aficio MP C2530 LD525C Aficio MP C2550

SAVIN C9020L C9020 C9025L C9025

DOCUMENTATION HISTORY REV. NO. *

DATE 10/2008

COMMENTS Original Printing

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041 TABLE OF CONTENTS PRODUCT INFORMATION 1. PRODUCT INFORMATION.......................................................... 1-1 1.1 SPECIFICATIONS......................................................................................1-1 1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION ....................................................................1-2 1.2.1 H-MODEL ..........................................................................................1-2 1.2.2 L-MODEL...........................................................................................1-5 1.3 OVERVIEW ................................................................................................1-7

INSTALLATION 2. INSTALLATION............................................................................ 2-1 2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS ............................................................2-1 2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT ................................................................................2-1 2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL..............................................................................2-1 2.1.3 MACHINE SPACE REQUIREMENTS ...............................................2-2 2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS ...............................................................2-2 2.2 OPTIONAL UNIT COMBINATIONS............................................................2-3 2.2.1 MACHINE OPTIONS.........................................................................2-3 2.2.2 CONTROLLER OPTIONS .................................................................2-3 2.3 COPIER INSTALLATION ...........................................................................2-5 2.3.1 POWER SOCKETS FOR PERIPHERALS ........................................2-5 2.3.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART ........................................................2-5 2.3.3 ACCESSORY CHECK ......................................................................2-6 2.3.4 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .........................................................2-9 Tapes and Retainers.............................................................................2-9 Developer and Toner Bottles ..............................................................2-11 Paper Trays ........................................................................................2-12 Emblem and Decals............................................................................2-13 Fax Settings for D037-17 ....................................................................2-13 Initialize the Developer........................................................................2-13

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Settings Relevant to the Service Contract ..........................................2-14 Settings for @Remote Service............................................................2-15 2.3.5 MOVING THE MACHINE ................................................................2-18 2.3.6 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE ..................................................2-19 Main Frame.........................................................................................2-19 2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331)......................................................................2-20 2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ....................................................................2-20 2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-20 2.5 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425)......................................................................2-23 2.5.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-23 2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-23 2.6 CASTER TABLE (D488)...........................................................................2-26 2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-26 2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-26 2.7 ARDF (D366) ............................................................................................2-28 2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-28 2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-28 2.8 PLATEN COVER INSTALLATION (G329) ...............................................2-32 2.9 SIDE TRAY (D427)...................................................................................2-33 2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-33 2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-33 2.10 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426) ...................................................................2-36 2.10.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-36 2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-36 2.11 SHIFT TRAY UNIT (D428)..................................................................2-39 2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-39 2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-39 2.12 INTERNAL FINISHER (D429).............................................................2-41 2.12.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-41 2.12.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-42 Preparing before Installing the Internal Finisher..................................2-42 Internal Finisher Installation ................................................................2-44 2.13 PUNCH UNIT (D390)..........................................................................2-47 2.13.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-47 2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-47 Removing the Internal Finisher ...........................................................2-48 Preparing the Punch Unit before Installing the Internal Finisher .........2-50

D037/D038/D040/D041

ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installing the Punch and Inverter Unit .................................................2-52 Preparing the Internal Finisher............................................................2-54 Installing the Internal Finisher .............................................................2-55 2.14 USB2.0/SD SLOT TYPE A .................................................................2-59 2.14.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ...............................................................2-59 2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-59 2.14.3 TESTING THE SD CARD/USB SLOT .......................................2-62 2.15 MECHANICAL COUNTER (NA ONLY)...............................................2-64 2.15.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-64 2.16 KEY COUNTER BRACKET ................................................................2-66 2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-66 2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT ...................................................2-68 2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-68 2.18 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT TYPE F (B829)..................................2-70 2.18.1 INSTALLATION .........................................................................2-70 User Tool Setting ................................................................................2-71 2.19 ANTI-CONDENSATION HEATER ......................................................2-72 2.19.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-72 2.20 TRAY HEATER (MAINFRAME) ..........................................................2-76 2.20.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-76 2.21 TRAY HEATERS (OPTIONAL UNIT)..................................................2-78 2.21.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-78 Tray Heater for D425 ..........................................................................2-78 Tray Heater for D331 ..........................................................................2-82 2.22 CONTROLLER OPTIONS ..................................................................2-86 2.22.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................2-86 I/F Card Slots ......................................................................................2-86 SD Card Slots .....................................................................................2-86 USB Slots ...........................................................................................2-87 2.22.2 SD CARD APPLI MOVE ............................................................2-87 Overview .............................................................................................2-87 Move Exec ..........................................................................................2-88 Undo Exec ..........................................................................................2-89 2.22.3 POSTSCRIPT 3 (D038/D041 ONLY).........................................2-89 2.22.4 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER (D038/D041 ONLY)....................2-90 2.22.5 IEEE1284 (D038/D041 ONLY)...................................................2-91 Installation Procedure .........................................................................2-91

SM

iii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

2.22.6 IEEE 802.11 A/G, G (WIRELESS LAN: D038/D041 ONLY) ......2-92 Installation Procedure .........................................................................2-92 UP Mode Settings for Wireless LAN ...................................................2-94 SP Mode and UP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g Wireless LAN2-95 2.22.7 BLUETOOTH (D038/D041 ONLY).............................................2-96 2.22.8 DATAOVERWRITESECURITY UNIT TYPE I (D362: D038/D041 ONLY) 2-97 Before You Begin the Procedure ........................................................2-97 Seal Check and Removal ...................................................................2-98 Installation Procedure .........................................................................2-98 2.22.9 HDD ENCRYPTION UNIT (D038/D041 ONLY) .......................2-100 Before You Begin the Procedure ......................................................2-100 Seal Check and Removal .................................................................2-101 Installation Procedure .......................................................................2-102 Recovery from a Device Problem .....................................................2-103 Restoring the Encryption key ............................................................2-103 Clearing the NVRAM.........................................................................2-104 2.22.10 PICTBRIDGE (D038/D041 ONLY) .......................................2-104 2.22.11 VM CARD TYPE I (D038/D041 ONLY) ................................2-105 Installation Procedure .......................................................................2-105 Firmware Update Procedure .............................................................2-106 2.22.12 BROWSER UNIT TYPE E (D038/D041 ONLY)....................2-107 Installation Procedure .......................................................................2-107 Update Procedure.............................................................................2-108 2.22.13 GIGABIT ETHERNET (D038/D041 ONLY) ..........................2-109 2.22.14 MEMORY UNIT TYPE I 512MB (D038/D041 ONLY) ...........2-110 2.22.15 CHECK ALL CONNECTIONS ..............................................2-111

PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE 3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE.................................................... 3-1 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES...........................................................................3-1 3.2 PM PARTS SETTINGS ..............................................................................3-2 3.2.1 BEFORE REMOVING THE OLD PM PARTS....................................3-2 3.2.2 AFTER INSTALLING THE NEW PM PARTS ....................................3-3 3.2.3 PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION CHECK..............................3-3 3.2.4 OPERATION CHECK........................................................................3-4 D037/D038/D040/D041

iv CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................ 4-1 4.1 BEFOREHAND...........................................................................................4-1 4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS .......................................................................................4-2 4.3 IMAGE ADJUSTMENT ...............................................................................4-3 4.3.1 SCANNING........................................................................................4-3 Scanner sub-scan magnification ...........................................................4-3 Scanner leading edge and side-to-side registration ..............................4-3 4.3.2 ARDF.................................................................................................4-4 ARDF side-to-side, leading edge registration and trailing edge ............4-4 ARDF sub-scan magnification...............................................................4-5 4.3.3 REGISTRATION................................................................................4-5 Image Area ...........................................................................................4-5 Leading Edge........................................................................................4-6 Side to Side...........................................................................................4-6 Adjustment Standard ............................................................................4-6 Paper Registration Standard.................................................................4-6 Adjustment Procedure ..........................................................................4-6 4.3.4 ERASE MARGIN ADJUSTMENT ......................................................4-6 4.3.5 COLOR REGISTRATION ..................................................................4-7 Line Position Adjustment ......................................................................4-7 4.3.6 PRINTER GAMMA CORRECTION ...................................................4-8 Copy Mode ...........................................................................................4-8 Printer Mode .......................................................................................4-13 4.4 EXTERIOR COVERS ...............................................................................4-15 4.4.1 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE ..........................................4-15 4.4.2 FRONT DOOR ................................................................................4-15 4.4.3 ITB CLEANING UNIT COVER.........................................................4-16 4.4.4 LEFT COVER ..................................................................................4-17 4.4.5 REAR COVER.................................................................................4-17 4.4.6 REAR LOWER COVER...................................................................4-18 4.4.7 DUST FILTER .................................................................................4-18 4.4.8 RIGHT REAR COVER.....................................................................4-18 4.4.9 OPERATION PANEL.......................................................................4-19 For D038/D041 ...................................................................................4-19 SM

v CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

For D037/D040 ...................................................................................4-20 4.4.10 TOUCH PANEL POSITION ADJUSTMENT (D038/D041) .........4-20 4.4.11 INNER RIGHT COVER ..............................................................4-21 4.4.12 INNER COVER ..........................................................................4-21 4.4.13 FRONT RIGHT COVER.............................................................4-22 4.4.14 RIGHT UPPER COVER.............................................................4-22 4.4.15 LEFT FRAME AND LEFT FRAME REAR COVER ....................4-23 4.4.16 PAPER EXIT COVER ................................................................4-23 4.4.17 INVERTER TRAY ......................................................................4-24 4.4.18 INNER TRAY .............................................................................4-24 4.4.19 INNER REAR COVER ...............................................................4-24 4.5 SCANNER UNIT.......................................................................................4-26 4.5.1 EXPOSURE GLASS........................................................................4-26 4.5.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS .....................................................4-27 4.5.3 EXPOSURE LAMP..........................................................................4-28 Reassembling .....................................................................................4-30 4.5.4 SCANNER MOTOR.........................................................................4-30 4.5.5 SENSOR BOARD UNIT (SBU)........................................................4-31 When reassembling ............................................................................4-32 4.5.6 EXPOSURE LAMP STABILIZER ....................................................4-32 4.5.7 SCANNER HP SENSOR .................................................................4-32 4.5.8 PLATEN COVER SENSOR.............................................................4-33 4.5.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE ...............................................................4-34 Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire ...................................................4-36 4.5.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE ............................................................4-38 Reinstalling the Rear Scanner Wire ....................................................4-38 4.6 LASER OPTICS .......................................................................................4-40 4.6.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATION ........................................................4-40 4.6.2 LASER UNIT ...................................................................................4-40 Preparing a new laser unit ..................................................................4-41 Before removing the old laser unit ......................................................4-41 Recovery procedure for no replacement preparation of laser unit ......4-42 Removing the laser unit ......................................................................4-43 After installing a new laser unit ...........................................................4-44 4.6.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR .........................................................4-45 4.7 IMAGE CREATION...................................................................................4-47 4.7.1 PCDU (PHOTO CONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT) ........4-47

D037/D038/D040/D041

vi CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

When installing a new PCDU ..............................................................4-47 4.7.2 DRUM UNIT AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT.......................................4-48 New unit detection for the development unit .......................................4-50 4.7.3 TONER HOPPER UNIT ..................................................................4-50 Toner hopper unit: K, C, M..................................................................4-50 Toner hopper unit: Y ...........................................................................4-51 When installing a new toner hopper unit .............................................4-52 4.7.4 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR...............................................................4-52 4.7.5 TONER COLLECTION MOTOR......................................................4-54 4.7.6 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR ................4-56 4.7.7 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE SET SWITCH ...................4-56 4.7.8 RFID BOARD ..................................................................................4-57 4.8 IMAGE TRANSFER..................................................................................4-58 4.8.1 ITB CLEANING UNIT ......................................................................4-58 When installing the ITB cleaning unit ..................................................4-58 4.8.2 ITB TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR.....................4-58 4.8.3 ITB (IMAGE TRANSFER BELT) UNIT ............................................4-59 4.8.4 ITB UNIT MOTOR ...........................................................................4-60 4.8.5 IMAGE TRANSFER BELT...............................................................4-60 When reinstalling a new image transfer belt .......................................4-64 4.8.6 ITB CONTACT MOTOR ..................................................................4-64 4.8.7 ITB CONTACT SENSOR.................................................................4-65 4.9 PAPER TRANSFER .................................................................................4-67 4.9.1 PTR (PAPER TRANSFER ROLLER) UNIT .....................................4-67 4.9.2 OPENING THE PAPER TRANSFER UNIT .....................................4-68 4.9.3 ID SENSOR BOARD .......................................................................4-68 Cleaning for ID sensors ......................................................................4-69 After installing a new ID sensor unit/board..........................................4-70 4.9.4 TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR...................................4-70 4.10 DRIVE UNIT........................................................................................4-72 4.10.1 GEAR UNIT ...............................................................................4-72 Adjustment after reinstalling the gear unit ...........................................4-73 4.10.2 REGISTRATION MOTOR..........................................................4-74 4.10.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T1........................................................4-74 4.10.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T2........................................................4-75 4.10.5 DRUM MOTOR: CMY................................................................4-75 4.10.6 DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: CMY................................................4-76

SM

vii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

4.10.7 DRUM/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: K .........................................4-76 4.10.8 DEVELOPMENT CLUTCH: K ....................................................4-77 4.10.9 FUSING/PAPER EXIT MOTOR .................................................4-77 4.11 FUSING ..............................................................................................4-80 4.11.1 PM PARTS.................................................................................4-80 4.11.2 FUSING UNIT ............................................................................4-80 When installing the fusing unit ............................................................4-81 4.11.3 ENTRANCE GUIDE PLATE.......................................................4-81 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-81 4.11.4 STRIPPER PLATE.....................................................................4-82 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-83 4.11.5 EXIT GUIDE PLATE CLEANING PROCEDURE .......................4-84 4.11.6 PRESSURE ROLLER FUSING LAMP.......................................4-84 4.11.7 HEATING ROLLER FUSING LAMP ..........................................4-86 4.11.8 FUSING BELT ...........................................................................4-87 4.11.9 HEATING, FUSING AND TENSION ROLLER...........................4-90 When reinstalling the fusing roller .......................................................4-91 4.11.10 PRESSURE ROLLER ............................................................4-91 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-93 4.11.11 HEATING ROLLER THERMOSTATS ....................................4-93 4.11.12 HEATING ROLLER THERMISTOR .......................................4-93 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-94 4.11.13 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMISTOR....................................4-94 Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center ....................................................4-94 Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center ....................................................4-95 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-96 4.11.14 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMOSTAT...................................4-96 4.11.15 THERMOPILE ........................................................................4-96 When cleaning the lens of the thermopile ...........................................4-97 4.11.16 CLEANING UNIT (OPTION) INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 4-98 4.12 PAPER FEED ...................................................................................4-100 4.12.1 PAPER TRAY ..........................................................................4-100 4.12.2 FEED ROLLER ........................................................................4-100 Tray 1 and Tray 2..............................................................................4-100 When reinstalling the feed roller........................................................4-100 4.12.3 FRICTION PAD........................................................................4-100 When reinstalling the friction pad ......................................................4-101

D037/D038/D040/D041

viii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

4.12.4 PAPER SIZE SWITCH.............................................................4-102 4.12.5 PAPER END SENSOR ............................................................4-102 Paper End Sensor: T1 ......................................................................4-102 Paper End Sensor: T2 ......................................................................4-103 4.12.6 REGISTRATION SENSOR ......................................................4-103 Cleaning the registration roller ..........................................................4-104 4.12.7 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR ........................................4-105 Vertical Transport Sensor 1 ..............................................................4-105 Vertical Transport Sensor 2 ..............................................................4-106 4.13 PAPER EXIT.....................................................................................4-108 4.13.1 JUNCTION GATE SOLENOID FAN ........................................4-108 When installing the junction gate solenoid fan ..................................4-108 4.13.2 PAPER EXIT UNIT ..................................................................4-108 4.13.3 FUSING EXIT ..........................................................................4-109 4.13.4 PAPER EXIT SENSOR............................................................4-110 When installing the paper exit sensor ...............................................4-111 4.13.5 INVERTER SENSOR...............................................................4-111 4.13.6 INVERTER MOTOR ................................................................4-112 4.13.7 FUSING FRONT FAN ..............................................................4-113 When installing the fusing front fan ...................................................4-113 4.14 DUPLEX UNIT ..................................................................................4-114 4.14.1 DUPLEX UNIT .........................................................................4-114 4.14.2 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR..............................................4-115 4.14.3 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR..........................................................4-116 4.14.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE MOTOR................................................4-117 4.14.5 DUPLEX EXIT MOTOR ...........................................................4-118 4.14.6 BY-PASS MOTOR ...................................................................4-119 4.14.7 BY-PASS TRAY UNIT .............................................................4-120 4.14.8 BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH SENSOR.....................................4-120 4.14.9 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR ...........................................4-121 When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor..............................4-122 4.14.10 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR ........................................4-123 Reinstalling the By-pass Paper End Sensor .....................................4-123 4.14.11 BY-PASS FEED ROLLER ....................................................4-123 4.14.12 BY-PASS TRAY HP SENSOR .............................................4-123 4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS .........................................................4-125 4.15.1 BOARDS..................................................................................4-125

SM

ix CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

4.15.2 CONTROLLER BOX COVER ..................................................4-126 4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOX................................................................4-126 Opening the controller box ................................................................4-126 4.15.4 BCU .........................................................................................4-127 When installing the new BCU............................................................4-128 4.15.5 HDD (ONLY FOR D038/D041) ................................................4-128 4.15.6 CONTROLLER BOX FAN........................................................4-129 When installing the controller box fan ...............................................4-130 4.15.7 FUSING REAR FAN ................................................................4-130 When installing the fusing rear fan....................................................4-131 4.15.8 PSU .........................................................................................4-131 4.15.9 HVPS: TTS BOARD.................................................................4-132 4.15.10 HVPS: CB BOARD ...............................................................4-132 4.15.11 I-CONTROLLER BOARD .....................................................4-133 When installing the new controller board ..........................................4-135 When installing a new HDD unit........................................................4-135 Disposal of HDD Units ......................................................................4-136 Reinstallation ....................................................................................4-136 4.15.12 NVRAM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.............................4-136 NVRAM on the BCU .........................................................................4-136 NVRAM on the Controller .................................................................4-137 4.16 MACHINE BOOT-UP ........................................................................4-138

SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE 5. SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE .................................... 5-1 5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE.....................................................................5-1 5.1.1 SP TABLES .......................................................................................5-1 5.1.2 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 H-MODEL (D038/D041) ...........5-1 SP Mode Button Summary ...................................................................5-2 Switching Between SP Mode and Copy Mode for Test Printing............5-3 Selecting the Program Number.............................................................5-3 Service Mode Lock/Unlock ...................................................................5-4 5.1.3 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 L-MODEL (D037/D040)............5-4 Selecting Programs...............................................................................5-5 Specifying Values .................................................................................5-5 Activating Copy Mode ...........................................................................5-5 D037/D038/D040/D041

x CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Quitting Programs/Ending SP Mode .....................................................5-5 5.1.4 REMARKS.........................................................................................5-6 Display on the Control Panel Screen ....................................................5-6 Others ...................................................................................................5-6 5.2 FIRMWARE UPDATE.................................................................................5-8 5.2.1 TYPE OF FIRMWARE.......................................................................5-8 H-Model (D038/D041)...........................................................................5-8 L-Model (D037/D040) ...........................................................................5-9 5.2.2 BEFORE YOU BEGIN.....................................................................5-10 5.2.3 UPDATING FIRMWARE .................................................................5-11 Preparation .........................................................................................5-11 Updating Procedure ............................................................................5-11 Error Messages...................................................................................5-12 Firmware Update Error .......................................................................5-12 Recovery after Power Loss .................................................................5-13 5.2.4 UPDATING THE LCDC FOR THE OPERATION PANEL................5-13 5.2.5 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS..................................5-14 Error Message Table ..........................................................................5-14 5.3 INSTALLING ANOTHER LANGUAGE .....................................................5-16 5.4 REBOOT/SYSTEM SETTING RESET .....................................................5-19 5.4.1 SOFTWARE RESET .......................................................................5-19 5.4.2 SYSTEM SETTINGS AND COPY SETTING RESET......................5-19 System Setting Reset .........................................................................5-19 Copier Setting Reset...........................................................................5-19 5.5 CONTROLLER SELF-DIAGNOSTICS .....................................................5-21 5.5.1 OVERVIEW .....................................................................................5-21 5.6 SD CARD APPLI MOVE...........................................................................5-22 5.6.1 OVERVIEW .....................................................................................5-22 5.6.2 MOVE EXEC ...................................................................................5-23 5.6.3 UNDO EXEC ...................................................................................5-23 5.7 DOWNLOADING STAMP DATA ..............................................................5-25 5.8 NVRAM DATA UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD ....................................................5-26 5.8.1 UPLOADING CONTENT OF NVRAM TO AN SD CARD ................5-26 5.8.2 DOWNLOADING AN SD CARD TO NVRAM ..................................5-26 5.9 ADDRESS BOOK UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD ...............................................5-28 5.9.1 INFORMATION LIST.......................................................................5-28 5.9.2 DOWNLOAD ...................................................................................5-28

SM

xi CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

5.9.3 UPLOAD..........................................................................................5-29 5.10 USING THE DEBUG LOG ..................................................................5-30 5.10.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................5-30 5.10.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG ........5-30 5.10.3 RETRIEVING THE DEBUG LOG FROM THE HDD ..................5-34 5.10.4 RECORDING ERRORS MANUALLY ........................................5-34 5.11 CARD SAVE FUNCTION....................................................................5-36 5.11.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................5-36 Card Save: ..........................................................................................5-36 5.11.2 PROCEDURE ............................................................................5-36 For D038/D041 ...................................................................................5-36 For D037/D040 ...................................................................................5-39 Error Messages...................................................................................5-41 5.11.3 ERROR MESSAGES .................................................................5-41

TROUBLESHOOTING 6. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................. 6-1 6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS ..................................................................6-1 6.2 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS ..........................................6-2 6.3 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE ...................................................................6-3 6.3.1 SUB-SCAN MAGNIFICATION ERROR.............................................6-3 Sub-scan Magnification Adjustment Procedure ....................................6-3 Motor Speed Adjustment ......................................................................6-4 6.3.2 TRAPEZOID IMAGE ADJUSTMENT ................................................6-6 Before Adjusting the Trapezoid Image..................................................6-6 Adjusting the Trapezoid Image .............................................................6-7 6.4 JAM DETECTION.....................................................................................6-10 6.5 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS..................................................6-11 6.6 SCANNER TEST MODE ..........................................................................6-12 6.6.1 SBU TEST MODE ...........................................................................6-12 6.6.2 IPU TEST MODE.............................................................................6-12 SP4-904-1 Register Access ................................................................6-12 SP4-904-2 Image Path .......................................................................6-12

D037/D038/D040/D041

xii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041 APPENDICES SEE APPENDIX SECTION FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D331 PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 SEE SECTION D331 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D366 ARDF DF3030 SEE SECTION D366 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D388 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040 SEE SECTION D388 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D425 PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070 SEE SECTION D425 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D426 1 BIN TRAY BN3060 SEE SECTION D426 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D427 SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550 SEE SECTION D427 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D428 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030 SEE SECTION D428 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

SM

xiii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429 INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550 SEE SECTION D429 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D432/D433 FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530 SEE SECTION D432/D433 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS

D037/D038/D040/D041

xiv CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Read This First Important Safety Notices Responsibilities of the Customer Engineer Customer Engineer Maintenance shall be done only by trained customer engineers who have completed service training for the machine and all optional devices designed for use with the machine. Reference Material for Maintenance ƒ

Maintenance shall be done using the special tools and procedures prescribed for maintenance of the machine described in the reference materials (service manuals, technical bulletins, operating instructions, and safety guidelines for customer engineers).

ƒ

In regard to other safety issues not described in this document, all customer engineers shall strictly obey procedures and recommendations described the "CE Safety Guide".

ƒ

Use only consumable supplies and replacement parts designed for use of the machine.

Before Installation, Maintenance Shipping and Moving the Machine ƒ

Work carefully when lifting or moving the machine. If the machine is heavy, two or more customer engineers may be required to prevent injuries (muscle strains, spinal injuries, etc.) or damage to the machine if it is dropped or tipped over.

ƒ

Personnel moving or working around the machine should always wear proper clothing and footwear. Never wear loose fitting clothing or accessories (neckties, loose sweaters, bracelets, etc. ) or casual footwear (slippers, sandals, etc.) when lifting or moving the machine.

ƒ

Always unplug the power cord from the power source before you move the product. Before you move the product, arrange the power cord so it will not fall under the product.

Power ƒ

Always disconnect the power plug before doing any maintenance procedure. After switching off the machine, power is still supplied to the main machine and other

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

devices. To prevent electrical shock, switch the machine off, wait for a few seconds, then unplug the machine from the power source. ƒ

Before you do any checks or adjustments after turning the machine off, work carefully to avoid injury. After removing covers or opening the machine to do checks or adjustments, never touch electrical components or moving parts (gears, timing belts, etc.).

ƒ

After turning the machine on with any cover removed, keep your hands away from electrical components and moving parts. Never touch the cover of the fusing unit, gears, timing belts, etc.

Installation, Disassembly, and Adjustments ƒ

After installation, maintenance, or adjustment, always check the operation of the machine to make sure that it is operating normally. This ensures that all shipping materials, protective materials, wires and tags, metal brackets, etc., removed for installation, have been removed and that no tools remain inside the machine. This also ensures that all release interlock switches have been restored to normal operation.

ƒ

Never use your fingers to check moving parts causing spurious noise. Never use your fingers to lubricate moving parts while the machine is operating.

Special Tools ƒ

Use only standard tools approved for machine maintenance.

ƒ

For special adjustments, use only the special tools and lubricants described in the service manual. Using tools incorrectly, or using tools that could damage parts, could damage the machine or cause injuries.

During Maintenance General ƒ

Before you begin a maintenance procedure: 1) Switch the machine off, 2) Disconnect the power plug from the power source, 3) Allow the machine to cool for at least 10 minutes.

ƒ

Avoid touching the components inside the machine that are labeled as hot surfaces.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Safety Devices ƒ

Never remove any safety device unless it requires replacement. Always replace safety devices immediately.

ƒ

Never do any procedure that defeats the function of any safety device. Modification or removal of a safety device (fuse, switch, etc.) could lead to a fire and personal injury. Always test the operation of the machine to ensure that it is operating normally and safely after removal and replacement of any safety device.

ƒ

For replacements use only the correct fuses or circuit breakers rated for use with the machine. Using replacement devices not designed for use with the machine could lead to a fire and personal injuries.

Organic Cleaners ƒ

During preventive maintenance, never use any organic cleaners (alcohol, etc.) other than those described in the service manual.

ƒ

Make sure the room is well ventilated before using any organic cleaner. Use organic solvents in small amounts to avoid breathing the fumes and becoming nauseous.

ƒ

Switch the machine off, unplug it, and allow it to cool before doing preventive maintenance. To avoid fire or explosion, never use an organic cleaner near any part that generates heat.

ƒ

Wash your hands thoroughly after cleaning parts with an organic cleaner to contamination of food, drinks, etc. which could cause illness.

ƒ

Clean the floor completely after accidental spillage of silicone oil or other materials to prevent slippery surfaces that could cause accidents leading to hand or leg injuries. Use "My Ace" Silicone Oil Remover (or dry rags) to soak up spills. For more details, please refer to Technical Bulletin "Silicone Oil Removal" (A024-50).

Lithium Batteries ƒ

Always replace a lithium battery on a PCB with the same type of battery prescribed for use on that board. Replacing a lithium battery with any type other than the one prescribed for use on the board could lead to an explosion or damage to the PCB.

ƒ

Never discard used batteries by mixing them with other trash. Remove them from the work site and dispose of them in accordance with local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Ozone Filters ƒ

Always replace ozone filters as soon as their service life expires (as described in the service manual).

ƒ

An excessive amount of ozone can build up around machines that use ozone filters if they are not replaced at the prescribed time. Excessive ozone could cause personnel working around the machine to feel unwell.

Power Plug and Power Cord ƒ

Before serving the machine (especially when responding to a service call), always make sure that the power plug has been inserted completely into the power source. A partially inserted plug could lead to heat generation (due to a power surge caused by high resistance) and cause a fire or other problems.

ƒ

Always check the power plug and make sure that it is free of dust and lint. Clean it if necessary. A dirty plug can generate heat which could cause a fire.

ƒ

Inspect the length of the power cord for cuts or other damage. Replace the power cord if necessary. A frayed or otherwise damaged power cord can cause a short circuit which could lead to a fire or personal injury from electrical shock.

ƒ

Check the length of the power cord between the machine and power supply. Make sure the power cord is not coiled or wrapped around any object such as a table leg. Coiling the power cord can cause excessive heat to build up and could cause a fire.

ƒ

Make sure that the area around the power source is free of obstacles so the power cord can be removed quickly in case of an emergency.

ƒ

Make sure that the power cord is grounded (earthed) at the power source with the ground wire on the plug.

ƒ

Connect the power cord directly into the power source. Never use an extension cord.

ƒ

When you disconnect the power plug from the power source, always pull on the plug, not the cable.

After Installation, Servicing Disposal of Used Items ƒ

Never incinerate used toner or toner cartridges.

ƒ

Toner or toner cartridges thrown into a fire can ignite or explode and cause serious

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

injury. At the work site always carefully wrap used toner and toner cartridges with plastic bags to avoid spillage before disposal or removal. ƒ

Always dispose of used items (developer, toner, toner cartridges, OPC drums, etc.) in accordance with the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.

ƒ

To protect the environment, never dispose of this product or any kind of waste from consumables at a household waste collection point. Dispose of these items at one of our dealers or at an authorized collection site.

ƒ

Return used selenium drums to the service center for handling in accordance with company policy regarding the recycling or disposal of such items.

Points to Confirm with Operators At the end of installation or a service call, instruct the user about use of the machine. Emphasize the following points. ƒ

Show operators how to remove jammed paper and troubleshoot other minor problems by following the procedures described in the operating instructions.

ƒ

Point out the parts inside the machine that they should never touch or attempt to remove.

ƒ

Confirm that operators know how to store and dispose of consumables.

ƒ

Make sure that all operators have access to an operating instruction manual for the machine.

ƒ

Confirm that operators have read and understand all the safety instructions described in the operating instructions.

ƒ

Demonstrate how to turn off the power and disconnect the power plug (by pulling the plug, not the cord) if any of the following events occur: 1) something has spilled into the product, 2) service or repair of the product is necessary, 3) the product cover has been damaged.

ƒ

Caution operators about removing paper fasteners around the machine. They should never allow paper clips, staples, or any other small metallic objects to fall into the machine.

Special Safety Instructions for Toner Accidental Physical Exposure ƒ

Work carefully when removing paper jams or replacing toner bottles or cartridges to avoid spilling toner on clothing or the hands.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

ƒ

If toner is inhaled, immediately gargle with large amounts of cold water and move to a well ventilated location. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.

ƒ

If toner gets on the skin, wash immediately with soap and cold running water.

ƒ

If toner gets into the eyes, flush the eyes with cold running water or eye wash. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.

ƒ

If toner is swallowed, drink a large amount of cold water to dilute the ingested toner. If there are signs of any problem, seek medical attention.

ƒ

If toner spills on clothing, wash the affected area immediately with soap and cold water. Never use hot water! Hot water can cause toner to set and permanently stain fabric.

Handling and Storing Toner ƒ

Toner, used toner, and developer are extremely flammable.

ƒ

Never store toner, developer, toner cartridges, or toner bottles (including empty toner bottles or cartridges) in a location where they will be exposed to high temperature or an open flame.

ƒ

Always store toner and developer supplies such as toner and developer packages, cartridges, and bottles (including used toner and empty bottles and cartridges) out of the reach of children.

ƒ

Always store fresh toner supplies or empty bottles or cartridges in a cool, dry location that is not exposed to direct sunlight.

Toner Disposal ƒ

Never attempt to incinerate toner, used toner, or empty toner containers (bottles or cartridges). Burning toner can explode and scatter, causing serious burns.

ƒ

Always wrap used toner and empty toner bottles and cartridges in plastic bags to avoid spillage. Follow the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.

ƒ

Dispose of used toner and toner cartridges at one of our dealers or at an authorized collection site. Always dispose of used toner cartridges and toner bottles in accordance with the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Safety Instructions for this Machine Prevention of Physical Injury 1.

Before disassembling or assembling parts of the machine and peripherals, make sure that the machine and peripheral power cords are unplugged.

2.

The plug should be near the machine and easily accessible.

3.

Note that some components of the machine and the paper tray unit are supplied with electrical voltage even if the main power switch is turned off.

4.

If any adjustment or operation check has to be made with exterior covers off or open while the main switch is turned on, keep hands away from electrified or mechanically driven components.

5.

If the [Start] key is pressed before the machine completes the warm-up period (the [Start] key starts blinking red and green ), keep hands away from the mechanical and the electrical components as the machine starts making copies as soon as the warm-up period is completed.

6.

The inside and the metal parts of the fusing unit become extremely hot while the machine is operating. Be careful to avoid touching those components with your bare hands.

7.

To prevent a fire or explosion, keep the machine away from flammable liquids, gases, and aerosols.

Health Safety Conditions 1.

Never operate the machine without the ozone filters installed.

2.

Always replace the ozone filters with the specified types at the proper intervals.

3.

Toner and developer are non-toxic, but if you get either of them in your eyes by accident, it may cause temporary eye discomfort. Try to remove with eye drops or flush with water as first aid. If unsuccessful, get medical attention.

Observance of Electrical Safety Standards 1.

The machine and its peripherals must be installed and maintained by a customer service representative who has completed the training course on those models.

2.

The NVRAM on the system control board has a lithium battery which can explode if replaced incorrectly. Replace the NVRAM only with an identical one. The manufacturer recommends replacing the entire NVRAM. Do not recharge or burn this battery. Used NVRAM must be handled in accordance with local regulations.

Safety and Ecological Notes for Disposal 1.

Do not incinerate toner bottles or used toner. Toner dust may ignite suddenly when exposed to an open flame.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

2.

Dispose of used toner, developer, and organic photoconductors in accordance with local regulations. (These are non-toxic supplies.)

3.

Dispose of replaced parts in accordance with local regulations.

4.

When keeping used lithium batteries in order to dispose of them later, do not put more than 100 batteries per sealed box. Storing larger numbers or not sealing them apart may lead to chemical reactions and heat build-up. ƒ

The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this type is incorrectly replaced.

ƒ

Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Discard used batteries in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions.

Laser Safety The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical units in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the requisite equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer Engineer. The laser chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required. ƒ

Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual may result in hazardous radiation exposure.

ƒ

WARNING: Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Optics Housing Unit section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.

ƒ

CAUTION MARKING:

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Symbols, Abbreviations and Trademarks This manual uses several symbols and abbreviations. The meaning of those symbols and abbreviations are as follows:

See or Refer to



Clip ring



Screw

Connector

=

Clamp



E-ring

SEF

Short Edge Feed

LEF

Long Edge Feed

Trademarks Microsoft®, Windows®, and MS-DOS® are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and /or other countries. PostScript® is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated. PCL® is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company. Ethernet® is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation. PowerPC® is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation. Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE APPENDIX: PM TABLES

TAB POSITION 2 TAB POSITION 5

TROUBLESHOOTING APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE

D426 1 BIN TRAY BN3060 D427 SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550

APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES D388 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040 D428 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

TAB POSITION 8

APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION

TAB POSITION 7

SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS

TAB POSITION 6

REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS D429 INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550

TAB POSITION 3

INSTALLATION APPENDIX: OVERVIEW D331 PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 D425 PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070

TAB POSITION 4

PRODUCT INFORMATION APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS D366 ARDF DF3030 D432/D433 FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530

TAB POSITION 1

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PRODUCT INFORMATION

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Product Information

Specifications

1. PRODUCT INFORMATION 1.1 SPECIFICATIONS See "Appendices" for the following information: ƒ

Mainframe Specifications

ƒ

Printer Specifications

ƒ

Scanner Specifications

ƒ

Supported Paper Sizes

ƒ

Software Accessories

ƒ

Optional Equipment

SM

1-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Machine Configuration

1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION There are two grades for this machine. ƒ

L-Model: This is a light model. Expansion functions and options are limited.

ƒ

H-Model: This is a high grade model. Various expansion functions and options can be used.

1.2.1 H-MODEL

Machine

Call

Code

out

D038/D041

[1]

D038, D041

Platen cover

G329

[2]

One from the two;

ARDF

D366

[3]

Side tray

D427

[4]

Item

Mainframe

D037/D038/D040/D041

Remarks

[3] is standard. -

1-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Machine

Call

Code

out

1-bin tray

D426

[11]

Shift tray

D388

[10]

Internal finisher

D492

[9]

Item

Remarks

One of the following 4 choices: [9] only, [10] only,

Punch unit: 2/3 holes Punch unit: 2 holes Punch unit: 4 holes

D390-17

D390-27

Requires [9].

[8]

D390-31

Two-tray paper feed unit

D331

[11] only, or [10]+[11]

Requires [9].

Requires [9].

[5]

One from [5], [6], and [7]; The one-tray PFU [6] requires [7].

One-tray paper feed unit

D425

[6]

If neither [5] nor [6] is installed, install [7] if required by the customer.

Caster Table

Item

D448

[7]

Machine code

USB2.0/SD Slot

D422

Fax Option

D432

Memory Unit Type B

G578

Hand Set

B433

Gigabit Ethernet

G874

IEEE 1284

B679

SM

Remark -

SAF memory: Requires the Fax Option. For NA model only: Requires the Fax Option. You can only install one of these at a time.

1-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Product Information

Machine Configuration

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Machine Configuration Wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11a/g) Wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11g) Bluetooth File Format Converter Copy Data Security Unit

D377-01, 02

D377-19

B826 D377-04 B829

-

B870

-

Key Counter Bracket

A674

-

Memory Unit Type I

D435-01

Optional Counter Interface Unit

Printer Enhanced Option

PostScript 3

(For printer function)

D435-03, -04, -05 D435-09, -10, -11

You can only install one of these in SD slot 1 at a time

Data Overwrite Security Unit

D362

PictBridge

M344

VM Card

D430-01, 02, 03

Browser Unit

D430-05, 06, 07

HDD Encryption Unit

D037/D038/D040/D041

In SD card slot 2

D377-16

1-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Product Information

Machine Configuration

1.2.2 L-MODEL

Machine

Call

Code

out

D037/D040

[1]

D037, D040

Platen cover

G329

[2]

One from the two;

ARDF

D366

[3]

Side tray

D427

[4]

-

1-bin tray

D426

[8]

-

D331

[5]

Item

Mainframe

Two-tray paper feed unit

Remarks

[3] is standard for NA and EU

One from [5], [6], and [7]; The one-tray PFU [6] requires [7].

One-tray paper feed unit Caster Table

SM

D425

[6]

If neither [5] nor [6] is installed, install [7] if required by the customer.

D448

[7]

1-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Machine Configuration

Item

Machine code

Remark

Fax Option

D433

Hand Set

B433

Copy Data Security Unit

B829

-

B870

-

Optional Counter Interface Unit

Printer Enhanced Option

For NA model only: Requires the Fax Option.

D435-03, -04, You can only install one of

-05

these in SD slot 1 at a time PictBridge

D037/D038/D040/D041

M344

1-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Product Information

Overview

1.3 OVERVIEW For "Overview" information, see "Appendices".

SM

1-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

INSTALLATION

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installation Requirements

2. INSTALLATION

Installaion

2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS 2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT

1.

Temperature Range: 10°C to 32°C (50°F to 89.6°F)

2.

Humidity Range: 15% to 80% RH

3.

Ambient Illumination: Less than 1500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight)

4.

Ventilation: 3 times/hr/person or more

5.

Do not let the machine get exposed to the following: 1) Cool air from an air conditioner 2) Heat from a heater

6.

Do not install the machine in areas that are exposed to corrosive gas.

7.

Install the machine at locations lower than 2,500 m (8,200 ft.) above sea level.

8.

Install the machine on a strong, level base. (Inclination on any side must be no more than 5 mm.)

9.

Do not install the machine in areas that get strong vibrations.

2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL Front to back: Within 5 mm (0.2") Right to left: Within 5 mm (0.2")

SM

2-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installation Requirements

2.1.3 MACHINE SPACE REQUIREMENTS ƒ

This machine, which uses high voltage power sources, can generate ozone gas. High ozone density is harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a well-ventilated room.

A: Over 100 mm (3.9") B: Over 100 mm (3.9") C: Over 100 mm (3.9") D: Over 100 mm (3.9") Put the machine near the power source with the clearance shown above.

2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS

1.

ƒ

Insert the plug firmly in the outlet.

ƒ

Do not use an outlet extension plug or cord.

ƒ

Ground the machine.

Input voltage level: ƒ

120 V, 60 Hz: More than 12 A

ƒ

220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz: More than 8 A

2.

Permissible voltage fluctuation: ±10 %

3.

Do not put things on the power cord.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Optional Unit Combinations

2.2 OPTIONAL UNIT COMBINATIONS

Options No.

Remarks D037/D040

D038/D041

1

2-tray paper feed unit

2-tray paper feed unit

2

1-tray paper feed unit

1-tray paper feed unit

3

Caster table

Caster table

4

Platen cover

Platen cover

One from No.1 or No.2 (No. 2 requires No. 3)

One from No.4 or No.5 5

ARDF

ARDF (Standard)

6

1-bin tray unit

1-bin tray unit

7

-

Shift tray

If No 9 is installed, then No 6 and/or No 7 cannot

8

Side Tray

Side Tray

9

-

Internal finisher

10

-

*Punch kit (4 types)

11

Fax unit

Fax unit

-

12

-

Memory Unit (32M)*

Fax unit required

be installed.

No. 9 required; One of the types

*: Child options (Child options require a parent option.)

2.2.2 CONTROLLER OPTIONS

Options No.

Remarks D037/D040

SM

D038/D041

2-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

2.2.1 MACHINE OPTIONS

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Optional Unit Combinations 1

-

IEEE 802.11a/g

2

-

IEEE 1284

3

-

Bluetooth

4

-

File Format Converter

5

-

Gigabit Ethernet

6

-

PostScript 3

One from six items (I/F

7

Slot)

Printer Enhanced

-

Option

One of these (SD card slot 1)

8

PictBridge

PictBridge

9

-

DataOverwriteSecurity Unit

10

-

HDD Encryption Unit

11

-

Browser Unit

12

-

VM Card

SD card slot 2

13

Copy Data Security Unit

Copy Data Security Unit

-

14

-

Memory Unit (512M)

For SDK applications

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SD card slot 2 (during installation only) SD card slot 2 (during installation only)

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation

2.3 COPIER INSTALLATION

Installaion

2.3.1 POWER SOCKETS FOR PERIPHERALS

CAUTION Rating voltage for peripherals. Make sure to plug the cables into the correct sockets.

[1] ARDF: Rating voltage output connector for accessory Max. DC24V

[2] Finisher: Rating voltage output connector for accessory Max. DC24V

SM

2-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation

2.3.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART This flow chart shows the best procedure for installation.

*1: The shift tray should be installed first if you want to install the shift tray with the 1-bin tray at the same time.

2.3.3 ACCESSORY CHECK Check the quantity and condition of these accessories. For D037/D040 No.

Description

Q’ty

1.

Stamp

1

2.

EU Safety Sheet

1

Destination -17, -67

-67 3.

WEEE

D037/D038/D040/D041

1

2-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation No. 4.

Description

Q’ty

Certification

Destination

1

5.

Warranty Sheet (Chinese)

1

6.

Operating Instruction – About this machine

1

7.

Operating Instruction – Troubleshooting

1

8.

Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Copy Guide

1

9.

Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Fax Guide

1

10. Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Printer Guide

1

11. Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Scanner Guide

1

Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Printer &

1

12.

Scanner Guide

-17, -29, -21, -19

-17, -67, -29, -21, -19

-67, -29, -21, -19 -17, -67, -29, -21, -19, -28

13. Operating Instruction – Manual for This Machine

1 -67

14. Operating Instruction – Safety Information

1

15. CD-ROM Instruction – About this machine

1

16. CD-ROM Instruction – Troubleshooting

1

17. CD-ROM Instruction –Copy/Document Server Reference

1

18. CD-ROM Instruction –Facsimile Reference

1

19. CD-ROM Instruction –Printer Reference

1

20. CD-ROM Instruction –Scanner Reference

1

21. CD-ROM Instruction – Printer & Scanner Reference

1

22. CD-ROM Instruction – Network & General Setting Guide

1

23. CD-ROM Instruction – Security Reference

1

24. Printer Driver CD-ROM

1

-29, 28

25. Scanner Driver & Utility CD-ROM

1

-17, -67, -29

-17, -67, -29,

SM

2-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

-21, -19

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

-21

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation No.

Description

Q’ty

26. Clear Cover

Destination

1

For D038/D041

No.

Description

Q’ty

1.

Stamp

1

2.

EU Safety Sheet

1

Destination -57, -67

-67 3.

WEEE

1

4.

Certification

1 -21

5.

Warranty Sheet (Chinese)

1

6.

Operating Instruction – About this machine

1

7.

Operating Instruction – Troubleshooting

1

8.

Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Copy Guide

9.

Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Printer Guide

1

-57, -29, -21, -19 -67, -29, -21, -19

1

10. Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Scanner Guide

1

11. Operating Instruction – Manual for This Machine

1

-57, -67, -29, -21, -19

-67 12. Operating Instruction – Safety Information

1

13. CD-ROM Instruction – About this machine

1

14. CD-ROM Instruction – Troubleshooting

1

15. CD-ROM Instruction –Copy/Document Server Reference

1

16. CD-ROM Instruction –Facsimile Reference

1

17. CD-ROM Instruction –Printer Reference

1

18. CD-ROM Instruction –Scanner Reference

1

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

-57, -67, -29, -21, -19

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation Description

Q’ty

19. CD-ROM Instruction – Network & General Setting Guide

1

20. CD-ROM Instruction – Security Reference

1

Destination

-67, -29, -21,

21. PostScript 3 Supplement

-19, -28

22. Printer Driver CD-ROM

1

23. Scanner Driver & Utility CD-ROM

1

-29, 28

-57, -67, -29 24. Clear Cover

1

2.3.4 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Remove the tapes from the development units before you turn the main switch on. The development units can be severely damaged if you do not remove the tapes.

Put the machine on the paper tray unit first if you install an optional paper tray unit at the same time. Then install the machine and other options. ƒ

Keep the shipping retainers after you install the machine. You may need them in the future if you transport the machine to another location.

Tapes and Retainers

1.

Remove all the tapes and retainers on the machine.

2.

Remove all the tapes and retainers in trays 1 and 2.

SM

2-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

No.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation

3.

Remove the scanner unit stay [A].

4.

Keep the scanner unit stay in the cutout in the inner tray. ƒ

For the EU models, the scanner unit stay cannot be inserted in the cutout on the inner tray. You must bring this stay back to your depot.

5.

Install the inverter tray [A] (hooks).

6.

Open the duplex unit [A].

7.

Remove the sheet [B] of paper with a red tag.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Copier Installation

8.

Open the paper transfer unit [A].

9.

Remove the front and rear stoppers [B] with a red tag.

10. Close the duplex unit.

11. Attach the handle cover [A] to the front side of the duplex unit.

Developer and Toner Bottles

1.

Open the front door [A] and remove the PCDU toner collection bottle [B].

2.

Remove all tapes except the tape [C] from the four development units and from the toner hopper units.

SM

2-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation

ƒ

Do not remove the tape [C] at this moment. You will find how to remove this tape later.

ƒ

The toner hopper cover [C] is removed with tape [D].

ƒ

Make sure that the all toner hopper covers are removed, when removing all tapes.

3.

Check if the toner hopper shutter [A] is fully closed. ƒ

If the toner hopper shutter is not fully closed and the inlet [B] of the toner hopper unit is visible, the toner bottle cannot be installed properly.

4.

Press the ITB lock lever [A] and turn it up as shown above.

5.

Remove the black PCDU [B] ( x 2).

6.

Remove the cover sheet [A] from the black PCDU.

7.

Reinstall the black PCDU into the mainframe ( x 2).

8.

Reinstall the PCDU toner collection bottle.

9.

Shake each toner bottle five or six times.

10. Slide the toner bottles in toner bottle cartridges, then turn each one to the right (clockwise). 11. Close the front door.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation

Installaion

Paper Trays

1.

Pull each paper tray [A] out. Then adjust the side guides and end guide to match the paper size.

ƒ

To move the side guides, first pull out the tray fully. Then push down the green lock at the rear inside the tray.

Emblem and Decals

1.

Attach the correct emblem [A] and the cover [B] to the front door [C] of the machine, if the emblem is not attached. ƒ

If you want to change the emblem that has been already attached, remove the panel with an object (not a sharp object) as shown [D], and then install the correct emblem.

2.

SM

Attach the correct paper tray number and size decals to the paper trays [E].

2-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation ƒ

Paper tray number and size decals are also used for the optional paper tray or the optional LCT. Keep these decals for use with these optional units.

Fax Settings for D037-17 The D037-17 model has a fax unit as a standard function. Because of this, the fax settings are required at machine installation. Refer to steps 7 to 9 and 14 to 16 in the "Fax Option (D432) Installation Procedure" in the “Field Service Manual” of the fax option manual.

Initialize the Developer 1.

Make sure that the platen or ARDF is closed and the main power is turned off.

2.

Plug in the machine.

3.

Turn the main power switch on. The machine automatically starts the initialization procedure. The Start button LED (C) turns green when this procedure has finished.

4.

Make copies of image samples (text, photo, and text/photo modes).

5.

Do the Automatic Color Calibration process (ACC) for each mode (Copy mode, Printer 600 x 600 dpi, Printer 1800 x 600 dpi, and Printer 1200 x 1200 dpi) as follows ((Printer 1200 x 1200 dpi is for D038/D041 only): ƒ

1) Print the ACC test pattern (User tools > Maintenance > ACC > Start).

ƒ

2) Put the printout on the exposure glass.

ƒ

3) Put 10 sheets of white paper on top of the test chart.

ƒ

4) Close the ARDF or the platen cover.

ƒ

5) Press “Start Scanning” on the LCD panel. The machine starts the ACC.

6.

Check that the sample image has been copied normally.

7.

Open the front cover.

8.

Remove the instruction guide sheet [A], and make sure the SMC report [B] is stored as shown above. Then replace the instruction guide sheet.

Settings Relevant to the Service Contract Change the necessary settings for the following SP modes if the customer has made a service contract.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation

ƒ

You must select one of the counter methods (developments/prints) in accordance with the contract ( SP5045-001).

SP No.

Function

Default

Specifies if the counting method used in meter charge mode is based on SP5-045-001

developments or prints. NOTE: You can set

“0”: Developments

this one time only. You cannot change the setting after you have set it for the first time. A3/11" x 17" double counting SP No.

Function

Default

Specifies whether the counter is doubled for SP5-104-001

A3/11" x 17" paper. When you have to

“No”: Single counting

change this setting, contact your supervisor. Service Tel. No. Setting SP No.

Function

Default

5812-002 programs the service station fax SP5-812-001 through 004

number. The number is printed on the counter list when the meter charge mode is selected. This lets the user fax the counter data to the service station.

Settings for @Remote Service ƒ

Prepare and check the following check points before you visit the customer site. For details, ask the @Remote key person.

Check points before making @Remote settings 1.

The setting of SP5816-201 in the mainframe must be "0".

2.

Device ID2 (SP5811-003) must be correctly programmed. ƒ

SM

6 spaces must be put between the 3-digit prefix and the following 8-digit number

2-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

Counting method

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation (e.g. xxx______xxxxxxxx). ƒ

ID2 (SP5811-003) and the serial number (SP5811-001) must be the same (e.g. ID2: A01______23456789 = serial No. A0123456789)

3.

4.

The following settings must be correctly programmed. ƒ

Proxy server IP address (SP5816-063)

ƒ

Proxy server Port number (SP5816-064)

ƒ

Proxy User ID (SP5816-065)

ƒ

Proxy Password (SP5816-066)

Get a Request Number

Execute the @Remote Settings 1.

Enter the SP mode.

2.

Input the Request number which you have obtained from @Remote Center GUI, and then enter [OK] with SP5816-202.

3.

Confirm the Request number, and then click [EXECUTE] with SP5816-203.

4.

Check the confirmation result with SP5816-204.

Value

Meaning

Solution/ Workaround

0

Succeeded

-

1

Request number error

Check the request number again.

3

4

5

Communication error (proxy

Communication error (proxy

Check the network condition.

disabled) Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)

6

Communication error

8

Other error

9

Check the network condition.

enabled)

Check the network condition. See "SP5816-208 Error Codes" below this.

Request number confirmation

Processing… Please wait.

executing

D037/D038/D040/D041

Check Proxy user name and password.

2-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation 5.

Make sure that the screen displays the Location Information with SP5816-205 only

6.

Click [EXECUTE] to execute the registration with SP5816-206.

7.

Check the registration result with SP5816-207.

Value

Solution/ Workaround

0

Succeeded

-

1

Request number error

Check the request number again.

2

Already registered

Check the registration status.

3

4

5

8

9

8.

Meaning

Communication error (proxy

Check the network condition.

enabled) Communication error (proxy

Check the network condition.

disabled) Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)

Check Proxy user name and password.

See "SP5816-208 Error Codes" below

Other error

this.

Request number confirmation

Processing… Please wait.

executing

Exit the SP mode.

SP5816-208 Error Codes

Cause

Code

Operation Error, Incorrect Setting

-12002

Meaning

Inquiry, registration attempted without acquiring Request No.

-12003 Attempted registration without

Solution/ Workaround Obtain a Request Number before attempting the Inquiry or Registration. Perform Confirmation

execution of a confirmation and before attempting the no previous registration.

SM

2-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Registration.

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

when it has been input at the Center GUI.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation Cause

Code

Meaning

-12004 Attempted setting with illegal

Solution/ Workaround Check ID2 of the

entries for certification and ID2. mainframe. -12005 @Remote communication is prohibited. The device has an Embedded RC gate-related problem.

Make sure that "Remote Service" in User Tools is set to "Do not prohibit".

-12006 A confirmation request was made after the confirmation

Execute registration.

had been already completed. -12007 The request number used at registration was different from

Check Request No.

the one used at confirmation. -12008 Update certification failed

Error Caused by Response from GW URL

Check the mainframe

because mainframe was in

condition. If the mainframe

use.

is in use, try again later.

-2385 Other error -2387 Not supported at the Service Center -2389 Database out of service -2390 Program out of service

-2391

Two registrations for the same

Check the registration

mainframe

condition of the mainframe

-2392 Parameter error -2393 External RCG not managed -2394 Mainframe not managed

-2395

D037/D038/D040/D041

Box ID for external RCG is illegal.

2-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier Installation Code

-2396

Meaning Mainframe ID for external RCG is illegal.

-2397 Incorrect ID2 format

-2398

Solution/ Workaround

Incorrect request number format

Check the ID2 of the mainframe.

Check the Request No.

2.3.5 MOVING THE MACHINE This section shows you how to manually move the machine from one floor to another floor. See the section “Transporting the Machine” if you have to pack the machine and move it a longer distance. ƒ

Remove all trays from the optional paper feed unit.

2.3.6 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE Main Frame 1.

Do SP 4806-001 to move the scanner carriage from the home position. This prevents dust from falling into the machine during transportation.

2.

Make sure there is no paper left in the paper trays. Then fix down the bottom plates with a sheet of paper and tape.

3.

Do one of the following: ƒ

Attach shipping tape to the covers and doors.

ƒ

Shrink-wrap the machine tightly. ƒ

After you move the machine, Make sure you do the "Auto Color Registration" as follows. This optimizes color registration.

ƒ

Do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode c" (SP2-111-3).

ƒ

Then do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode a" (SP2-111-1). To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.

ƒ

Make sure that the side fences in the trays are correctly positioned to prevent color registration errors.

SM

2-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

Cause

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed Unit (D331)

2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331) 2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Paper Feed Unit

1

2

Screw - M4 x 10

4

3

Securing Bracket

2

2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.

ƒ

The handles of the main machine for lifting must be inserted inside the machine and locked, unless these handles are used for the installation or relocation of the main machine.

ƒ

You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed Unit (D331) ƒ

This installation procedure uses the following symbol.

ƒ

: Screws

Remove the strips of tape.

2.

Set the copier [A] on the paper tray unit [B].

Installaion

1.

ƒ

When installing the copier, be careful not to pinch the cable [C].

3.

Remove the connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1).

4.

Connect the cable [B] to the copier, as shown.

5.

Attach a securing bracket [C] to each side of the paper tray unit, as shown ( x 1: M3 x 8 each).

6.

SM

Re-install the connector cover.

2-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed Unit (D331)

7.

Remove the 1st and 2nd paper trays [A] and secure the paper tray unit with two screws (M4 x 10) [B].

8.

Reinstall all the paper trays.

9.

Attach the appropriate paper tray number decal and paper size decal to each handle of the trays. ƒ

The paper tray number and size decal sheet is in the accessory box of the main machine.

10. Rotate the adjuster [A] until the machine cannot be pushed across the floor. 11. Load paper into the paper trays and select the proper paper size. 12. Turn on the main switch. 13. Adjust the registration for each tray ( Section: Image Adjustment). ƒ

For tray 3, use SP1002-004

ƒ

For tray 4, use SP1002-005

14. Check the machine’s operation and copy quality.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed Unit (D425)

2.5 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425)

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Paper Feed Unit

1

2

Securing bracket

2

3

Screw (M4 x 10)

4

2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation procedure.

ƒ

You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage.

ƒ

Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.

ƒ

The one-tray paper feed unit must be installed on the caster table (D448). Prepare the caster table first before installing this unit.

SM

2-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

2.5.1 COMPONENT CHECK

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed Unit (D425)

ƒ

This installation procedure uses the following symbols:

ƒ

: Screws

1.

Remove all tape on the paper feed unit.

2.

Remove the paper tray and remove all tapes and padding.

3.

Put the paper tray unit on the caster table (D448). ƒ

For details about the installation of the caster table, see the Section: "Caster Table (D488)"” installation procedure.

4.

Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine.

5.

Lift the copier and install it on the paper feed unit [C]. ƒ

Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Paper Feed Unit (D425)

6.

Remove the rear connector cover [A] of the main machine (rivet screw x 1).

7.

Connect the harness [B] to the main machine.

8.

Reinstall the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1).

9.

Remove tray 1 and 2 of the machine.

10. Fasten the screws (M4 x 10) [C]. 11. Reinstall all trays. 12. Attach the securing brackets [D] (M4 x 10;  x 1 each). 13. Load paper into the paper feed unit. 14. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 15. Adjust the registration for each tray ( Section: Image Adjustment). ƒ

Use SP1002-004

16. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.

SM

2-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Caster Table (D488)

2.6 CASTER TABLE (D488) 2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Caster Table

1

2

Pin

2

3

Step Screw

2

2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1.

Put the caster table on a flat place.

2.

Install the two pins in the screw holes. ƒ

Use the screw holes [A] and [C] if the mainframe is directly installed on the caster

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Caster Table (D488) table. ƒ

Use the screw holes [B] and [C] if the one-tray paper feed unit (D425) is installed

Installaion

on the caster table.

3.

Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine, if the copier is to be installed on the caster table. ƒ

Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.

4.

Lift the copier or one-tray paper feed unit [C], and then install it on the caster table [D].

5.

Pull out tray 2 of the mainframe or the tray of the one-tray paper feed unit.

6.

Secure the machine or one-tray paper feed unit to the caster table (step screw x 2)

7.

Reinstall the tray in the mainframe or one-tray paper feed unit.

SM

2-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

ARDF (D366)

2.7 ARDF (D366) 2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

ARDF

1

2

Stamp Cartridge

1

3

Knob Screw

2

4

Stud Screw

2

5

Attention Decal – Top Cover

1

2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ 1.

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

Remove all tapes and shipping retainers.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

ARDF (D366)

2.

Insert the two stud screws [A] on the top of the machine.

3.

Mount the ARDF [A] by aligning the screw keyholes [B] of the ARDF support plate over the stud screws.

4.

Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine.

5.

Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [C].

SM

2-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

ARDF (D366)

6.

Install the stamp cartridge [A] in the ARDF.

[B]

[A]

b789i104

7.

Peel off the platen sheet [A] and place it on the exposure glass.

8.

Align the rear left corner (of the platen sheet) with the corner [B] on the exposure glass.

9.

Close the ARDF.

10. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

ARDF (D366)

11. Attach the decal [A] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language that you want. 12. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the machine, and then check the ARDF operation. 13. Make a full size copy. Check that the registrations (side-to-side and leading edge) and image skew are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations and image skew (see

Section: "Image Adjustment"" in the "Replacements and Adjustments" chapter).

SM

2-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Platen Cover Installation (G329)

2.8 PLATEN COVER INSTALLATION (G329)

1.

Install the stud screws [A] ( x 2) on the top cover as shown.

2.

Position the platen cover bracket [B] on the heads of the stud screws, and slide the platen cover [C] to the left.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Side Tray (D427)

2.9 SIDE TRAY (D427)

Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Side Tray Paper Exit Unit

1

2

Side Tray

1

3

Decal: Push

1

4

Decal: Door Push

1

5

Screw: M3x8

1

6

Tray Stopper

1

2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

SM

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

2-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Side Tray (D427) 1.

Remove all tapes on the side tray.

2.

Open the duplex unit [A].

3.

Remove the right upper cover [B] ( x 2).

4.

Close the side tray paper exit unit [A], and then connect the harness [B] to the machine.

5.

Install the side tray paper exit unit ( x 2: removed in step 3).

6.

Install the side tray [A].

7.

Lift the side tray, and then install the tray stopper [B] ( x 1: M3x8).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Side Tray (D427)

8.

Attach the ‘Push door’ decal [A] to the top front edge of the duplex unit cover.

9.

Close the duplex unit, and then attach the ‘Push’ decal [A] to the duplex unit cover.

10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 11. Check the side tray operation.

SM

2-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

1-Bin Tray Unit (D426)

2.10 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426) 2.10.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Tray

1

2

1-Bin Tray Unit

1

3

Screw: Blue (M3 x 6)

1

4

Screw (M3 x 8)

1

5

Tray Support Bar

1

2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

1-Bin Tray Unit (D426) ƒ

If both the shift tray unit and the 1-bin tray unit are installed in the mainframe at the same time, install the shift tray unit first. Installing the shift tray unit after the 1-bin tray unit may be difficult.

Remove all tapes.

2.

Remove the inverter tray [A] (hook).

3.

Open the right door [B] of the machine.

4.

Remove the front right cover [C] ( x 1).

5.

Remove the paper exit cover [A].

6.

Remove the connector cover [A] with a small flat screwdriver.

Installaion

1.

SM

2-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

1-Bin Tray Unit (D426) 7.

Remove the left frame cover [B] ( x 1).

8.

Install the 1-bin tray unit [A] ( x 1: M3x6 blue, x 1).

9.

Install the tray [A] (with the tray support bar) in the machine.

10. Attach the tray support cover [B] ( x 2: M3x8 in the accessories and one screw removed in step 7). 11. Reassemble the machine. 12. Turn on the main power switch of the machine, and check the 1-bin tray unit operation.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Shift Tray Unit (D428)

2.11 SHIFT TRAY UNIT (D428)

Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No. 1

Description Shift Tray Unit

Q’ty 1

2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

ƒ

If both the shift tray unit and the 1-bin tray unit are installed in the mainframe at the same time, install the shift tray unit first. Installing the shift tray unit after the 1-bin tray unit may be difficult.

1.

SM

Remove all tapes.

2-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Shift Tray Unit (D428) 2.

Remove the inverter tray [A] (hook).

3.

Remove the output tray [B] ( x 2).

4.

Put the shift tray [A] in the machine, and then connect the harness to the connector [B] on the inner rear frame. ƒ

If the shift tray is difficult to install in the mainframe, remove the paper exit cover [C] first ( x 1).

5.

Install the shift tray [A] fully in the machine ( x 2).

6.

Reinstall the inverter tray.

7.

Turn on the main power switch of the machine.

8.

Check the shift tray unit operation.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Internal Finisher (D429)

2.12 INTERNAL FINISHER (D429) This procedure explains how to install the internal finisher, without installing the punch unit

2.12.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

SM

Description

Q’ty

1

Internal Finisher

1

2

Inverter Unit

1

3

Inner Bottom Plate

1

4

Screw: M3x10

3

5

Screw: M3x6

11

6

Guide Rail

1

7

Inverter Cover

1

8

Left Cover

1

2-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

at the same time.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Internal Finisher (D429)

2.12.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

Preparing before Installing the Internal Finisher 1.

Remove all tapes from the internal finisher.

2.

Remove the inverter tray [A].

3.

Open the front door [B].

4.

Remove the lower inner cover [A].

5.

Press the ITB lock lever [B] and turn it up as shown above.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Internal Finisher (D429)

6.

Remove the inner right cover [A] ( x 2).

7.

Open the duplex unit [A], and then remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1).

8.

Remove the following:

SM

ƒ

Inner tray [A] ( x 2)

ƒ

Left frame rear cover [B] ( x 2)

ƒ

Left frame cover [C] ( x 1)

ƒ

Paper exit cover [D] ( x 1)

ƒ

Inner rear cover [E] ( x 1)

2-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Internal Finisher (D429)

9.

Install the inner bottom plate [A] ( x 6).

10. Attach the left cover [A] ( x 2: M3x6, one screw removed in step 8).

Internal Finisher Installation

1.

Insert the inverter unit [A] in the machine.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Internal Finisher (D429)

2.

Insert two joint pins [A] into the two holes in the inner rear bracket.

3.

Fully attach the front side [B] of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe after inserting the two joint pins ( x 1: M3x6). ƒ

Insert the two joint pins before attaching the front side of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe. Otherwise, paper jams may occur between the paper exit unit and inverter unit.

4.

Install the guide rail [A] ( x 2: M3x6).

5.

Attach the inverter cover [A] ( x 3: M3x10).

SM

2-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Internal Finisher (D429)

6.

Install the internal finisher [A] from the left side of the machine.

7.

Insert the rear rail pins [A] into the frame of the machine ( x 1: M3x6).

8.

Push the internal finisher [A] and connect the cable [B] to the power socket of the machine.

9.

Reassemble the machine.

10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 11. Check the internal finisher operation.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390)

2.13 PUNCH UNIT (D390)

Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

Punch Unit

1

2

Output Tray Lower Cover

1

3

Drawer Connector

1

4

Bracket

1

5

Left Frame Cover

1

6

Punch Cover

1

2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE If the internal finisher has not already been installed, skip the ‘Removing the Internal Finisher’ section, and go to the ‘Preparing the Punch Unit before Installing the Internal

SM

2-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

2.13.1 COMPONENT CHECK

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390) Finisher’ section. Also do ‘Preparing before Installing the Internal Finisher’ in the ‘Internal Finisher (D429)’ section. If the internal finisher has already been installed, you must remove it first. Start from the ‘Removing the Internal Finisher’ section. ƒ

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

Removing the Internal Finisher 1.

Open the front door.

2.

Open the right door [A], and then remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1).

3.

Disconnect the cable [A] from the power socket of the machine, and then pull out the internal finisher [B].

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Punch Unit (D390)

4.

Remove the internal finisher [A] ( x 1: M3x6).

5.

Remove the inverter cover [A] ( x 3: M3x10).

6.

Remove the guide rail [A] ( x 2: M3x6).

SM

2-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390)

7.

Pull the inverter unit [A] toward the front side ( x 1: M3x6).

8.

Remove the inverter unit [A] from the machine.

Preparing the Punch Unit before Installing the Internal Finisher

1.

Remove the inverter right bracket [A] from the inverter unit ( x 4).

2.

To remove screw [B], open guide plate [C].

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Punch Unit (D390)

3.

Remove the positioning pin bracket [A] from the inverter right bracket ( x 2).

4.

Attach the inverter right bracket [A] to the punch unit [B] ( x 1: M3x6).

5.

Slide the inverter small guide [A] to the front side (arrow direction), and then remove it ( x 1).

6.

Remove all the tapes on the punch unit. ƒ

SM

If all the tapes are not removed, SC763 may occur.

2-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390)

7.

Attach the inverter unit [A] to the punch unit [B], and then secure the inverter unit with the punch unit ( x 4 removed in step 1).

8.

Attach the drawer connector [A] of the punch unit to the rear bracket of the inverter unit ( x 2 removed in step 3).

9.

Attach the clamp [B] to the rear bracket of the inverter unit.

Installing the Punch and Inverter Unit

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390) Install the punch and inverter unit [A] in the mainframe.

2.

Insert the two joint pins [A] (this picture does not show the two joint pins) into the two

Installaion

1.

holes in the inner rear bracket. 3.

Fully attach the front side [B] of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe after inserting two joint pins ( x 1: M3x6). ƒ

Insert the two joint pins before attaching the front side of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe. Otherwise, paper jams may occur between the paper exit unit and inverter unit.

4.

Remove the stopper [A] from the guide rail, and then attach with the screw holes [B] (these screw holes must be used when the internal finisher is installed with the punch unit).

SM

2-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390)

5.

Install the guide rail [A] on the front edge of the inner bottom plate ( x 2).

6.

Install the punch cover [A] ( x 3: M3x6).

Preparing the Internal Finisher

1.

Remove the left rear cover [A] and the rear cover [B] of the internal finisher ( x 2 each).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Punch Unit (D390)

2.

Attach the drawer connector [A] to the rear bracket of the finisher.

3.

Connect the harnesses [B] to the connectors [C] on the main board.

4.

ƒ

Black harness connector to CN16

ƒ

Gray harness connector to CN17

Reinstall the rear cover (removed in step 1) ( x 2).

Installing the Internal Finisher

1.

Install the internal finisher [A] in the mainframe ( x 1).

2.

Remove the bracket [A] ( x 2).

SM

2-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390)

3.

Attach the bracket [A] ( x 2); this bracket is for the internal finisher when used with the punch unit.

4.

Remove the output tray lower cover [A]; this cover is for the internal finisher without the punch unit ( x 3).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Punch Unit (D390)

5.

Attach the output tray lower cover [A]; this cover is for the internal finisher when used with the punch unit ( x 3).

Note

The two projections [A] on the output tray lower cover (this plate is actually attached to the output tray lower cover) must be inserted along the two guide rails [B] inside the output tray unit.

SM

2-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit (D390)

[A]

Correct

Incorrect d390i550

d390i551

Push the slide plate [A] to check if the output tray lower cover is correctly installed. The left side picture shows the correct result and the right side picture shows the incorrect result.

6.

Attach the left frame cover [A] ( x 2).

7.

Push the internal finisher in the mainframe.

8.

Connect the I/F cable [B] of the finisher to the inlet of the mainframe.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

USB2.0/SD Slot Type A

2.14 USB2.0/SD SLOT TYPE A

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

USB2.0/SD Slot

1

2

Ground Plate

1

3

USB Cable

1

4

Screw: M3 x 6 blue

1

5

Screw: M3 x 8

4

6

Decal

1

2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Connect the USB cable [B] to the USB slot [A] in the USB2.0/SD Slot unit.

2.

Attach the ground plate [C] to the bracket of the USB2.0/SD Slot ( x 1: M3x6 blue).

SM

2-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

2.14.1 ACCESSORY CHECK

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

USB2.0/SD Slot Type A

3.

Remove the screw [A] first, and the rear cover [B] ( x 7).

4.

Remove the scanner left cover [A] ( x 2).

5.

Remove the left frame cover [B] ( x 2).

6.

Remove the part [A] on the scanner left cover.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

7.

Make four holes in the scanner left cover with a screwdriver as shown [A]. ƒ

Smooth the four holes in the scanner left cover as shown [B].

8.

Route the USB cable [A] through the gaps in the left scanner cover.

9.

Secure the USB2.0/SD Slot [B] with the left scanner cover as shown above ( x 4: M3x8). ƒ

SM

Use the screw holes [C] as shown above.

2-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

USB2.0/SD Slot Type A

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

USB2.0/SD Slot Type A

10. Attach the scanner left cover [A] to the mainframe, and then connect the USB cable [B] to USB-A (this is the USB slot closest to the front side of the machine) as shown above. ƒ

Make sure that the USB cable is inserted in USB-A (front side).

11. Plug in and turn on the mainframe. 12. Enter the SP mode, and then change the setting of SP1013-001 from “0” to “1”.

13. Attach the decal [A] to the USB2.0/SD Slot as shown above.

2.14.3 TESTING THE SD CARD/USB SLOT 1.

Insert an SD card or USB memory device in the slot.

You can connect only one removable memory device at a time. 1.

Close the media slot cover.

If you leave the cover open, static electricity conducted through an inserted SD card could cause the machine to malfunction.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

USB2.0/SD Slot Type A 1.

Make sure that no previous settings remain.

1.

Place an original on the exposure glass.

2.

Press [Store File].

3.

Press [Store to Memory Device].

4.

Press [OK].

5.

Press the [Start] key.

Installaion

If a previous setting remains, press the [Clear Modes] key.

When writing is complete, a confirmation message appears. 1.

Press [Exit].

2.

Remove the memory device from the media slot.

Do not remove the memory device while writing is in process.

SM

2-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Mechanical Counter (NA Only)

2.15 MECHANICAL COUNTER (NA ONLY) ƒ

This counter is supplied as a spare part.

2.15.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1.

Rear cover ( Section: "Rear Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section: "Rear Lower Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)

3.

Controller box cover ( Section: "Controller Box Cover " in the “Replacement and Adjustment” section)

4.

Remove the cutouts [A] in the rear lower cover with nippers.

5.

Attach the mechanical counters [A] to the bracket [B] and connect the harness to each mechanical counter as shown above.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Mechanical Counter (NA Only)

6.

Attach the clamp [A] as shown above.

7.

Attach the mechanical counter bracket [B] to the frame ( x 2).

8.

Connect the mechanical counter harness [C] to the mechanical counter [D] and the BCU (CN218) [E], and route the harness as shown above (= x 6)

9.

Reassemble the machine.

10. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch. 11. Enter the SP mode. 12. Set SP5987-001 to "1: ON". 13. Exit the SP mode, and then turn the machine off and on.

SM

2-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Key Counter Bracket

2.16 KEY COUNTER BRACKET After the key counter bracket is installed in the mainframe, the following options cannot be used at the same time. ƒ

Internal finisher (D429)

ƒ

Handset (B433)

2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Hold the key counter plate nuts [A] on the inside of the key counter bracket [B] and insert the key counter holder [C].

2.

Secure the key counter holder to the bracket ( x 2).

3.

Install the key counter cover [D] ( x 2).

4.

Rear cover ( "Rear Cover" in the Replacement and Adjustment section)

5.

Cut off the part [A] of the rear cover.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Key Counter Bracket

6.

Peel off double sided tape on the key counter bracket, and attach the key counter to the scanner right cover.

7.

Connect the key counter cable [A] to the connector [B].

8.

Reassemble the machine.

SM

2-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Key Counter Interface Unit

2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT 2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE

1.

Rear cover ( Section: "Rear Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section: "Rear Lower Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)

3.

Cut off the part [A] of the rear cover.

4.

Attach the clamp [A] to the DRB bracket.

5.

Install the key counter interface board [B] on the DRB bracket ( x 4).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Key Counter Interface Unit

6.

Connect and route the key counter cable [A] to the connector on the key counter interface board as shown above (ground screw x 1, = x 6).

7.

Connect and route the harness [B] to the connector on the key counter interface board and connector CN216 [C] on the BCU (= x 5)

8.

Pull the key counter cable through from the cutout and connect it to the connector [A] of the key counter unit.

9.

SM

Reassemble the machine.

2-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copy Data Security Unit Type F (B829)

2.18 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT TYPE F (B829) 2.18.1 INSTALLATION ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

1.

Remove the rear lower cover [A] of the machine ( x 5).

2.

Remove the rear cover [B] of the machine ( x 7)

3.

Scanner cable bracket [A] ( x 4)

4.

Loosen the eight screws, and slide up the controller box cover [B].

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Copy Data Security Unit Type F (B829)

5.

Attach the ICIB-3 (copy data security board) [A] to CN 504 [B] on the BCU ( x 2).

6.

Reassemble the machine.

User Tool Setting 1.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

2.

Go into the User Tools mode, and select System Settings > Administrator Tools > Copy Data Security Option > “On”.

3.

Exit User Tools.

4.

Check the operation. ƒ

The machine will issue an SC165 error if the machine is powered on with the ICIB-3 removed and the “Data Security for Copying “feature set to “ON”.

ƒ

When you remove this option from the machine, first set the setting to “OFF” with the user tool before removing this board. If you forget to do this, “Data Security for Copying “feature cannot appear in the user tool setting. And then SC165 will appear every time the machine is switched on, and the machine cannot be used.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see "Check All Connections" at the end of this section).

SM

2-71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Anti-Condensation Heater

2.19 ANTI-CONDENSATION HEATER 2.19.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

This heater is supplied as a spare part.

1.

Rear cover ( Section: "Rear Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)

2.

Open the ARDF or platen cover.

3.

Glass cover [A] (stepped screw x 4)

4.

Scanner right cover [A] ( x 2)

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Anti-Condensation Heater

5.

ARDF exposure glass [A] ƒ

Position the white marker [B] at the rear-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.

6.

Rear scale [A] (stepped screw x 3)

7.

Exposure glass [A] with left scale. ƒ

SM

Position the marker at the front-left corner when you reattach the exposure

2-73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Anti-Condensation Heater glass.

8.

Move the scanner carriage fully across to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [A] at the rear of the machine.

9.

Put the connector of the heater [B] through the cutout [C].

10. Move the scanner carriage to the left side as shown above by rotating the scanner motor at the rear of the machine. 11. Install the heater in the scanner unit ( x 1). 12. Secure the cable cover [A] and the left side of the heater ( x 1).

13. Attach a clamp as shown above. 14. Connect the harness [A] of the heater to the connector [B] in the frame of the machine.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Anti-Condensation Heater

Installaion

15. Reassemble the machine.

16. Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.

SM

2-75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Heater (Mainframe)

2.20 TRAY HEATER (MAINFRAME) 2.20.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

This heater is supplied as a spare part.

1.

Remove trays 1 and 2 from the machine.

2.

Remove the connector cover [A] ( x 1).

3.

Connect the connector [B] of the heater to the connector of the main machine.

4.

Install the heater [C] inside the machine ( x 1)

5.

Reassemble the machine.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Tray Heater (Mainframe)

6.

SM

Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.

2-77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

2.21 TRAY HEATERS (OPTIONAL UNIT) 2.21.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

This heater is supplied as a spare part.

Tray Heater for D425

1.

Remove the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1) of the mainframe.

2.

Disconnect the harness [B].

3.

Remove the rear lower cover [A] of the mainframe ( x 5).

4.

Pull out all the tray cassettes of the paper feed unit.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

5.

Remove the securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each), and then the rear cover [B] of the paper feed unit ( x 2).

6.

Pass the connector [A] through the opening [B].

7.

Install the tray heater [C] ( x 1)

8.

Connect the heater harness [A] of the heater to the relay harness [B].

SM

2-79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

9.

Insert the heater harness [A] into the tube [B], and push the tube against the rear frame of the paper feed unit as shown above. ƒ

Make sure that the tube is in contact with the rear frame [C].

10. Route the relay harness [A] as shown above (= x 5). ƒ

Make sure that the connector [A] is placed securely as shown above.

ƒ

Make sure that the edge of the tube [B] is placed as shown above.

11. Reattach the rear cover of the paper feed unit ( x 2) and securing brackets ( x 1 each)

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

12. Remove the connector cap [A] from the tray heater harness. 13. Connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness [C] of the mainframe. ƒ

Do not connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness of the mainframe before installing the securing bracket [D]. Otherwise, the securing bracket may pinch the relay harness.

14. Reinstall the rear lower cover of the mainframe ( x 5). 15. Reinstall all the tray cassettes.

16. Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.

SM

2-81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

Tray Heater for D331

1.

Remove the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1) of the mainframe.

2.

Disconnect the harness [B].

3.

Remove the rear lower cover [A] of the mainframe ( x 5).

4.

Pull out all the tray cassettes of the paper feed unit.

5.

Remove the securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each), and then rear cover [B] of the paper feed unit ( x 2).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

6.

Pass the connector [A] through the opening [B].

7.

Install the tray heater [C] ( x 1).

8.

Connect heater harness [A] of the heater to the relay harness [B].

9.

Remove the harness guide [A] ( x 1), and move it in the blue arrow direction as shown above.

SM

2-83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

10. Insert the heater harness [A] into the tube [B], and push the tube against the rear frame of the paper feed unit as shown above. ƒ

Make sure that the tube is contact with the rear frame [C].

11. Route the relay harness as shown above (= x 6). ƒ

Make sure that the edge of the tube [A] is placed as shown above.

ƒ

The clamp [B] is not used.

12. Reinstall the harness guide. 13. Reattach the rear cover of the paper feed unit ( x 2) and securing brackets ( x 1 each).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)

14. Remove the connector cap [A] from the tray heater harness. 15. Connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness [C] of the mainframe. ƒ

Do not connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness of the mainframe before installing the securing bracket [D]. Otherwise, the securing bracket may pinch the relay harness.

16. Reinstall the rear lower cover of the mainframe ( x 5). 17. Reinstall all the tray cassettes.

18. Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.

SM

2-85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

2.22 CONTROLLER OPTIONS 2.22.1 OVERVIEW This machine has I/F card slots for optional I/F connections and SD card slot applications. After you install an option, check that the machine can recognize it (see “Check All Connections” at the end of this section).

I/F Card Slots ƒ

Fax slot [A] is used for the Fax Option

ƒ

I/F slot [B] is used for one of the optional I/F connections (only one can be installed): IEEE1284, IEEE802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN), Bluetooth, File Format Converter, or Gigabit Ethernet. ƒ

The I/F Slot [B] is only used for D038/D041 (H Model).

SD Card Slots D037/D040: ƒ

Slot 1 is used for "Printer Enhanced Option".

ƒ

Slot 2 is used for service only (for example, updating the firmware).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options D038/D041: ƒ

Slot 1 is used for one of the optional applications: PostScript 3, Data Overwrite Security Unit, PictBridge Slot 2 is used for installing the Browser Unit, HDD Encryption unit, VM card or for service only (for example, updating the firmware).

USB Slots ƒ

Left-side USB slot [C]: Used for connecting a digital camera (only works if PictBridge is installed).

ƒ

Right-side USB slot [D]: Used when installing the optional USB2.0/SD card slot ƒ

D038/D041 has two slots. D037/D040 has only one slot (there is no optional USB2.0/SD card slot for these models).

2.22.2 SD CARD APPLI MOVE ƒ

The PostScript3 application and fonts cannot be moved to another SD card. However, other applications can be moved onto the PostScript3 SD card.

Overview The service program “SD Card Appli Move” (SP5-873) lets you copy application programs from one SD card to another SD card. Slot 1 is used to store application programs. But there are 3 possible applications (PostScript 3, DOS (DataOverwriteSecurity) unit, PictBridge). You cannot run application programs from Slot 2. However you can move application programs from Slot 2 to Slot 1 with the following procedure. Make sure that the target SD card has enough space. 1.

Enter SP5873 “SD Card Appli Move”.

2.

Then move the application from the SD Card in Slot 2 to the SD Card in Slot 1. ƒ

3.

Do steps 1-2 again if you want to move another application program.

Exit the SP mode.

Be very careful when you do the SD Card Appli Move procedure: ƒ

The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program from an SD card to another SD card. Authentication fails if you try to use the SD card after you copy the application program from one card to another card.

ƒ

SM

Do not use the SD card if it has been used before for other purposes. Normal operation

2-87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

ƒ

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options is not guaranteed when such an SD card is used.

ƒ

Hold down the lever [A] and turn it in the arrow direction.

ƒ

Remove the inner cover [B] ( x 4), and then keep the SD card in the place [C] after you copy the application program from one card to another card. This is done for the following reasons: 1) The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program. 2) You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.

ƒ

You cannot copy PostScript application to another SD card. You have to copy the other application (PictBridge, DOS Unit) to the SD card that stores the PostScript application.

Move Exec The menu “Move Exec” (SP5-873-001) lets you copy application programs from the original SD card to another SD card. ƒ

Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.

1.

Turn the main switch off.

2.

Make sure that an SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied to this SD card.

3.

Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 2.The application program is copied from this SD card.

4.

Turn the main switch on.

5.

Start the SP mode.

6.

Select SP5-873-001 “Move Exec.”

7.

Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options 8.

Turn the main switch off.

9.

Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.

10. Turn the main switch on.

Undo Exec “Undo Exec” (SP5-873-002) lets you copy back application programs from an SD card to the original SD card. You can use this program when, for example, you have mistakenly copied some programs by using Move Exec (SP5-873-001). ƒ

Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.

1.

Turn the main switch off.

2.

Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.

3.

Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 1.The application program is copied back from this SD card.

4.

Turn the main switch on.

5.

Start the SP mode.

6.

Select SP5-873-002 “Undo Exec.”

7.

Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.

8.

Turn the main switch off.

9.

Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2. ƒ

This step assumes that the application programs in the SD card are used by the machine.

10. Turn the main switch on. 11. Check that the application programs run normally. 12. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).

2.22.3 POSTSCRIPT 3 (D038/D041 ONLY) The PostScript3 application and fonts cannot be moved to another SD card. However, other applications can be moved onto the PostScript3 SD card. ƒ

SM

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

2-89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

11. Check that the application programs run normally.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

1.

Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots ( x 1).

2.

Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 1 [B] until you hear a click.

3.

Attach the slot cover [A] ( x 1).

4.

Attach the “Adobe PostScript 3” decal [A] to the front door.

5.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).

2.22.4 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER (D038/D041 ONLY) ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Controller Options

1.

Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] ( x 2).

2.

Install the file format converter [B] into the I/F-slot and then fasten it with screws.

3.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

4.

Check or set the following SP codes with the values shown below.

SP No.

Title

Setting

SP5-836-001

Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)

"1"

SP5-836-002

Panel Setting

"0"

5.

Check the operation.

6.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).

2.22.5 IEEE1284 (D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth).

SM

2-91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

1.

Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] ( x 2).

2.

Install the interface board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the I/F-slot.

3.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).

2.22.6 IEEE 802.11 A/G, G (WIRELESS LAN: D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options 1.

Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] from the I/F-slot ( x 2).

2.

Install the wireless LAN board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the I/F-slot.

3.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at

Installaion

the end of this section).

4.

Peel off the double-sided tapes on the Velcro fasteners [A], and then attach them at the front left and rear left of the machine.

5.

Attach "ANT1" (having a black ferrite core) [B] to the front left of the machine.

6.

Attach "ANT2" (having a white ferrite core) [C] to the rear right of the machine. ƒ

"ANT1" is a transmission/reception antenna and "ANT2" is a reception antenna. Do not attach them at the wrong places.

7.

Attach the clamps as shown above.

8.

Wire the cables and clamp them (= x 7). ƒ

Make sure that the cables are not slack. Keep them wired tightly along the covers.

You may have to move the machine if the reception is not clear. ƒ

Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment that generates strong magnetic fields.

ƒ

Put the machine as close as possible to the access point.

Installing Various Hardware Combinations

SM

2-93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

ƒ

Refer to the above picture when installing the USB2.0/SD.

UP Mode Settings for Wireless LAN Enter the UP mode. Then do the procedure below to perform the initial interface settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g. These settings take effect every time the machine is powered on. ƒ

You cannot use the wireless LAN if you use Ethernet.

1.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.

2.

On the touch panel, press “System Settings”. ƒ

The Network I/F (default: Ethernet) must be set for either Ethernet or wireless LAN.

3.

Select “Interface Settings”.

4.

Press “Wireless LAN”. Only the wireless LAN options show.

5.

Communication Mode. Select either “802.11 Ad hoc”, “Ad hoc” or “Infrastructure”.

6.

SSID Setting. Enter the SSID setting. (The setting is case sensitive.)

7.

Channel. You need this setting when Ad Hoc Mode is selected. Range: 1 to 14 (default: 11) ƒ

8.

The allowed range for the channel settings may vary for different countries.

WEP (Encryption) Setting. The WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) setting is designed to protect wireless data transmission. The same WEP key is required on the receiving side in order to unlock encoded data. There are 64 bit and 128 bit WEP keys. WEP: Selects “Active” or “Inactive” (“Inactive” is default.). Range of Allowed Settings: 64 bit: 10 characters 128 bit: 26 characters

9.

Transmission Speed. Press the Next button to show more settings. Then select the

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options transmission speed for the mode: Auto, 11 Mbps, 5.5 Mbps, 2 Mbps, 1 Mbps (default: Auto). This setting should match the distance between the closest machine or access

ƒ

For the Ad Hoc Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest PC in the network. For the Infrastructure Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest access point.

11 Mbps: 140 m (153 yd.) 5.5 Mbps: 200 m (219 yd.) 2 Mbps: 270 m (295 yd.) 1 Mbps: 400 m (437 yd.) 10. Press “Return to Default” to initialize the wireless LAN settings. Press “Yes” to initialize the following settings: ƒ

Transmission mode

ƒ

Channel

ƒ

Transmission Speed

ƒ

WEP

ƒ

SSID

ƒ

WEP Key

SP Mode and UP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g Wireless LAN The following SP commands and UP modes can be set for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g.

SP No.

Name

5840-006

Channel MAX

5840-007

Channel MIN

5840-011

WEP Key Select

Used to select the WEP key (Default: 00).

UP mode

Name

Function

SSID

Used to confirm the current SSID setting.

WEP Key

SM

Function Sets the maximum range of the channel settings for the country. Sets the minimum range of the channels settings allowed for your country.

Used to confirm the current WEP

2-95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

point. This depends on which mode is selected.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options key setting. Used to show the maximum WEP Mode

length of the string that can be used for the WEP Key entry.

2.22.7 BLUETOOTH (D038/D041 ONLY) ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth).

1.

Remove the slot cover [A] ( x 2).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Controller Options

2.

Install the Bluetooth board [A] (Knob-screw x 2) into the slot.

3.

Insert the Bluetooth card [B] into the Bluetooth card adaptor.

4.

Install the Bluetooth card adaptor on the Bluetooth board.

5.

Attach the antenna cap to the Bluetooth board.

6.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).

2.22.8 DATAOVERWRITESECURITY UNIT TYPE I (D362: D038/D041 ONLY) Before You Begin the Procedure 1.

Confirm that the DataOverwriteSecurity unit SD card is the correct type for the machine. The correct type for this machine is "Type I".

2.

Make sure that the following settings are not at their factory default values: ƒ

Supervisor login password

ƒ

Administrator login name

ƒ

Administrator login password

If any of these settings is at a factory default value, tell the customer these settings must be changed before you do the installation procedure. 3.

Make sure that “Admin. Authentication” is ON. [System Settings] – [Administrator Tools] – [Administrator Authentication Management] - [Admin. Authentication] If this setting is OFF, tell the customer this setting must be ON before you do the installation procedure.

4.

SM

Make sure that “Administrator Tools” is enabled (selected).

2-97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options [System Settings] – [Administrator Tools] – [Administrator Authentication Management] - [Available Settings] If this setting is disabled (not selected), tell the customer this setting must be enabled (selected) before you do the installation procedure.

Seal Check and Removal

ƒ

You must check the box seals to make sure that they were not removed after the items were sealed in the box at the factory before you do the installation.

1.

Check the box seals [A] on each corner of the box. ƒ

Make sure that a tape is attached to each corner.

ƒ

The surfaces of the tapes must be blank. If you see “VOID” on the tapes, do not install the components in the box.

2.

If the surfaces of the tapes do not show “VOID”, remove them from the corners of the box.

3.

You can see the “VOID” marks [B] when you remove each seal. In this condition, they cannot be attached to the box again.

Installation Procedure ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

ƒ

You must install the DataOverwriteSecurity unit in SD Card slot 1. However, the Postscript option and others are also installed in SD Card slot 1. You must do the "SD Card Appli Move" procedure first if you want to install the Data Overwrite Security unit.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options Turn off the main power switch if the machine is turned on.

2.

Disconnect the network cable if it is connected.

3.

Remove the slot cover [A] of SD slots ( x 1).

4.

Turn the SD-card label face [B] to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot

Installaion

1.

1 until you hear a click. 5.

Connect the network cable if it needs to be connected.

6.

Turn on the main power switch.

7.

Go into the SP mode and push “EXECUTE” with SP5-878-001.

8.

Exit the SP mode and turn off the operation switch. Then turn off the main power switch.

9.

Turn on the machine power.

10. Go into the User Tools mode, and select System Settings> Administrator Tools> Auto Erase Memory Setting> On. 11. Exit the User Tools mode.

12. Check the display and make sure that the overwrite erase icon [A] shows. 13. Check the overwrite erase icon.

SM

2-99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options ƒ

The icon [B]: This icon is lit when there is temporary data to be overwritten, and blinks during overwriting.

ƒ

The icon [C]: This icon is lit when there is no temporary data to be overwritten.

2.22.9 HDD ENCRYPTION UNIT (D038/D041 ONLY) Before You Begin the Procedure 1.

Make sure that the following settings are not at the factory default settings: ƒ

Supervisor login password

ƒ

Administrator login name

ƒ

Administrator login password ƒ

These settings must be set up by the customer before the HDD Encryption unit can be installed.

2.

Confirm that "Admin. Authentication" is on: [User Tools] > "System Settings"> "Administrator Tools"> "Administrator Authentication Management"> "Admin. Authentication"> "On" If this setting is "Off", tell the customer that this setting must be "On" before you can do the installation procedure.

3.

Confirm that "Administrator Tools" is selected and enabled: [User Tools]> "System Settings"> "Administrator Tools"> "Administrator Authentication Management"> "Available Settings" ƒ

"Available Settings" is not displayed until Step 2 is done.

If this setting is not selected, tell the customer that this setting must be selected before you can do the installation procedure.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

Installaion

Seal Check and Removal

ƒ

You must check the box seals to make sure that they were not removed after the items were sealed in the box at the factory before you do the installation.

1.

Check the box seals [A] on each corner of the box. ƒ

Make sure that a tape is attached to each corner.

ƒ

The surfaces of the tapes must be blank. If you see “VOID” on the tapes, do not install the components in the box.

2.

If the surfaces of the tapes do not show “VOID”, remove them from the corners of the box.

3.

You can see the “VOID” marks [B] when you remove each seal. In this condition, they cannot be attached to the box again.

SM

2-101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

Installation Procedure

1.

Remove the SD card slot cover [A] ( x 1).

2.

Turn the SD-card label to face the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 2 [B] until you hear a click.

3.

Turn on the main power switch, and then enter the SP mode.

4.

Select SP5878-002, and then press "Execute" on the LCD.

5.

Exit the SP mode after "Completed" is displayed on the LCD.

6.

Turn off the main power switch.

7.

Remove the SD card from slot 2.

8.

Attach the SD card slot cover [A] ( x 1).

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

Installaion

Recovery from a Device Problem

Restoring the Encryption key When replacing the controller board for a model in which the HDD encryption unit has been installed, updating the encryption key is required. 1.

Prepare an SD card which is initialized.

2.

Make the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.

3.

Make an "nvram_key.txt" file in the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.

4.

Ask an administrator to input the encryption key (this has been printed out earlier by the user) into the "nvram_key.txt" file.

5.

Remove only the HDD unit ( Section: HDD (Only for D038/D041)).

6.

Turn on the main power switch.

7.

Confirm that the prompt on the LCD tells you to install the SD card (storing the encryption key) in the machine.

8.

Turn off the main power switch.

9.

Insert the SD card that contains the encryption key into slot 2.

10. Turn on the main power switch, and the machine automatically restores the encryption key in the flash memory on the controller board. 11. Turn off the main power switch after the machine has returned to normal status. 12. Remove the SD card from slot 2. 13. Reinstall the HDD unit.

SM

2-103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

Clearing the NVRAM When replacing the controller board for a model in which the HDD encryption unit has been installed and a customer has lost the encryption key, clearing the NVRAM is required to recover the HDD encryption unit. 1.

Prepare an SD card which is initialized.

2.

Make the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.

3.

Make an "nvram_key.txt" file in the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.

4.

Input "nvclear" into the "nvram_key.txt" file.

5.

Turn on the main power switch.

6.

Confirm that the prompt on the LCD tells you to install the SD card (storing the encryption key) in the machine.

7.

Turn off the main power switch.

8.

Insert the SD card that contains “nvclear” into slot 2.

9.

Turn on the main power switch, and the machine automatically restores the encryption key in the flash memory on the controller board.

10. Turn off the main power switch after the machine has returned to normal status. 11. Remove the SD card from slot 2. 12. Turn on the main power switch. 13. Initialize the NVRAM (SP5801-001) and HDD unit (SP5832-001) with SP mode. 14. The user must enable the HDD encryption unit with a user tool.

2.22.10 PICTBRIDGE (D038/D041 ONLY) ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

ƒ

You must install the PictBridge option in SD Card slot 1. However, the Postscript option and the data overwrite security unit option are also installed in SD Card slot 1. You must do the SD Card Appli move procedure first if you have the postscript or data overwrite security unit option installed and you want to install the PictBridge unit.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installaion

Controller Options

1.

Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] for SD cards ( x 1).

2.

Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 1 [B] until you hear a click.

3.

Attach the SD-card slot cover [A] ( x 1).

4.

Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).

2.22.11 VM CARD TYPE I (D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure 1.

Switch the machine off.

2.

Remove the SD card slot cover [A] ( x1).

3.

Insert the SD card [B] into slot 2.

SM

2-105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options 4.

Reattach the SD card slot cover.

5.

Switch the machine on.

6.

On the operation panel, remove the bottom blank keytop and replace it with the keytop provided.

7.

Attach the decal to the copier.

Firmware Update Procedure Application halt 1.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” key, then press the “Extended Feature Settings” button and press the “Extended Feature Setting” button that appears. If required, log in as a machine administrator.

2.

Press “Administrator Tools”, then press “Heap/Stack Size Settings”. Take note of the heap size and stack size. (After updating, the heap and stack size settings are cleared.)

3.

Press “Startup”, then stop all applications. ƒ

The following problems can occur if the VM firmware is updated without the application halt.

4.

ƒ

The VM firmware update fails.

ƒ

All settings for the application are cleared.

Turn the main power off, then remove the SD card slot cover, and remove the VM SD card from the SD card slot.

Updating the VM SD card 1.

Insert the SD card into the SD card writer that is connected to a PC.

2.

Make sure which drive is assigned for the SD card.

3.

Decompress the downloaded update file, then there are two files (one file has an “.exe” file extension and the other has a “.bat” file extension).

4.

Double click the “.bat” file, then the command prompt screen appears.

5.

The first command line is shown as “Please input drive letter of SD card [a – x]:” Then enter the SD card drive name, and press the “Enter” key.

6.

“Press any key to continue…” appears, then press the “Enter” key again. The update to the SD card starts.

7.

“Press any key to continue…”appears again, then press “Enter” key. The command prompt screen disappears automatically if the update is successful.

8.

Remove the SD card from the SD card writer after the access lamp going off on the SD card writer.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options 9.

Insert the SD card in the SD card slot 2 of the machine and turn the main power on.

Starting the application 1.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” key, then press the “Extended Feature Settings” button

machine administrator. 2.

Press “Startup”, then change the status to “Starting up” for each application.

3.

Press “Administrator Tools”, then press “Heap/Stack Size Settings”. Program the heap size and stack size as the settings as before.

4.

Turn the main power off and on.

5.

Enter the “Extended Feature Settings” menu again, and check the version of the VM card firmware on the “Extended Feature Info” screen. ƒ

The version of the VM card firmware is also shown on the Self Diagnostic Report (a part of the SMC report). But the version on the Self Diagnostic Report is not changed after updating.

2.22.12 BROWSER UNIT TYPE E (D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

Do not leave the SD card in slot 2 after installing this application.

1.

Remove the slot cover [A] for SD cards ( x 1).

2.

Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 2

SM

2-107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Installaion

and press the “Extended Feature Setting” button that appears. If required, log in as a

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options until you hear a click. 3.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

4.

Push the "User Tools" key. ƒ

If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required. Otherwise, skip to step 7

5.

Push the "Login/ Logout" key.

6.

Login with the administrator user name and password.

7.

Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.

8.

Touch "Install" on the LCD.

9.

Touch "SD Card".

10. Touch the "Browser" line. 11. Under "Install to" touch "Machine HDD" and touch "Next". 12. When you see "Ready to Install", check the information on the screen to confirm your previous selection. 13. Touch "OK". You will see "Installing the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed". 14. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen. 15. Touch "Change Allocation". 16. Touch the "Browser" line. 17. Press the hard key that you want to use for the Browser Unit. As a default, this function is assigned to the "Other Functions" key (the bottom key of the function keys). 18. Touch "OK". 19. Touch "Exit" twice to go back to the copy screen. 20. Turn off the main power switch. 21. Install the key for "Browser Unit" to the place where you want. 22. Remove the SD card from slot 2. 23. Attach the slot cover [A] ( x 1). 24. Keep the SD card in the place ( Section: SD Card Appli Move in Installation section) after you install the application program from the card to HDD. This is because: ¬ The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program. You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.

Update Procedure 1.

Remove the slot cover [A] for SD cards ( x 1).

2.

Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 2 until you hear a click.

3.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options 4.

Push the "User Tools" key. ƒ

If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required.

5.

Push the "Login/ Logout" key.

6.

Login with the administrator user name and password.

7.

Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.

8.

Touch "Uninstall" on the LCD.

9.

Touch the "Browser" line

Installaion

Otherwise, skip to step 7

10. Confirmation message appears on the LCD. 11. Touch "Yes" to proceed. 12. Reconfirmation message appears on the LCD. 13. Touch "Yes" to uninstall the browser unit. 14. You will see "Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed". 15. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen. 16. Exit "User/Tools" setting, and then turn off the main power switch. 17. Remove the SD card from SD card slot 2. 18. Overwrite the updated program in the "sdk" folder of the browser unit application with PC. 19. Do the "Installation Procedure" to install the browser unit.

2.22.13 GIGABIT ETHERNET (D038/D041 ONLY) ƒ

SM

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

2-109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options 1.

Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] from the I/F-slot ( x 2).

2.

Install the Gigabit Ethernet board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the I/F-slot.

3.

Attach the two caps to the Ethernet (10/100 Base-T) ports as shown above.

4.

Attach the ferrite core [A] to the LAN cable [B] as shown above, and connect the LAN cable to the machine.

5.

Connect the USB cable to the USB connector.

6.

Make sure that the machine can recognize this option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).

2.22.14 MEMORY UNIT TYPE I 512MB (D038/D041 ONLY) ƒ

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)

3.

HDD bracket ( Section: HDD (Only for D038/D041)

4.

Unlock the lock levers [A].

5.

Remove the installed memory [B] (256 MB).

6.

Push the memory unit [C] (512 MB) until both lock levers lock the memory unit.

7.

Reassemble the machine.

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Options

2.22.15 CHECK ALL CONNECTIONS 1.

Plug in the power cord. Then turn on the main switch.

2.

Enter the printer user mode. Then print the configuration page. Installaion

User Tools > Printer Settings > List Test Print > Config. Page All installed options are shown in the “System Reference” column.

SM

2-111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Maintenance Tables

3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES See "Appendices" for the following information: Preventive Maintenance Items

ƒ

Other Yield Parts Preventive Maintenance

ƒ

SM

3-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PM Parts Settings

3.2 PM PARTS SETTINGS 3.2.1 BEFORE REMOVING THE OLD PM PARTS 1.

Enter the SP mode.

2.

Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004.

3.

Set the following SPs to "1" before you turn the power off. Then, the machine will reset the PM counters automatically. In the case of developer, the developer initialization will also be done automatically.

4.

Exit the SP mode.

Item

SP Black: 3902-001

Development Unit

Cyan: 3902-002 Magenta: 3902-003 Yellow: 3902-004 Black: 3902-009

Drum Unit

Cyan: 3902-010 Magenta: 3902-011 Yellow: 3902-012

ITB Unit

3902-013

Fusing Unit

3902-014

Fusing Roller

3902-015

Fusing Belt

3902-016

ITB Cleaning Unit

3902-017

PTR Unit

3902-018

PCDU Toner Collection Bottle

3902-019*1

ITB Toner Collection Bottle

3902-020*1

D037/D038/D040/D041

3-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PM Parts Settings ƒ

*1: Only if the toner collection bottle is replaced before the machine detects near-full.

For the following units, there is a new unit detection mechanism. It is not necessary to reset PM counters. ƒ

Development unit

ƒ

PCU/ ITB Toner Collection Bottle (if full or near-full)

1.

Turn on the main power switch.

2.

Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004 and check the counter values.

3.

Make sure that the PM counters for the replaced units are “0” with SP7-803. If the PM counter for a unit was not reset, then reset that counter with SP 7-804.

4.

Make sure that the exchange counter counts up with SP7-853.

5.

Make sure that the counters for the previous units (SP7-906) on the new SMC logging data list (from step 2 above) are equal to the counters (SP7-803) for these units on the previous SMC logging data list (the list that was output in the “Before removing the old parts” section).

6.

Make sure that the unit replacement date is updated with SP7-950.

3.2.3 PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION CHECK 1.

Clean the exposure glasses (for DF and book scanning).

2.

Enter the user tools mode.

3.

Do the “Automatic Color Calibration “(ACC) for the copier mode & printer mode as follows: ƒ

Print the ACC test pattern (User Tools > Maintenance > ACC > Start).

ƒ

Put the printout on the exposure glass.

ƒ

Put 10 sheets of white paper on the test chart. This ensures the precise ACC adjustment.

ƒ

Close the ARDF or the platen cover.

ƒ

Press “Start Scanning” on the LCD. Then, the machine starts the ACC.

4.

Exit the User Tools mode, and then enter the SP mode.

5.

Do the “Forced line position adjustment” as follows. ƒ

First do SP2-111-3 (Mode c).

ƒ

Then do SP2-111-1 (Mode a).

ƒ

To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.

SM

3-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Preventive Maintenance

3.2.2 AFTER INSTALLING THE NEW PM PARTS

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PM Parts Settings 6.

Exit the SP mode.

3.2.4 OPERATION CHECK Check if the sample image has been copied normally.

D037/D038/D040/D041

3-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Beforehand

4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 4.1 BEFOREHAND ƒ

Installing options, please do the following:

ƒ

If there is a fax unit in the machine, print out all messages stored in the memory, the lists of user-programmed items, and the system parameter list.

ƒ

If there are printer jobs in the machine, print out all jobs in the printer buffer.

ƒ

Turn off the main switch and disconnect the power cord, the telephone line, and

Replacement & Adjustment

the network cable.

SM

4-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Special Tools

4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS

Part Number

Description

Q’ty

B645 5010

SD Card

1

B645 6820

USB Reader/Writer

1

VSSM9000

Digital Multimeter – FLUKE87

1

C401 9503

20X Magnification Scope

1

A257 9300

Grease Barrierta – S552R

1

A092 9503

C4 Color Test Chart (3 pcs/set)

1

A184 9501

Optics Adjustment Tool (2 pcs/set)

2

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment

4.3 IMAGE ADJUSTMENT 4.3.1 SCANNING Check the printing registration/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment before you do the following scanner adjustments. ƒ

Use S-2-1 test chart to do the following adjustments.

Replacement & Adjustment

Scanner sub-scan magnification

A: Sub-scan magnification 1.

Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.

2.

Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP4-008 if necessary. Standard: ±1.0%.

Scanner leading edge and side-to-side registration

A: Leading Edge Registration

SM

4-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment 1.

Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.

2.

Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP modes if necessary. Standard: 0 ± 2 mm for the leading edge registration, 0 ± 2 mm for the side-to-side registration.

SP mode Leading Edge Registration

SP4-010-001

Side-to-Side Registration

SP4-011-001

4.3.2 ARDF ARDF side-to-side, leading edge registration and trailing edge

A: Leading edge registration, B: Side-to-Side registration Use A3/DLT paper to make a temporary test chart as shown above. 1.

Put the temporary test chart on the ARDF. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.

2.

Check the registration. Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP modes if necessary. Standard: 4.2 ± 3.0 mm for the leading edge registration, 2 ± 3.0 mm for the side-to-side registration. Use the following SP modes to adjust if necessary.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment SP Code

What It Does

Adjustment Range

SP6-006-001

Side-to-Side Registration (1st side)

± 3.0 mm

SP6-006-002

Side-to-Side Registration (2nd side)

± 3.0 mm

SP6-006-003

Leading Edge Registration

± 5.0 mm

SP6-006-005

Buckle: Duplex Front

± 5.0 mm

SP6-006-006

Buckle: Duplex Rear

± 5.0 mm

SP6-006-007

Rear Edge Erase (Trailing Edge)

± 5.0 mm

1.

Put the temporary test chart on the ARDF. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.

2.

Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP6-017-001 if necessary. ƒ

Standard: ±5.0%

ƒ

Reduction mode: ±5.0%

ƒ

Enlargement mode: ±5.0%

4.3.3 REGISTRATION Image Area

A = C = 5.2 mm (0.2"), B = 2.0 mm Make sure that the registration is adjusted within the adjustment standard range as shown below.

SM

4-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

ARDF sub-scan magnification

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment

Leading Edge Adjusts the leading edge registration for each paper type and process line speed.

Side to Side Adjusts the side-to-side registration for each paper feed station. Use SP mode (SP1-002) to adjust the side-to-side registration for the optional paper feed unit, LCT, and duplex unit.

Adjustment Standard ƒ

Leading edge (sub-scan direction): 5.2 ± 2 mm

ƒ

Side to side (main-scan direction): 2 ± 1 mm

Paper Registration Standard The registration in both main- and sub-scan directions can change within the following tolerance. ƒ

Sub-scan direction: 0 ± 9 mm

ƒ

Main-scan direction: 0 ± 4 mm

Adjustment Procedure 1.

Enter SP2-109-003.

2.

Print out the test pattern (14: Trimming Area) with SP2-109-003. ƒ

Registration can change slightly as shown on the previous page. Print some pages of the "Trimming Area" for step 3 and 4. Then average the leading edge and side-to-side registration values, and adjust each SP mode.

3.

Do the leading edge registration adjustment. 1) Check the leading edge registration and adjust it with SP1-001. 2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper type and process line speed). 3) Input the value. Then press the  key. 4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.

4.

Do the side-to-side registration adjustment. 1) Check the side-to-side registration and adjust it with SP1-002. 2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper feed station). 3) Input the value. Then press the  key. 4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.

4.3.4 ERASE MARGIN ADJUSTMENT ƒ

Adjust the erase margin C and D only if the registration (main scan and sub scan)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment cannot be adjusted within the standard values. Do the registration adjustment after

1.

Enter SP2-109-003.

2.

Print out the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern) with SP2-109-003.

3.

Check the erase margin A and B. Adjust them with SP2-103-001 to -010 if necessary. ƒ

Leading edge: 1.5 to 5.0 mm,

ƒ

Side-to-side: 0.5 to 4.0 mm,

ƒ

Trailing edge: 0.5 to 0.6 mm

4.3.5 COLOR REGISTRATION Line Position Adjustment The automatic line position adjustment usually is done for a specified condition to get the best color prints. Do the following if color registration shifts: ƒ

Do “Auto Color Registration” as follows to do the forced line position adjustment. 1.

First do SP2-111-3.

2.

Then do SP2-111-1. To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12 (0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed).

ƒ

You should also do the line position adjustment at these times: 1.

SM

After you transport or move the machine (you should do the forced line position

4-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

adjusting the erase margin C and D, and then adjust the erase margin A and B.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment adjustment if you install the machine at the user location.) if the machine is pre-installed at the workshop and moved to the user location, 2.

When you remove the PCDU

3.

When you remove or replace the motors, clutches, and/or gears related to the drum/development/transfer sections

4.

When you remove or replace the image transfer belt, image transfer belt unit or laser optical housing unit

4.3.6 PRINTER GAMMA CORRECTION ƒ

The ACC is usually sufficient to adjust the color balance to get the best print output. You only need the printer gamma correction to fine-tune to meet user requirements.

Use SP modes if you want to modify the printer gamma curve created with ACC. You can adjust the gamma data for the following: ƒ

Highlight

ƒ

Middle

ƒ

Shadow areas

ƒ

IDmax.

The adjustable range is from 0 to 30 (31 steps).

Copy Mode - Photo Mode, Full Color -

Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart

Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that

ID max:

the density of level 10

(K, C, M, and Y)

matches that of level 10 on the C-4 chart.

1 For adjusting K ID max: SP4-915-004 For adjusting C ID max: SP4-916-004 For adjusting M ID max: SP4-917-004 For adjusting Y ID max: SP4-918-004 2 Middle (Middle ID)

Adjust the offset value so that

(K, C, M, and Y)

the density of level 6 matches

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart

Adjustment Standard that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.

For adjusting K Middle: SP4-915-002 For adjusting C Middle: SP4-916-002 For adjusting M Middle: SP4-917-002 For adjusting Y Middle: SP4-918-002 Adjust the offset value so that Shadow (High ID)

the density of level 8 matches

(K, C, M, and Y)

that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.

3 Replacement & Adjustment

For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-915-003 For adjusting C Shadow: SP4-916-003 For adjusting M Shadow: SP4-917-003 For adjusting Y Shadow: SP4-918-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does not Highlight (Low ID)

show on the copy and the

(K, C, M, and Y)

density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on

4

the C-4 chart. For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-915-005 For adjusting C Highlight: SP4-916-005 For adjusting M Highlight: SP4-917-005 For adjusting Y Highlight: SP4-918-005 Adjust the offset value so that the color balance of black

K Highlight (Low ID) 5

scale levels 3 through 5 in the

(C,M, and Y)

copy is seen as gray (no C,


M, or Y should be visible). If

copy>

the black scale contains C, M, or Y, do steps 1 to 4 again.

SM

4-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart

Adjustment Standard

For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-915-005

- Photo Mode, Single Color -

Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart

Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that the density of level 10

ID max: (K)

matches that of level 10 on

1

the C-4 chart. For adjusting K ID max: SP4-909-004 Adjust the offset value so that

2

Middle (Middle ID)

the density of level 6 matches

(K)

that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.

For adjusting K Middle: SP4-909-002 Adjust the offset value so that

3

Shadow (High ID)

the density of level 8 matches

(K)

that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.

For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-909-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does not

4

Highlight (Low ID)

show on the copy and the

(K)

density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on the C-4 chart.

For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-909-001

- Text (Letter) Mode, Full Color -

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment

Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart (K)

Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that

ID max: (K, C, M,

the density of level 10

and Y)

matches that of level 10 on the C-4 chart.

1 For adjusting K ID max: SP4-910-004 For adjusting C ID max: SP4-911-004 For adjusting M ID max: SP4-912-004 For adjusting Y ID max: SP4-913-004

Middle (Middle ID)

the density of level 6 matches

(K, C, M, and Y)

that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.

2 For adjusting K Middle: SP4-910-002 For adjusting C Middle: SP4-911-002 For adjusting M Middle: SP4-912-002 For adjusting Y Middle: SP4-913-002 Adjust the offset value so that Shadow (High ID)

the density of level 8 matches

(K, C, M, and Y)

that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.

3 For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-910-003 For adjusting C Shadow: SP4-911-003 For adjusting M Shadow: SP4-912-003 For adjusting Y Shadow: SP4-913-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does not 4

Highlight (Low ID)

show on the copy and the

(K, C, M, and Y)

density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on the C-4 chart.

SM

4-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

Adjust the offset value so that

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart (K)

Adjustment Standard

For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-910-001 For adjusting C Highlight: SP4-911-001 For adjusting M Highlight: SP4-912-001 For adjusting Y Highlight: SP4-913-001

- Text (Letter) Mode, Single Color -

Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart (K)

Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that the density of level 10

ID max: (K)

matches that of level 10 on

1

the C-4 chart. For adjusting K ID max: SP4-914-004 Adjust the offset value so

2

Middle (Middle ID)

that the density of level 6

(K)

matches that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.

For adjusting K Middle: SP4-914-002 Adjust the offset value so

3

Shadow (High ID)

that the density of level 8

(K)

matches that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.

For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-914-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does 4

Highlight (Low ID)

not show on the copy and

(K)

the density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on the C-4 chart.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart (K)

Adjustment Standard

For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-914-001

ƒ

Text parts of the test pattern cannot be printed clearly after you adjust “shadow” as shown above. At this time, check if the 5 line/mm pattern at each corner is printed clearly. If it is not, adjust the offset value of “shadow” again until it is.

Printer Mode ƒ

1200 x 1200 photo mode

ƒ

1200 x 1200 text mode

ƒ

2400 x 600 photo mode

ƒ

2400 x 600 text mode

ƒ

1800 x 600 photo mode

ƒ

1800 x 600 text mode

ƒ

600 x 600 photo mode

ƒ

600 x 600 text mode

Replacement & Adjustment

There are six adjustable modes (select these modes with printer SP1-102-001):

K

C

M

Y

Highlight

SP1-104-1

SP1-104-21

SP1-104-41

SP1-104-61

Shadow

SP1-104-2

SP1-104-22

SP1-104-42

SP1-104-62

Middle

SP1-104-3

SP1-104-23

SP1-104-43

SP1-104-63

IDmax

SP1-104-4

SP1-104-24

SP1-104-44

SP1-104-64

- Adjustment Procedure 1.

Do ACC for the printer mode.

2.

Turn the main power off and on.

3.

Enter SP mode.

4.

Select “Printer SP”.

5.

Select SP1-102-001. Then select the necessary print mode to adjust.

6.

Choose SP1-103-1 to print out a tone control test sheet if you want to examine the image quality for these settings.

7.

SM

Adjust the color density with SP1-104. Compare the tone control test sheet with the C4

4-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Adjustment test chart. ƒ 8.

Adjust the density in this order: “ID Max”, “Shadow”, “Middle”, “Highlight”.

Use SP1-105-001 to keep the adjusted settings.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

4.4 EXTERIOR COVERS 4.4.1 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE If you replace this toner collection bottle after the machine detects that it is full or near-full, the machine automatically resets the PM counter for the PCDU toner collection bottle after replacement. But, if you replace a bottle that is not full or near-full, then you must reset the PM counter

Replacement & Adjustment

for this unit. To do this, set SP 3902 019 to 1 before you start to work on the machine.

1.

Open the front door [A].

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle [A] (lock x 2)

4.4.2 FRONT DOOR 1.

Open the front door.

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))

SM

4-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

3.

Release the belt [A].

4.

Front door [A] ( x 2, pin x 2)

4.4.3 ITB CLEANING UNIT COVER

1.

Open the ITB cleaning unit cover [A] ( x 2).

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

2.

Release the tab [A], and then remove the ITB cleaning unit cover [B].

Replacement & Adjustment

4.4.4 LEFT COVER

1.

Left cover [A] ( x 10)

4.4.5 REAR COVER

1.

SM

Rear cover [A] ( x 8)

4-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers ƒ

Remove the screw [B] of the lower cover when reinstalling the rear cover.

4.4.6 REAR LOWER COVER

1.

Rear lower cover [A] ( x 5)

4.4.7 DUST FILTER

1.

Dust filter cover [A] (hooks)

2.

Dust filter [B]

4.4.8 RIGHT REAR COVER 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

2.

Open the duplex unit [A].

3.

Right rear cover [B] ( x 5)

Replacement & Adjustment

4.4.9 OPERATION PANEL For D038/D041

1.

Remove six screws on the operation panel [A].

2.

Slide the operation panel to the front side.

3.

Disconnect the harness [A].

SM

4-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers 4.

Operation panel [B]

For D037/D040

1.

Remove six screws on the operation panel.

2.

Slide the operation panel to the front side.

3.

Remove the connector [A].

4.

Operation panel [B]

4.4.10 TOUCH PANEL POSITION ADJUSTMENT (D038/D041) ƒ

It is necessary to calibrate the touch panel at the following times:

ƒ

When you replace the operation panel.

ƒ

When you replace the controller board.

ƒ

When the touch panel detection function does not operate correctly

Do not use items [2] to [9] on the Self-Diagnostic Menu. These items are for design use only. 1.

Press S, press , press \ 5 times to open the Self-Diagnostics menu.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

2.

On the touch screen press “Touch Screen Adjust” (or press ).

3.

Use a pointed (not sharp) tool to press the upper left mark).

4.

Press the lower right mark when “*” shows.

5.

Press [#] OK on the screen (or press k) when you are finished.

6.

Touch [#] Exit on the screen to close the Self-Diagnostic menu. Save the calibration settings.

4.4.11 INNER RIGHT COVER 1.

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

2.

Press the ITB lock lever [A] and turn it up clockwise as shown above.

3.

Inner right cover [B] ( x 2)

4.4.12 INNER COVER 1.

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

2.

Inner right cover ( Section: Inner Cover)

SM

4-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

Exterior Covers

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

3.

Inner cover [A] ( x 4)

4.4.13 FRONT RIGHT COVER 1.

Open the duplex unit.

1.

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

1.

Inner right cover ( Section: Inner Right Cover)

2.

Remove the front right cover [A] with the operation panel [B] lifted up ( x 1).

4.4.14 RIGHT UPPER COVER

1.

Right upper cover [A] ( x 2)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

1.

Left frame cover [A] ( x 1)

2.

Left frame rear cover [B] ( x 2) Replacement & Adjustment

4.4.15 LEFT FRAME AND LEFT FRAME REAR COVER

4.4.16 PAPER EXIT COVER

1.

Inverter tray [A]

2.

Paper exit cover [B] ( x 1)

SM

4-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

4.4.17 INVERTER TRAY

1.

Inverter tray [A] (hooks)

4.4.18 INNER TRAY

1.

Inner tray [A] ( x 2)

4.4.19 INNER REAR COVER 1.

Left frame cover ( Section: Left Frame and Left Frame Rear Cover)

2.

Paper exit cover ( Section: Paper Exit Cover)

3.

Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Exterior Covers

Inner rear cover [A] ( x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

4.

SM

4-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

4.5 SCANNER UNIT 4.5.1 EXPOSURE GLASS 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Open the ARDF or platen cover.

3.

Glass cover [A] ( x 4)

4.

Scanner right cover [A] ( x 2)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit 5.

ARDF exposure glass [A] ƒ

Position the white marker [B] at the rear-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.

Rear scale [A] ( x 3)

7.

Exposure glass [A] with left scale ƒ

Replacement & Adjustment

6.

Position the marker at the front-left corner when you reattach the exposure glass.

4.5.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS 1.

SM

Exposure glass with left scale ( Section: Exposure Glass)

4-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

2.

SBU cover [A] ( x 6) ƒ

The three screws [B] do not need to be fully removed. Just loosen them to remove the SBU cover.

3.

Original length sensors [A] (hooks, = x1, x 1 each))

4.5.3 EXPOSURE LAMP 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Operation panel ( Section: Operation Panel)

3.

Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit Scanner rear cover [A] ( x 1)

5.

Disconnect the connector [A] from the lamp stabilizer [B].

6.

Move the carriage unit [A] to the cutout position [B].

7.

Cable guide [A] (hooks)

Replacement & Adjustment

4.

ƒ 8.

SM

Keep the cable guide for reassembling.

Adjustor clamp [B] ( x 1)

4-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit 9.

Pulley [C]

10. Release the cable clamp [A] (one hook under the cable clamp) at the rear edge of the exposure lamp. 11. Hold down the snap [B], and then slide the exposure lamp [C] to the front side.

12. Exposure lamp [A]

Reassembling

Run the cable so there is no slack. Slide the adjustor clamp [A] to adjust the cable slack.

4.5.4 SCANNER MOTOR 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

Scanner motor bracket [A] ( x 2, spring x 1, x 1, timing belt x 1)

3.

Scanner motor [A] ( x 2, ground plate [B] x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

2.

ƒ

Make sure that the ground plate [B] is attached when installing the scanner motor in the scanner motor bracket.

ƒ

Do the scanner image adjustment after replacing the scanner motor ( Section: Image Adjustment).

4.5.5 SENSOR BOARD UNIT (SBU) 1.

SM

Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)

4-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

2.

Original length sensor bracket [A] ( x 1, = x1, x 1 each)

3.

Sensor board unit [A] ( x 4, ground screw x 1, x 2)

When reassembling Adjust the following SP modes after you replace the sensor board unit: ƒ

SP4–008 (Sub Scan Mag): Section: "Image Adjustment: Scanning".

ƒ

SP4–010 (Sub Mag Reg.): Section: "Image Adjustment: Scanning".

ƒ

SP4–011 (Main Scan Reg): Section: "Image Adjustment: Scanning".

ƒ

SP4–688 (DF: Density Adjustment): Use this to adjust the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.

4.5.6 EXPOSURE LAMP STABILIZER 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

2.

Exposure lamp stabilizer bracket [A] ( x 2, x 2)

4.5.7 SCANNER HP SENSOR Rear Cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Scanner rear cover ( Section: Exposure Lamp)

3.

Move the 1st scanner carriage [A] to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [B]

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

clockwise.

4.

Remove the mylar [A].

5.

Remove the scanner HP sensor [B] ( x 1, hooks).

SM

4-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

4.5.8 PLATEN COVER SENSOR 1.

Scanner rear cover ( Section: Exposure Lamp)

2.

Holder bracket [A] ( x 1)

3.

Platen cover sensor [B] ( x 1)

4.5.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE 1.

Rear Cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Operation panel ( Section: Operation Panel)

3.

Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)

4.

Scanner left cover [A] ( x 2)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

Scanner left stay [A] ( x 3)

6.

Scanner front frame [B] ( x 5)

7.

Take aside the connector bracket [A] ( x 2).

8.

Scanner rear frame [B] ( x 8, = x all, x all)

9.

Scanner motor bracket ( Section: Scanner Motor)

Replacement & Adjustment

5.

10. Rear scanner drive pulley [A] ( x 1)

SM

4-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

11. Front scanner wire clamp [A] 12. Loosen the front scanner wire bracket [B] ( x 1) 13. Front scanner wire 14. Move the shaft [C] in the red arrow direction ( x 1: at front), and remove the scanner drive pulley [D] ( x 1). ƒ

When removing the rear scanner wire, remove the e-ring at the rear side of the shaft.

Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire

1.

Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.

2.

Pass the right end (with the ball) [B] through the square hole. Pass the left end (with

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit the ring) through the notch. 3.

Wind the right end counterclockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times. Wind the left end clockwise three times. ƒ

The two green marks [C] come together when you have done this. Stick the wire to the pulley with tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the

Replacement & Adjustment

time of installation.

4.

Install the drive pulley on the shaft [A]. ƒ

5.

Do not attach the pulley to the shaft with the screw at this time.

Insert the left end into the slit [B]. The end should go via the rear track of the left pulley [C] and the rear track of the movable pulley [D].

SM

4-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit

6.

Hook the right end onto the front scanner wire bracket [A]. The end should go via the rear track of the right pulley [B] and the front track of the movable pulley [C]. ƒ

Do not attach the scanner wire bracket with the screw at this time.

[D] [I]

[A]

[H]

[B] [E]

[G]

[C] [F]

d037r273

7.

Remove the tape from the drive pulley.

8.

Insert a scanner positioning pin [A] through the 2nd carriage hole [B] and the left holes [C] in the front rail. Insert another scanner positioning pin [D] through the 1st carriage hole [E] and the right holes in the front rail [F].

9.

Insert two more scanner positioning pins through the holes in the rear rail.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit 10. Screw the drive pulley to the shaft [G]. 11. Screw the scanner wire bracket to the front rail [H]. 12. Install the scanner wire clamp [I]. 13. Pull out the positioning pins. ƒ

Make sure the 1st and 2nd carriages move smoothly after you remove the positioning pins. Do steps 8 through 13 again if they do not.

1.

Rear Cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Operation panel ( Section:.Operation Panel)

3.

Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)

4.

Scanner left cover ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)

5.

Scanner front frame ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)

6.

Scanner left stay ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)

7.

Scanner rear frame ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)

8.

Follow steps 10 through 14 in Section: Front Scanner Wire. You can remove the rear scanner wire with the same manner for replacing the front scanner wire.

Reinstalling the Rear Scanner Wire

1.

Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.

2.

Pass the left end (with the ball) [B] through the drive pulley notch. Pass the right end (with the ring) through the drive pulley hole.

3.

Wind the left end [B] clockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times. Wind the right end counterclockwise three times.

SM

4-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

4.5.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Unit ƒ

The two green marks [C] come together when you do this. Attach the wire to the pulley with tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.

4.

Install the drive pulley on the shaft. ƒ

5.

Do not attach the pulley on the shaft with the screw at this time.

Install the wire. ƒ

The winding of the wire on the three pulleys at the rear of the scanner should be the same as the winding on the three pulleys at the front. This must show as a mirror image.

Example: At the front of the machine, the side of the drive pulley with the three windings must face the front of the machine. At the rear of the machine, it must face the rear. 6.

Do steps 7 through 13 from the “Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire” ( Section: Front Scanner Wire).

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Laser Optics

4.6 LASER OPTICS ƒ

Turn off the main switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section. Laser beams can cause serious eye injury.

4.6.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATION

Replacement & Adjustment

The caution decal is placed as shown below.

ƒ

Be sure to turn off the main switch and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet before beginning any disassembly or adjustment of the laser unit. This copier uses a class IIIb laser beam with a wavelength of 648 - 663 nm and an output of 9 mW. The laser can cause serious eye injury.

4.6.2 LASER UNIT ƒ

Before installing a new laser unit, remove the polygon motor holder bracket and the tag from the new unit.

SM

4-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Laser Optics

Preparing a new laser unit

1.

Polygon mirror motor cover [A] of the laser unit ( x 4)

2.

Polygon motor holder bracket [B] with a red tag ( x 3)

3.

Install the three screws [C] (removed in step 2) in the laser unit.

4.

Reinstall the polygon mirror motor cover [A] ( x 4).

Before removing the old laser unit Do the following settings before removing the laser unit. These are adjustments for skew

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Laser Optics adjustment motors in the laser unit. 1.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the copier.

2.

Enter the SP mode.

3.

Execute SP2-220-001 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Cyan.

4.

Execute SP2-220-002 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Magenta.

5.

Execute SP2-220-003 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Yellow.

6.

Exit the SP mode.

7.

Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.

Recovery procedure for no replacement preparation of laser unit If you did not do the procedure in ‘Before removing the laser unit’ before removing the laser unit, you must do the following. Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.

2.

Remove the left cover (see the following "Removing the laser unit").

3.

Disconnect the harness [A] of the skew correction motor.

4.

Do steps 1 to 7 of "Before removing the laser unit".

5.

Connect the harness [A] and reinstall the left cover.

6.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

SM

4-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Laser Optics

Removing the laser unit

1.

Left cover [A] ( x 10)

2.

ITB cleaning unit [A] ( x 2)

3.

Ventilation rear fan holder [A] ( x 2, x 1)

4.

Ventilation front fan holder [B] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Laser Optics

5.

Remove the laser unit [A] ( x 2, = x 2, x 3)

After installing a new laser unit 1.

Open the front door of the machine.

2.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

3.

Check that the settings of SP2-119-001, -002 and -003 are "0". If these settings are not "0", execute "Recovery procedure for no replacement preparation of laser unit" described above. ƒ

4.

If this step is not correctly done, an image problem may occur on printouts.

Input the SP settings on the sheet provided with a new LD unit. ƒ

SP2-101-001 to -004: Color Registration: Main Scan for each color

ƒ

SP2-101-013 to -016: Color Registration: Sub Scan for each color

ƒ

SP2-102-001, -003, -004, -006, -007, -009, -010, -012: Main Magnification for each color and line speed

ƒ

SM

SP2-104-001 to -004: :LD Initial Power Adjustment for each color

4-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

Do the following adjustment after installing the new laser unit.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Laser Optics ƒ

The printed values [A] are different for each laser unit.

5.

Print the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern in the SP2-109-003).

6.

Check that the left and right trim margin is within 4 ± 1 mm. If not, change the standard value for the main scan magnification adjustment.

7.

Select "0" with SP2-109-003 after printing the "1-dot trimming pattern.

8.

Do the line position adjustment. ƒ

First do SP2-111-003.

ƒ

Then do SP2-111-001.

ƒ

To check if SP 2-111-001 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-010 to -012.

9.

Exit the SP mode.

4.6.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR 1.

Laser unit ( Section: Laser Unit)

2.

Polygon mirror motor cover [A] ( x 4)

3.

Polygon mirror motor holder [A] ( x 1)

4.

Polygon mirror motor [B] ( x 4, x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Laser Optics After installing the laser optics housing unit: ƒ

Do the "Line Pos. Adjust Execute:Mode c" (SP2-111-003).

ƒ

Then do the "Line Pos. Adjust Execute:Mode a" (SP2-111-001).

To check if SP 2-111-001 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message

Replacement & Adjustment

is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP2-194-010 to -012.

SM

4-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

4.7 IMAGE CREATION 4.7.1 PCDU (PHOTO CONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT) ƒ

Do not touch the OPC drum. Do not let metal objects touch the development sleeve.

1.

Open the front door.

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

3.

Turn the ITB lock lever [A] to the ‘up’ position.

4.

PCDU [B] ( x 2 each)

When installing a new PCDU

Remove the cover [A] on the toner inlet and pull out the tape [B] from the new development unit before installing a new PCDU in the machine.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

4.7.2 DRUM UNIT AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT The new drum unit has a front cover. When you attach the new drum unit to the development unit, remove the front cover first. Use it for installing the new drum unit and development unit. 1.

If you install a new drum unit only, set SP 3902-xxx to "1". ƒ

Black: 3902-009

ƒ

Cyan: 3902-010

ƒ

Magenta: 3902-011

ƒ

Yellow: 3902-012 ƒ

If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the drum unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.

If you install a new development unit only, set SP 3902-xxx to "1". ƒ

Black: 3902-001

ƒ

Cyan: 3902-002

ƒ

Magenta: 3902-003

ƒ

Yellow: 3902-004 ƒ

Replacement & Adjustment

2.

If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the development unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.

3.

Turn the machine power off.

4.

PCDU ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))

5.

Front cover [A] ( x 2)

SM

4-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

6.

Rear cover [A] ( x 2)

7.

Drum unit [A] and development unit [B] ( x 1)

ƒ

When the development unit is removed from the drum unit, clean the entrance mylar [A] with a vacuum cleaner.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

Remove the connector [A] with a small flat tool [B]. ƒ

9.

Keep this connector [A] for the new drum unit.

If you change the development unit, do the ACC procedure.

10. Execute the drum phase adjustment with SP1902-001 twice.

New unit detection for the development unit When a new development unit is installed in the machine, the machine will automatically reset the PM counters for the development unit and drum unit, even if the drum unit was not changed. To avoid resetting both counters after you install a new development unit only, make sure that step 2 in the procedure above is done before installing.

4.7.3 TONER HOPPER UNIT Toner hopper unit: K, C, M 1.

Open the front door.

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

3.

Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)

4.

PCDU ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit)) ƒ

Remove the corresponding color PCDU. For example, if you remove the toner hopper unit: K, remove the black PCDU.

SM

4-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

8.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

5.

Toner supply drive gear [A] (hook x 1)

6.

Toner hopper unit: K, C, M [B] ( x 2, = x 1 for K and M; 2 for C , x 1 each)

7.

Place the toner hopper unit [A] on sheets of paper.

Toner hopper unit: Y 1.

Open the front door.

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

3.

Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)

4.

PCDU ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))

5.

Gear cover [A] ( x 2, = x 2)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation 6.

Toner supply drive gear (hook x 1)

7.

Toner hopper unit: Y [B] ( x 2, x 1 each)

8.

Place the toner hopper unit [A] on sheets of paper.

Developer must be added to the new toner hopper. Some developer (8 g) is provided with each new toner hopper unit. Pour this into the toner hopper unit before reattaching the inner cover.

1.

Slowly open the toner hopper shutter [A]. ƒ

Do not try to open the toner hopper shutter fully at one try. This shutter comes off easily without the inner cover. If the toner hopper shutter has come off, reattach it.

2.

Pour the developer (8 g) into the inlet [B] of the toner hopper unit.

3.

Close the toner hopper shutter.

4.

Reassemble the machine.

4.7.4 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR 1.

SM

Open the front door.

4-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

When installing a new toner hopper unit

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation 2.

PCDU toner collection bottle Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

3.

Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)

4.

Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)

5.

Toner supply drive gear [A] (hook x 1)

6.

Pull the toner supply drive shaft [B].

7.

Take aside the toner supply gear unit [A] ( x 3).

NOTE When removing the toner supply gear unit for Yellow, one of screws on the toner supply gear unit is difficult to see. 1) Remove the left cover ( Section: Left Cover)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

Replacement & Adjustment

2) Check the screw position [A] as shown above.

8.

Release the clamp [A], and then disconnect the harness [B].

9.

Toner supply motor [A] (= x 1, x 1,  x 2)

4.7.5 TONER COLLECTION MOTOR 1.

Open the front door.

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

3.

PCDU: Yellow ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))

SM

4-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation 4.

Ventilation Fan: Front ( Ventilation Fan)

5.

Disconnect two harnesses [A].

6.

Toner collection motor assembly [A] (= x 2,  x 3)

7.

Gears [A] ( x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

8.

Toner collection motor [A] ( x 2)

4.7.6 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR Toner collection motor assembly ( Section: Toner Collection Motor)

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle full sensor [A] (= x 1, x 1, hooks)

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

4.7.7 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE SET SWITCH 1.

Toner collection motor assembly ( Section: Toner Collection Motor)

2.

PCDU toner collection bottle set switch [A] (hooks, x 1)

SM

4-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Creation

4.7.8 RFID BOARD 1.

All toner hopper units ( Section: Toner Hopper Unit)

2.

Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)

3.

Toner supply drive shafts [A]

4.

Harness cover [A] ( x 1)

5.

RFID board [A] ( x 3, = x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

4.8 IMAGE TRANSFER 4.8.1 ITB CLEANING UNIT If you replace the cleaning unit or toner collection bottle after the machine detects that it is full or near-full, the machine automatically resets the PM counter for the bottle after replacement. But, if you replace a bottle that is not full or near-full, then you must reset the PM counter for this unit. To do this, set SPs 3902-017 and -020 to 1 before you turn off the power switch. If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the units automatically, after you turn the power on again. SP 3902-017 is for the ITB cleaning unit and SP 3902-020 is for the ITB toner collection

1.

Left cover ( Section: Left Cover)

2.

ITB cleaning unit [A] ( x 2)

Replacement & Adjustment

bottle.

When installing the ITB cleaning unit Secure the front side [B] first with a screw. This [B] is the positioning screw.

4.8.2 ITB TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR 1.

SM

Left cover ( Section: Left Cover)

4-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

2.

Bottle full sensor assembly [A] ( x 1, = x 1, x 1)

3.

ITB toner collection bottle full sensor [B] (hooks)

4.8.3 ITB (IMAGE TRANSFER BELT) UNIT 1.

Left cover ( Section: Left Cover)

2.

ITB cleaning unit ( Section: ITB Cleaning Unit)

3.

PCU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

4.

Unlock the ITB lock lever ( Section: Inner Right Cover).

5.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

6.

Hinge bracket [A] ( x 1)

7.

Pull the lever [B] to open the paper transfer unit.

8.

Harness cover [C] ( x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

9.

Grasp the handles [A], and then pull out the ITB unit fully [B] ( x 2, x 1).

10. Remove the ITB unit motor after pulling out the ITB unit from the machine. ( Next procedure)

1.

ITB cleaning unit ( Section: ITB Cleaning Unit)

2.

ITB unit ( Section: ITB Unit)

3.

ITB unit motor [A] ( x 3, x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

4.8.4 ITB UNIT MOTOR

4.8.5 IMAGE TRANSFER BELT 1.

ITB cleaning unit ( Section: ITB Cleaning Unit)

2.

ITB unit ( Section: ITB Unit)

3.

ITB unit motor ( Section: ITB Unit Motor)

SM

4-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

4.

Two stays [A] ( x 2 each)

5.

Rear holder bracket [A] (as seen from the front) ( x 1: M3x10)

6.

Front holder bracket [A] (as seen from the rear) ( x 1: M3x10)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

Handle [A] ( x 2: M3x10)

8.

Guide bracket [A]

9.

Pull the tension roller [A] as shown.

Replacement & Adjustment

7.

SM

4-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

10. Front guide pin bracket [A] ( x 1) 11. Press roller bracket [B] ( x 2)

12. Attach the handle, which was removed in step 6, to the projection [B] on the rear left side ( x 1). ƒ

This handle will be used as a stand in later steps.

13. Stand the ITB unit [A] as shown above.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer 14. Image transfer belt [B]

ƒ

Reset the PM counter

ƒ

There is a rim [A] at each edge of the transfer belt. The ends of all the rollers ([B] for example) in the transfer belt unit must be between the two rims. ƒ

There are two rims (width [C]: about 5 mm) at the front and rear edges inside the image transfer belt.

ƒ

This belt must be installed the correct way around. When you reinstall the image transfer belt unit, install it with the number [A] on the belt at the rear side of the unit.

4.8.6 ITB CONTACT MOTOR 1.

Pull out all the toner bottles.

2.

Inverter tray ( Section: Inverter Tray)

3.

Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)

SM

4-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

When reinstalling a new image transfer belt

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

4.

Take aside the ITB contact motor unit [A] ( x 2)

5.

Disconnect two harnesses [A], and then remove the ITB contact motor unit (= x 1)

6.

ITB contact motor [A] ( x 2)

4.8.7 ITB CONTACT SENSOR 1.

ITB contact motor unit ( Section: ITB Contact Motor)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Image Transfer

ITB contact sensor [A] (hooks)

Replacement & Adjustment

2.

SM

4-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Transfer

4.9 PAPER TRANSFER 4.9.1 PTR (PAPER TRANSFER ROLLER) UNIT ƒ

If you install a new PTR unit, then set SP 3902-018 to "1" before you start this procedure. ƒ

If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the paper transfer unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.

1.

Open the duplex unit.

2.

Open the paper transfer unit [A].

3.

Remove the PTR unit [A], releasing the two locks [B].

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Transfer

4.

Remove the two springs [A]. ƒ

Keep these two springs from the old PTR unit and install them in the new PTR unit.

1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Hinge bracket [A] ( x 1)

3.

Open the paper transfer unit [B].

Replacement & Adjustment

4.9.2 OPENING THE PAPER TRANSFER UNIT

4.9.3 ID SENSOR BOARD 1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

SM

4-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Transfer

3.

ID sensor cover [A] ( x 2)

4.

ID sensor board [A] ( x 6, , = x 1, x 1) ƒ

If the black spacer [B] is stuck to the sensor board as shown above, remove all black spacers. These black spacers should be used when a new ID sensor board is installed.

Cleaning for ID sensors ID sensors require cleaning maintenance every EM. Do the following steps for ID sensor cleaning. 1.

PCDU: K ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))

2.

ITB unit ( Section: ITB (Image Transfer Belt) Unit)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Transfer

Clean the ID sensors [A]. ƒ

Use a cloth moistened with alcohol to clean the ID sensors. ƒ

Do not use a dry cloth. Otherwise, the ID sensors may get more dirty due to static electricity.

After installing a new ID sensor unit/board Do the following adjustment after installing a new ID sensor unit/board. 1.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the copier.

2.

Enter the SP mode.

3.

Input all correction coefficients [A] for the ID sensor with the SP modes referring to the barcode sheet provided with the new ID sensor unit/board. ƒ

4.

For example, input "0.98" with SP3-362-013.

Exit the SP mode.

4.9.4 TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR 1.

SM

Right rear cover ( Section: Right Rear Cover)

4-71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

3.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Transfer

2.

Temperature and humidity sensor [A] ( x 1, x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit

Replacement & Adjustment

4.10 DRIVE UNIT

The drawing above shows the drive unit layout.

1. ITB drive motor

6. Drum/Development motor: K

2. Fusing/paper exit motor

7. Paper feed motor: T1

3. Drum motor: CMY

8. Paper feed motor: T2

4. Development motor: CMY

9. Registration motor

5. Development clutch: K

There are some motors and clutches that are not shown in the above drawing:

ƒ

Duplex inverter motor

ƒ

Duplex Exit Motor

ƒ

Duplex Entrance Motor

ƒ

By-pass Motor

4.10.1 GEAR UNIT 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)

SM

4-73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit 3.

Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)

4.

Remove all connectors and clamps (blue arrows) on the HVPS: CB board [A].

5.

Pull all the PCDUs to the front side. ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))

6.

Gear unit [A] ( x all, = x all: blue arrows,  x 8) ƒ

The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the gear unit.

Adjustment after reinstalling the gear unit Do the following procedures after reinstalling the gear unit. 1.

Turn on the main power switch.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit 2.

Enter "System SP" in the SP mode.

3.

Do "Drum Phase Adj." with SP1902-001.

4.

Check the result of the Drum Phase Adjustment with SP1902-002. 0: Success, 2: Failure due to no sampling data, 3: Failure due to insufficient number of pattern detections When the result of this adjustment is "2" or "3": ƒ

Check that the all PCDUs are correctly set and that the ITB unit is correctly set.

ƒ

Do "Drum Phase Adj." again after checking the PCDUs and ITB unit.

When the result is still "2" or "3" after checking the PCDUs and image transfer belt unit: ƒ 5.

Check that the gear unit is installed correctly.

Exit the SP mode.

1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)

3.

Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)

4.

Registration motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

4.10.2 REGISTRATION MOTOR

4.10.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T1 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Right Lower Cover)

3.

Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)

SM

4-75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit

4.

Paper feed motor: T1 [A] ( x 1,  x 2) ƒ

The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the paper feed motor T1.

4.10.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T2 1.

Rear cover Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section:Rear Lower Cover)

3.

Paper feed motor: T2 [A] ( x 1,  x 2)

4.10.5 DRUM MOTOR: CMY

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit Do not remove the PCDUs when you replace the drum motor-CMY.

1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)

3.

Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)

4.

Drum motor: CMY [A] ( x 3, x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

ƒ

4.10.6 DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: CMY 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover

2.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)

3.

Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)

4.

Development motor: CMY [A] ( x 3, x 1)

4.10.7 DRUM/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: K 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

1.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)

2.

Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)

SM

4-77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit

3.

Drum/Development motor: K [A] ( x 3, x 1)

4.10.8 DEVELOPMENT CLUTCH: K 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

1.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)

2.

Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)

3.

Drum/Development Motor: K ( Section: Drum/Development Motor: K)

4.

Remove the bracket with the development clutch: K [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)

5.

Remove the development clutch: K [B] from the bracket.

4.10.9 FUSING/PAPER EXIT MOTOR 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

1.

Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)

2.

Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)

3.

Drum/Development Motor: K ( Section: Drum/Development Motor: K)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit

4.

Loosen the stay [A] ( x 1, hook [B] x 1) ƒ

The hook [B] is installed as shown above. Do not pull the stay by force, or the

Replacement & Adjustment

hook might be broken.

5.

Fusing/paper exit motor [A] ( x 3, x 1) ƒ

The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the fusing/paper exit motor.

SM

4-79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Unit

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

4.11 FUSING 4.11.1 PM PARTS

PM Parts

Replacement Procedure

Fusing Roller

Section: Heating, Fusing and Tension Roller

Fusing Belt

Section: Fusing Belt

Section: Heating Roller Thermistor and Section:

Thermistor

Entrance Guide Plate

Section: Entrance Guide Plate

Exit Guide Plate

Section: Exit Guide Plate Cleaning Procedure

Stripper Plate

Section: Stripper Plate

Thermopile

Section: Thermopile

4.11.2 FUSING UNIT ƒ

Turn off the main switch and wait until the fusing unit cools down before beginning any of the procedures in this section. The fusing unit can cause serious burns.

1.

If you install a new fusing unit (at PM for example), then set SP 3902-014 to "1" before you start this procedure. ƒ

If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the fusing unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.

2.

Turn off the main power switch.

3.

Open the duplex unit.

SM

4-81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

Pressure Roller Thermistor

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

4.

Open the paper transfer unit [A]

5.

Release the lock levers [B].

6.

Hold the fusing unit handles [C], and then pull out the fusing unit.

When installing the fusing unit Make sure that the both lock levers [B] are locked before closing the duplex unit. Otherwise, these lock levers [B] can be broken.

4.11.3 ENTRANCE GUIDE PLATE 1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Entrance Guide Plate [A] ( x 2)

Cleaning Requirement The entrance guide plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the entrance guide plate with a cloth moistened with alcohol at the following points.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

Replacement & Adjustment

4.11.4 STRIPPER PLATE 1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Fusing upper cover [A] ( x 4)

3.

Spring [A] and bearing [B] at front and rear side

SM

4-83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

4.

Top frame [A] ( x 4, x 1)

5.

Release the springs [A] at the front and rear side.

6.

Stripper plate [B]

Cleaning Requirement The stripper plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the stripper plate with a cloth moistened with alcohol at the following points.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

4.11.5 EXIT GUIDE PLATE CLEANING PROCEDURE The exit guide plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Open the exit guide plate [A].

3.

Clean the exit guide plate [A] with a cloth moistened with alcohol.

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

4.11.6 PRESSURE ROLLER FUSING LAMP 1.

SM

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

4-85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

2.

Fusing upper cover [A] ( x 4)

3.

Remove the cable [A] from the rear stay ( x 1).

4.

Remove the cable [A] from the front stay ( x 1). ƒ

The color of the pressure roller fusing lamp cord differs depending on the destination.

ƒ 5.

Red: 220 - 240 V, Blue: 120 V

Front pressure roller lamp stay [B] ( x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

6.

Pressure roller fusing lamp [A]

4.11.7 HEATING ROLLER FUSING LAMP Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Remove the cords [A] from the front stay ( x 2)

3.

Remove the cords [A] from the rear stay ( x 2)

4.

Rear stay [B] ( x 2)

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

SM

4-87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

5.

Heating roller fusing lamp [A]

4.11.8 FUSING BELT If you install a new fusing belt, set SP 3902-016 to "1" before you start this procedure. ƒ

If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the fusing belt automatically, after you turn the power on again.

1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)

3.

Heating roller fusing lamp ( Section: Heating Roller Fusing Lamp)

4.

Idle gear [A] and fusing roller gear [B]

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

Remove the front cord [A] of the pressure roller fusing lamp ( x 1).

6.

Front stay [B] ( x 2)

7.

Spring [A] and bearing [B] at front and rear side

8.

Top frame [A] ( x 4, x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

5.

SM

4-89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

9.

Release the springs [A] at the front and rear side.

10. Stripper plate [B]

11. Take the thermostat base [A] aside ( x 2). ƒ

This prevents the fusing belt from being torn or scratched when the fusing belt is removed from the fusing unit.

12. Bearings [A] of the heating roller (C-ring x 1 each)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing 13. Bearings [B] of the fusing roller ( x 1 each)

Replacement & Adjustment

14. Fusing belt [A] with rollers

15. Fusing belt [A]

4.11.9 HEATING, FUSING AND TENSION ROLLER If you install a new fusing roller, set SP 3902-015 to "1" before you start this procedure. ƒ

If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the fusing unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.

1.

SM

Fusing belt with rollers ( Section: Fusing Belt)

4-91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

2.

Fusing roller [A]

3.

Heating roller [B]

4.

Tension roller [C]

When reinstalling the fusing roller When replacing the fusing roller, you have to apply lubricant to the following places. Fusing Roller

ƒ

Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the area [A] at the front side of the fusing roller.

ƒ

Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the area [B] at the rear side of the fusing roller. ƒ

Do not apply lubricant to areas other than the areas [A] and [B] as shown above.

4.11.10 PRESSURE ROLLER 1.

Fusing belt with rollers ( Section: Fusing Belt)

2.

Pressure roller fusing lamp ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

Pressure levers [A] at the rear side (snap ring x 1, spring x 1)

4.

Top right frame [A] ( x 4)

5.

Pressure roller gear [A] and bearing [B] at the rear side (C-ring x 1)

6.

Bearing [C] (C-ring x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

3.

SM

4-93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

7.

Pressure roller [A]

Cleaning Requirement The pressure roller requires cleaning maintenance (if it is dirty) at every 60 K interval. Clean the pressure roller with a cloth moistened with alcohol.

4.11.11 HEATING ROLLER THERMOSTATS 1.

Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)

2.

Heating roller thermostats [A] ( x 3) ƒ

Do not re-use a thermostat that is already opened. Safety is not guaranteed if you do this.

4.11.12 HEATING ROLLER THERMISTOR 1.

Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

Disconnect the connector [A].

3.

Heating roller thermistor assembly [B] ( x 1)

4.

Heating roller thermistor [A] ( x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

2.

Cleaning Requirement The heating roller thermistor requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the heating roller thermistor with a dry cloth.

4.11.13 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMISTOR Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center 1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)

SM

4-95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

3.

Thermistor center assembly [A] ( x 1, x 1)

4.

Pressure roller thermistor: Center [A] ( x 1)

Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center 1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)

3.

Thermistor end assembly [A] ( x 1, x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

4.

Pressure roller thermistor: End [A] ( x 1)

Cleaning Requirement The pressure roller thermistors (center and end) require cleaning maintenance at every 60 Replacement & Adjustment

K interval. Clean the pressure roller thermistors (center and end) with a dry cloth.

4.11.14 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMOSTAT 1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

1.

Fusing belt with rollers ( Section: Fusing Belt)

2.

Pressure roller ( Section: Pressure Roller)

3.

Pressure roller thermostats [A] ( x 2)

4.11.15 THERMOPILE 1.

SM

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

4-97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

2.

Thermopile base [A] ( x 1, x 1)

3.

Thermopile cover [A] ( x 2)

4.

Thermopile [B]

When cleaning the lens of the thermopile ƒ

Do this cleaning procedure after the fusing unit has completely cooled down. Otherwise, you may get a serious burn.

1.

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Clean the thermopile lens [A] with a dry cloth.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

4.11.16 CLEANING UNIT (OPTION) INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Fusing upper cover [A] ( x 4)

3.

Top right frame [A] ( x 4)

4.

Install the cleaning unit [A] in the fusing unit.

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

SM

4-99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fusing

5.

Secure the cleaning unit [A] ( x 2)

6.

Reassemble the fusing unit.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed

4.12 PAPER FEED

1.

Pull paper tray 1 or 2 [A] part of the way out.

2.

Remove two screws from both tray guides.

3.

Pull out paper tray 1 or 2 [A].

Replacement & Adjustment

4.12.1 PAPER TRAY

4.12.2 FEED ROLLER Tray 1 and Tray 2 1.

Paper tray 1 or 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)

2.

Press down the bottom plate [A].

3.

Slide the feed roller shaft [B] to the rear side ( x 1).

4.

Feed roller [C] (hook x 1)

When reinstalling the feed roller Do not touch the feed roller with your bare hands when replacing it. If you do, clean the feed roller with a damp cloth or alcohol.

4.12.3 FRICTION PAD 1.

SM

Paper tray 1 or 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)

4-101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed 2.

Feed roller ( Section: Feed Roller)

3.

Remove the coupling gear [A] (pin x 1, spring x 1,  x 1).

4.

Slide the feed roller shaft to the front side, and then remove it.

5.

Friction pad [A] (hooks, spring x 1)

When reinstalling the friction pad

Make sure that the mylar [A] does not go under the friction pad when reinstalling the friction pad. Do not touch the feed roller with your bare hands, when replacing it. If you do, clean the feed roller with a damp cloth or alcohol.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed

4.12.4 PAPER SIZE SWITCH Paper tray 1 and 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)

ƒ

Paper size switch: T1 [A]

ƒ

Paper size switch: T2 [B] Replacement & Adjustment

1.

2.

Paper size switch [A] (hooks, x 1)

4.12.5 PAPER END SENSOR Paper End Sensor: T1 1.

SM

Paper tray 1 and 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)

4-103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed 2.

Release the two clamps [A].

3.

Paper end sensor: T1 [B] (hooks, x 1)

Paper End Sensor: T2 1.

Paper tray 1 and 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)

2.

Release the clamp [A].

3.

Paper end sensor: T2 [B] (hooks, x 1)

4.12.6 REGISTRATION SENSOR 1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Open the paper transfer unit to the fully-open position ( Section: PTR (Paper Transfer Roller) Unit).

3.

Registration roller guide [A] ( x 2)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed

Close the paper transfer unit [A].

5.

Relay guide plate [B] ( x 2)

6.

Upper vertical transport guide [C] (= x 1,  x 2)

7.

Registration sensor [A] (= x 2, hooks, x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

4.

Cleaning the registration roller

SM

4-105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed Clean the registration roller and registration idle roller [A] with a damp cloth every 60 K (total count). ƒ

Never use alcohol to clean the registration roller.

4.12.7 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR Vertical Transport Sensor 1 1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Open the paper transfer unit to the fully-open position ( Section: PTR (Paper Transfer Roller) Unit).

3.

Middle guide plate [A] ( x 2)

4.

Open the lower right door [A].

5.

Release the belt [B].

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed

Open the lower guide plate [A]

7.

Middle guide bracket [B] ( x 4, = x 2, x 1)

8.

Sensor bracket [A] ( x 1, = x 1)

9.

Vertical transport sensor 1 [B] ( x 1, hooks)

Replacement & Adjustment

6.

Vertical Transport Sensor 2 1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Open the lower right door [A].

3.

Release the belt [B].

SM

4-107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed

4.

Release the rear pivot [A], and then remove the lower right door [B].

5.

Lower guide bracket [A] ( x 2)

6.

Sensor bracket [A] ( x 1)

7.

Vertical transport sensor 2 [B] (hooks, x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Exit

4.13 PAPER EXIT 4.13.1 JUNCTION GATE SOLENOID FAN Right upper cover ( Section: Right Upper Cover)

2.

Right rear cover

3.

Fan base [A] ( x 1, x 1)

4.

Junction gate solenoid fan [B] (hooks)

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

When installing the junction gate solenoid fan Make sure that the junction gate solenoid fan is installed with its decal facing to the left side.

4.13.2 PAPER EXIT UNIT 1.

Fusing Unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

2.

Front right cover ( Section: Front Right Cover)

3.

Junction gate solenoid fan base ( Section: Junction Gate Solenoid Fan)

4.

Paper exit cover ( Section: Paper Exit Cover)

5.

Inner Tray ( Section: Inner Tray)

SM

4-109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Exit 6.

Front harness cover [A] ( x 1)

7.

Remove or disconnect the following:

8.

ƒ

Two screws [A] at the front side

ƒ

Front harness [B]

ƒ

Ground cable [C] ( x 1)

ƒ

Rear harness [D]

Paper exit unit [A]

4.13.3 FUSING EXIT 1.

Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Exit

Sensor assembly [A] ( x 1, = x 1, x 1)

3.

Fusing exit sensor [A] ( x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

2.

4.13.4 PAPER EXIT SENSOR 1.

Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)

2.

Paper exit sensor [A] (hooks, x 1)

SM

4-111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Exit

When installing the paper exit sensor

ƒ

Stand the paper exit unit so that [A] is facing up. Otherwise, the paper exit sensor feeler interrupts the installation of the paper exit sensor.

ƒ

Insert the hook [B] first.

4.13.5 INVERTER SENSOR 1.

Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)

2.

Remove the screw [A].

3.

Release all clamps that clamp the harness [B].

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-112 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Exit 4.

Move the sensor assembly [A] to the cutout [B], and then remove it (= x1, x 1)

5.

Inverter sensor [A] (hooks)

4.13.6 INVERTER MOTOR Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)

2.

Inverter motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

SM

4-113 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Exit

4.13.7 FUSING FRONT FAN 1.

Front right cover ( Section: Front Right Cover)

2.

Fusing front fan [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)

When installing the fusing front fan Make sure that the fusing front fan is installed with its decal facing to the rear side.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-114 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

4.14 DUPLEX UNIT 4.14.1 DUPLEX UNIT Open the duplex unit.

2.

Remove the screw [A].

3.

Move the duplex unit in the direction shown by ™, and remove the hook [A].

4.

Disconnect the harness [B].

5.

Release the front and rear arms [A], [B] ( x 1 each).

SM

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

4-115 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

6.

Remove the clip [A].

7.

Slide the duplex unit [B] to the front side, and then remove it.

4.14.2 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR 1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Duplex inner cover [A] ( x 2)

3.

Duplex entrance guide unit [A] (hook x 3) ƒ

Lift up the duplex guide plate [A] first when reinstalling the duplex entrance

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-116 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

Replacement & Adjustment

guide unit.

4.

Duplex outer guide plate [A] ( x 4)

5.

Duplex entrance sensor [A] (hook)

4.14.3 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR 1.

Pull out the 1st tray.

2.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

SM

4-117 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

1.

Duplex exit sensor assembly cover [A] ( x 1)

2.

Duplex exit sensor assembly [B] ( x 1, ground screw x 1, = x 1, x 1)

3.

Duplex exit sensor [A] (hook)

4.14.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE MOTOR 1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-118 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

Duplex entrance motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x1, x 1)

4.

Separate the duplex entrance motor [A] from the bracket ( x 2)

Replacement & Adjustment

3.

4.14.5 DUPLEX EXIT MOTOR 1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)

3.

Duplex exit motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 2, x 1)

SM

4-119 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

4.

Separate the duplex exit motor [A] from the bracket ( x 2)

4.14.6 BY-PASS MOTOR 1.

Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)

3.

By-pass motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 2, x 1) ƒ

4.

Remove the clamp [B] from the bracket to disconnect the harness.

By-pass motor [A] ( x 2)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-120 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

4.14.7 BY-PASS TRAY UNIT Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)

2.

Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)

3.

Reinstall the duplex unit once, and open it.

4.

Disconnect the harness [A].

5.

Close the duplex unit.

6.

Open the by-pass tray unit [A]

7.

By-pass tray unit ( x 2, hook [B]). ƒ

Replacement & Adjustment

1.

Use a flat-head screw driver or similar tool to push the hook [B] down.

4.14.8 BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH SENSOR 1.

SM

Open the by-pass tray unit.

4-121 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

2.

By-pass tray right cover [A] ( x 2)

3.

By-pass paper length sensor [A] ( x 1)

4.14.9 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR 1.

By-pass tray unit ( Section: By-Pass Tray Unit)

2.

By-pass tray cover [A] (hook x 1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-122 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

3.

By-pass paper size sensor [A] ( x 1)

Replacement & Adjustment

When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor

1.

Adjust the projection [A] of the left side fence bar (it must be centered).

2.

Install the by-pass paper size detection switch so that the hole [B] in this switch faces the projection [C] of the left side fence bar.

3.

Reassemble the copier.

4.

Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

5.

Check this switch operation with SP5803-046 (By-Pass Size Detection SW < Input Check).

- Display on the LCD -

SM

Paper Size

Display

Paper Size

Display

A3 SEF

00001001

A5 SEF

00001110

B4 SEF

00001011

B6 SEF

00001100

A4 SEF

00000011

A6 SEF

00001101

B5 SEF

00000111

Smaller A6 SEF

00001101

4-123 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

4.14.10 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR 1.

By-pass tray unit ( Section: By-Pass Tray Unit)

2.

By-pass paper end sensor [A] ( x 1, hook)

Reinstalling the By-pass Paper End Sensor ƒ

Reinstall the right hook first and then the left hook using a flat-head screw driver or similar tool.

4.14.11 BY-PASS FEED ROLLER 1.

By-pass tray unit ( Section: By-Pass Tray Unit)

2.

By-pass feed roller [A] (hook)

4.14.12 BY-PASS TRAY HP SENSOR 1.

Open the by-pass tray unit.

2.

Open the duplex unit.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-124 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Duplex Unit

Remove the hand holder [A].

4.

Rotate the actuator [A] counter clockwise as shown above.

5.

By-pass tray HP sensor [B] (hook).

Replacement & Adjustment

3.

SM

4-125 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 4.15.1 BOARDS Controller Box Closed

[A]

BCU

[B]

i-Controller Board (D038/D041)

[B1]

i-Controller Board (D037/D040)

[C]

HDD (D038/D041 only)

[D]

DRB

[E]

PSU

Controller Box Open

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-126 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[F]

HVPS: TTS Board

[G]

HVPS: CB Board

Replacement & Adjustment

Electrical Components

4.15.2 CONTROLLER BOX COVER 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Scanner cable bracket [A] ( x 4)

3.

Loosen the eight screws.

4.

Slide up the controller box cover [B], and then remove it.

4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOX Opening the controller box 1.

SM

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

4-127 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components 2.

Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)

3.

Remove the four screws and disconnect the scanner cable [A] ( x 1, ground screw x 1)

4.

Open the controller box [A].

4.15.4 BCU 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-128 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

BCU [A] ( x 7, x All) ƒ

Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the BCU. Insert the NVRAM in the NVRAM slot with the "half-moon" pointing [B] to the downward side.

When installing the new BCU 1.

Remove the NVRAM from the old BCU.

2.

Install the NVRAM on the new BCU after you replace the BCU.

3.

Reassemble the machine.

4.

Turn on the main power of the machine.

5.

"SC995-01" occurs.

6.

Enter the serial number with SP5811-004.

7.

Turn the main power of the machine off and on. ƒ

Make sure you print out the SMC reports (“SP Mode Data” and “Logging Data”) before you replace the NVRAM.

ƒ

Keep NVRAM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage NVRAM data.

4.15.5 HDD (ONLY FOR D038/D041) 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)

SM

4-129 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

3.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

3.

HDD assembly [A] ( x 3, x 2 from the controller board).

4.

HDD [A] ( x 4, x 2). ƒ

Reconnect the harnesses to the controller board.

4.15.6 CONTROLLER BOX FAN 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-130 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

3.

Controller box fan [A] ( x 2, = x 2, x 1)

When installing the controller box fan Make sure that the controller box fan is installed with its decal facing upward.

4.15.7 FUSING REAR FAN 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Fusing rear fan with the bracket [A]

SM

( x 2, x 1, = x 1)

4-131 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

Electrical Components

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

3.

Remove the bracket [A] from the fusing rear fan [B] (hook x 6).

When installing the fusing rear fan Make sure that the fusing rear fan is installed with its decal facing to the rear side.

4.15.8 PSU 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

DRB with the bracket [A] ( x 4, x all, = x all)

3.

Power cord [A] (Blue: ground screw x 1, x 2)

4.

Remove the clamp [B] from the bracket.

5.

PSU board [C] ( x 9, = x All, x All)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-132 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)

3.

Fusing rear fan [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)

4.

HVPS: TTS board [B] ( x 5, x all)

Replacement & Adjustment

4.15.9 HVPS: TTS BOARD

4.15.10 HVPS: CB BOARD 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)

3.

HVPS: CB board [A] ( x 6, All s)

SM

4-133 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

4.15.11 I-CONTROLLER BOARD 1.

Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)

2.

Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)

3.

Controller box left bracket [A] ( x 5)

For D037/D040

1.

i-controller board [A] ( x 9, x all)

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-134 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

2.

Replacement & Adjustment

Electrical Components

Remove the Interface rails [A], NVRAM [B] and RAM-DIMM [C].

For D038/D041

1.

HDD ( Section: HDD (Only for D038/D041))

2.

i-controller board [A] ( x 8, x all)

SM

4-135 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

3.

Remove the interface rails [A], NVRAMs [B] and RAM-DIMMs [C]

When installing the new controller board 1.

Remove the NVRAM from the old controller board.

2.

Install the NVRAM on the new controller board after you replace the controller board.

3.

Reassemble the machine.

4.

Turn on the main power of the machine ƒ

Make sure you print out the SMC reports (“SP Mode Data” and “Logging Data”) before you replace the NVRAM.

ƒ

Keep NVRAMs away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage NVRAM data.

ƒ

Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the controller board.

When installing a new HDD unit 1.

Turn the main power switch on. The disk is automatically formatted.

2.

Install the stamp data using "SP5853".

3.

Switch the machine off and on to enable the fixed stamps for use.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-136 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

Disposal of HDD Units ƒ

Never remove an HDD unit from the work site without the consent of the client.

ƒ

If the customer has any concerns about the security of any information on the HDD, the HDD must remain with the customer for disposal or safe keeping.

ƒ

The HDD may contain proprietary or classified (Confidential, Secret) information. Specifically, the HDD contains document server documents and data stored in temporary files created automatically during copy job sorting and jam recovery. Such data is stored on the HDD in a special format so it cannot normally be read but can be recovered with illegal methods.

Reinstallation Explain to the customer that the following information stored on the HDD is lost when the ƒ

Document server documents

ƒ

Custom-made stamps

ƒ

Document server address book

The address book and document server documents (if needed) must be input again. If you previously backed up the address book to an SD card with SP5846 051, you can use SP 5846 052 to copy the data from the SD card to the hard disk. If the customer is using the Data Overwrite Security feature, the DOS function must be set up again. For more, see Section 1 (Installation). If the customer is using the optional Browser Unit, this unit must be installed again. For more, see Section 1 (Installation).

4.15.12 NVRAM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE NVRAM on the BCU 1.

Make sure that you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the machine.

2.

Output the SMC data ( SP5-990-001) if possible.

3.

Turn the main switch off.

4.

Install an SD card into SD card slot 2. Then turn the main power on.

5.

Copy the NVRAM data to an SD card ( SP5-824-001) if possible.

6.

Turn off the main switch. Then unplug the power cord.

7.

Replace the NVRAM on the BCU and reassemble the machine.

8.

Plug in the power cord. Then turn the main switch on.

9.

SC995-01 occurs.

10. Copy the data from the SD card to the NVRAM ( SP5-825-001) if you have

SM

4-137 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replacement & Adjustment

HDD is replaced:

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components successfully copied them to the SD card. 11. Turn the main switch off. Then remove the SD card from SD card slot 2. 12. Turn the main switch on. 13. Specify the SP and UP mode settings. 14. Do the process control self-check. 15. Do ACC for the copier application program. 16. Do ACC for the printer application program.

NVRAM on the Controller 1.

Make sure that you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the machine.

2.

Output the SMC data ( SP5-990-001) if possible.

3.

Turn the main switch off. Then unplug the power cord.

4.

Install a New NVRAM on the controller. Then reassemble the machine.

5.

Turn the main switch on.

6.

SC995-02 occurs.

7.

Turn the machine off and on.

8.

Do the process control self-check.

9.

Do ACC for the copier application program.

10. Do ACC for the printer application program.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-138 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Machine Boot-Up

4.16 MACHINE BOOT-UP This machine boots up the modules in the following order.

Module Name System application

2

Copy application

3

Printer application

4

Web System application

5

Scanner application

6

Fax application

ƒ

SM

Replacement & Adjustment

1

It takes approximately 90 seconds to boot up all modules.

4-139 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Program Mode

5. SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE 5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE ƒ

Make sure that the data-in LED () is not on before you go into the SP mode. This LED indicates that some data is coming to the machine. When the LED is on, wait for the copier to process the data.

5.1.1 SP TABLES See "Appendices" for the following information: ƒ

System SP Tables

ƒ

Printer SP Tables

ƒ

Scanner SP Tables

ƒ

System SP: SP modes related to the engine functions

ƒ

Printer SP: SP modes related to the controller functions

ƒ

Scanner SP: SP modes related to the scanner functions

ƒ

Fax SP: SP modes related to the fax functions

Select one of the Service Program modes (System, Printer, Scanner, or Fax) from the touch panel as shown in the diagram below after you access the SP mode. This section explains the functions of the System/Printer/Scanner SP modes. Refer to the Fax service manual for the Fax SP modes.

SM

5-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

5.1.2 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 H-MODEL (D038/D041)

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Program Mode

SP Mode Button Summary Here is a short summary of the touch-panel buttons.

™

Opens all SP groups and sublevels.

š

Closes all open groups and sublevels and restores the initial SP mode display.

›

Opens the copy window (copy mode) so you can make test copies. Press SP Mode (highlighted) in the copy window to return to the SP mode screen, Enter the SP code directly with the number keys if you know the SP number. Then

œ

press. (The required SP Mode number will be highlighted when pressing . If not, just press the required SP Mode number.)



Press two times to leave the SP mode and return to the copy window to resume normal operation.

ž

Press any Class 1 number to open a list of Class 2 SP modes.

Ÿ

Press to scroll the show to the previous or next group.

 

Press to scroll to the previous or next display in segments the size of the screen display (page).

¡

Press to scroll the show the previous or next line (line by line).

¢

Press to move the highlight on the left to the previous or next selection in the list.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Program Mode

Switching Between SP Mode and Copy Mode for Test Printing 1.

In the SP mode, select the test print. Then press "Copy Window".

2.

Use the copy window (copier mode), to select the appropriate settings (paper size, etc.) for the test print.

3.

Press Start C to start the test print.

4.

Press SP Mode (highlighted) to return to the SP mode screen and repeat from step 1.

Selecting the Program Number Program numbers have two or three levels. 1.

Refer to the Service Tables to find the SP that you want to adjust before you begin.

2.

Press the Group number on the left side SP Mode window that contains the SP that you want to adjust.

3.

Use the scrolling buttons in the center of the SP mode window to show the SP number that you want to open. Then press that number to expand the list.

4.

Use the center touch-panel buttons to scroll to the number and title of the item that you want to set and press it. The small entry box on the right activates and shows the

System Maintenance Reference

below default or the current settings.

ƒ 1.

Refer to the SP Tables for the range of allowed settings.

Do this procedure to enter a setting: ƒ

Press to toggle between plus and minus and use the keypad to enter the appropriate number. The number you enter writes over the previous setting.

ƒ

Press  to enter the setting. (The value is not registered if you enter a number that is out of range.)

ƒ

SM

Press “Yes” when you are prompted to complete the selection.

5-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Program Mode 2.

If you need to perform a test print, press Copy Window to open the copy window and select the settings for the test print. Press Start C and then press SP Mode (highlighted) in the copy window to return to the SP mode display.

3.

Press Exit two times to return to the copy window when you are finished.

Service Mode Lock/Unlock At locations where the machine contains sensitive data, the customer engineer cannot operate the machine until the Administrator turns the service mode lock off. This function makes sure that work on the machine is always done with the permission of the Administrator. 1.

If you cannot go into the SP mode, ask the Administrator to log in with the User Tool and then set “Service Mode Lock” to OFF after he or she logs in: User Tools > System Settings > Administrator Tools > Service Mode Lock > OFF ƒ

This unlocks the machine and lets you get access to all the SP codes.

ƒ

The CE can service the machine and turn the machine off and on. It is not necessary to ask the Administrator to log in again each time the machine is turned on.

2.

Go into the SP mode and set SP5169 to “1” if you must use the printer bit switches.

3.

After machine servicing is completed: ƒ

Change SP5169 from “1” to “0”.

ƒ

Turn the machine off and on. Tell the administrator that you have completed servicing the machine.

ƒ

The Administrator will then set the “Service Mode Lock” to ON.

5.1.3 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 L-MODEL (D037/D040) ƒ

System SP: SP modes related to the engine functions

ƒ

Printer SP: SP modes related to the controller functions

ƒ

Scanner SP: SP modes related to the scanner functions

ƒ

Fax SP: SP modes related to the fax functions

Select one of the Service Program modes (System, Printer, Scanner, or Fax) from the operation panel as shown in the diagram below after you access the SP mode. This section explains the functions of the System/Printer/Scanner SP modes. Refer to the Fax service manual for the Fax SP modes.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Program Mode

Selecting Programs ƒ

When a blinking underscore (or several blinking underscores) is displayed, you can type a number from the numeric keypad [A].

ƒ

When the sign "' (/OK" [B] is displayed upper right corner, you can scroll through the menu by pressing the left-arrow key [C] or the right-arrow key [D]. To select a program, press the "OK" key [E].

1.

After locating a program, press the "OK" key. A blinking underscore (or several blinking underscores) indicates which value you can change. The value in parentheses is the default value of the menu.

2.

Type a necessary value from the numeric keypad. To switch between positive (plus) and negative (minus) values, press the [./*] (period/asterisk) key.

3.

To validate the value, press the "OK" key. To cancel the value, press the cancel key [F].

Activating Copy Mode You can activate the copy mode while the SP mode is running. When you do so, the copier outputs images or patterns that help you adjust the SP-mode program. 1.

Press the C key. The copy mode is activated.

2.

Specify copy settings and press the "OK" key.

3.

To return to the SP mode, press the D key. ƒ

You cannot end the SP mode while the copy mode is activated.

Quitting Programs/Ending SP Mode Press the D key or the "Cancel" key to quit the program. You can end the SP mode by pressing one of these keys several times.

SM

5-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

Specifying Values

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Program Mode

5.1.4 REMARKS Display on the Control Panel Screen The maximum number of characters which can show on the control panel screen is limited to 30 (H-model)/ 17 (L-model) characters. For this reason, some of the SP modes shown on the screen need to be abbreviated. The following are abbreviations used for the SP modes for which the full description is over 30 (H-model)/ 17 (L-model) characters.

Paper Weight Thin paper: 52-59.9 g/m2 Plain Paper1: 60-74 g/m2, 16-20lb. Plain Paper2: 74.1-90 g/m2, 20-24lb. Middle Thick: 90.1-105 g/m2, 24-28lb. Thick Paper 1: 105.1-169 g/m2, 28.5-44.9lb. Thick Paper 2: 169.1-210 g/m2, 45-56lb. Thick Paper 3: 210.1-256 g/m2, 56lb-68lb Paper Type

Paper Feed Station

N: Normal paper

P: Paper tray

MTH: Middle thick paper

B: By-pass table

TH: Thick paper Color Mode [Color] [K]: Black in B&W mode

[Y], [M], or [C]: Yellow, Magenta, or Cyan in Full Color mode [YMC]: Only for Yellow, Magenta, and Cyan [FC]: Full Color mode [FC, K], [FC, Y], [FC, M], or [FC, C]: Black, Yellow, Magenta, or Cyan in full color mode Print Mode

Process Speed

S: Simplex

L: Low speed (60 mm/s)

D: Duplex

M: Middle speed (120 mm/s)

Others The following symbols are used in the SP mode tables. FA: Factory setting (Data may be adjusted from the default setting at the factory. Refer to the factory setting

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Program Mode sheets enclosed. You can find it under the jammed paper removal decal.) DFU: Design/Factory Use only Do not touch these SP modes in the field. A sharp (#) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that the main switch must be turned off and on to effect the setting change. An asterisk (*) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that this mode is stored in the NVRAM. If you do a RAM clear, this SP mode will be reset to the default value. “ENG” and “CTL” show which NVRAM contains the data. ƒ

ENG: NVRAM on the BCU board

ƒ

CTL: NVRAM on the controller board

The settings of each SP mode are explained in the right-hand column of the SP table in the following way. [Adjustable range / Default setting / Step] Alphanumeric ƒ

If “Alphanumeric” is written to the right of the bracket as shown above, the setting of the SP mode shows on the screen using alphanumeric characters instead of only numbers. However, the settings in the bracket in the SP mode table are explained by using only the numbers.

SM

5-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Maintenance Reference

SSP: This denotes a “Special Service Program” mode setting.

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update

5.2 FIRMWARE UPDATE To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware downloaded onto an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2 on the left rear side of the controller box.

5.2.1 TYPE OF FIRMWARE H-Model (D038/D041)

Location of

Type of firmware

Function

Engine

Printer engine control

System/Copy Application

Printer Application

Scanner Application

firmware BCU Flash ROM Flash ROM on the

Operating system

controller board Flash ROM on the

Feature application

controller board Flash ROM on the

Feature application

controller board Flash ROM on the

Message shown

Engine

System/Copy

Printer

Scanner

Fax Application

Feature application

NIB

Network Interface

Operation Panel

Panel control

Operation Panel

OpePanel.

Fax FCU

Fax control

FCU

GWFCU-4(ww)-1-1

Remote Fax

Fax control

controller board Flash ROM on the controller board

Flash ROM on the controller board

Language firmware Language

Fax

Network Support

Remote Fax

Language 1

Two languages can be

Operation Panel

selected from 16

Language 2

languages.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update WebDocBox

WebSys

PS/ PDF

Document server

Flash ROM on the

application

controller board

Web Service application

Page description language (PostScript3)

Flash ROM on the controller board

Web Uapl

Web Support

PS3 SD card

PS3/ PDF

PictBridge

PictBridge control

PictBridge SD card

PctBrgd

ARDF

ARDF control

ARDF

ADF

Finisher (D429)

Finisher control

Finisher (D429)

Finisher

L-Model (D037/D040)

Function

Engine

Printer engine control

System/Copy Application

Printer Application

Scanner Application

firmware BCU Flash ROM Flash ROM on the

Operating system

controller board Flash ROM on the

Feature application

controller board Flash ROM on the

Feature application

controller board Flash ROM on the

Message shown

Engine

System/Copy

Printer

Scanner

Fax Application

Feature application

NIB

Network Interface

Operation Panel

Panel control

Operation Panel

OpePanel.

Fax FCU

Fax control

FCU

GWFCU-4(ww)-1-1

SM

controller board Flash ROM on the controller board

5-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax

Network Support

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

Location of

Type of firmware

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update Remote Fax

Flash ROM on the

Fax control

controller board

Language firmware Language

Remote Fax

Language 1

Two languages can be

Operation Panel

selected from 16

Language 2

languages.

WebDocBox

Document server

Flash ROM on the

application

controller board

WebSys

Web Service application

ARDF

ARDF control

Flash ROM on the controller board ARDF

Web Uapl

Web Support

ADF

5.2.2 BEFORE YOU BEGIN An SD card is a precision device. Always observe the following precautions when you handle SD cards: ƒ

Always switch the machine off before you insert an SD card. Never insert the SD card into the slot with the power on.

ƒ

Do not remove the SD card from the service slot after the power has been switched on.

ƒ

Never switch the machine off while the firmware is downloading from the SD card.

ƒ

Keep SD cards in a safe location where they are not exposed to high temperature, high humidity, or exposure to direct sunlight.

ƒ

Always handle SD cards with care. Do not bend or scratch them. Do not let the SD card get exposed to shock or vibration.

ƒ

Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked when you download an application to it. If not, downloading fails and a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade.

Keep the following points in mind when you use the firmware update software: ƒ

“Upload” means to send data from the machine to the SD card. “Download” means to send data from the SD card to the machine.

ƒ

To select an item on the LCD, touch the appropriate button on the soft touch-screen of the LCD, or, press the appropriate number key on the 10-key pad of the operation panel. For example, when “Exit (0)” shows on the screen you can touch the Exit button on the screen, or, press the button on the operation panel of the copier.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update ƒ

Make sure that the machine is disconnected from the network to prevent a print job for arriving while the firmware update is in progress before you start the firmware update procedure.

5.2.3 UPDATING FIRMWARE Preparation ƒ

If the SD card is blank, copy the entire “romdata” folder onto the SD card.

ƒ

If the card already contains the “romdata” folder, copy the “D037” folder onto the card.

If the card already contains folders up to “D037”, copy the necessary firmware files (e.g. D037xxxx.fwu) into this folder. ƒ

Do not put multiple machine firmware programs on the same SD card. Copy the only model firmware you want.

Updating Procedure 1.

Turn the main power switch off.

2.

Remove the slot cover ( x 1).

3.

Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2. Make sure the label on the SD card faces the

4.

Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make sure the SD card locks in place. ƒ

To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops out of the slot.

5.

Disconnect the network cable from the copier if the machine is connected to a network.

6.

Switch the main power switch on. After about 45 seconds, the initial version update screen appears on the LCD in English.

7.

On the screen, touch the button or press the corresponding number key on the operation panel to select the item in the menu that you want to update.

ROM/NEW

What it means Tells you the number of the module and name of the version

ROM:

currently installed. The first line is the module number, the second line the version name.

NEW:

SM

Tells you the number of the module and name version on the SD

5-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

rear side of the machine.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update card. The first line is the module number, the second line the version name.

ƒ

Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same time. It is recommended to update firmware modules one by one.

8.

Touch “UpDate (#)” (or ) to start the update. ƒ

The progress bar does not show for the operation panel firmware after you touch “OpPanel”. The power on key flashes on and off at 0.5 s intervals when the LCDC firmware is updating. The power key flashes on and off at 3 s intervals when the update is finished.

9.

The "Update is Done" message appears on the operation panel after completing the updating. The message differs depending on the firmware that has been updated.

10. Switch the copier main power switch off when you see the “Update is Done” message or follow the procedure that is displayed on the operation panel. 11. Press in the SD card to release it. Then remove it from the slot. 12. Switch the copier on for normal operation.

Error Messages An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during the download. The error code consists of the letter “E” and a number. The example above shows error “E24” displayed. For details, refer to the Error Message Table. ( Section: Handling Firmware Update Error)

Firmware Update Error If a firmware update error occurs, this means the update was cancelled during the update because the module selected for update was not on the SD card.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update

Recovery after Power Loss If the ROM update is interrupted as a result of accidental loss of power while the firmware is updating, then the correct operation of the machine cannot be guaranteed after the machine is switched on again. If the ROM update does not complete successfully for any reason, then in order to ensure the correct operation of the machine, the ROM update error will continue to show until the ROM is updated successfully.

download automatically from the card without the menu display.

5.2.4 UPDATING THE LCDC FOR THE OPERATION PANEL Do the following procedure to update the LCDC (LCD Control Board). 1.

Turn the copier main switch off.

2.

Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).

3.

Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2.

4.

Switch the copier main switch on.

5.

The initial screen opens in English after about 45 seconds.

6.

Touch “Ope Panel.xx”.

7.

"xx" differs depending on the destination.

8.

Touch “UpDate(#) or () to start the update.

9.

Downloading starts after about 9 seconds.

10. The operation panel goes off and the main power on key flashes in red at 0.5 s intervals when the data is downloading. The same key starts flashing in green at 1 s intervals when the update is finished. 11. Switch the copier main power switch off and remove the SD card. Then switch the copier on.

SM

5-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

In this case, insert the card again and switch on the machine to continue the firmware

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update 12. Press the “Exit” button. Then turn the copier off and on again.

5.2.5 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during a download. The error code consists of the letter “E” and a number (“E20”, for example).

Error Message Table

Code

Meaning

20

Cannot map logical address

Make sure the SD card is inserted correctly.

21

Cannot access memory

HDD connection incorrect or replace hard disks.

Cannot decompress

Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is

compressed data

corrupted.

Error occurred when ROM

Controller program abnormal. If the second

update program started

attempt fails, replace controller board.

22

23

24

30

31

32

33

34

Solution

Make sure SD card inserted correctly, or use

SD card access error

another SD card.

No HDD available for stamp data download

Data incorrect for continuous download

HDD connection incorrect or replace hard disks.

Insert the SD card with the remaining data required for the download, the re-start the procedure.

Data incorrect after download interrupted

Execute the recovery procedure for the intended module download, then repeat the installation procedure.

Incorrect SD card version

Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is corrupted.

Module mismatch - Correct

SD update data is incorrect. Acquire the correct

module is not on the SD

data (Japan, Overseas, OEM, etc.) then install

card)

again.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Firmware Update

36

40

42

43

44

50

SM

SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD

on SD card is not for this

card is for another machine. Acquire correct

machine

update data then install again. SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD

Cannot write module – Cause other than E34, E35

Engine module download failed

card is for another machine. Acquire correct update data then install again. Replace the update data for the module on the SD card and try again, or replace the BCU board.

Operation panel module

Replace the update data for the module on the

download failed

SD card and try again, or replace the LCDC.

Stamp data module

Replace the update data for the module on the

download failed

SD card and try again, or replace the hard disks.

Controller module download failed

SD card and tray again, or replace controller board.

Electronic confirmation check failed

Replace the update data for the module on the

SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD card is for another machine. Acquire correct update data then install again.

5-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

35

Module mismatch – Module

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installing Another Language

5.3 INSTALLING ANOTHER LANGUAGE Many languages are available. But you can only switch between two languages at a time. Do the following procedure to select the two languages you want. You can select both of the languages you want from the user interface on the operation panel. 1.

Switch the copier main power switch off.

2.

Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).

3.

Insert the SD card with the language data into SD Card Slot 2.

4.

Switch the copier main power switch on. The initial screen opens after about 45 seconds.

5.

Touch "Language Data (2)" on the screen (or press ).

6.

Touch "LANG. 1(1)" or "LANG. 2(2)"

Key

LANG. 1(1)

LANG. 1(2)

Exit(0)

7.

What it does Touch this button on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to open the next screen so you can select the 1st language. Touch this button on the screen (or press  on the 10-key pad) to open the next screen so you can select the 2nd language. Touch this key on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to quit the update procedure and return to normal screen.

Touch "LANG 1(1)" to select the 1st Language. Touch "LANG (2)" to select the 2nd Language.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installing Another Language

8.

Touch the appropriate button on the screen (or press the number on the 10-keypad) to select a language as the 1st (or 2nd) language.

9.

ƒ

If a language is already selected, it will show in reverse.

ƒ

Touching "Exit (0)" returns you to the previous screen.

If you do not see the language that you want to select, touch "↑(7)" or "↓(9)" on the screen (or press  or ) to show more choices. The Download Screen opens after you select a language.

The following show to right of the selection: ƒ

1. The first column shows the language currently selected.

ƒ

2. The 2nd column shows the language selected to replace that language.

The example below shows that the download will replace "Japanese" with "Italian" as the 1st language.

10. Touch "Update(#)" on the screen (or press) to start the download. Another screen with a progress bar does not show when the language is downloading.

SM

5-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

The 1st or 2nd language selected for updating shows.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Installing Another Language The following occur at the time the language is downloading: ƒ

The operation panel switches off.

ƒ

The LED on the power on key flashes rapidly.

11. After the message of installation completed has shown on the LCD, switch the copier main power switch off. Then remove the SD card from the slot. 12. Switch the copier main power switch on to resume normal operation.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Reboot/System Setting Reset

5.4 REBOOT/SYSTEM SETTING RESET 5.4.1 SOFTWARE RESET You can reboot the software with one of the following two procedures: 1.

Turn the main power switch off and on.

2.

Press and hold down  together for over 10 seconds. When the machine beeps once, release both buttons. After “Now loading. Please wait” shows for a few seconds, the copy window will open. The machine is ready for normal operation.

5.4.2 SYSTEM SETTINGS AND COPY SETTING RESET System Setting Reset The system settings in the UP mode can be reset to their defaults. Use the following procedure. 1.

Press User Tools/Counter .

2.

Hold down  and then press System Settings. You must press  first. System Maintenance Reference

ƒ

3.

Press yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the system settings.

4.

Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.

Copier Setting Reset Use the following procedure to reset the copy settings in the UP mode to their defaults. 1.

Press User Tools/Counter .

2.

Hold down  and then press Copier/Document Server Settings. ƒ

SM

You must press  first.

5-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Reboot/System Setting Reset

3.

Press “Yes” when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the Copier Document Server settings.

4.

Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Controller Self-Diagnostics

5.5 CONTROLLER SELF-DIAGNOSTICS 5.5.1 OVERVIEW There are three types of self-diagnostics for the controller. 1.

Power-on self-diagnostics: The machine automatically starts the self-diagnostics just after the power has been turned on.

2.

SC detection: The machine automatically detects SC conditions at power-on or during operation.

System Maintenance Reference

The following shows the workflow of the power-on and detailed self-diagnostics.

SM

5-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SD Card Appli Move

5.6 SD CARD APPLI MOVE 5.6.1 OVERVIEW The service program “SD Card Appli Move” (SP5-873) lets you to copy application programs from one SD card to another SD card. Slot 1 and Slot 2 are used to store application programs. However, more than two optional applications are supplied for this machine. In that case, you can move application programs from Slot 2 to Slot 1 with the following procedure. Consider the following limitations when you try to merge SD cards. ƒ

PostScript3 cannot be moved to the other SD card.

ƒ

The destination SD card should have the largest memory size of all the application SD cards. Refer to the following table for the memory size of each SD card.

Outline of SD Card Appli Move: 1.

Choose a SD card with enough space. ƒ

Do not use an SD card if it has been used on a computer. Normal operation is not guaranteed when such an SD card is used.

2.

Enter SP5873 “SD Card Appli Move”. Then move the application from the SD Card in Slot 2 to the card in slot 1.

3.

Exit the SP mode Use caution when you do the SD Card Appli Move procedure: ƒ

The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program from an SD card to another SD card. Authentication fails if you try to use the SD card after you copy the application program from one card to another card.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SD Card Appli Move 4.

Remove the inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover in the Replacement and Adjustment).

5.

Keep the SD card in the place [A] inside the inner cover after you have copied the application program from one card to another card. This is done for the following reasons: ƒ

1) The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program.

ƒ

2) You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.

5.6.2 MOVE EXEC The menu “Move Exec” (SP5-873-001) lets you copy application programs from the original SD card to another SD card. ƒ

Do not turn ON the write protect switch of an application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.

1.

Turn the main switch off.

2.

Make sure that an SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied into

3.

Insert the SD card (having stored the application program) to SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied from this SD card.

4.

Turn the main switch on.

5.

Start the SP mode.

6.

Select SP5-873-001 “Move Exec.”

7.

Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.

8.

Turn the main switch off.

9.

Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.

10. Turn the main switch on. 11. Check that the application programs run normally.

5.6.3 UNDO EXEC The menu “Undo Exec” (SP5-873-002) lets you copy back application programs from an SD card to the original SD card. You can use this program when, for example, you have mistakenly copied some programs by using Move Exec (SP5-873-001). ƒ

Do not turn ON the write protect switch of an application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs

SM

5-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

this SD card.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SD Card Appli Move during a firmware upgrade or application merge. 1.

Turn the main switch off.

2.

Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.

3.

Insert the SD card (having stored the application program) to SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied back from this SD card.

4.

Turn the main switch on.

5.

Start the SP mode.

6.

Select SP5-873-002 “Undo Exec.”

7.

Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.

8.

Turn the main switch off.

9.

Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2. ƒ

This step assumes that the application programs in the SD card are used by the machine.

10. Turn the main switch on. 11. Check that the application programs run normally.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Downloading Stamp Data

5.7 DOWNLOADING STAMP DATA The stamp data should be downloaded from the controller firmware to the hard disks at the following times: ƒ

After the hard disks have been replaced.

The print data contains the controller software. Execute SP 5853 to download the fixed stamp data required by the hard disks. 1.

Enter the SP mode.

2.

Select SP5853 and then press “EXECUTE”. The following screen opens while the

The download is finished when the message prompts you to close.

3.

SM

Press the “Exit” button. Then turn the copier off and on again.

5-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

stamp data is downloading.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NVRAM Data Upload/Download

5.8 NVRAM DATA UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD 5.8.1 UPLOADING CONTENT OF NVRAM TO AN SD CARD Do the following procedure to upload SP code settings from NVRAM to an SD card. ƒ

This data should always be uploaded to an SD card before the NVRAM is replaced.

ƒ 1.

Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked

Do SP5990-001 (SMC Print) before you switch the machine off. You will need a record of the NVRAM settings if the upload fails.

2.

Switch the copier main power switch off.

3.

Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).

4.

Insert the SD card into SD card slot 2. Then switch the copier on.

5.

Execute SP5824-001 (NVRAM Data Upload) and then press the “Execute” key.

6.

The following files are coped to an NVRAM folder on the SD card when the upload procedure is finished. The file is saved to the path and the following filename: NVRAM¥<serial number>.NV Here is an example with Serial Number “K5000017114”: NVRAM¥K5000017114.NV

7.

In order to prevent an error during the download, be sure to mark the SD card that holds the uploaded data with the number of the machine from which the data was uploaded. ƒ

You can upload NVRAM data from more than one machine to the same SD card.

5.8.2 DOWNLOADING AN SD CARD TO NVRAM Do the following procedure to download SP data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine. ƒ

The NVRAM data download may fail if the SD card with the NVRAM data is damaged, or if the connection between the controller and BCU is defective.

ƒ

Do the download procedure again if the download fails.

ƒ

Do the following procedure if the second attempt fails:

ƒ

Enter the NVRAM data manually using the SMC print you created before uploading the NVRAM data.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NVRAM Data Upload/Download 1.

Switch the copier main power switch off.

2.

Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).

3.

Insert the SD card with the NVRAM data into SD Card Slot 2.

4.

Switch the copier main power switch on.

5.

Do SP5825-001 (NVRAM Data Download) and press the “Execute” key. ƒ

The serial number of the file on the SD card must match the serial number of the machine for the NVRAM data to download successfully. The download fails if the serial numbers do not match.

This procedure does not download the following data to the NVRAM: Total Count

ƒ

C/O, P/O Count

System Maintenance Reference

ƒ

SM

5-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Address Book Upload/Download

5.9 ADDRESS BOOK UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD 5.9.1 INFORMATION LIST The following information is possible to be uploaded and downloaded.

Information ƒ

Registration No.

ƒ

User Code

ƒ

E-mail

ƒ

Protection Code

ƒ

Fax Destination

ƒ

Fax Option

ƒ

Group Name

ƒ

Key Display

ƒ

Select Title

ƒ

Folder

ƒ

Local Authentication

ƒ

Folder Authentication

ƒ

Account ACL

ƒ

New Document Initial ACL

ƒ

LDAP Authentication

5.9.2 DOWNLOAD 1.

Prepare a formatted SD card.

2.

Make sure that the write-protection on the SD card is off.

3.

Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.

4.

Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine ( x 1).

5.

Install the SD card into the SD card slot 2 (for service use).

6.

Turn on the main power switch.

7.

Enter the SP mode.

8.

Do SP5-846-051 (Backup All Addr Book).

9.

Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.

10. Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2. 11. Install the SD slot cover. ƒ

If the capacity of SD card is not enough to store the local user information, an error message is displayed.

ƒ

Carefully handle the SD card, which contains user information. Do not take it back to your location.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Address Book Upload/Download

5.9.3 UPLOAD 1.

Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.

2.

Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine ( x 1).

3.

Install the SD card, which has already been uploaded, into the SD card slot 2.

4.

Turn on the main power switch.

5.

Enter the SP mode.

6.

Do SP5-846-052 (Restore All Addr Book).

7.

Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.

8.

Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2.

9.

Install the SD slot cover. ƒ

The counter in the user code information is initialized after uploading.

ƒ

The information of an administrator and supervisor cannot be downloaded nor uploaded.

ƒ

If there is no data of address book information in the SD card, an error message is

System Maintenance Reference

displayed.

SM

5-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Using the Debug Log

5.10 USING THE DEBUG LOG 5.10.1 OVERVIEW This machine provides a Save Debug Log feature that allows the Customer Engineer to save and retrieve error information for analysis. Every time an error occurs, debug information is recorded in volatile memory. But this information is lost when the machine is switched off and on. To capture this debug information, the Save Debug Log feature provides two main features: ƒ

Switching on the debug feature so error information is saved directly to the HDD for later retrieval.

ƒ

Copying the error information from the HDD to an SD card.

Do the following procedure below to set up the machine so the error information is saved automatically to the HDD when a user has problems with the machine. Then ask the user to reproduce the problem.

5.10.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG The debug information cannot be saved until the “Save Debug Log” function has been switched on and a target has been selected. 1.

Enter the SP mode and switch the Save Debug Log feature on. ƒ

Enter “System SP”.

ƒ

On the LCD panel, open SP5857.

2.

Under “5857 Save Debug Log”, touch “1 On/Off”.

3.

On the control panel keypad, press “1”. Then press . This switches the Save Debug Log feature on. ƒ

The default setting is “0” (OFF). This feature must be switched on in order for the debug information to be saved.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Using the Debug Log

4.

Select the target destination where the debug information will be saved. Under “5857 Save Debug Log”, touch “2 Target”, enter “2” with the operation panel key to select the hard disk as the target destination. Then press . ƒ

Select “3 SD Card” to save the debug information directly to the SD card if it is inserted in the service slot.

5.

Now touch “5858” and specify the events that you want to record in the debug log. SP5858 (Debug Save When) provides the following items for selection.

Engine SC Error

2

Controller SC Error

3

Any SC Error

4

Jam

ƒ

Saves data when an engine-related SC code is generated. Saves debug data when a controller-related SC Code is generated. Saves data only for the SC code that you specify by entering code number. Saves data for jams.

More than one event can be selected.

Example 1: To Select Items 1, 2, 4 Touch the appropriate items(s). Press “ON” for each selection. This example shows “Engine SC Error” selected.

SM

5-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

1

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Using the Debug Log

Example 2: To Specify an SC Code Touch “3 Any SC Error”, enter the 3-digit SC code number with the control panel number keys. Then press . This example shows an entry for SC670.

ƒ

For details about SC code numbers, please refer to the SC tables in Section 4. “Troubleshooting”.

6.

Select one or more memory modules for reading and recording debug information. Touch “5859”. Under “5859” press the necessary key item for the module that you want to record. Enter the appropriate 4-digit number. Then press . ƒ

Refer to the two tables below for the 4-digit numbers to enter for each key.

The example below shows “Key 1” with “2222” entered.

The following keys can be set with the corresponding numbers. (The initials in parentheses indicate the names of the modules.)

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Using the Debug Log 4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10

Copy

Printer

Scanner

1

2222 (SCS)

2

14000 (SRM)

3

256 (IMH)

4

1000 (ECS)

5

1025 (MCS)

Web

6

4848 (COPY)

4400 (GPS)

5375 (Scan)

5682 (NFA)

7

2224 (BCU)

4500 (PDL)

5682 (NFA)

6600 (WebDB)

3000 (UCS)

3300 (PTS)

4600

8

(GPS-PM)

9

2000 (NCS)

2000 (NCS)

6666 (WebSys)

10

2224 (BCU)

4126 (DCS)

2000 (NCS)

ƒ

The default settings for Keys 1 to 10 are all zero (“0”).

Key to Acronyms

Acronym

Meaning

Acronym

Meaning

ECS

Engine Control Service

NFA

Net File Application

GPS

GW Print Service

PDL

Printer Design Language

PTS

Print Server

System Control Service

GSP-PM

GW Print Service – Print Module

IMH

Image Memory Handler

SCS

MCS

Memory Control Service

SRM

SM

5-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Resource Management

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

Key No.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Using the Debug Log NCS

1.

Network Control Service

WebDB

Web Document Box (Document Server)

The machine is now set to record the debugging information automatically on the HDD (the target selected with SP5857-002) for the events that you selected with SP5858 and the memory modules selected with SP5859.

Please keep the following important points in mind when you do this setting: ƒ

Note that the number entries for Keys 1 to 5 are the same for the Copy, Printer, Scanner, and Web memory modules.

ƒ

The initial settings are all zero.

ƒ

These settings remain in effect until you change them. Be sure to check all the settings, especially the settings for Keys 6 to 10. To switch off a key setting, enter a zero for that key.

ƒ

You can select any number of keys from 1 to 10 (or all) by entering the corresponding 4-digit numbers from the table.

ƒ

You cannot mix settings for the groups (COPY, PRINTER, etc.) for 006 to 010. For example, if you want to create a PRINTER debug log you must select the settings from the 9 available selections for the “PRINTER” column only.

ƒ

One area of the disk is reserved to store the debug log. The size of this area is limited to 4 MB.

5.10.3 RETRIEVING THE DEBUG LOG FROM THE HDD Retrieve the debug log by copying it from the hard disk to an SD card. 1.

Insert the SD card into slot 2 (service slot) of the copier.

2.

Enter the SP mode and execute SP5857-009 (Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB)) to write the debugging data to the SD card.

3.

Use a card reader to copy the file and send it for analysis to your local Ricoh representative by email. You can also send the SD card by regular mail if you want.

5.10.4 RECORDING ERRORS MANUALLY SC errors and jams only are recorded to the debug log automatically. Please instruct the user to do the following immediately after occurrence to save the debug data for any other errors that occur while the customer engineer is not on site. Such problems also include a controller or panel freeze. ƒ

You must previously switch on the Save Debug Feature (SP5857-001) and select

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Using the Debug Log the hard disk as the save destination (SP5857-002) if you want to use this feature. 1.

Press S (Clear Modes).on the operation panel when the error occurs.

2.

On the control panel, enter “01”. Then hold down D for at least 3 seconds until the machine beeps and then release it. This saves the debug log to the hard disk for later retrieval with an SD card by the service representatives.

3.

Switch the machine off and on to resume operation. The debug information for the error is saved on the hard disk. This lets the service

System Maintenance Reference

representative retrieve it on their next visit by copying it from the HDD to an SD card.

SM

5-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Card Save Function

5.11 CARD SAVE FUNCTION 5.11.1 OVERVIEW Card Save: ƒ

The Card Save function is used to save print jobs received by the printer on an SD card with no print output. Card Save mode is toggled using printer Bit Switch #1 bit number 4. Card Save will remain enabled until the SD card becomes full, or until all file names have been used.

ƒ

Captures are stored on the SD card in the folder /prt/cardsave. File names are assigned sequentially from PRT00000.prn to PRT99999.prn. An additional file PRT.CTL will be created. This file contains a list of all files created on the card by the card save function.

ƒ

Previously stored files on the SD card can be overwritten or left intact. Card Save SD has “Add” and “New” menu items. ƒ

Card Save (Add): Appends files to the SD Card. Does not overwrite existing files. If the card becomes full or if all file names are used, an error will be displayed on the operation panel. Subsequent jobs will not be stored.

ƒ

Card Save (New): Overwrites files in the card's /prt/cardsave directory.

Limitation: ƒ

Card Save cannot be used with PJL Status Readback commands. PJL Status Readbacks will not work. In addition they will cause the Card Save to fail.

5.11.2 PROCEDURE For D038/D041 1.

Turn the main power switch OFF.

2.

Insert the SD card into slot 2. Then turn the power ON.

3.

Enter SP mode.

4.

Select the “Printer Sp”.

5.

Select SP-1001 "Bit Switch”.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Card Save Function

6.

Select “Bit Switch 1 Settings” and use the numeric keypad to turn bit 4 ON and then press the “#” button to register the change. The result should look like: 00010000. By

System Maintenance Reference

doing this, Card Save option will appear in the “List/Test Print” menu.

7.

Press “Exit” to exit SP Mode.

8.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” button.

9.

Select “Printer Features”.

10. Card Save (Add) and Card Save (New) should be displayed on the screen. Select Card Save (Add) or Card Save (New).

SM

5-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Card Save Function

11. Press “OK” and then exit the “User Tools/Counter” menu.

12. Press the “Printer” button. 13. Card Save should be displayed in the top left of the display panel.

14. Send a job to the printer. The Communicating light should start blinking as shown below.

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Card Save Function

15. As soon as the printer receives the data, it will be stored on the SD card automatically with no print output. Nothing is displayed on the screen, indicating that a Card Save operation was successful.

System Maintenance Reference

16. Press “Offline” and then the “Clear/Stop” button to exit Card Save mode.

17. Change the Bit Switch Settings back to the default 00000000. Press the “#” button in the numeric keypad to register the changes. 18. Remove the SD card after the main power switch is turned off.

For D037/D040 1.

SM

Turn the main power switch OFF.

5-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Card Save Function 2.

Insert the SD card into the service slot of the controller board. Then turn the power ON. ƒ

To determine which slot is the service slot, please see the service manual.

3.

Enter SP mode.

4.

Select “Printer SP”.

5.

Select “Service Mode” and press “OK” button.

6.

Select “1.001 Bit Switch”and press “OK” button.

7.

Use the arrow key to turn “Bit Switch 4” and use the numeric key “4” to turn bit 4 ON. The result should look like: 00010000. By doing this Card Save option will appear in “List/Test Print”.

8.

Press the “Escape” button several times to exit SP Mode.

9.

Press the “User Tools/Counter” button.

10. Use the arrow key and select “Printer Features”.

11. Use the arrow key and select “List/Test Print”.

12. Use the arrow key and select “Cardsave (ADD) or Cardsave (New).

13. To enable the newly configured settings, select “switch” button and then press the

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Card Save Function “Escape” button to exit the “List/Test Print” menu. 14. Send a job to the printer. 15. As soon as the printer receives the data, it will be stored on the SD card automatically with no print output. Nothing is displayed on the screen indicating that a Card Save operation was successful. 16. Press the “Online” button and then the “Escape” button to exit Card Save mode. 17. Change the Bit Switch Settings back to the default 00000000. 18. Remove the SD card after main power switch is turned off.

Error Messages Card Save error messages: ƒ

Init error: A card save process (i.e. card detection, change to kernel mode) failed to initialize.

ƒ

Card not found: Card cannot be detected in the slot.

ƒ

No memory: Insufficient working memory to process the job.

ƒ

Write error: Failed to write to the card.

ƒ

Other error: An unknown error occurred.

If an error occurs, pressing “OK” will cause the device to discard the job and return to the

5.11.3 ERROR MESSAGES Card Save error messages: ƒ

Init error: A card save process (e.g. card detection, change to kernel mode) failed to initialize.

ƒ

Card not found: Card cannot be detected in the slot.

ƒ

No memory: Insufficient working memory to process the job.

ƒ

Write error: Failed to write to the card.

ƒ

Other error: An unknown error occurred.

If an error occurs, pressing “OK” will cause the device to discard the job and return to the ready state.

SM

5-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

System Maintenance Reference

ready state.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

TROUBLESHOOTING

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Call Conditions

6. TROUBLESHOOTING 6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS

Troubleshooting

For "SC Table" information, see "Appendices".

SM

6-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Process Control Error Conditions

6.2 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS See "Appendices" for the following information: ƒ

Developer Initialization Result

ƒ

Process Control Self-Check Result

ƒ

Line Position Adjustment Result

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide

6.3 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE See "Appendices" for the following information: ƒ

Image Quality

ƒ

Line Position Adjustment

ƒ

Image Problems at Periodical Intervals

6.3.1 SUB-SCAN MAGNIFICATION ERROR If a sub-scan magnification error of an image occurs on an output, follow the procedure below to adjust the sub-scan magnification.

Sub-scan Magnification Adjustment Procedure 1.

Adjust the sub-scan magnification for each paper type and print mode with the following SPs. ƒ

Input the same value in these SP settings. Otherwise, color registration errors

ƒ

SP1-803-001: Plain paper/ 600 dpi Input

ƒ

SP1-803-002: Plain paper/ 1200 dpi Input

ƒ

SP1-803-003: Thick paper Input

2.

Turn the main power of the machine off and on.

3.

Check if all settings of the following SPs are "0" (success). ƒ

SP1-803-004: Plain paper/ 600 dpi Result

ƒ

SP1-803-005: Plain paper/ 1200 dpi Result

ƒ

SP1-803-006: Thick paper Result ƒ

If one of the settings of SP1-803-004 to 006 is "1" (error), return to step 1 and then input a value which is closer to "0" compared with the previously input value.

ƒ

For example, if "+0.9" is input in the settings of SP1-803-001 to 003 and an error occurs, input "+0.8" or less with SP1-803-001 to 003.

ƒ

For example, if "-0.9" is input in the settings of SP1-803-001 to 003 and an error occurs, input "-0.8" or more with SP1-803-001 to 003.

ƒ

If an error still remains, refer to "Motor Speed Adjustment".

4.

Execute the line position adjustment (rough) with SP2-111-003.

5.

Execute the line position adjustment (fine) with SP2-111-001.

SM

6-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Troubleshooting

occur on outputs and this cannot be recovered by the line position adjustment.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide 6.

Make sample copies and check if outputs are satisfactory.

Motor Speed Adjustment If "Sub-scan Magnification Adjustment Procedure" does not solve the sub-scan magnification error, the setting of the motor speed adjustment may be out of adjustable range. Check the following three points. 1.

An error ("1") occurs in the SP1-803-004. [Setting values of the following SPs + input value with SP1-803-001] > motor speed adjustable range e.g.) 3.5 (SP1-801-002) + 1 (SP1-803-001 to -003) = 4.5 In this case, "4.5" is over the maximum adjustable value ("4") of the SP1-801-002. As a result, the result of the motor speed adjustment issues "1" (error). ƒ

Adjust the settings of the SP1-830-001 to -003 so that the total value (motor speed setting value + input value) is within the adjustable range for each motor described below.

SP No.

Max.

Min.

SP1-801-002

4

-4

Regist Mot:120 (0.3 default)

SP1-801-003

4

-4

Bk OpcDevMot:120 (-0.4 default)

SP1-801-007

6

-6

Fusing Mot:120 (-0.4 default)

SP1-801-009

4

-4

Transfer Mot:120 (0 default)

SP1-801-012

2

-2

Feed1:CW120 (0.3 default)

SP1-801-014

2

-2

Feed1:CCW120 (0.3 default)

SP1-801-016

2

-2

Feed2:CW120 (0.3 default)

SP1-801-018

2

-2

Feed2:CCW120 (0.3 default)

SP1-801-020

2

-2

By-pass:120 (0.3 default)

SP1-801-022

2

-2

Inverter:CW120 (0 default)

SP1-801-024

2

-2

Inverter:CCW120 (0 default)

SP1-801-026

2

-2

Duplex Entrance:120 (0.3 default)

D037/D038/D040/D041

Title

6-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide SP No. SP1-801-028

2.

Max.

Min.

2

-2

Title Duplex Exit:120 (0.3 default)

An error ("1") occurs in the SP1-803-005. [Setting values of the following SPs + input value with SP1-803-001] > motor speed adjustable range e.g.) 1.5 (SP1-801-025) + 1 (SP1-803-001 to -003) = 2.5 In this case, "2.5" is over the maximum adjustable value ("2") of the SP1-801-025. As a result, the result of the motor speed adjustment issues "1" (error). ƒ

Adjust the settings of the SP1-830-001 to -003 so that the total value (motor speed setting value + input value) is within the adjustable range for each motor described below.

SM

Max.

Min.

Title

SP1-801-025

2

-2

Duplex Entrance:60

SP1-801-027

2

-2

Duplex Exit:60

SP1-801-033

4

-4

Regist Mot:60:1200dpi

SP1-801-034

2

-2

Feed1:CW60:1200dpi

SP1-801-035

2

-2

Feed1:CCW60:1200dpi

SP1-801-036

2

-2

Feed2:CW60:1200dpi

SP1-801-037

2

-2

Feed2:CCW60:1200dpi

SP1-801-038

2

-2

By-pass:60:1200dpi

SP1-801-039

2

-2

Inverter:CW60:1200dpi

SP1-801-040

2

-2

Inverter:CCW60:1200dpi

SP1-801-041

6

-6

FusingMot:60:1200dpi

SP1-801-042

4

-4

BkOpcDevMot:60:1200dpi

SP1-801-043

4

-4

TransferMot:60:1200dpi

6-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting

SP No.

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide 3.

An error ("1") occurs in the SP1-803-006. [Setting values of the following SPs + input value with SP1-803-001] > motor speed adjustable range e.g.) 3.5 (SP1-801-001) + 1 (SP1-803-001 to -003) = 4.5 In this case, "4.5" is over the maximum adjustable value ("4") of the SP1-801-025. As a result, the result of the motor speed adjustment issues "1" (error). ƒ

Adjust the settings of the SP1-830-001 to -003 so that the total value (motor speed setting value + input value) is within the adjustable range for each motor described below.

SP No.

Max.

Min.

Title

SP1-801-001

4

-4

Regist Mot:60:Thick

SP1-801-004

4

-4

Bk OpcDevMot:60:Thick

SP1-801-008

6

-6

Fusing Mot:60:Thick

SP1-801-010

4

-4

TransferMot:60:Thick

SP1-801-011

2

-2

Feed1:CW60:Thick

SP1-801-013

2

-2

Feed1:CCW60:Thick

SP1-801-015

2

-2

Feed2:CW60:Thick

SP1-801-017

2

-2

Feed2:CCW60:Thick

SP1-801-019

2

-2

By-pass:60:Thick

SP1-801-021

2

-2

Inverter:CW60:Thick

SP1-801-023

2

-2

Inverter:CCW60:Thick

6.3.2 TRAPEZOID IMAGE ADJUSTMENT Before Adjusting the Trapezoid Image 1.

Enter SP2-109 and print out the test pattern 14 (Trimming Area).

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide

2.

Make sure the horizontal lines are parallel. “Parallel”: The gap between horizontal lines is 1.8 mm or less.

3.

If the lines are not parallel, check the following and apply corrections as necessary: ƒ

Make sure that the side fences of the tray are set neatly against the sides of the paper.

ƒ

Make sure that the PTR unit is connected to the bracket correctly.

ƒ

Make sure that the shafts of the duplex unit are not bent nor damaged.

Adjusting the Trapezoid Image

SM

Remove the following items: ƒ

Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)

ƒ

Front right cover ( Section: Front Right Cover)

ƒ

PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)

ƒ

Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)

ƒ

Inner right cover ( Section: Inner Right Cover)

6-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Troubleshooting

1.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide

2.

Remove the interlock switch bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 1, x 2).

3.

Loosen the four screws [A] on the front fusing guide.

4.

Remove the screw [B] on the adjustor lever. ƒ

5.

This screw is not necessary after tightening the front fusing guide.

If the horizontal lines slope down to the left [A], move the front fusing guide upward. To

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide do this, turn the adjustor lever [B] of the fusing front guide clockwise [C]. ƒ

6.

One step of the adjustor lever moves the front fusing guide by 1 mm.

If the horizontal lines slope down to the right [A], move the fusing front guide downward. To do this, turn the adjustor lever [B] of the front fusing guide counterclockwise [C]. ƒ

One step of the adjustor lever moves the front fusing guide by 1 mm.

Retighten the four screws for the front fusing guide.

8.

Print out the test pattern and check the image quality.

9.

If the symptom still occurs, repeat the above steps.

Troubleshooting

7.

SM

6-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection

6.4 JAM DETECTION See "Appendices" for the following information: ƒ

Paper Jam Display

ƒ

Jam Codes and Display Codes (Paper Size Code) (Sensor Locations)

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Component Defects

6.5 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS See "Appendices" for the following information: ƒ

Sensors

ƒ

Blown Fuse Conditions

Troubleshooting

(Power Supply Unit)

SM

6-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Test Mode

6.6 SCANNER TEST MODE 6.6.1 SBU TEST MODE Output the SBU test pattern with SP4-807-001 to make sure the scanner SBU control operates correctly. The SBU test pattern prints out after you have set the SP mode settings and pressed the start key. ƒ

The CCD on the SBU board may be defective if the copy is abnormal and the SBU test pattern is normal.

ƒ

The followings can be the cause if the copy is normal and the SBU test pattern is abnormal: ƒ

The harness may not be correctly connected between the SBU and the i-controller.

ƒ

The i-controller or SBU board may be defective.

6.6.2 IPU TEST MODE You can check the BICU board with the SP mode menu, SP4-904-1. If no error is detected, the test ends. Then the completion code shows in the operation panel display. If an error is detected, the test is interrupted. Then an error code shows. The table below lists the completion and error codes.

SP4-904-1 Register Access There are 16 bits switches in this SP. Each bit indicates a different CPU. The error result is displayed on the operation panel as a decimal number. 0: Normal, 1: Error

SP4-904-2 Image Path There are 16 bits switches in this SP. Each bit indicates a different CPU path. The error result is displayed on the operation panel as a decimal number. 0: Normal, 1: Error Errors may be caused by the following problems: 1.

2.

Short circuit on the signal lines ƒ

When the i-controller board is installed, a pin or two on the ASIC is damaged.

ƒ

Some conductive matter or object is trapped among the pins.

ƒ

Condensation

Destruction of circuit elements ƒ

Over current or a defective element breaks the circuit.

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner Test Mode 3.

Abnormal power supply •The required voltage is not supplied to the devices.

4.

Overheat/overcooling ƒ

5.

Static electricity ƒ

6.

The environment is inappropriate for the board (the scanner unit).

Static electricity of a high voltage occurs during the test.

Others ƒ

The scanner and i-controller are incorrectly connected.

When you have completed a check, turn the main switch off and on before you do another check. When you have completed all necessary checks, turn the main switch off and

Troubleshooting

on.Error! No index entries found.

SM

6-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL APPENDICES

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041 APPENDICES TABLE OF CONTENTS APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS 1. APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS ................................................... 1-1 1.1 COPIER ..................................................................................................... 1-1 1.2 PRINTER ................................................................................................... 1-5 1.3 SCANNER ................................................................................................. 1-7 1.4 SUPPORTED PAPER SIZES .................................................................... 1-8 1.4.1 PAPER FEED ................................................................................... 1-8 North America ...................................................................................... 1-8 Europe/ Asia....................................................................................... 1-10 1.4.2 PAPER EXIT................................................................................... 1-12 Mainframe and optional trays ............................................................. 1-12 Internal Finisher.................................................................................. 1-14 1.4.3 PLATEN/ARDF ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION............................... 1-16 1.5 SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES .................................................................. 1-18 1.5.1 PRINTER DRIVERS ....................................................................... 1-18 1.5.2 SCANNER AND LAN FAX DRIVERS ............................................. 1-18 1.5.3 UTILITY SOFTWARE ..................................................................... 1-19 1.6 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT......................................................................... 1-21 1.6.1 ARDF (D366: STANDARD FOR H-MODELS (D038/D041))........... 1-21 1.6.2 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425) ............................................................ 1-21 1.6.3 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331) ............................................................ 1-22 1.6.4 INTERNAL FINISHER & PUNCH UNIT (D429) .............................. 1-23 1.6.5 SHIFT TRAY (D428) ....................................................................... 1-24 1.6.6 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426) ............................................................... 1-24 1.6.7 SIDE TRAY (D427) ......................................................................... 1-25

APPENDIX: OVERVIEW 2. APPENDIX: OVERVIEW.............................................................. 2-1 2.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................................ 2-1 SM Appendix

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ........................................... 2-1 2.1.2 PAPER PATH ................................................................................... 2-2 With options.......................................................................................... 2-2 Without options..................................................................................... 2-3 2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT................................................................................ 2-4

APPENDIX: PM TABLES 3. APPENDIX: PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TABLES ............... 3-1 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES .......................................................................... 3-1 3.1.1 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE ITEMS ............................................ 3-1 Mainframe ............................................................................................ 3-1 ARDF (D366)........................................................................................ 3-3 One-tray Paper Feed Unit (D425) ........................................................ 3-4 Two-tray Paper Feed Unit (D331) ........................................................ 3-4 1 Bin Tray (D426) ................................................................................. 3-4 Shift Tray (D427) .................................................................................. 3-5 3.1.2 OTHERS YIELD PARTS................................................................... 3-5 ARDF ................................................................................................... 3-5

APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS 4. APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS ............................... 4-1 4.1 SC TABLES ............................................................................................... 4-1 4.1.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS......................................................... 4-1 Summary .............................................................................................. 4-1 SC Code Classification......................................................................... 4-2 4.1.2 SC1XX: SCANNING ......................................................................... 4-4 4.1.3 SC 2XX: EXPOSURE ....................................................................... 4-8 4.1.4 SC3XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 1................................................ 4-13 4.1.5 SC4XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 2................................................ 4-18 4.1.6 SC5XX: PAPER FEED AND FUSING ............................................ 4-21 4.1.7 SC6XX: DEVICE COMMUNICATION ............................................. 4-34 4.1.8 SC7XX: PERIPHERALS ................................................................. 4-42 4.1.9 SC8XX: OVERALL SYSTEM .......................................................... 4-48 D037/D038/D040/D041

ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

4.1.10

SC9XX: MISCELLANEOUS ...................................................... 4-66

APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS 5. APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS ....... 5-1 5.1 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS.......................................... 5-1 5.1.1 DEVELOPER INITIALIZATION RESULT.......................................... 5-1 5.1.2 PROCESS CONTROL SELF-CHECK RESULT ............................... 5-2 Vsg Adjustment Result ......................................................................... 5-4 5.1.3 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT RESULT........................................ 5-5

APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 6. APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE ................................ 6-1 6.1 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE................................................................... 6-1 6.1.1 IMAGE QUALITY .............................................................................. 6-1 6.1.2 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT....................................................... 6-3 Test ...................................................................................................... 6-3 Countermeasure list for color registration errors .................................. 6-3 6.1.3 IMAGE PROBLEMS AT REGULAR INTERVALS............................. 6-9

APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION 7. APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION.................................................... 7-1 7.1 JAM DETECTION ...................................................................................... 7-1 7.1.1 PAPER JAM DISPLAY ..................................................................... 7-1 Paper Size Code .................................................................................. 7-1 7.1.2 JAM CODES AND DISPLAY CODES............................................... 7-2 Mainframe ............................................................................................ 7-2 ARDF (Original Jam) ............................................................................ 7-5 Sensor Locations.................................................................................. 7-7

SM Appendix

iii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS 8. APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS ................ 8-1 8.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS ................................................... 8-1 8.1.1 SENSORS ........................................................................................ 8-1 8.1.2 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS........................................................... 8-6 Power Supply Unit................................................................................ 8-6

APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES 9. APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES ................................................. 9-1 9.1 SYSTEM SERVICE MODE........................................................................ 9-1 9.1.1 SERVICE MODE TABLE .................................................................. 9-1 SP1-XXX (Feed)................................................................................... 9-1 SP2-XXX (Drum) ................................................................................ 9-24 SP3-XXX (Process).......................................................................... 9-112 SP4-XXX (Scanner) ......................................................................... 9-162 SP5-XXX (Mode).............................................................................. 9-187 SP6-XXX (Peripherals)..................................................................... 9-250 SP7-XXX (Data Log) ........................................................................ 9-253 SP8-xxx: Data Log2 ......................................................................... 9-287 9.1.2 INPUT CHECK TABLE ................................................................. 9-336 Copier............................................................................................... 9-337 ARDF (D366).................................................................................... 9-341 Internal Finisher (D429).................................................................... 9-341 Table 1: Paper Size Switch (Tray 1/ 2)............................................. 9-343 Table 2: Paper Size (By-pass Table)................................................ 9-344 Table 3: APS Original Size Detection............................................... 9-344 Table 4: Paper Size Switch (Tray 3/ 4)............................................. 9-345 Table 5: Area Display ....................................................................... 9-346 9.1.3 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE ............................................................. 9-346 Copier............................................................................................... 9-346 Internal Finisher (D429).................................................................... 9-352 ARDF (D366).................................................................................... 9-353 9.1.4 TEST PATTERN PRINTING ......................................................... 9-354 D037/D038/D040/D041

iv CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

9.2 PRINTER SERVICE MODE................................................................... 9-356 9.2.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) ........................................................ 9-356 9.3 SCANNER SP MODE ............................................................................ 9-363 9.3.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS) ............................................ 9-363 9.3.2 SP2-XXX (SCANNING-IMAGE QUALITY).................................... 9-364

SM Appendix

v CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier

1. APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS 1.1 COPIER

Configuration:

Print Process:

Resolution:

Gradation:

Desktop Laser beam scanning & Dry electrostatic transfer system 4 drums tandem method Scan: 600 dpi Print: 600 dpi Scan: 8 bits/pixel each for RGB/ 600 dpi 1 bit/pixel (B/W C1L) Print: 600dpi / 4 bits/pixel

Original type:

Sheets, book, objects

Maximum original size:

A3/11" x 17" ADF 1 to 1, LT/ A4 LEF Thin (60 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 20 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 25 cpm (color/black & white) Plain 1 (74 g/m2 or less)/ 2 (90 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 20 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 25 cpm (color/black & white) Middle Thick (105 g/m2 or less)

Copy speed:

D037/D038: 20 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 25 cpm (color/black & white) Thick 1 (169 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) Thick 2 (220 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) Thick 3 (256 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white)

SM Appendix

1-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) OHP, Glossy (1200 dpi) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) First copy (normal

Color: 9.5 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF)

mode):

Black & white: 6.5 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF)

Warm-up time:

Less than 30 seconds (20°C) Standard tray: 250 sheets x 2 + 100

Print Paper Capacity: 2

(80 g/m , 20 lb)

By-pass tray: 100 sheets (Plain), 40 sheets (Thick 1: 106 169g/m2), 20 sheets (Thick 2/3: 170 - 256 g/m2), 35 sheets (Postcard) Optional paper feed tray: 500 sheets x 2 (Refer to “Supported Paper Sizes”.) -

Print Paper Size:

Minimum A5 (LEF)/

Tray 1/ Tray 2

8.5" x 11"

By-pass

90 x 148 mm A5 (LEF)/

Optional Tray

8.5" x 11"

Maximum

A3/11" x 17"

305 x 600 mm

A3/11" x 17"

Standard tray 1: 60 to 256 g/m2 (16 to 68 lb.) Standard tray 2: 60 to 169 g/m2 (16 to 45 lb.) Printing Paper Weight:

Optional paper tray: 60 to 105 g/m2 (16 to 28 lb.) By-pass tray: 52 to 256 g/m2 (14 to 68 lb.) Duplex unit: 60 to 105 g/m2 (16 to 28 lb.) Standard exit tray: 500 sheets or more (face down)*1 Shift tray: 250 sheets (80 g/m2)

Output Paper Capacity:

1-bin tray: 100 (80 g/m2) Side tray: 50 (80 g/m2) Internal finisher 500 (80 g/m2) *1: T6200, A4 LEF

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Copier Continuous copy:

Up to 999 sheets Arbitrary: From 25 to 400% (1% step) H Fixed:

L Fixed:

NA

Europe

NA

Europe

25%

25%

25%

25%

50%

50%

50%

50%

65%

61%

65%

-

73%

71%

-

71%

78%

82%

78%

82%

85%

87%

-

-

93%

93%

93%

93%

100%

100%

100%

100%

121%

115%

121%

-

129%

122%

129%

122%

155%

141%

155%

141%

200%

200%

-

200%

400%

400%

400%

400%

Zoom:

Memory:

Power Source:

H Standard: 768 MB/ Max.:1 GB L Standard: 512 MB 120 V, 60 Hz: 12A or more (for North America) 220 V - 240 V, 50/60 Hz: 8A or more (for Europe/ASIA) -

Power Consumption:

SM Appendix

120V

220 - 240V

Maximum

1440 W or less

1680 W or less

Energy Saver

H: 7.8 W or less

H: 6.4 W or less

1-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Copier L: 6.1 W or less

L: 6.0 W or less

(*1) The complete system consists of mainframe, ARDF, finisher, and LCT. The above measurements were made in accordance with Ricoh standard methodology. Dimensions (W x D x H): Copier: 587 x 655 x 725 mm (23.1" x 25.8" x 28.5") Copier (L) + PFU + Right tray: 854 x 655 x 1117 mm (33.6" x 25.8" x 44.0") Copier (H) + PFU + Right tray + Internal finisher: 1009 x 655 x 1117 mm (39.7" x 25.8" x 44.0")

Weight:

D037/D038/D040/D041

Less than 85 kg (187 lb.) [without ARDF excluding toner] Less than 100 kg (220 lb.) [with ARDF excluding toner]

1-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Printer

1.2 PRINTER

PCL 5c/6 (standard for H, optional for L) RPCS (Refined Printing Command Stream) Printer Languages:

Adobe PostScript 3 (optional) PDF Direct (optional) PictBridge (optional) PCL 5c/6: 300 x 300 dpi : Available only in B/W mode 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits)

Resolution and Gradation:

RPCS: 600 x 600 dpi, 1,800 x 600 dpi*, 1200 dpi x 1200 dpi *1,800 x 600 dpi = 600 x 600 dpi (2 bits) PS3: 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits) 1200 dpi x 1200 dpi D037/D038: 20 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode

Printing speed:

12.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type) D040/D041: 25 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode 12.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type) PCL 5c/6 (Standard): H 45 Compatible fonts

Resident Fonts:

13 International fonts Adobe PostScript 3 (Optional): H 136 fonts (24 Type 2 fonts, 112 Type 14 fonts) USB2.0: Standard Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T): Standard

Host Interfaces:

Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Base-T): Optional only for H IEEE1284 parallel x 1: Optional only for H IEEE802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN): Optional only for H

SM Appendix

1-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Bluetooth (Wireless): Optional only for H Network Protocols:

TCP/IP (IPv4, IPv6), IPX/SPX, AppleTalk (Auto Switching)

HDD

60 GB (standard only for H)

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Scanner

1.3 SCANNER

Standard Scanner

Main scan/Sub scan

Resolution:

600 dpi Twain Mode:

Available scanning

100 to1200 dpi

Resolution Range:

Delivery Mode: 100/200/300/400/600 dpi

Grayscales:

1 bit or 8 bits/pixel each for RGB (H model) only

Scanning Throughput (ARDF mode):

Scan to E-mail / Folder: BW: 26 ipm (A4LEF / BW Text (Print) / 200dpi /Compression: On (MH)) FC: 41 ipm (A4LEF / FC Text / Photo / 200dpi / Compression: Standard)

Interface:

Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T/1000 Base-T for TCP/IP), Wireless LAN, USB2.0/SD Slot

Compression

B&W: TIFF (MH, MR, MMR)

Method:

Gray Scale, Full Color: JPEG

SM Appendix

1-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Supported Paper Sizes

1.4 SUPPORTED PAPER SIZES 1.4.1 PAPER FEED North America BT: By-pass Tray, T1/2: Tray 1/2 (standard), T3/4: Tray 3/4 (option), DU: Duplex Unit

Paper

Size

BT

T1/2

T3/4

DU

12" x 18"

M

-

-

-

A3 SEF

297 x 420mm

M

S1

S1

M

A4 SEF

210 x 297mm

M

A

A

M

A4 LEF

297 x 210mm

M

S3

S3

M

A5 SEF

148 x 210mm

M

-

M

M

A5 LEF

210 x 148mm

M

A

A

M

A6 SEF

105 x 148mm

M

-

-

-

B4 SEF

257 x 364mm

M

S2

S2

M

B5 SEF

182 x 257mm

M

A

A

M

B5 LEF

257 x 182mm

M

S4

S4

M

B6 SEF

128 x 182mm

M

-

-

-

Ledger

11" x 17"

A

A1

A1

M

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

A

A

A

M

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

A

A3

A3

M

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

M

A2

A2

M

8.25" x 14"

M

M

M

M

A3 W

Government Legal SEF

D037/D038/D040/D041

(W x L)

1-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Supported Paper Sizes Size

Paper

(W x L)

BT

T1/2

T3/4

DU

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x 8.5"

A

-

-

-

Executive SEF

7.25" x 10.5"

M

M

M

M

Executive LEF

10.5" x 7.25"

M

A4

A4

M

8" x 13"

M

M

M

M

8.5" x 13"

M

M

M

M

8.25" x 13"

M

M

M

M

11" x 15"

M

M

M

M

10" x 14"

M

M

M

M

8" x 10"

M

M

M

M

8K

267 x 390mm

M

M

M

M

16K SEF

195 x 267mm

M

M

M

M

16K LEF

267 x 195mm

M

M

M

M

M

M

M

-

F SEF Foolscap SEF

Folio SEF

Custom Com10 Env.

4.125" x 9.5"

M

-

-

-

Monarch Env.

3.875" x 7.5"

M

-

-

-

C6 Env.

114 x 162mm

M

-

-

-

C5 Env.

162 x 229mm

M

-

-

-

DL Env.

110 x 220mm

M

-

-

-

Remarks:

A

Supported: the sensor detects the paper size.

M

Supported: the user specifies the paper size.

SM Appendix

1-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Supported Paper Sizes Supported: depends on a technician adjustment S

Paper size which has same superscript number can be changeable with SP setting. (eg. Ledger: A1 <=> A3 SEF: S1)

-

Not supported

Europe/ Asia BT: By-pass Tray, T1/2: Tray 1/2 (standard), T3/4: Tray 3/4 (option), DU: Duplex Unit

Paper

Size

BT

T1/2

T3/4

DU

12" x 18"

M

-

-

-

A3 SEF

297 x 420mm

A

A1

S1

M

A4 SEF

210 x 297mm

A

A

A

M

A4 LEF

297 x 210mm

A

A3

A3

M

A5 SEF

148 x 210mm

A

-

A

M

A5 LEF

210 x 148mm

A

A

A

M

A6 SEF

105 x 148mm

M

-

-

-

B4 SEF

257 x 364mm

M

A2

A2

M

B5 SEF

182 x 257mm

M

A

A

M

B5 LEF

257 x 182mm

M

A4

A4

M

B6 SEF

128 x 182mm

M

-

-

-

Ledger

11" x 17"

M

S1

S1

M

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

M

A

A

M

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

M

S3

S3

M

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

M

S2

S2

M

A3 W

D037/D038/D040/D041

(W x L)

1-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Supported Paper Sizes Paper

Size

BT

T1/2

T3/4

DU

8.25" x 14"

M

M

M

M

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x 8.5"

M

-

-

-

Executive SEF

7.25" x 10.5"

M

M

M

M

Executive LEF

10.5" x 7.25"

M

S4

S4

M

8" x 13"

M

M

M

M

8.5" x 13"

M

M

M

M

8.25" x 13"

M

M

M

M

11" x 15"

M

M

M

M

10" x 14"

M

M

M

M

8" x 10"

M

M

M

M

8K

267 x 390mm

M

M

M

M

16K SEF

195 x 267mm

M

M

M

M

16K LEF

267 x 195mm

M

M

M

M

M

M

M

-

Government Legal SEF

F SEF Foolscap SEF

Folio SEF

(W x L)

Custom Com10 Env.

4.125" x 9.5"

M

-

-

-

Monarch Env.

3.875" x 7.5"

M

-

-

-

C6 Env.

114 x 162mm

M

-

-

-

C5 Env.

162 x 229mm

M

-

-

-

DL Env.

110 x 220mm

M

-

-

-

Remarks:

SM Appendix

1-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Supported Paper Sizes A

Supported: the sensor detects the paper size.

M

Supported: the user specifies the paper size. Supported: depends on a technician adjustment

S

Paper size which has same superscript number can be changeable with SP setting. (eg. Ledger: S1 <=> A3 SEF: A1)

-

Not supported

1.4.2 PAPER EXIT Mainframe and optional trays Main: Mainframe/ 1-bin: 1-bin tray/ Shift: Shift Tray/ Side: Side Tray

Paper

Size (W x L)

Main

1-bin

Shift

Side

A3 W

12" x 18"

Y

-

-

-

A3 SEF

297 x 420 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

A4 SEF

210 x 297 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

A4 LEF

297 x 210 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

A5 SEF

148 x 210 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

A5 LEF

210 x 148 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

A6 SEF

105 x 148 mm

Y

-

Y

-

B4 SEF

257 x 364 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

B5 SEF

182 x 257 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

B5 LEF

257 x 182 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

B6 SEF

128 x 182 mm

Y

-

Y

-

Ledger

11" x 17"

Y

Y

Y

Y

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

Y

Y

Y

Y

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Supported Paper Sizes Paper

Size (W x L)

Main

1-bin

Shift

Side

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

Y

Y

Y

Y

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

Y

Y

Y

Y

8.25" x 14"

Y

Y

Y

Y

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x 8.5"

Y

Y

Y

Y

Executive SEF

7.25" x 10.5"

Y

Y

Y

Y

Executive LEF

10.5" x 7.25"

Y

Y

Y

Y

F SEF

8" x 13"

Y

Y

Y

Y

Foolscap SEF

8.5" x 13"

Y

Y

Y

Y

8.25" x 13"

Y

Y

Y

Y

11" x 15"

Y

Y

Y

Y

10" x 14"

Y

Y

Y

Y

8" x 10"

Y

Y

Y

Y

8K

267 x 390 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

16K SEF

195 x 267 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

16K LEF

267 x 195 mm

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

-

Y

-

Government Legal SEF

Folio SEF

Custom Com10 Env.

4.125" x 9.5"

Y

-

Y

-

Monarch Env.

3.875" x 7.5"

Y

-

Y

-

C6 Env.

114 x 162 mm

Y

-

Y

-

C5 Env.

162 x 229 mm

Y

-

Y

-

DL Env.

110 x 220 mm

Y

-

Y

-

Remarks: SM Appendix

1-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Supported Paper Sizes

Y

Supported

-

Not supported

Internal Finisher Str: Straight Feed Out/ Inv: Inverter Path/ Srt; Sort/ Stp: Staple/ 2/3P: 2/3 Holes Punch/ 4P: 4 Holes Punch/ S4P: Scandinavia 4 Holes Punch/ RT: Right Tray

Paper

Internal finisher

Size (W x L) Str

Inv

Srt

Stp

2/3P

4P

S4P

A3 W

12" x 18"

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

A3 SEF

297 x 420 mm

Y

Y

10

30

Y

Y

Y

A4 SEF

210 x 297 mm

Y

Y

20

50

Y*

-

Y

A4 LEF

297 x 210 mm

Y

Y

20

50

Y

Y

Y

A5 SEF

148 x 210 mm

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

A5 LEF

210 x 148 mm

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

A6 SEF

105 x 148 mm

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

B4 SEF

257 x 364 mm

Y

Y

10

30

-

-

-

B5 SEF

182 x 257 mm

Y

Y

20

50

-

-

-

B5 LEF

257 x 182 mm

Y

Y

20

50

-

-

-

B6 SEF

128 x 182 mm

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

Ledger

11" x 17"

Y

Y

10

30

Y

Y

Y

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

Y

Y

20

50

Y*

-

Y

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

Y

Y

20

50

Y

Y

Y

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

Y

Y

10

30

Y*

-

Y

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Supported Paper Sizes Paper

Internal finisher

Size (W x L) Str

Inv

Srt

Stp

2/3P

4P

S4P

8.25" x 14"

Y

Y

10

30

-

-

-

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x 8.5"

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

Executive SEF

7.25" x 10.5"

Y

Y

20

50

-

-

-

Executive LEF

10.5" x 7.25"

Y

Y

20

50

-

-

-

F SEF

8" x 13"

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

Foolscap SEF

8.5" x 13"

Y

Y

10

30

Y*

-

Y

8.25" x 13"

Y

Y

10

30

-

-

-

11" x 15"

Y

Y

10

30

-

-

-

10" x 14"

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

8" x 10"

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

8K

267 x 390 mm

Y

Y

10

30

-

-

-

16K SEF

195 x 267 mm

Y

Y

-

-

-

-

-

16K LEF

267 x 195 mm

Y

Y

20

50

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Government Legal SEF

Folio SEF

Custom Com10 Env.

4.125" x 9.5"

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Monarch Env.

3.875" x 7.5"

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

C6 Env.

114 x 162 mm

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

C5 Env.

162 x 229 mm

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

DL Env.

110 x 220 mm

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Remarks:

SM Appendix

1-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Supported Paper Sizes Y

Supported (*1: 2 holes punch only)

30

Output up to 30 sheets

50

Output up to 50 sheets

-

Not supported

1.4.3 PLATEN/ARDF ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION

Platen

ARDF

Platen

ARDF

Inches

Inches

Metric

Metric

A3 (297 x 420) L

-

Y

Y*3

Y

B4 (257 x 364) L

-

-

Y*3

Y

A4 (210 x 297) L

Y*1

Y

Y*3

Y

A4 (297 x 210) S

Y*3

Y

Y*3

Y

B5 (182 x 257) L

-

-

Y*3

Y

B5 (257 x 182) S

-

-

Y*3

Y

A5 (148 x 210) L

-

-

-*1

Y

A5 (210 x 148) S

-

-

-*1

Y

B6 (128 x 182) L

-

-

-

-

B6 (182 x 128) S

-

-

-

-

11" x 17" (DLT)

Y

Y*2

-

Y*2

11" x 15"

-

Y*2

-

-

10" x 14"

-

Y

-

-

8.5" x 14" (LG)

Y

Y*2

-

-

8.5" x 13" (F4)

-

Y*2

Y*4

Y*4

Size (width x length) [mm]

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Supported Paper Sizes 8.25" x 13"

-

-

Y*4

Y*4

8" x 13"(F)

-

-

Y*4

Y*4

8.5" x 11" (LT)

Y*3

Y*2

Y*3

Y*2

11" x 8.5" (LT)

Y*3

Y*2

Y*3

Y*2

-

Y*2

-

-

5.5" x 8.5" (HLT)

-*1

Y

-

-

8.5" x 5.5" (HLT)

-*1

Y

-

-

8K (267 x 390)

-

-

Y*3

Y*2

16K L (195 x 267)

-

-

Y*3

Y*2

16K S (267 x 195)

-

-

Y*3

Y*2

-

Y

-

-

-

Y*2

-

-

8" x 10"

7.25" x 10.5" (Executive) 10.5" x 7.25" (Executive)

*1: Use SP4-303 to detect original sizes as A5 lengthwise/HLT when the message “Can-t detect original size” shows. *2: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP6-016-1. *3: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP4-305-1. *4: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP5-126-1.

SM Appendix

1-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Software Accessories

1.5 SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES The printer drivers and utility software are provided as following two CD-ROMs 1: Printer Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM 2: Scanner/PostScript® Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM. An auto-run installer lets you to select the components you want to install.

1.5.1 PRINTER DRIVERS

Printer Language

Windows 2000, XP, Server 2003, Vista, Server 20038

PCL5c

MacOS8.6 to 9.x, MacOSX10.1 or later

Yes

No

PS3 *2)

Yes

Yes

RPCS

Yes

No

/ PCL6

ƒ

The PCL5c/6 and RPCS drivers are provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM

ƒ

The PS drivers are provided on the Scanner/PostScript® Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM.

ƒ

The printer drivers for Windows NT 4.0 are only for the Intel x86 platform. There is no Windows NT 4.0 printer driver for the PowerPC, Alpha, or MIPS platforms.

ƒ

The PS3 drivers are all genuine Adobe PS drivers, except for Windows 2000/XP/2003/Vista. Windows 2000 uses Microsoft PS. A PPD file for each operating system is provided with the driver.

ƒ

The PS3 driver for Macintosh supports Mac OS X 10.1 or later versions.

1.5.2 SCANNER AND LAN FAX DRIVERS

Printer

Windows

Windows

Windows 2000, XP,

Language

95/98/ME

NT4.0

Server 2003/Vista

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

MacOS8.6 to 9.x, MacOSX10.1 or later

SM Appendix

Software Accessories Network TWAIN LAN-FAX

ƒ

Yes

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

Yes

No

The Network TWAIN and LAN Fax drivers are provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM.

ƒ

This software lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover Sheet Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)

1.5.3 UTILITY SOFTWARE

Software Font Manager 2000 (Win9x/ME, 2000/XP/2003, NT4)

Description A font management utility with screen fonts for the printer This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM

Smart Device Monitor for Admin

A printer management utility for network

(Win 95/98/Me, NT4,

administrators. NIB setup utilities are also available.

2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista)

This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM A printer management utility for client users.

DeskTopBinder – SmartDeviceMonitor for Client (Win 95/98/Me, NT4, 2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista)

A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or TCP/IP network. A peer-to-peer print utility over a TCP/IP network. This provides the parallel printing and recovery printing features. This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or

Printer Utility for Mac

TCP This software provides several convenient

(Mac)

functions for printing from Macintosh clients. This is provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM

DeskTopBinder Lite

SM Appendix

DeskTopBinder Lite itself can be used as personal

1-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Software Accessories (Win9x/ME, 2000/XP/2003, NT4)

document management software and can manage both image data converted from paper documents and application files saved in each client’s PC. This is provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Optional Equipment

1.6 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT 1.6.1 ARDF (D366: STANDARD FOR H-MODELS (D038/D041))

Simplex Paper Size/Weight: Duplex

Size

A3 to A5, DLT to HLT

Weight

40 to 128 g/m2 (10 to 34 lb.)

Size

A3 to A5, DLT to HLT

Weight

52 to 105 g/m2 (14 to 28 lb.)

Table Capacity:

50 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb)

Original Standard Position:

Rear left corner

Separation:

Feed belt and separation roller

Original Transport:

Roller transport

Original Feed Order:

From the top original Copy

Supported Magnification Ratios:

Fax

-

32 to 200 %

Color

32.6 to 200 %

Black & white

48.9 to 200 %

Power Source:

DC 24V, 5V from the scanner unit

Power Consumption:

50 W or less

Dimensions (W × D × H):

550 mm x 491 mm x 120 mm (21.7" x 19.3" x 4.7")

Weight:

10 kg (22 lb.)

1.6.2 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425)

Paper Feed System:

FRR

Paper Height Detection:

4 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, Near end)

SM Appendix

1-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Optional Equipment Capacity:

500 sheets

Paper Weight:

80 g/m2 (21 lb.)

Paper Size:

A3 SEF to A5, DLT SEF to HLT

Power Source:

DC 24V, 5V (from the main frame)

Power Consumption:

58 W

Dimensions (W x D x H):

550 mm x 520 mm x 137 mm (22" x 20.8" x 5.48")

Weight:

Less than 12 kg (26.4 lbs)

1.6.3 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331)

Paper Size:

A5 to A3, 51/2" x 81/2" SEF to 11" x 17"

Paper Weight:

60 - 105 g/m2, 16 - 28 lb

Tray Capacity:

500 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb) x 2 trays

Paper Feed System:

Feed roller and friction pad

Paper Height Detection:

4 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, Near end) ƒ

24 Vdc and 5Vdc (from the copier/printer)

ƒ

120 Vac (120 V version) from the copier/printer when the optional tray heater is installed

Power Source: ƒ

220 – 240 Vac (230 V version) from the copier/printer when the optional tray heater is installed

Power Consumption:

35 W (Copying/printing)

Weight:

25 kg (55 lb)

Size (W x D x H):

550 mm x 520 mm x 271 mm

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Optional Equipment

1.6.4 INTERNAL FINISHER & PUNCH UNIT (D429)

No punch mode: A3/11" x 17" to B6/5.5" x 8.5" (SEF) Punch mode: 2 holes: A3, A4 or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 14" (SEF), 8.5" x 13" (SEF), 8.5" x 11" 3 holes: Print Paper Size:

A3, A4 (LEF) or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 11" (LEF) 4 holes (Europe): A3, A4 (LEF) or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 11" (LEF) 4 holes (Scandinavia): A3, A4 or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 14" (SEF), 8.5" x 13" (SEF), 8.5" x 11", 7.25" x 10.5" Staple mode: A3/11" x 17" to B5/8.5" x 11" No punch mode: 52 to 256 g/m2 (14 to 68 lb.) Punch mode:

Paper Weight:

52 to 163 g/m2 (14 to 43 lb.) Staple mode: 52 to 128 g/m2 (14 to 34 lb.) Label/Thick paper/OHP cannot be stapled

Tray Capacity:

500 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or less 250 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14" or more Single size:

Staple capacity:

50 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller 30 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger 3 positions

Staple position:

1-staple: 2 positions (Top Left, Top Right) 2-staples: 1 positions

SM Appendix

1-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Optional Equipment Staple replenishment:

Cartridge (5000 staples)

Power consumption:

50 W + 12 W (Punch Unit)

Dimensions (W x D x H):

440 x 595 x 205 mm (17.3" x 23.4" x8.1")

Weight:

Without punch unit:

13 kg (28.6 lb.)

With punch unit:

16.2 Kg (35.6 lb.)

1.6.5 SHIFT TRAY (D428)

Paper Capacity:

250 sheet (A4/ 81/2” x 111/2” or smaller: 80g/m2/ 20 lbs) Standard sizes A6 SEF to A3, HLT to DLT

Paper Size:

Non-standard sizes Width: 90 to 305 mm Length: 148 to 600 mm

Paper Weight:

52-256 g/m2/ 14 - 68 lbs

Power Consumption:

Max 13 W (Power is supplied from the mainframe.)

Dimension (W x D x H):

431 x 477.5 x 107mm (17.2” x 19.1” x 4.3”)

Weight:

Approx. 2kg (4.4lbs)

1.6.6 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426)

Paper Size:

Standard Size: A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF

Paper Weight:

60 to 105 g/m2, 16 to 28 lb.

Tray Capacity:

100 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb., A4)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)

D037/D038/D040/D041

1-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

Optional Equipment Power Consumption:

Less than 1 W

Weight:

Less than 2kg (4.4lbs)

Size (W x D x H):

455 x 530 x 226mm (18.2” x 21.2” x 9”)

1.6.7 SIDE TRAY (D427)

Paper Size:

Standard Size: A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF

Paper Weight:

60 to 105 g/m2, 16 to 28 lb.

Tray Capacity:

50 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb., A4)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)

Power Consumption:

Less than 40 W

Weight:

1.5 kg

Size (W x D x H):

480 x 480 x 170mm (19.2”x19.2”x6.8”)

SM Appendix

1-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Specifications

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: OVERVIEW

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Overview

2. APPENDIX: OVERVIEW

Appendix: Overview

2.1 OVERVIEW 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

1. 2nd carriage

16. Vertical transport roller 2

2. 1st carriage

17. Feed roller: T1

3. Original length sensor

18. Vertical transport roller 3

4. Lens

19. Tray 2

5. SBU

20. Tray 1

6. Inverter roller

21. Laser unit

SM Appendix

2-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Overview 7. Paper exit roller

22. Drum unit

8. Junction gate

23. Development unit

9. Duplex unit

24. ITB cleaning unit

10. Fusing unit

25. ITB roller

11. PTR (Paper transfer roller) unit

26. Toner bottle

12. Registration roller

27. ITB (Image Transfer Belt) unit

13. Vertical transport roller 1

28. Inner Tray

14. By-pass feed roller 15. Feed roller: T1

2.1.2 PAPER PATH With options

1. DF path

6. By-pass tray path

2. Exit path: Straight feed out

7. Vertical transport path: Tray 2

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Overview 3. Exit path: Side tray

8. Vertical transport path: Tray 3 (option)

4. Duplex path

9. Vertical transport path: Tray 4 (option)

5. Vertical transport path: Tray 1

10. Inverter path (option)

Appendix: Overview

11. Exit path: Staple/ Shift

Without options

1. DF path

5. By-pass tray path

2. Inverter path

6. Vertical transport path: Tray 2

3. Duplex path

7. Exit path

4. Vertical transport path: T1

SM Appendix

2-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Overview

2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT

1. Scanner motor

10. Paper feed motor: T1

2. Toner supply motors

11. By-pass motor

3. ITB contact motor

12. Registration motor

4. Used toner collection motor

13. Duplex exit motor

5. Drum motor: CMY

14. PTR contact motor

6. Development motor: CMY

15. ITB unit motor

7. Development clutch: K

16. Duplex entrance motor

8. Drum/Development motor: K

17. Fusing/Paper exit motor

9. Paper feed motor: T2

18. Inverter motor

D037/D038/D040/D041

2-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Maintenance Tables

3. APPENDIX: PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TABLES 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES 3.1.1 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE ITEMS Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables

Chart: A4 (LT)/5% Mode: 3 copies / original (prints/job) Ratio 30% Environment: Normal temperature and humidity Yield may change depending on circumstances and print conditions. Symbol keys: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricant, I: Inspect

Mainframe

Item

60K

150K

240K

EM

Remarks

Scanner Reflector

C

Optics cloth

1st/2nd/3rd Mirrors

C

Optics cloth

Front and Rear Rails

C

Dry cloth

Exposure Glass

C

C

Dry cloth; alcohol

ADF Exposure Glass

C

C

Dry cloth; alcohol

APS Sensor

C

Dry cloth

PCDU Drum Unit-K, C, M, Y

R

PCDU Toner Collection Bottle

R

ITB and PTR unit

SM Appendix

3-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Maintenance Tables Item ITB Cleaning Unit

60K

150K

240K

EM

Remarks

R

Fusing Fusing Roller

R

Fusing Belt

R

S552R

Alcohol

Pressure Roller

C*

Heating Roller Thermistor

C

C

Dry cloth

Pressure Roller Thermistor

C

C

Dry cloth

Entrance Guide Plate

C

C

Alcohol

Exit Guide Plate

C

C

Alcohol

Stripper Plate

C

C

Alcohol

C

Dry cloth

Thermopile

*: Clean it if dirty.

C

Others Dust Filter

R

Item

60K

120K

240K

EM

Remarks

Paper Feed Feed Roller: Tray 1/2

R

C

Damp cloth

Friction Pad: Tray 1/2

R

C

Dry cloth

Registration Roller

C*1

C

Damp cloth Never use alcohol.

Registration Sensor

C

Dry cloth

Vertical Transport Roller

C

Damp cloth

D037/D038/D040/D041

3-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Maintenance Tables Item

60K

120K

240K

EM

Remarks

Vertical Transport Sensor

C

Dry cloth

By-pass Feed Roller

C

Damp cloth

By-pass Friction Pad

C

Dry cloth

By-pass HP Sensor

C

Dry cloth

Duplex Transport Roller

C

Damp cloth

Duplex Exit Sensor

C

Dry cloth

Paper Exit Paper Exit Roller

Damp cloth

Inverter Roller

C

Damp cloth

Inverter Relay Roller

C

Damp cloth

Inverter Sensor

C

Dry cloth

Fusing Exit Sensor

C

Dry cloth

*1: The registration roller requires a cleaning maintenance every 60 K (total count).

ARDF (D366)

Item

120K

EM

Remarks

Sensors

C

Platen Sheet Cover

C

White Plate

C

Dry or damp cloth

Drive Gear

L

Grease G501

Transport Roller

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

SM Appendix

3-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Blower brush Damp cloth; alcohol (Replace if required.)

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables

Duplex

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Maintenance Tables Exit Roller

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

Inverter Roller

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

Idle Rollers

C

Damp cloth; alcohol

One-tray Paper Feed Unit (D425)

Item

60K

120K

EM

R

C

Dry cloth

Feed Roller

Remarks

Bottom Plate Pad

C

C

Dry cloth

Paper Feed Guide

C

C

Dry cloth

C

Dry cloth

Friction Pad

R

Paper Feed Clutch

I

Two-tray Paper Feed Unit (D331)

Item

60K

120K

EM

Remarks

Paper Feed Roller

R

C

Dry cloth

Friction Pad

R

C

Dry cloth

Paper Feed Guides

C

C

Dry cloth

Relay Rollers

C

C

Dry cloth

Bottom Plate Pad

C

C

Dry cloth

Relay Clutch

I

Replace if necessary

Paper Feed Clutch

I

Replace if necessary

1 Bin Tray (D426)

D037/D038/D040/D041

3-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Maintenance Tables Items

15K

EM

Exit Rollers

C

C

Idle Rollers

C

Remarks Damp or Dry cloth Damp or Dry cloth

C

Damp cloth

C

Blower brush

Paper Sensor

C

Blower brush

Bearing

C

S552R

Exit Sensor

C

Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables

Tray

Shift Tray (D427)

Items

EM

Tray

C

Remarks Damp cloth

3.1.2 OTHERS YIELD PARTS The parts mentioned in these tables have a target yield. However, the total copy/print volume made by the machine will not reach the target yield within the machine’s targeted lifetime if the machine is used under the target usage conditions (ACV, color ratio, P/J, and C/O). So, these parts are categorized not as PM parts but as yield parts (EM parts).

ARDF

Item

80K

120K

240K

Remarks

Pick-up Roller

R

Number of originals

Feed Belt

R

Number of originals

Separation Roller

R

Number of originals

SM Appendix

3-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

4. APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS 4.1 SC TABLES 4.1.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS Summary The ‘SC Table’ section shows the SC codes for controller errors and other errors. The latter (not controller errors) are put into four types. The type is determined by their reset procedures. The table shows the classification of the SC codes.

Controller errors

CTL

Definition

Reset Procedure

The error has occurred in the

See “Troubleshooting Procedure”

controller.

in the table.

The error involves the fusing A

unit. The machine operation is disabled. The user cannot reset the error.

Turn the main switch off and on. Reset the SC (set SP5-810-1). Turn the main switch off and on.

The error involves one or some B

specific units. The machine

Turn the operation switch off and

operates as usual, excluding

on.

the related units. The error is logged. The

Other errors C

SC-code history is updated.

The SC will not show. Only the

The machine operates as

SC history is updated.

usual. The machine operation is disabled. You can reset the machine by turning the D

operation switch or main switch off and on. If the error occurs

Turn the operation switch or main power switch off and on.

again, the same SC code is displayed.

SM Appendix

4-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

Key

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

After you turn the main power switch off, wait for one second or more before you turn the main power switch on ( SC 672). All SCs are logged. The print log data (SP5-990-004) in SP mode can check the latest 10 SC codes detected and total counters when the SC code is detected. ƒ

If the problem concerns electrical circuit boards, first disconnect then reconnect the connectors before you replace the PCBs.

ƒ

If the problem concerns a motor lock, first check the mechanical load before you replace motors or sensors.

SC Code Classification The table shows the classification of the SC codes:

Class 1

1XX

2XX

3XX

4XX

Section

SC Code

Scanning

Laser exposure

Image development 1

Image development 2

D037/D038/D040/D041

Detailed section

100 -

Scanner

190 -

Unique for a specific model

200 -

Polygon motor

220 -

Synchronization control

230 -

FGATE signal related

240 -

LD control

280 -

Unique for a specific model

300 -

Charge

330 -

Drum potential

350 -

Development

380 -

Unique for a specific model

400 -

Image transfer

420 -

Paper separation

430 -

Cleaning

4-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

5XX

5XX

6XX

7XX

8XX

SM Appendix

Section

SC Code

Paper feed / Fusing

Paper feed / Fusing

Communication

Peripherals

Controller

Detailed section

440 -

Around drum

460 -

Unit

480 -

Others

500 -

Paper feed

515 -

Duplex

520 -

Paper transport

530 -

Fan motor

540 -

Fusing

560 -

Others

570 -

Unique for a specific model

600 -

Electrical counters

620 -

Mechanical counters

630 -

Account control

640 -

CSS

650 -

Network

670 -

Internal data processing

680 -

Unique for a specific model

700 -

Original handling

720 -

Two-tray finisher

740 -

Booklet finisher

800 -

Error after ready condition

820 -

Diagnostics error

4-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

Class 1

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables Class 1

Section

9XX

SC Code

Others

Detailed section

860 -

Hard disk

880 -

Unique for a specific model

900 -

Counter

920 -

Memory

990 -

Others

4.1.2 SC1XX: SCANNING

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Exposure lamp error The peak white level is less than 64/255 digits (8 bits) when scanning the shading plate.

101

D

ƒ

Exposure lamp defective

ƒ

Lamp stabilizer defective

ƒ

Exposure lamp connector defective

ƒ

Standard white plate dirty

ƒ

Scanner mirror or scanner lens out of position or dirty

1.

Check and clean the scanner mirror(s) and scanner lens.

2.

Check and clean the shading plate.

3.

Replace the exposure lamp.

4.

Replace the lamp stabilizer.

5.

Replace the scanner mirror(s) or scanner lens.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Scanner home position error 1 The scanner home position sensor does not detect the “OFF” condition during operation.

No.

D

Scanner motor driver defective

ƒ

Scanner motor defective

ƒ

Harness between BCU and scanner motor disconnected

ƒ

Scanner HP sensor defective

ƒ

Harness between BCU and HP sensor disconnected

1.

Check the cable connection between the BCU and scanner motor.

2.

Check the cable connection between the BCU and HP sensor.

3.

Replace the scanner motor.

4.

Replace the scanner HP sensor.

Type

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

120

ƒ

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Scanner home position error 2 The scanner home position sensor does not detect the “ON” condition during operation.

121

D

ƒ

Scanner motor driver defective

ƒ

Scanner motor defective

ƒ

Harness between BCU and scanner motor disconnected

ƒ

Scanner HP sensor defective

ƒ

Harness between BCU and HP sensor disconnected

1.

Check the cable connection between the BCU board and scanner motor.

SM Appendix

2.

Check the cable connection between the BCU and HP sensor.

3.

Replace the scanner motor.

4.

Replace the HP sensor.

4-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Black level detection error The black level cannot be adjusted within the target value during the zero clamp.

141

No.

D

ƒ

Harness disconnected

ƒ

Defective SBU

1.

Check the cable connection

2.

Replace the SBU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) White level detection error The white level cannot be adjusted within the target during auto gain control.

142

No. 144

D

Type D

ƒ

Dirty exposure glass or optics section

ƒ

SBU board defective

ƒ

Exposure lamp defective

ƒ

Lamp stabilizer defective

ƒ

Scanner motor defective

1.

Clean the exposure glass, white plate, mirrors, and lens.

2.

Check if the exposure lamp is lit during initialization.

3.

Check the harness connection between SBU and BCU.

4.

Replace the exposure lamp.

5.

Replace the scanner motor.

6.

Replace the SBU board.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SBU communication error The SBU connection cannot be detected at power on or recovery from the energy save mode.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No. 161

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Defective SBU

ƒ

Defective harness

ƒ

Defective detection port on the BCU

1.

Replace the harness.

2.

Replace the SBU.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) IPU error

detected. 001

D

ƒ

Defective i-controller

ƒ

Defective connection between i-controller and SBU

1.

Check the connection between i-controller and SBU.

2.

Replace the i-controller.

Detected an error during an access to the i-controller. 002

D

ƒ

Defective i-controller board

Replace the i-controller board.

No. 165

Type D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Copy Data Security Unit error ƒ

The copy data security board is not detected when the copy data security function is set "ON" with the initial setting.

ƒ

A device check error occurs when the copy data security function is set "ON" with the initial setting.

SM Appendix

ƒ

Incorrect installation of the copy data security board

ƒ

Defective copy data security board

4-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

The error result of self-diagnostic by the ASIC on the i-controller is

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.

Reinstall the copy data security board.

2.

Replace the copy data security board.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Serial Number Mismatch Serial number stored in the memory does not have the correct

ƒ

code. 195

D

ƒ

NVRAM defective

ƒ

BCU replaced without original NVRAM

1.

Check the serial number with SP5-811-002.

2.

If the stored serial number is incorrect, contact your supervisor.

4.1.3 SC 2XX: EXPOSURE

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Polygon motor error 1: ON timeout The polygon mirror motor does not reach the targeted operating speed within the specified time after turning on or changing speed

202

D

ƒ

Defective or disconnected harness to polygon motor driver board

ƒ

Defective polygon motor driver board

ƒ

Defective polygon motor.

1.

Replace the polygon motor.

2.

Replace the laser unit.

3.

Replace the harness.

4.

Replace the BCU.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Polygon motor error 2: OFF timeout The polygon mirror motor does leave the READY status within 3 seconds after the polygon motor switches off.

D

No.

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness to polygon motor driver board

ƒ

Defective polygon motor driver board

ƒ

Defective polygon motor

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the polygon motor.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Polygon motor error 3: XSCRDY signal error The SCRDY_N signal goes HIGH (inactive) while the laser diode is firing.

204

D

No.

Type

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness to polygon motor driver board

ƒ

Defective polygon motor

ƒ

Defective polygon motor driver board

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the polygon motor.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

220

D

Laser synchronizing detection error: start position [K]: LD0

222

D

Laser synchronizing detection error: start position [Y]: LD0 The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the

-

-

LDB [K], [Y], is not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is rotating normally.

SM Appendix

4-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

203

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Disconnected cable from the laser synchronizing detection unit or

ƒ

defective connection

No.

ƒ

Defective laser synchronizing detector

ƒ

Defective LDB

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check the connectors.

2.

Replace the laser unit.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: K The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image in normal job or MUSIC for start position [K].

230

No.

D

ƒ

Defective ASIC (Lupus)

ƒ

Poor connection between i-controller and BCU.

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check the connection between the controller board and the BCU.

2.

Replace the BCU.

3.

Replace the controller board.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE OFF error: K ƒ

231

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position

D

adjustment) for end position [K]. ƒ

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.

See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: Y The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after

232

D

processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [Y]. See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

ƒ 233

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position

D

adjustment) for end position [Y]. ƒ

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.

See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: M The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after

234

D

processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [M]. See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

SM Appendix

4-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

FGATE OFF error: Y

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE OFF error: M The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after

ƒ 235

processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position

D

adjustment) for end position [M]. The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.

ƒ

See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: C The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after

236

D

processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [C]. See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE OFF error: C The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after

ƒ 237

processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position

D

adjustment) for end position [C]. The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.

ƒ

See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

240

C

LD error: K

241

C

LD error: Y

-

-

The BCU detects LDB error a few times consecutively when LDB unit

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) turns on after LDB initialization.

No.

ƒ

Worn-out LD

ƒ

Disconnected or broken harness of the LD

1.

Replace the harness of the LD.

2.

Replace the laser unit.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

Line position adjustment fails four consecutive times.

285

D

ƒ

Pattern sampling error ( insufficient image density )

ƒ

Defective ID sensors for the line position adjustment

ƒ

Defective image transfer belt unit

ƒ

Defective PCDU(s)

ƒ

Defective laser unit

1.

Check and reinstall the image transfer belt unit and PCDU(s).

2.

Check if each toner bottle has enough toner.

3.

Replace the ID sensor.

4.

Replace the image transfer belt unit.

5.

Replace the PCDU(s).

6.

Replace the laser unit.

4.1.4 SC3XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 1 No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

300

D

AC charge output error [K]

301

D

AC charge output error [M]

302

D

AC charge output error [C]

SM Appendix

4-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

Line position adjustment (MUSIC) error

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

303

D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) AC charge output error [Y] The measured voltage is not proper when BCU measures the charge output for each color.

-

-

No.

ƒ

Disconnected or broken high voltage cable

ƒ

Defective or not installed PCDU

ƒ

Defective HVPS-CB board

1.

Check or replace the connectors.

2.

Replace the PCDU for the affected color.

3.

Replace the HVPS-CB board.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Color development motor error The motor LOCK signal is not detected for more than two seconds while the motor START signal is on.

325

D

ƒ

Color development motor slip due to an increase in the torque

1.

Adjust the torque properly by replacing or cleaning the development unit.

2.

No.

Type

Replace the development motor: CMY if the load torque is normal.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

360

D

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: K

361

D

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: M

362

D

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: C

363

D

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: Y

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds the specified value (default: 4.7V) with SP3020-002 for twenty counts.

ƒ

The [Vt - Vtref] value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds the specified value (default: 5.0V) with SP3020-001.

-

-

ƒ

Black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor disconnected

ƒ

Harness between TD sensor and development unit defective

ƒ

Defective TD sensor.

1.

Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector Appendix: Service Call Conditions

and harness between the TD sensor and development unit for damage.

No.

2.

Check the drawer connector of the PCDU.

3.

Replace the development unit.

4.

Replace the PCDU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

364

D

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: K

365

D

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: M

366

D

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: C

367

D

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: Y The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor is below the specified value with SP3020-004 (default: 0.5V) for 10 counts.

-

-

ƒ

TD sensor harness disconnected, loose, defective

ƒ

A drawer connector disconnected, loose, defective

ƒ

TD sensor defective

1.

Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector and harness between the TD sensor and development unit for damage.

SM Appendix

4-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

No.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 2.

Check the drawer connector of the PCDU.

3.

Replace the development unit.

4.

Replace the PCDU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

372

D

TD sensor adjustment error: K

373

D

TD sensor adjustment error: M

374

D

TD sensor adjustment error: C

375

D

TD sensor adjustment error: Y During TD sensor initialization, the output value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor is not within the range of the specified value with SP3238-001 to -004 (default: 2.5V) ± 0.2V

-

-

No.

ƒ

Heat seal not removed from a new developer pack

ƒ

TD harness sensor disconnected, loose or defective

ƒ

TD sensor defective

ƒ

Harness between TD sensor and drawer disconnected, defective

1.

Remove the heat seal from each PCDU.

2.

Replace the PCDU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

380

C

Drum gear position sensor error: K

381

C

Drum gear position sensor error: M, C, Y The machine does not detect the drum position signal for 2.4 seconds at the drum phase adjustment.

-

-

ƒ

Dirty or defective drum gear position sensor

1.

Replace the drum gear position sensor.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 2.

No.

Type

396

D

Replace the PCDU.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Drum/Development motor error: K The machine detects a High signal from the drum/development motor:

-

-

No.

ƒ

Overload on the drum/development motor: K

ƒ

Defective drum/development motor: K

ƒ

Defective harness

ƒ

Shorted 24 V fuse on the PSU

ƒ

Defective interlock system

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the drum/development motor: K.

3.

Replace the 24V fuse on the PSU.

Type

397

D

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

K for 2 seconds after the drum/development motor: K turned on.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Drum motor error: CMY The machine detects a High signal from the drum motor: CMY for 2 seconds after the drum motor: CMY turned on.

-

-

SM Appendix

ƒ

Overload on the drum motor: CMY

ƒ

Defective drum motor: CMY

ƒ

Defective harness

ƒ

Shorted 24 V fuse on the PSU

ƒ

Defective interlock system

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the drum motor: CMY.

3.

Replace the 24V fuse on the PSU.

4-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

4.1.5 SC4XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 2 No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ID sensor adjustment error When the Vsg error counter reaches "3", the machine detects "SC400". The Vsg error counter counts "1" when the Vsg detected by ID sensor is more than the value (default: 4.5V) specified with SP3324-005 or less than the value (default: 3.5V) specified with SP3324-006.

400

D

ƒ

Dirty or defective ID sensor

1.

Check the harness of the ID sensor.

2.

Clean or replace the ID sensor. ƒ

After replacing the ID sensor, input the ID sensor correction coefficient with SP3362-013 and -016. For details, refer to "ID sensor board" in the Replacement and Adjustment section.

No.

1.

Replace the BCU.

2.

Replace the ITB unit.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ITB unit motor error The motor LOCK signal is not detected for more than two seconds while the motor START signal is on.

441

No. 442

D

Type D

ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Defective ITB unit motor

1.

Replace the ITB unit.

2.

Replace the BCU.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ITB contact motor error The ITB contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) the sensor while the polygon motor rotates.

No.

ƒ

Dirty ITB contact sensor

ƒ

Defective ITB contact motor

ƒ

Disconnected connector of ITB contact sensor or motor

ƒ

Disconnected cable

1.

Replace the ITB contact sensor.

2.

Replace the ITB contact motor.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

ITB unit error The machine detects the encoder sensor error.

443

No. 452

C

ƒ

Disconnect or defective harness

ƒ

Defective encoder sensor

ƒ

ITB unit installation error

ƒ

Defective ITB unit motor

1.

Connect or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the encoder sensor.

3.

Check if the ITB unit is correctly set.

4.

Replace the ITB unit motor.

5.

Replace the ITB unit.

Type D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Paper transfer unit contact error The paper transfer unit contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at the sensor while the polygon motor rotates.

SM Appendix

ƒ

Defective paper transfer unit contact sensor

ƒ

Defective paper transfer unit contact motor

4-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Broken +24V fuse on PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check the connection between the paper transfer unit and PSU.

2.

Replace the paper transfer unit contact sensor.

3.

Replace the paper transfer unit contact motor.

4.

Replace the +24V fuse on the PSU.

5.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) High voltage power: Drum/ development bias output error An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the drum or development.

491

No. 492

D

ƒ

High voltage leak

ƒ

Broken harness

ƒ

Defective drum unit or development unit

ƒ

Defective HVPS-CB board

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the drum unit or paper transfer unit.

3.

Replace the HVPS-CB board.

Type C

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) High voltage power: Image transfer/ paper transfer bias output error An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the separation, image transfer bet or paper transfer roller. ƒ

High voltage leak

ƒ

Broken harness

ƒ

Defective image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit

ƒ

Defective HVPS-TTS board

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

No.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit.

3.

Replace the HVPS-TTS board.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Toner collection motor error The machine detects that the PCDU toner collection bottle is not set

495

D

ƒ

PCDU toner collection bottle motor damaged

ƒ

Disconnect or defective harness

ƒ

Defective DRB board

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Replace the waste toner collection bottle motor.

2.

Check or replace the harness.

3.

Replace the DRB board

4.

Replace the BCU

4.1.6 SC5XX: PAPER FEED AND FUSING No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

503

B

3rd paper tray lift motor malfunction (optional Paper Tray Unit)

504

B

4th paper tray lift motor malfunction (optional Paper Tray Unit)

-

-

The paper lift sensor did not activate within 18 sec. after the tray lift motor switched on. ƒ

An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the motor drive and caused an overload.

SM Appendix

ƒ

Paper lift sensor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged

ƒ

Paper lift sensor defective

ƒ

Tray lift motor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged

ƒ

Tray lift motor defective

4-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

when the toner collection motor is turned off.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the tray lift motor.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Paper tray feed motor lock (optional Paper Tray Unit) A motor lock signal is not detected for more than 1.5 s or the lock signal is not detected for more than 1.0 s during rotation. An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the

ƒ 506

B

feed motor drive and caused an overload. Paper tray feed motor connection loose, disconnected, or

ƒ

damaged

No.

ƒ

Paper tray feed motor defective

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the feed motor.

3.

Replace the BCU

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) By-pass bottom plate error The signal from the by-pass tray HP sensor does not change for 1.0 second after the by-pass motor has rotated counterclockwise. If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the SC is generated.

508

B

ƒ

Disconnect or defective harness of the by-pass motor

ƒ

Defective by-pass motor

ƒ

Disconnect or defective harness of the by-pass tray HP sensor

ƒ

Defective by-pass tray HP sensor

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the by-pass motor.

3.

Replace the by-pass tray HP sensor.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 4.

No.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

530

D

Ventilation fan: front error

531

D

Ventilation fan: rear error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.

No.

Type

Defective ventilation fan: front or rear

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness

ƒ

Defective DRB

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the ventilation fan: front (SC530) or rear (SC531).

3.

Replace the DRB.

4.

Replace the BCU.

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

ƒ

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Laser unit fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.

532

D

SM Appendix

ƒ

Defective laser unit fan

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness

ƒ

Defective drive board

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the laser unit fan.

3.

Replace the DRB.

4.

Replace the BCU.

4-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fusing front fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.

533

No.

D

ƒ

Defective fusing front fan

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness

ƒ

Defective DRB

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the fusing front fan.

3.

Replace the DRB.

4.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fusing rear fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.

534

No. 535

D

Type D

ƒ

Defective fusing rear fan

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness

ƒ

Defective DRB

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the fusing rear fan.

3.

Replace the DRB.

4.

Replace the BCU.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Controller box fan error

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor

No.

ƒ

Defective controller box fan

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness

ƒ

Defective DRB

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the controller box fan.

3.

Replace the DRB.

4.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Junction gate solenoid fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.

536

No. 540

D

Type D

ƒ

Defective junction gate solenoid fan

ƒ

Disconnected or defective harness

ƒ

Defective DRB

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the Junction gate solenoid fan.

3.

Replace the DRB.

4.

Replace the BCU.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fusing/Paper exit motor error The BCU receives the lock signal 2.0 seconds after turning on the fusing/paper exit motor.

SM Appendix

4-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

lock signal was first detected.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Defective fusing/paper exit motor

Replace the fusing/paper exit motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller error 1 The temperature detected by the thermopile does not reach 0°C for 6 seconds.

541

No. 542

A

ƒ

Loose connection of the thermopile

ƒ

Defective thermopile

1.

Check that the thermopile is firmly connected.

2.

Replace the thermopile.

Type A

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller warm-up error 1 ƒ

After the main switch is turned on or the cover is closed, the increment of the heating roller temperature per 10 seconds is 40°C or less. If this condition is detected five times consecutively, SC 542 is defined.

ƒ

The heating roller temperature does not reach 100°C for 9 seconds after the heating lamp on.

ƒ

The heating roller temperature does not reach the ready temperature while 75 seconds after the heating lamp on.

ƒ

The center temperature of the heating roller does not reach the ready temperature for 30 seconds after the edge temperature of the heating roller has reached the ready temperature.

ƒ

Dirty or defective thermopile

ƒ

Defective heating roller lamp

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.

Check if the thermopile is firmly connected.

2.

Replace the thermopile.

3.

Replace the heating roller lamp.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 1 (software error) The detected fusing temperature stays at 230°C for 1 second.

543

A

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

No.

1.

Replace the PSU.

2.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

Related SC code: SC 553

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 1 (hardware error) During stand-by mode or a print job, the detected heating roller temperature reaches 250 °C.

544

A

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective fusing control system

Related SC code: SC 543

SM Appendix

1.

Replace the PSU.

2.

Replace the BCU.

4-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp consecutive full power 1 When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the heating roller fusing lamp keeps on full power for 37 seconds.

545

A

Broken heating roller thermistor

ƒ

Related SC code: SC 555 Replace the heating roller thermistor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Zero cross error The zero cross signal is detected three times even though the

ƒ

heater relay is off when turning on the main power. The zero cross signal is not detected for 2 seconds even though

ƒ

the heater relay is on after turning on the main power or closing the front door. 547

D

The detection error occurs twice or more in the 11 zero cross signal

ƒ

detections. This error is defined when the detected zero cross signal is less than 45.

No. 551

Type A

ƒ

Defective fusing lamp relay

ƒ

Defective fusing lamp relay circuit

ƒ

Unstable power supply

1.

Check the power supply source.

2.

Replace the PSU

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller thermistor (end) error 2

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

The temperature measured by the heating roller thermistor (end) does not reach 0°C for 150 seconds and the temperature/humidity sensor of the machine detects 5°C or more.

ƒ

The heating roller thermistor detects -5°C for 9 seconds.

ƒ

Loose connection of heating roller thermistor

ƒ

Defective heating roller thermistor

No.

1.

Check that the heating roller thermistor is firmly connected.

2.

Replace the heating roller thermistor.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller warm-up error 2 ƒ

After the main switch is turned on or the cover is closed, the increment of the heating roller temperature per 10 seconds is 40°C or less. If this condition is detected five times consecutively, SC 552 is defined.

ƒ

The heating roller temperature does not reach 100°C for 9 seconds after the heating lamp on.

ƒ 552

A

The heating roller temperature does not reach the ready temperature while 75 seconds after the heating lamp on.

ƒ

The end temperature of the heating roller does not reach the ready temperature for 30 seconds after the edge temperature of the heating roller has reached the ready temperature.

ƒ

Dirty or defective thermistor (end)

ƒ

Heating roller fusing lamp broken

Related SC code: SC 542

SM Appendix

1.

Check if the heating roller thermistor is firmly connected.

2.

Replace the heating roller fusing lamp.

4-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

Related SC code: SC 541

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 2 (software error) The detected pressure roller temperature stays at 230°C or more for 1 second.

553

A

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

Related SC code: SC 543

No.

1.

Replace the heating roller thermistor.

2.

Replace the PSU.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 2 (hardware error) The heating roller thermistor detects 250°C or more.

554

No. 555

A

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective fusing control system

1.

Replace the heating roller thermistor.

2.

Replace the PSU.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type A

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller lamp consecutive full power 2 When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the pressure roller-fusing lamp keeps ON full power for 130 seconds or more. ƒ

Broken heating roller fusing lamp

Related SC code: SC 545

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.

Replace the heating roller fusing lamp.

2.

Replace the PSU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Zero cross frequency error When the zero cross signal is 66 or more and it is detected 10 times or

C

more in 11 detections, the machine determines that input 60 Hz and SC557 occurs. ƒ

Noise (High frequency)

Check the power supply source.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Consecutive fusing jam The paper jam counter for the fusing unit reaches 3 times. The paper jam counter is cleared if the paper is fed correctly.

559

A

This SC is activated only when SP1159-001 is set to "1" (default "0"). ƒ

Paper jam in the fusing unit.

Remove the paper that is jammed in the fusing unit. Then make sure that the fusing unit is clean and has no obstacles in the paper feed path.

No. 561

Type A

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller thermister error 3 The temperature measured by the pressure roller thermistor (center) does not reach 0 °C for 45 seconds.

SM Appendix

ƒ

Loose connection of pressure roller thermistor

ƒ

Defective pressure roller thermistor

4-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

557

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Related SC code: SC 541

No.

1.

Check that the pressure roller thermistor is firmly connected.

2.

Replace the pressure roller thermistor.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 3 (software error) The detected fusing roller temperature stays at 230°C or more for 1 second.

563

No.

A

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Replace the pressure roller thermistor (center).

2.

Replace the PSU.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 3 (hardware error) The pressure roller thermistor (center) detects 250°C or more.

564

No. 565

A

Type A

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective fusing control system

1.

Replace the pressure roller thermistor (center).

2.

Replace the PSU.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller fusing lamp consecutive full power 3

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the pressure roller fusing lamp keeps ON full power for 250 seconds or more.

No.

ƒ

Broken Pressure roller fusing lamp

1.

Replace the pressure roller fusing lamp.

2.

Replace the PSU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller thermister error 4

not reach 0 °C for 20 seconds. 571

A

ƒ

Loose connection of pressure roller thermistor (end)

ƒ

Defective pressure roller thermistor (end)

Related SC code: SC 541

No.

1.

Check that the pressure roller thermistor (end) is firmly connected.

2.

Replace the pressure roller thermistor (end).

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 4 (software error) The detected pressure roller temperature stays at 230°C or more for 1 second.

573

A

SM Appendix

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Replace the pressure roller thermistor (end).

2.

Replace the PSU.

3.

Replace the BCU.

4-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

The temperature measured by the pressure roller thermistor (end) does

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 4 (hardware error) The pressure roller thermistor (end) detects 250°C or more.

574

A

ƒ

Defective pressure roller thermistor (end)

ƒ

Defective PSU

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective fusing control system

1.

Replace the pressure roller thermistor (end).

2.

Replace the PSU.

3.

Replace the BCU.

4.1.7 SC6XX: DEVICE COMMUNICATION

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

610

D

Mechanical counter error: K

611

D

Mechanical counter error: FC This SC is only for NA models. The machine detects the mechanical counter error when SP5987-001 is set to "1".

-

-

No. 620

Type D

ƒ

Disconnected mechanical counter

ƒ

Defective mechanical counter

1.

Check or replace the mechanical counter.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ARDF communication error After the ARDF is detected, the break signal occurs or communication timeout occurs.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables Type

No.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Incorrect installation of ARDF

ƒ

ARDF defective

ƒ

BCU board defective

ƒ

External noise

1.

Check the cable connection of the ARDF.

2.

Shut out the external noise.

3.

Replace the ARDF.

4.

Replace the BCU board.

Type

621

D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher communication error While the BCU communicates with an optional unit, an SC code is displayed if one of following conditions occurs. ƒ

The BCU receives the break signal which is generated by the peripherals only just after the main switch is turned on.

ƒ

When the BCU does not receive an OK signal from a peripheral 100ms after sending a command to it. The BCU resends the command. The BCU does not receive an OK signal after sending the command 3 times.

-

-

No. 632

Type CTL

SM Appendix

ƒ

Cable problems

ƒ

BCU problems

ƒ

PSU problems in the machine

ƒ

Main board problems in the peripherals

1.

Check if the cables of peripherals are correctly connected.

2.

Replace the PSU if no power is supplied to peripherals.

3.

Replace the main board of peripherals.

4.

Replace the BCU.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 1

4-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

No.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

B

After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100 ms. Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board

ƒ

and copier control board is disconnected or damaged Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter

ƒ

device.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 2 After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100

633

CTL

ms.

B Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board

ƒ

and copier control board is disconnected or damaged Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter

ƒ

device.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 3

634

No. 635

CTL

A backup RAM error was returned by the counter device.

B

Type CTL B

ƒ

Counter device control board defective

ƒ

Backup battery of counter device defective

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 4 A backup battery error was returned by the counter device.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No. 636

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Counter device control board defective

ƒ

Backup battery of counter device defective

Type CTL

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD Card Error Expanded authentication module error There is no expanded authentication module in the machine. The SD card or the file of the expanded authentication module is broken.

01

D

ƒ

No expanded authentication module

ƒ

Defective SD card

ƒ

No DESS module

1.

Install the expanded authentication module.

2.

Install the SD card.

3.

Install the DESS module.

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

There is no DESS module in the machine.

Version error

02

No. 641

D

The version of the expanded authentication module is not correct. ƒ

Incorrect module version

1.

Install the correct file of the expanded authentication module.

Type CTL D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) BCU control data transfer abnormal A sampling of the control data sent from the BCU reveals an abnormality. ƒ

SM Appendix

Controller board defective

4-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

No.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

External noise

ƒ

BCU board defective

1.

Check the connection between the controller board and BCU.

2.

Replace the controller board.

3.

Replace the BCU.

Type CTL

650

B

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Communication error of the remote service modem (RCG-M) Authentication error The authentication for the RCG-M fails at a dial up connection.

-001

-

ƒ

Incorrect SP settings

ƒ

Disconnected telephone line

ƒ

Disconnected modem board

Check and set the correct user name (SP5816-156) and password (SP5816-157). Incorrect modem setting

-004

-

Dial up fails due to the incorrect modem setting. Same as -001 Check and set the correct AT command (SP5819-160). Communication line error The supplied voltage is not sufficient due to the defective

-005

-

communication line or defective connection. Same as -001 Consult with the user's local telephone company.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Incorrect dial up connection -001: Program parameter error -002: Program execution error

651

CTL C

An unexpected error occurs when the modem (RCG-M) tries to call the center with a dial up connection. ƒ

Caused by a software bug

No action required because this SC does not interfere with operation of

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) NVRAM error Retry of NVRAM communication fails three times after the machine has

669

D

detected the NVRAM error. ƒ

Caused by noise

Turn the main power switch off and on.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Engine start up error

670

CTL D

The ready signal from the engine board is not detected. ƒ

Defective engine board.

Replace the engine board.

671

CTL D

SM Appendix

Engine board mismatch error Engine board and controller mismatch detected.

4-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

the machine.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

No.

ƒ

Wrong engine board installed.

ƒ

Wrong controller board installed.

ƒ

Check the type of engine board and controller board.

1.

Replace the BCU.

2.

Replace the controller board.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Controller-to-operation panel communication error at startup After powering on the machine, the communication circuit between the controller and the operation panel is not opened, or communication with controller is interrupted after a normal startup.

672

No.

CTL D

ƒ

Controller stall

ƒ

Controller board installed incorrectly

ƒ

Controller board defective

ƒ

Operation panel connector loose or defective

1.

Check the harness connection.

2.

Replace the controller board.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) RFID: Communication error ƒ

Communication error occurs when the RFID starts to communicate with the RFID receptor.

ƒ

Retry of RFID communication fails three times after the machine has detected the RFID communication error.

681

D

ƒ

Defective RFID reader and writer

ƒ

Disconnected ASAP I/F

ƒ

No memory chip on the toner cartridge

ƒ

Noise

1.

Replace the RFID controller board.

2.

Replace the toner cartridge.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Memory chip at TD sensor: Communication error Retry of memory chip communication fails three times after the

682

No.

D

ƒ

Damaged memory chip data

ƒ

Disconnected inter face

ƒ

No memory chip on the development unit

ƒ

Noise

1.

Replace the development unit.

2.

Replace the PCDU.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) RFID: Unit check error The machine gets RFID communication error even the toner cartridges

683

C

have not been installed in the machine. ƒ

Caused by noise

Turn the main power switch off and on.

No. 687

Type D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Memory address command error The BCU does not receive a memory address command from the controller for the prescribed time after the paper has reached the registration sensor.

SM Appendix

ƒ

Harness Disconnection at BCU

ƒ

Controller board loose or broken

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective i-controller

4-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

machine has detected the memory chip communication error.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.

Check if the controller is firmly connected to the BCU.

2.

Replace the BCU.

3.

Replace the i-controller.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) GAVD communication error ƒ

The I2C bus device ID is not identified during initialization.

ƒ

A device-status error occurs during I2C bus communication.

ƒ

The I2C bus communication is not established due to an error other than a buffer shortage.

690

D

ƒ

Loose connection

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective LD controller board

1.

Turn the main switch off and on.

2.

Check the cable connection.

3.

Replace the laser unit.

4.

Replace the BCU board.

4.1.8 SC7XX: PERIPHERALS

No. 730

Type B

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Shift tray motor error The shift tray HP sensor does not activate within 1.86 seconds after the shift tray motor starts to move at power on or copying. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code. ƒ

Defective shift tray motor

ƒ

Defective shift tray HP sensor.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Replace the shift tray motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher stapler motor error (D038/D041) The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues

740

B

ƒ

Staple jam

ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Defective stapler motor

ƒ

Defective stapler safety sensor

1.

Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.

No.

2.

Replace the stapler unit

3.

Replace the finisher main board.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher stapler movement motor error (D038/D041)

742

B

SM Appendix

ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Loose connection of the stapler unit HP sensor

ƒ

Loose connection of the stapler unit movement motor

ƒ

Defective stapler unit HP sensor

ƒ

Defective stapler movement motor

1.

Check the connection of the stapler movement motor.

2.

Check the connection of the stapler unit HP sensor.

3.

Replace the stapler unit HP sensor.

4.

Replace the stapler unit movement motor.

4-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

this SC code.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Tray lift motor error (D038/D041)

750

No.

B

ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Loose connection of the tray lift motor

ƒ

Defective tray lift motor

1.

Check the connections to the tray lift motor.

2.

Replace the tray lift motor.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher punch motor error (D038/D041) The punch HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the punch motor turned on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.

760

D

ƒ

Punch HP sensor disconnected, defective

ƒ

Punch motor disconnected or defective

ƒ

Punch motor overload due to obstruction

1.

Check the connections and cables for the punch motor and HP sensor.

No. 763

2.

Check for blockages in the punch motor mechanism.

3.

Replace the punch slider unit.

4.

Replace the punch unit.

5.

Replace the finisher main board.

Type B

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Punch registration motor error (D038/D041) The punch unit moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code. ƒ

D037/D038/D040/D041

Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective

4-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Defective registration motor

1.

Check the connections to the punch registration motor.

2.

Replace the punch unit slider.

3.

Replace the punch unit.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Paper edge detection sensor error (D038/D041) The machine does not detect correct voltage from the paper edge

787

D

No.

ƒ

Defective connector

ƒ

Defective paper edge detection sensor.

ƒ

Defective DA or AD converter.

1.

Replace the punch slider unit.

2.

Replace the punch unit.

Type

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

detection sensor.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

788

D

Paper size sensor error without side tray (D038/D041)

789

B

Paper size sensor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect correct voltage from the paper size sensors.

SM Appendix

ƒ

Defective connector

ƒ

Defective paper size sensors

ƒ

Defective DA or AD converter.

1.

Replace the punch slider unit.

2.

Replace the punch unit.

4-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

790

D

Front jogger motor error without side tray (D038/D041)

793

B

Front jogger motor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect a correct signal from the front jogger fence HP sensor at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.

No.

Type

ƒ

Defective front jogger motor

ƒ

Loosen connection

ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Defective front jogger fence HP sensor

1.

Replace the front jogger fence HP sensor.

2.

Replace the front jogger motor.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

791

D

Rear jogger motor error without side tray (D038/D041)

794

B

Rear jogger motor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect a correct signal from the rear jogger fence HP sensor at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.

No. 792

Type D

D037/D038/D040/D041

ƒ

Defective rear jogger motor

ƒ

Loosen connection

ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Defective rear jogger fence HP sensor

1.

Replace the rear jogger fence HP sensor.

2.

Replace the rear jogger motor.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pick-up roller contact motor error without side tray (D038/D041)

4-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

795

B

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pick-up roller contact motor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect a correct signal from the pick-up roller HP sensor at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error,

No.

Type

ƒ

Defective pick-up roller contact motor

ƒ

Loosen connection

ƒ

Motor overload

ƒ

Defective pick-up roller HP sensor

1.

Replace the pick-up contact motor.

2.

Replace the pick-up roller HP sensor.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Belt roller solenoid error

796

No.

B

ƒ

Disconnected harness

ƒ

Defective belt roller position sensor

ƒ

Defective belt roller solenoid

1.

Check the harness connection.

2.

Replace the belt roller position sensor.

3.

Replace the belt roller solenoid.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) NVRAM data error

797

D

SM Appendix

ƒ

Defective NVRAM on the main board of the internal finisher

1.

Check the harness connection.

2.

Replace the main board.

4-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Front Fan error The machine detects the fan lock signal (ON) consecutively 200 ms.

798

No.

D

ƒ

Front fan damaged

ƒ

Disconnect or defective the harness

ƒ

Front fan overload

1.

Check or replace the harness.

2.

Replace the front fan.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Output tray motor error

799

D

ƒ

Output tray motor damaged

ƒ

Output tray motor overload

ƒ

Loose connection of the Output tray motor

ƒ

Defective output tray motor

Replace the output tray unit.

4.1.9 SC8XX: OVERALL SYSTEM

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Energy saving I/O sub-system error

816

CTL D

The energy saving I/O sub-system detects an error. Controller board defective

ƒ

Replace the controller board.

No. 817

Type CTL

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Monitor Error

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

D

This is a file detection and electronic file signature check error when the boot loader attempts to read the self-diagnostic module, system kernel, or root system files from the OS Flash ROM, or the items on the SD card in the controller slot are false or corrupted.

No.

ƒ

OS Flash ROM data defective; change the controller firmware

ƒ

SD card data defective; use another SD card

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fatal kernel error

CTL C

Due to a control error, a RAM overflow occurred during system processing. One of the following messages was displayed on the operation panel.

[0x5032]

HAIC-P2 error

[0x696e]

init died

[0x766d]

vm_pageout: VM is full

[554C]

USB error

No. 820

Type

ƒ

System program defective

ƒ

Controller board defective

ƒ

Optional board defective

1.

Replace controller firmware

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

CTL

Self-diagnostics error: CPU

D

[XXXX]: Detailed error code CPU error

[0001] to

During the self-diagnostic, the controller CPU detects an error. There

[06FF]

are 47 types of error code (0001 to 4005) depending on the cause of

[0801] to [4005] the error. The CPU detects an error and displays the specific error code with the program address where the error occurs.

SM Appendix

ƒ

System firmware problem

ƒ

Defective controller

4-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

819

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.

Turn the main switch off and on.

2.

Reinstall the controller system firmware.

3.

Replace the controller.

When the problem cannot be fixed with the above procedure, the following information displayed on the screen needs to be fed back to a technical support center. ƒ

SC code

ƒ

Detailed error code

ƒ

Program address

CPU/Memory Error ƒ

System firmware problem

[0702]

ƒ

Defective RAM-DIMM

[0709]

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Reinstall the controller system software.

2.

Replace the RAM-DIMM.

3.

Replace the controller.

[070A]

No. 821

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

CTL

Self-diagnostics error: ASIC

D

[XXXX]: Detailed error code ASIC error

[0B00]

The write-&-verify check error has occurred in the ASIC. ƒ

Defective ASIC device

Replace the controller. [0B06]

ASIC detection error The I/O ASIC for system control is not detected. ƒ

Defective ASIC

ƒ

Defective North Bridge and PCI I/F

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Replace the controller board. Self-diagnosis error: ASIC The CPU checks if the ASIC timer works correctly compared with the CPU timer. If the ASIC timer does not function in the specified range,

[0D05]

ƒ

System firmware problem

ƒ

Defective RAM-DIMM

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Reinstall the controller system firmware.

2.

Replace the RAM-DIMM.

3.

Replace the controller board.

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

this SC code is displayed.

Video bridge device error 1: ASIC The CPU does not detects the video bridge device.

[50A1]

ƒ

Defective I/F between the video bridge device and i-controller

Replace the i-controller. Video bridge device error 1: ASIC The CPU detects the video bridge device, but detects error data from the video bridge device..

[50A2]

ƒ

Defective I/F between the video bridge device and i-controller

Replace the i-controller.

No. 822

Type CTL B

[3003]

SM Appendix

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error: HDD (Hard Disk Drive) [XXXX]: Detailed error code Timeout error

4-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

[3004] -

Command error When the main switch is turned on or starting the self-diagnostic, the

-

-

HDD stays busy for the specified time or more.

-

-

-

No. 823

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

Type CTL B

ƒ

Loose connection

ƒ

Defective HDD

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Check that the HDD is correctly connected to the controller.

2.

Replace the HDD.

3.

Replace the controller.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error: NIB [XXXX]: Detailed error code MAC address check sum error

[6101]

The result of the MAC address check sum does not match the check sum stored in ROM. PHY IC error

[6104]

The PHY IC on the controller cannot be correctly recognized. PHY IC loop-back error

[6105]

An error occurred during the loop-back test for the PHY IC on the controller.

-

Replace the controller.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) [1401]

824

CTL D

Self-diagnosis error: Standard NVRAM The controller cannot recognize the standard NVRAM installed or detects that the NVRAM is defective.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

No. 826

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Loose connection

ƒ

Defective standard NVRAM

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Check the standard NVRAM is firmly inserted into the socket.

2.

Replace the NVRAM.

3.

Replace the controller

Type CTL D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) [15FF] Self-diagnostic Error: RTC/optional NVRAM Appendix: Service Call Conditions

No.

RTC error [1501]

ƒ

Defective the RTC device

Replace the i-controller. The RTC device is not detected.

[15FF]

ƒ

RTC defective

ƒ

NVRAM without RTC installed

ƒ

Backup battery discharged

Replace the NVRAM with another NVRAM with an RTC device.

No. 827

Type CTL D

[0201]

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error: Standard SDRAM DIMM [XXXX]: Detailed error code Verification error Error detected during a write/verify check for the standard RAM (SDRAM DIMM). ƒ

SM Appendix

Loose connection

4-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Defective SDRAM DIMM

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Turn the main switch off and on.

2.

Replace the SDRAM DIMM.

3.

Replace the controller.

Resident memory error The SPD values in all RAM DIMM are incorrect or unreadable. [0202]

No.

ƒ

Defective RAM DIMM

ƒ

Defective SPD ROM on RAM DIMM

ƒ

Defective 12C bus

1.

Replace the RAM DIMM.

Type

828

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

CTL

Self-diagnostic error: ROM

D

[XXXX]: Detailed error code Check sum error 1 The boot monitor and OS program stored in the ROM DIMM is

ƒ

[0101]

checked. If the check sum of the program is incorrect, this SC code is displayed.

No.

Type CTL

829

B

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnosis error: optional RAM [XXXX]: Detailed error code Verification error (Slot 1)

[0401]

The data stored in the optional RAM in Slot 1 does not match the data when reading.

-

-

ƒ

D037/D038/D040/D041

Not specified RAM DIMM installed

4-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

-

Type

-

No. 833

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Defective RAM DIMM

1.

Replace the RAM DIMM.

2.

Replace the controller board.

Type CTL C

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error 8: Engine I/F ASIC ƒ

[0F30]

ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.

[0F31]

Replace the VBCU ƒ

ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.

[0F41]

Replace the VBCU Could not initialize or read the bus connection. [50B1]

ƒ

Check for loose connections at the mother board.

Replace the mother board Value of the SSCG register is incorrect. [50B2]

ƒ

Check for loose connections at the mother board.

Replace the mother board

No. 839

Type CTL C

[9101]

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) USB NAND Flash ROM error The ID of the USB NAND Flash ROM cannot be read. ƒ

SM Appendix

Defective controller board

4-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

No.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Replace the controller board. The USB NAND Flash ROM is disconnected.

[9110]

Defective controller board

ƒ

Replace the controller board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) IEEE1394 interface error The 1394 interface is unusable.

851

No.

CTL

ƒ

Defective IEEE1394

B

ƒ

Defective controller.

1.

Turn the main switch off and on.

2.

Replace the IEEE1394 interface board.

3.

Replace the controller.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Wireless LAN card not detected

853

CTL B

The wireless LAN card is not detected before communication is established, though the wireless LAN board is detected. Loose connection

ƒ

Check the connection.

No. 854

Type CTL B

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Wireless LAN/Bluetooth card not detected The wireless LAN/Bluetooth card is not detected after communication is established, but the wireless LAN board is detected.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Loose connection

Check the connection.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Wireless LAN/Bluetooth card error

855

CTL

856

B

No.

ƒ

Loose connection

ƒ

Defective wireless LAN/Bluetooth card

1.

Check the connection.

2.

Replace the wireless LAN/Bluetooth card.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) USB interface error The USB interface cannot be used due to a driver error.

857

No. 858

CTL B

ƒ

Defective USB driver

ƒ

Loose connection

1.

Check the connection.

2.

Replace the USB board.

Type CTL C

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD Encryption unit error 1 A serious error occurs when data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the HDD encryption unit. [0]

SM Appendix

Encryption key acquisition error: The controller fails to get a new encryption key.

4-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

An error is detected in the wireless LAN/Bluetooth card.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Defective controller board

1.

Replace the controller board.

Encryption key setting for HDD error: The controller fails to copy a new encryption key to the HDD.

[1]

ƒ

Defective SATA chip on the controller board

1.

Replace the controller board.

NVRAM data encryption error 1: An error occurs while the NVRAM data is encrypted.

[2]

ƒ

Defective NVRAM on the controller board

1.

Replace the NVRAM.

NVRAM data encryption error 2: [30]

An error occurs before the NVRAM data is encrypted. ƒ

Defective controller board

1.

Replace the controller board.

Other error: [30]

A serious error occurs while the data is encrypted. ƒ

No. 859

Type CTL C

Same as SC991

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD Encryption unit error 2 A serious error occurs when the HDD data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the HDD encryption unit. HDD check error: The HDD is not correctly installed. [8]

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

No HDD installed

ƒ

Unformatted HDD

ƒ

The encryption key on the controller is different from the one on the HDD

1.

Install the HDD correctly.

1.

Initialize the HDD.

Power failure during the data encryption: The data encryption (NVRAM and HDD) has not been completed. ƒ

Power failure during the data encryption

1.

Initialize the HDD. Appendix: Service Call Conditions

[9]

Data read/write error: [10]

The DMAC error is detected twice or more. ƒ

No.

Type

Same as SC863

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Initialization error The controller detects that the hard disk fails.

860

No.

861

CTL B

Type

CTL D

ƒ

HDD not initialized

ƒ

Defective HDD

1.

Reformat the HDD.

2.

Replace the HDD.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Reboot error The HDD does not become ready within 30 seconds after the power is supplied to the HDD.

SM Appendix

4-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ƒ

Loose connection

ƒ

Defective cables

ƒ

Defective HDD

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Check the connection between the HDD and controller.

2.

Check and replace the cables.

3.

Replace the HDD.

4.

Replace the controller.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Bad sector number error

862

No.

CTL D

The number of bad sectors in the HDD goes over 101. ƒ

Defective HDD

1.

Format the HDD with SP5-832-002.

2.

Replace the HDD.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Read error The data stored in the HDD cannot be read correctly.

863

No. 864

CTL D

Type CTL

ƒ

Defective HDD

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Replace the HDD.

2.

Replace the controller.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: CRC error

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) While reading data from the HDD or storing data in the HDD, data transmission fails. ƒ

Defective HDD

Replace the HDD.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Access error

CTL D

An error is detected while operating the HDD. ƒ

Defective HDD Appendix: Service Call Conditions

865

Replace the HDD.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD card authentication error

866

CTL B

A correct license is not found in the SD card. ƒ

SD-card data is corrupted.

Store correct data in the SD card.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD card error

867

CTL

The SD card is ejected from the slot.

D

SM Appendix

1.

Install the SD card.

2.

Turn the main switch off and on.

4-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD card access error

868

No.

CTL D

ƒ

-13 to -3: File system error

ƒ

Other number: Device error

An error report is sent from the SD card reader. ƒ

An error is detected in the SD card.

1.

For a file system error, format the SD card on your PC.

2.

For a device error, turn the mains switch off and on.

3.

Replace the SD card.

4.

Replace the controller.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Address book error An error is detected in the data copied to the address book over a network.

870

No.

CTL

ƒ

Defective software program

B

ƒ

Defective HDD

ƒ

Incorrect path to the server

1.

Initialize the address book data (SP5-846-050).

2.

Initialize the user information (SP5-832-006).

3.

Replace the HDD.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD mail data error

872

CTL B

An error is detected in the HDD at machine initialization. ƒ

Defective HDD

ƒ

Power failure during an access to the HDD

1.

Turn the main switch off and on.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 2.

Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-007).

3.

Replace the HDD.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD mail transfer error

873

No.

CTL B

ƒ

Defective HDD

ƒ

Power failure during an access to the HDD

1.

Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-008).

2.

Replace the HDD.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Delete All error 1: HDD An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted

874

No.

CTL D

physically by the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362). ƒ

DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (SD card) not installed

ƒ

Defective HDD

1.

Install the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362).

2.

Replace the HDD.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Delete All error 2: Data area

875

CTL D

An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted logically by the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362). ƒ

The logical format for the HDD fails.

Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again

SM Appendix

4-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

An error is detected in the HDD at machine initialization.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Log Data Error

876

CTL D

An error was detected in the handling of the log data at power on or during machine operation. This can be caused by switching the machine off while it is operating. Log Data Error 1

-001 ƒ

Damaged log data file in the HDD

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. Log Data Error 2 -002

ƒ

An encryption module not installed

1.

Disable the log encryption setting with SP9730-004 ("0" is off.)

2.

Install the DESS module.

Log Data Error 3 -003

ƒ

Invalid log encryption key due to defective NVRAM data

1.

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.

2.

Disable the log encryption setting with SP9730-004 ("0" is off.)

Log Data Error 4 -004 ƒ

Unusual log encryption function due to defective NVRAM data

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. Log Data Error 5 -005

ƒ

Installed NVRAM or HDD which is used in another machine

1.

Reinstall the previous NVRAM or HDD.

2.

Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.

-099 Log Data Error 99 ƒ

D037/D038/D040/D041

Other than the above causes

4-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Ask your supervisor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD Data Overwrite Security SD card error The 'all delete' function cannot be executed but the

No.

D

DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362) is installed and activated. ƒ

Defective SD card (D362)

ƒ

SD card (D362) not installed

1.

Replace the NVRAM and then install the new SD card (D362).

2.

Check and reinstall the SD card (D362).

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) TPM system authentication error

878

CTL D

The system firmware is not authenticated by TPM (security chip). ƒ

Incorrect updating for the system firmware

ƒ

Defective flash ROM on the controller board

Replace the controller board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) File format converter error

880

CTL D

The file format converter does not respond. ƒ

Defective file format converter

Replace the file format converter.

SM Appendix

4-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

877

CTL

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables

4.1.10 SC9XX: MISCELLANEOUS

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Electric counter error Abnormal data in the counters.

900

No.

CTL

ƒ

Defective NVRAM

D

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Check the connection between the NVRAM and controller.

2.

Replace the NVRAM.

3.

Replace the controller.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Printer application error An error is detected in the printer application program.

920

CTL

ƒ

Defective software

D

ƒ

Unexpected hardware resource (e.g., memory shortage)

1.

Software defective; switch off/on, or change the controller firmware if the problem is not solved

2.

No.

Type

Insufficient memory

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Printer font error

921

CTL D

A necessary font is not found in the SD card. ƒ

A necessary font is not found in the SD card.

ƒ

The SD card data is corrupted.

Check that the SD card has the correct data.

D037/D038/D040/D041

4-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Software performance error The software makes an unexpected operation.

D

Defective software

ƒ

Defective controller

ƒ

Software error

1.

Turn the main switch off and on.

2.

Reinstall the controller and/or engine main firmware.

ƒ

No.

Type

See Note 1 at the end of the SC table.

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Software continuity error The software has attempted to perform an unexpected operation.

991

CTL C

However, unlike SC 990, the object of the error is continuity of the software. ƒ

Software program error

ƒ

Internal parameter incorrect, insufficient working memory.

This SC is not displayed on the LCD (logging only).

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Undefined error

992

CTL D

Defective software program ƒ

No. 995

Type D

SM Appendix

An error undetectable by any other SC code occurred

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) CPM setting error

4-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

990

CTL

ƒ

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No. 995

Type D

-001

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) CPM setting error ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

NVRAM replacement error

1.

Install the previous NVRAM on the BCU.

2.

Input the serial number with SP5811-004, and turn the main power switch off/on.

-002

ƒ

Defective NVRAM on the controller

ƒ

Defective controller

1.

Update the controller firmware.

2.

Install a new NVRAM, and turn off and on the main power switch after SC995-002 has occurred. Incorrect type controller installed

ƒ

Defective controller

-003 ƒ

-004

No.

1.

Replace the controller with the correct type.

ƒ

Incorrect model controller installed.

1.

Replace the controller with the correct model.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Application function selection error ƒ

The application selected by the operation panel key does not start or ends abnormally.

997

CTL

ƒ

Software (including the software configuration) defective

ƒ

An option required by the application (RAM, DIMM, board) is not

B

installed ƒ

Nesting of the fax group addresses is too complicated

1.

Check the devices necessary for the application program. If necessary devices have not been installed, install them.

2.

D037/D038/D040/D041

Check that application programs are correctly configured.

4-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC Tables No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 3.

For a fax operation problem, simplify the nesting of the fax group addresses.

4.

Take necessary countermeasures specific to the application program. If the logs can be displayed on the operation panel, see the logs.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Application start error

998

CTL D

ƒ

Loose connection of RAM-DIMM, ROM-DIMM

ƒ

Defective controller

ƒ

Software problem

1.

Check the setting of SP5875-001. If the setting is set to "1 (OFF)", change it to "0 (OFF)".

2.

Check if the RAM-DIMM and ROM-DIMM are correctly connected.

3.

Reinstall the controller system firmware.

4.

Replace the controller.

Note 1 If a problem always occurs in a specific condition (for example. printer driver setting, image file), the problem may be caused by a software error. In this case, the following data and information needs to be sent back to your product specialist. Please understand that it may take some time to get a reply on how to solve the problem, because in some cases the design staff in Japan must analyze the data. ƒ

Symptom / Possible Causes / Action taken

ƒ

Summary sheet (SP mode “Printer SP”, SP1-004 [Print Summary])

ƒ

SMC - All (SP5-990-001)

ƒ

SMC - Logging (SP5-990-004)

ƒ

Printer driver settings used when the problem occurs

ƒ

All data displayed on the screen (SC code, error code, and program address where the problem is logged.)

ƒ

Image file which causes the problem, if possible

SM Appendix

4-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Service Call Conditions

No applications start within 60 seconds after the power is turned on.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Process Control Error Conditions

5. APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS 5.1 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS 5.1.1 DEVELOPER INITIALIZATION RESULT SP-3-014-001 (Developer Initialization Result)

No.

Result

Description

Possible Causes/Action

Developer 1

Successfully

initialization is

completed

successfully

-

completed. A cover was opened or the main switch was turned off during the initialization. 2

Forced termination

1.

Developer

Do the developer initialization again

initialization was

when done in SP mode. Reinstall the

forcibly terminated.

engine main firmware if the result is the same. 2.

Turn the main switch off and on when done at unit replacement.

6

Vt error

1.

Vt is more than 0.7V

development unit is not removed.

when Vcnt is 4.3V. Vcnt is less than 4.7V

7

8

Vcnt error 1

Vcnt error 2

SM Appendix

Make sure that the heat seal on the

2.

Defective TD sensor

1.

Defective TD sensor

when Vcnt is Vt target 2.

Vt target settings are not correct.

±0.2V.

3.

Toner density error

Vt is more than 0.7V

1.

Make sure that the heat seal on the

when Vcnt is 4.3V and

development unit is not removed.

5-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions

ƒ

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Process Control Error Conditions No.

Result

Description

Possible Causes/Action

Vcnt is less than 4.7V

2.

Defective TD sensor

1.

Make sure that the heat seal on the

when Vcnt is Vt target ±0.2V.

development unit is not removed 9

Vcnt error 3

ƒ

Vcnt is less than 4.7V. 2.

Defective TD sensor

3.

Vt target settings are not correct.

4.

Toner density error

The machine starts developer initialization after you set “1” in SP3-902-005, 006, 007, or 008. Developer initialization automatically resumes when you open and close the front door or turn the main switch off and on if an error other than Error 8 occurs.

5.1.2 PROCESS CONTROL SELF-CHECK RESULT Displayed number shows results of each color sensor check. 00000000 = YYCCMMKK SP3-012-001 to -010 (Process Control Self-check Result)

No. Result

Description

Possible Causes/Action

Process control 11

Successfully

self-check

Check the Vsg adjustment. See the "Vsg

completed

successfully

Adjustment Result" following this table.

completed. ƒ

Defective development unit

Vt maximum error and an image is faint: 41

Vt error

Vt maximum or

1.

Replace the toner hopper unit.

minimum error is

Vt maximum error and an image is O.K:

detected.

1.

Replace the development unit.

2.

Replace the BCU board.

Vt minimum error:

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Process Control Error Conditions Description

Possible Causes/Action

ID sensor 53

Solid image is not sufficient density:

1.

Retry the process control.

2.

Replace the ID sensors.

3.

Replace the BCU board.

(K5) detection

be sampled.

1.

Replace the ID sensors.

2.

Replace the BCU board.

ƒ

ID sensor is dirty:

1.

Clean the ID sensors.

2.

Retry the process control.

ƒ

ID sensor pattern density is too high

(K5) minimum error

58

ƒ

Solid image is O.K.

maximum/

57

Replace the BCU board.

ƒ

coefficient

56

2.

Not enough data can

ID sensor

55

Replace the development unit.

coefficient error

54

1.

When the K5 is more than the value of

ƒ

SP3-362-004, the

Same as 53

error 54 is displayed. Gamma is out of

Maximum

range. 5.0 < Gamma

Minimum

range. Gamma < 0.15

Vk is out of range.

Maximum

150 < Vk

Vk error:

Vk is out of range.

Minimum

Vk < –150

ƒ

ID sensor pattern density is too high.

ƒ

Hardware defective.

Same as 53

Gamma is out of

Vk error:

SM Appendix

ID sensor or shutter is defective.

than the value of

Gamma error:

Gamma error:

or low.

SP3-362-003 or less

ƒ

ID sensor pattern density is too low.

ƒ

Hardware defective.

1.

Same as 53

2.

Replace the toner hopper unit.

ƒ

ID sensor pattern density is too low.

ƒ

Hardware defective.

Same as 53 ƒ

ID sensor pattern density is too high.

ƒ

Background dirty

ƒ

Hardware defective

5-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions

No. Result

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Process Control Error Conditions No. Result

Description

Possible Causes/Action Same as 53

Sampling data 59

error during

be sampled during the

gamma

gamma correction.

correction 99

ƒ

Not enough data can

Unexpected

or low. ƒ

Hardware defective

Same as 53 ƒ

Process control fails.

error

ID sensor pattern density is too high

Power Failure

Check the power source.

Vsg Adjustment Result SP3-325-001 to -010 (Vsg Adjustment Result)

No. Result 1

O.K

Description

Possible Causes/Action

Vsg adjustment is correctly done.

ƒ

Dirty ID sensors (toner, dust, or foreign material)

2

ID sensor

Vsg cannot be

adjustment

adjusted within

error

4.0 ±0.5V.

ƒ

Dirty image transfer belt

ƒ

Scratched image transfer belt

ƒ

Defective ID sensors

ƒ

Poor connection

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Clean the ID sensors.

2.

Check the ITB cleaning unit. Clean or replace the image transfer belt.

3

3.

Replace the image transfer belt.

4.

Replace the ID sensors.

5.

Check the connection.

6.

Replace the BCU board.

ID sensor

ID sensor output

ƒ

Defective ID sensors

output error

is more than

ƒ

Poor connection

D037/D038/D040/D041

5-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Process Control Error Conditions No. Result

9

Description

Possible Causes/Action

"Voffset

ƒ

Defective BCU

Threshold"

1.

Replace the ID sensors.

(SP3-324-004)

2.

Check the connection.

3.

Replace the BCU board.

ƒ

Other cases

Vsg

Vsg adjustment

Adjustment

has not been

error

completed.

Retry SP3-321-010.

5.1.3 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT RESULT SP2-194-010 to -012 (Line Position Adjustment Result: M, C, Y) This SP shows the number as a line position adjustment result on the LCD. It shows which

No. 0 1

2

Result

Description

Note

Not done

Line position adjustment has not been done.

-

Completed

Line position adjustment has correctly been

successfully

done,

Cannot detect

ID sensors have not detected the patterns for

patterns

line position adjustment.

Fewer lines on 3

the pattern than the target

The patterns, which ID sensors have detected, are not enough for line position adjustment.

-

See Note

See Note

More lines on 4

the pattern than

Not used in this machine.

-

-

-

the target 5-9

ƒ

Not used

For details, see the "Troubleshooting Guide - Line Position Adjustment" section.

SM Appendix

5-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions

color has an error (M, Y or C).

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide

6. APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 6.1 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 6.1.1 IMAGE QUALITY The following work-flow shows the basic troubleshooting steps for the image quality problems on this product. Start

Can the problem be duplicated?

Verification of problem reported from users

Ask customer to duplicate it.

No

Yes

Image Quality?

No

Troubleshoot using the service manual or technical bulletin.

Yes Make copy in the enlargement or reduction mode.

Copy

Copy or Print?

Print

Location of the image problem shifted?

Make a test pattern using SP2-109.

Color related?

No

Troubleshoot depending on the type of problem.

Possible Symptoms

Yes

Vertical white dotted lines Check the transfer bias or paper condition. Vertical white lines on thick paper Check the timing when the problem occurs.

Yes

Dirty lines Check the transfer belt cleaning section. Poor fusing / Fusing offset Check the paper types selected in the printer driver. Smeared image at trailing edge Check the fusing unit speed. A

SM Appendix

B

Crow marks Check the humidity condition and adjust the transfer bias if necessary.

6-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

No problem on pattern * Font problem * Image data missing Especially, problems related to the above symptoms and if no problem is found on the test pattern, it may be related to the application used or driver. Collect a capture file for further investigation (select 'Print to File' in the driver).

b222t501

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide

No

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide A

B Possible Symptoms Color shift Check the level of the color shift and follow the troubleshooting guide if required.

Problem is related to the scanner section.

Make a test print from SBU in SP4807 in each color.

Connection of cable between the i-controller and laser unit.

No Yes Color missing

Mirror position of related colour located in the laser unit. i-Controller or BCU board defective

No

No

Make a test print from IPU in SP4-417 by selecting related color.

Can the problem be duplicated?

All colors?

Check Points

Can the problem be duplicated?

Yes

Yes

Check the scanner section (exposure glass, mirrors, scanner movement, etc.)

No

Check the connection between the SBU/ iController or replace the SBU.

Specify the color that caused the image problem.

Check the image processing area of the color specified in the previous step

Yes Check connection between the BCU/ iController, or replace the i-Controller.

Considerable Symptoms Toner blasting Check which color is blasting and adjust the toner limit or transfer bias. Image density change Check when the problem is reported and follow the necessary steps. Dirty Background Check in which condition the problem is reported, and follow the required procedure. Color vertical bands/lines/dirty background Check the OPC drum and/or development unit. Color shift Check the level of the color shift and follow the troubleshooting guide if required. Color lines/bands/dirty background When the PCDU is close to its life end, the developer or the cleaning blade of the drum unit wears out, causing vertical color lines, bands, or dirty background. Check the related color unit and replace it if necessary.

d037t502

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide

6.1.2 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT When there are color registration errors on the output, do the line position adjustment as follows. ƒ

Use A3/DLT size paper for this adjustment.

Test 1.

Do SP2-111-003 (Mode c: rough adjustment).

2.

Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to ‘Countermeasure list for color registration errors’.

3.

Do SP2-111-001 (Mode a: fine adjustment twice).

4.

Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to ‘Countermeasure list for color registration errors’.

5.

Put some A3/DLT paper on the by-pass tray. ƒ

When you print a test pattern, use the by-pass tray to feed the paper.

6.

Print out test pattern "7" with SP2-109-003.

7.

Check the printed output with a loupe.

8.

If there are no color registration errors on the output, the line position adjustment is correctly done. If not, refer to the countermeasure list for color registration errors.

After Executing SP2-111-003 ƒ

Result: "1" in SP2-194-007

ƒ

Result: "2" or "3" (Line pattern detection failure) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure ƒ

Defective image processing unit

ƒ

Low density of test pattern

White image, Abnormal image,

ƒ

Defective i-controller

Low density

1.

Replace the high voltage power supply unit.

2.

Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx).

SM Appendix

6-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide

Countermeasure list for color registration errors

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure 3.

Replace the BCU.

ƒ

Defective ID sensors

Normal image, but with color

ƒ

Defective BCU

registration errors

1.

Replace the ID sensor.

2.

Replace the BCU.

After Executing SP2-111-003 ƒ

Result: "1" in SP2-194-007

ƒ

One of results: "5" (Out of adjustable range) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012.

Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure

The main scan registrations of M, ƒ

Defective laser unit

C, Y are shifted by more than ±15 ƒ

Defective BCU

mm from the main scan

1.

Replace the laser unit.

registration of K.

2.

Replace the BCU.

ƒ

Defective image transfer belt

ƒ

Defective drive units

The sub scan registrations of M,

C, Y are shifted by more than ±20 ƒ

Defective BCU

mm from the sub scan

1.

Replace the image transfer belt.

registration of K.

2.

Replace the drum motor.

3.

Replace the BCU.

ƒ

Defective ID sensor at center

The main scan registration is

ƒ

Deformed center area on the image transfer belt

shifted by more than ±0.66 mm,

ƒ

Defective BCU

but only at the central area of the 1. image on the output.

The skew for M, C, Y is more than ±0.75 mm from the main scan registration of K

D037/D038/D040/D041

Replace the ID sensor.

2.

Replace the image transfer belt.

3.

Replace the BCU.

ƒ

Defective PCU

ƒ

Defective laser unit

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Reinstall or replace the BCU.

6-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check

Others

Possible cause/Countermeasure 2.

Replace the laser unit.

3.

Replace the BCU.

ƒ

Skew correction upper limit error

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective laser unit

1.

Replace the BCU.

2.

Replace the laser unit.

After Executing SP2-111-003 ƒ

Result: "1" in SP2-194-007

ƒ

Result: "0" in SP2-194-010, -011, -012.

Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure Do SP2-111-001 or -002.

After Executing SP2-111-001 ƒ

Result: "1" in SP2-194-007

ƒ

Result: "2" or "3" (Line pattern detection failure) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

Possible cause/Countermeasure

White image, Abnormal image,

ƒ

Defective image processing unit

Low density

ƒ

Low density of test pattern

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Replace the high voltage power supply unit.

2.

Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx).

3.

Replace the BCU.

Normal image, but with color

ƒ

Defective ID sensor

registration errors

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Replace the ID sensor.

2.

Replace the BCU.

SM Appendix

6-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide

Test pattern check

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide

After Executing SP2-111-001 ƒ

Result: "1" in SP2-194-007

ƒ

Result: "5" (Out of adjustable range) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

Test pattern check Low image density on the output

Possible cause/Countermeasure ƒ

Low pattern density

Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx). The main scan registrations of M, ƒ

No defective component

C, Y are shifted by more than

ƒ

Defective laser optics housing unit

±1.4 mm from the main scan

ƒ

Defective BCU

registration of K.

1.

Do SP2-111-003 again.

2.

Replace the laser unit.

3.

Replace the BCU.

The sub scan registrations of M,

ƒ

No defective component

C, Y are shifted by more than

ƒ

Defective image transfer belt

±1.4mm from the sub scan

ƒ

Defective drive units

registration of K.

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Do SP2-111-003 again.

2.

Replace the image transfer belt.

3.

Replace the drum motor.

4.

Replace the BCU.

The main scan registration is

ƒ

Defective ID sensor at center

shifted by more than ±0.66 mm,

ƒ

Deformed center area on the image transfer belt

but only at the central area of the ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Replace the ID sensor.

2.

Replace the image transfer belt.

3.

Replace the BCU.

The skew for M, C, Y is more

ƒ

Defective PCDU

than ± 0.75 mm from the main

ƒ

Defective laser unit

scan registration of K. – at the

ƒ

Defective BCU

end of the scan line?

1.

Reinstall or replace the PCDU.

image on the output.

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check

Others

Possible cause/Countermeasure 2.

Replace the laser unit.

3.

Replace the BCU.

ƒ

Skew correction upper limit error

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Defective laser unit

1.

Replace the BCU.

2.

Replace the laser unit.

After Executing SP2-111-001 ƒ

Result: "0" in SP2-194-007

ƒ

Result: No color registration errors in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure

The main scan registration of K is ƒ

Abnormal SP setting value of main scan: K

shifted.

Adjust the value with SP2-101-001.

The main scan length of K is

ƒ

shifted.

Abnormal SP setting value of main scan length detection: K

Adjust the value with SP2-102-001 and -003. Note: Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide

The setting value of these SPs should be same.

After Executing SP2-111-001 ƒ

Result: "0" in SP2-194-007

ƒ

Result: Color registration errors in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

Test pattern check Low image density on the output

Possible cause/Countermeasure ƒ

Low pattern density

Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx). The main scan registration is

SM Appendix

ƒ

Defective ID sensor at center

6-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure

shifted, but only at the central

ƒ

Deformed center area on the image transfer belt

area of the image on the output.

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Replace the ID sensor.

2.

Replace the image transfer belt.

3.

Replace the BCU.

The main scan registrations of M, ƒ

Defective laser optics housing unit

C, Y are shifted.

ƒ

Defective ID sensor

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Incorrect SP value

1.

Replace the laser optics housing unit.

2.

Replace the ID sensor.

3.

Replace the BCU.

4.

Adjust the value with SP2-182-004 to -021.

The sub scan registrations of M,

ƒ

Defective image transfer belt

C, Y are shifted.

ƒ

Defective drive units

ƒ

Defective ID sensor

ƒ

Defective BCU

ƒ

Incorrect SP value

1.

Replace the image transfer belt.

2.

Replace the ID sensor.

3.

Replace the drum motor.

4.

Replace the BCU.

5.

Adjust the value with SP2-182-022 to -039.

ƒ

Defective PCDU

ƒ

Defective laser optics housing unit

ƒ

Defective BCU

1.

Reinstall or replace the PCDU.

2.

Replace the laser optics housing unit.

3.

Replace the BCU.

The sub scan lines are shifted.

ƒ

Defective PCDU

Shifted lines appear cyclically.

ƒ

Defective drive unit

ƒ

Drum phase adjustment error

The skew of M, C, Y is different.

D037/D038/D040/D041

6-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure 1.

Do SP1-902-001 (Drum phase adjustment); see Replacement and Adjustment – Drive Unit – Gear Unit for details.

2.

Reinstall or replace the PCDU.

3.

Check or replace the drive unit.

6.1.3 IMAGE PROBLEMS AT REGULAR INTERVALS If a defect occurs in the image at one of these intervals, the related component may be defective.

Development roller: 32 mm

ƒ

PTR (Paper Transfer Roller): 75.0 mm

ƒ

Drum: 94.2 mm

ƒ

Fusing belt: 157.1 mm Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide

ƒ

SM Appendix

6-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection

7. APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION 7.1 JAM DETECTION 7.1.1 PAPER JAM DISPLAY SP7-507 shows the paper jam history.

ƒ

CODE: Indicates the jam code.

ƒ

SIZE: Indicates the paper Size Code.

ƒ

TOTAL: Indicates the total counter (SP7-502-001).

ƒ

DATE: indicates the date when the jam occurred.

Paper Size Code

Paper Size

Size Code

Paper Size

05

A4 LEF

141

B4 SEF

06

A5 LEF

142

B5 SEF

14

B5 LEF

160

DLT SEF

38

LT LEF

164

LG SEF

44

HLT LEF

166

LT SEF

132

A3 SEF

172

HLT SEF

133

A4 SEF

255

Others

134

A5 SEF

-

-

SM Appendix

7-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Jam Detection

Size Code

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection

7.1.2 JAM CODES AND DISPLAY CODES Mainframe SP7-504 shows how many jams occurred at each location.

Jam Code

LCD

Display

Description

7504 1

At Power On

Paper is stack at power-on.

Note

7504 3

Tray 1: ON

Paper is not fed from tray 1.

A2

7504 4

Tray 2: ON

Paper is not fed from tray 2.

A1

7504 5

Tray 3: ON

7504 6

Tray 4: ON

Paper is not fed from tray 4.

Y

7504 8

Bypass: ON

Paper is not fed from the by-pass tray.

A2

7504 9

Duplex: ON

Paper is jammed at the duplex unit.

Vertical Transport 1:

Vertical transport sensor 1 does not

ON

detect paper from tray 1.

Vertical Transport 2:

Vertical transport sensor 2 does not

ON

detect paper from tray 2.

SP

7504 11

7504 12

Paper is not fed from tray 3 (one-tray

Y

paper feed unit).

Z A1

Y

Registration sensor does not detect

7504 17

Registration: ON

7504 18

Fusing Entrance: ON

7504 19

Fusing Exit: ON

7504 20

Paper Exit: ON

7504 21

Relay Exit: ON

D037/D038/D040/D041

Display

A2

paper. Fusing entrance sensor does not detect paper. Fusing exit sensor does not detect

C

paper. Paper exit sensor does not detect paper. Tray exit sensor (bridge unit) does not detect paper.

7-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

B

C D

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection LCD

Display

Description

7504 24

Inverter Sn: ON

Inverter sensor does not detect paper.

7504 25

Duplex Exit: ON

7504 27

Duplex Entrance: ON

7504 28

1-Bin Exit Sensor

7504 29

R-tray Paper Exit: ON

SP

Display

Duplex exit sensor does not detect paper. Duplex entrance sensor does not detect paper. 1-bin tray exit sensor does not detect paper. Paper exit sensor of the side tray does not detect paper.

C Z

Z

C

C

Vertical Transport

Vertical transport sensor 1 does not turn

Sensor1

off.

Vertical Transport

Vertical transport sensor 2 does not turn

Sensor2

off.

Vertical Transport

Vertical transport sensor 3 does not turn

Sensor3

off.

Registration Sensor

Registration sensor does not turn off.

Fusing Entrance

Fusing entrance sensor does not turn

Sensor

off.

7504 59

Fusing Exit Sensor

Fusing exit sensor does not turn off.

C

7504 60

Exit Sensor

Paper exit sensor does not turn off.

C

7504 64

Inverter Sensor

Inverter sensor does not turn off.

C

7504 65

Duplex Exit Sensor

Duplex exit sensor does not turn off.

Z

Duplex Entrance

Duplex entrance sensor does not turn

Sensor

off.

1-Bin Exit: ON

1-bin tray exit sensor does not turn off.

7504 51

7504 52

7504 53 7504 57 7504 58

7504 67 7504 68

SM Appendix

7-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

A1, A2

Y

Y B C

Z R

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Jam Detection

Jam Code

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection Jam Code SP 7504 69

Display

Description

R-tray Paper Exit

Paper exit sensor of the side tray does

Sensor

not turn off.

LCD Display W

The machine does not get paper exit

7504 230

FIN:Paper Exit Error

7504 231

FIN:Command Error

7504 240

Fin. Entrance: ON

7504 241

Fin. Entrance Sensor

R1, R2

data from the internal finisher. The machine gets a command error

R1, R2

from the internal finisher. Entrance sensor of the internal finisher

C, R1,

does not detect paper.

R2

Entrance sensor of the internal finisher

R1, R2

does not turn off. The mainframe detects the lock signal

7504 242

Feed-Out Belt Motor

from the paper transport motor of the

R1, R2

internal finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal 7504 243

Stapler Motor

from the staple motor of the internal

R1, R2

finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal 7504 244

Jogger Motor

from the front or rear jogger motor of the

R1, R2

internal finisher.

7504 245

7504 246

Pick-Up Roller Lift Motor

Stapler Unit Drive Motor

The mainframe detects the lock signal from the pick-up roller contact motor of

R1, R2

the internal finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal from the stapler unit movement motor of

R1, R2

the punch unit. The mainframe detects the lock signal

7504 247

Output Tray Motor

from the feed motor of the internal

R1, R2

finisher.

D037/D038/D040/D041

7-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection Jam Code SP

Display

7504 248

Belt Lift Solenoid

7504 249

Finisher Fan

7504 250

Punch Motor

LCD

Description

Display

The mainframe detects the belt lift solenoid error from the internal finisher. The mainframe detects the finisher fan error from the internal finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal from the punch motor.

R1, R2

R1, R2

R1, R2

The mainframe detects the lock signal 7504 251

Finisher Proof Exit

from the registration motor of the punch

R1, R2

unit. 7504 252

7504 253

ƒ

FIN:Stapler Position

The stapler unit stays on the jogger end

Error

fence so that stapling is disabled. Unexpected job data is sent to the

FIN:Job Data Error

internal finisher from the mainframe.

R1, R2

R1, R2

The jam location display depends on where a paper jam is detected at power-on.

ARDF (Original Jam)

LCD

Display

Description

7505 1

At Power On

Original is stack at power-on.

7505 3

Skew Correction: ON

7505 4

Registration: ON

7505 5

Paper Exit: ON

7505 53

Skew Correction: OFF Skew correction sensor does not turn

SP

SM Appendix

Display P

Skew correction sensor does not detect paper. Registration sensor does not detect paper. Exit Sensor does not detect paper.

7-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

P

P P P

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Jam Detection

Jam Code

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection Jam Code SP

Display

Description

LCD Display

off. 7505 54

Registration: OFF

Registration sensor does not turn off.

P

7505 55

Paper Exit: OFF

Exit Sensor does not turn off.

P

D037/D038/D040/D041

7-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Jam Detection

Appendix: Jam Detection

Sensor Locations

SM Appendix

7-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Component Defects

8. APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS 8.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS 8.1.1 SENSORS

No.

SW4

The CN numbers in the following table are the connector numbers on the IOB.

Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name

Duplex Unit Open Switch

Active

CN

Condition

Open L

CN232/2 Shorted

Sxx

Sxx

Sxx

Sxx Sxx

ID Sensor: Front

A

CN214/8, 9

ID Sensor: Center

A

CN214/6, 7

ID Sensor: Rear

A

CN214/2, 3

H

CN232/4

L

CN214/11

ID Sensor Shutter Sensor

Registration Sensor

Drum Phase Sensor: K Drum Phase Sensor:

SM Appendix

H

CN220/2

H

CN220/17

Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted

Symptom "Open Cover" is displayed. "Open cover" cannot be detected. SC258/ SC400

SC258/ SC400

SC258/ SC400

SC400

Open

Jam A2 (Jam17)

Shorted

Jam B (Jam57)

Open/ Shorted Open/

8-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC380/SC396 SC381/SC397

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Electrical Component Defects

ƒ

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Component Defects No.

Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name

Active

CN

CMY

Sxx Sxx Sxx Sxx

Sxx

Sxx

Open

Toner End Sensor - Y L

Toner End Sensor -

CN234/14,

Vertical Transport Sensor 1

Toner end cannot be detected. Toner end is detected

17, 20, 23 Shorted

M

ITB Rotation Sensor

Symptom

Shorted

Toner End Sensor - K Toner End Sensor - C

Condition

when there is enough toner.

H/L

CN219/20

L

CN219/10

Open/ Shorted

SC443

Open

Jam A1 (Jam11)

Shorted

Jam A1, A2 (Jam51) Paper end is not

Open Sxx

Paper End

Sxx

Sensor 1, 2

L

CN214/17,

detected when there is no paper in the paper tray.

19

Paper end is detected Shorted

when there is paper in the paper tray.

Sxx

Vertical Transport Sensor 2

L

CN219/15

Open

Jam Y (Jam12)

Shorted

Jam Y (Jam52)

Open/ SWx

Tray 1 Paper Size Switch

L

CN211/11,

Shorted

12, 13, 15 Shorted

S12 Sxx

By-pass Paper Size Sensor By-pass Paper End

D037/D038/D040/D041

L L

CN221/9,

Open/

10, 12, 13

Shorted

CN221/18

Open

8-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper size error Tray 1 is detected when tray 1 is not set. Paper size error

Paper on the by-pass

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Component Defects No.

Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name

Active

CN

Condition

Symptom tray is not detected when paper is set.

Sensor

Paper on the by-pass Shorted

tray is detected when paper is not set.

Sxx

Sx

Sx

Sx

By-pass Paper Length Sensor

By-pass HP Sensor

Fusing Entrance Sensor Duplex Entrance Sensor

Duplex Exit Sensor

L

Open

Paper size error

Shorted H

CN221/21

L

CN214/14

L

L

Sx

TD Sensor - K

A

Sx

TD Sensor - M

A

Sx

TD Sensor - C

A

Sx

TD Sensor - Y

A

Sx

Fusing Exit Sensor

L

SM Appendix

CN221/15

CN221/24

CN221/27

Open/ Shorted

SC508

Open

Jam B (Jam18)

Shorted

Jam C (Jam58)

Open

Jam Z (Jam27)

Shorted

Jam Z (Jam67)

Open

Jam Z (Jam25)

Shorted

Jam Z (Jam65)

CN212/B9,

Open/

B11

Shorted

CN212/A9,

Open/

A11

Shorted

CN212/A3,

Open/

A5

Shorted

CN212/A3,

Open/

A5

Shorted

CN227/18

Open

8-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SC372

SC373

SC374

SC375 Jam C (Jam19)

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Electrical Component Defects

Sxx

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Component Defects No.

Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name

Active

CN

Condition Shorted

Symptom Jam C (Jam59) Used toner near full

Open

near full.

PCDU Toner Sxx

Collection Bottle Full

indicated when it is not

H

CN211/9

Used toner near full

Sensor Shorted

cannot be detected when the waste toner bottle is nearly full. Toner collection bottle

Open PCDU Toner SWx

Collection Bottle Set

L

is not detected when the waste toner bottle is set.

CN211/7

Toner collection bottle

Switch Shorted

is detected when the waste toner bottle is not set. Used toner near full

Open

Sxx

ITB Toner Collection Bottle Full Sensor

indicated when it is not near full.

H

CN211/4

Used toner near full Shorted

cannot be detected when the waste toner bottle is nearly full.

SWx

Tray 2 Paper Size Switch

L

CN211/16,

Open/

17, 18, 20

Shorted

Paper size error Printed image has

Sx

Temperature/ Humidity Sensor

A

CN222/15,

Open/

some problems such as

17

Shorted

rough image, dirty background, weak

D037/D038/D040/D041

8-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Component Defects No.

Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name

Active

CN

Condition

Symptom image or poor fusing.

TH1

TH2

TH3

S3

Sxx

Sxx

Sxx

Thermopile Heating Roller Thermistor Pressure Roller Thermistor 1 (Center) Pressure Roller Thermistor 2 (Ends)

Paper Exit Sensor

Original Length Sensor 1 Original Length Sensor 2

Scanner HP Sensor

A

CN237/14

A

CN233/4

A

CN233/11

A

CN233/9

L

CN227/21

A

CN206/2

A

CN206/5

H

CN205/2

Sxx

Platen Cover Sensor

L

CN205/5

Sxx

ITB Contact Sensor

L

CN234/5

Sx

Inverter Sensor

L

CN227/15

SWx

Right Lower Door Open Switch

SM Appendix

L

CN219/13

Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted

SC541

SC551

SC561

SC571

Open

Jam C (Jam20)

Shorted

Jam C (Jam60)

Open/

Original paper size

Shorted

cannot be detected.

Open/

Original paper size

Shorted

cannot be detected.

Open

SC120

Shorted

SC121

Open/

Platen cover open

Shorted

cannot be detected.

Open/ Shorted

SC442

Open

(Jam 24)

Shorted

Jam C (Jam64)

Open

8-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

"Open Cover" is displayed.

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: Electrical Component Defects

Sxx

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Component Defects No.

Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name

Active

CN

Condition

Shorted

Symptom "Open cover" cannot be detected.

8.1.2 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS Power Supply Unit

Rating

Fuse

Symptom when turning on the main switch

115V

220V - 240V

FU101

15A/125V

8A/250V

FU102

10A/125V

5A/250V

FU103

2A/250V

2A/250V

FU4

5A/250V

5A/250V

FU5

5A/250V

5A/250V

5V power to the BCU is not supplied.

FU6

5A/250V

5A/125V

5VS power to the i-controller is not supplied.

FU7

10A/125V

10A/125V

24VS power to the BCU is not supplied.

FU8

10A/125V

10A/125V

24VS power to the BCU is not supplied.

FU9

6.3A/125V

6.3A/125V

ƒ

The i-controller works, but SC547 is issued. (5V power to the fusing unit is not supplied.) No response. (5V power to the PSU is not supplied.) 5V power to the scanner heater and tray heater is not supplied. 5V power to the i-controller and BCU is not supplied.

24V power to the DRB and i-controller is not supplied.

For continued protection against risk of fire, replace only with same type and rating of fuse.

D037/D038/D040/D041

8-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

9. APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES 9.1 SYSTEM SERVICE MODE 9.1.1 SERVICE MODE TABLE SP1-XXX (Feed)

[Leading Edge Registration] Leading Edge Registration Adjustment (Tray Location, Paper Type, Color Mode), Paper Type -> Plain, Thick 1, Thick 1001

2 or Thick3 Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration motor operation timing for each mode. *ENG

002 Tray:Thick1:600dpi

*ENG

003 Tray:M-Thick:600dpi

*ENG

004 By-pass:Plain:600dpi

*ENG

005 By-pass:Thick1:600dpi

*ENG

006 By-pass:Thick2:600dpi

*ENG

007 By-pass:Thick3:600dpi

*ENG

008 By-pass: M-Thick:600dpi

*ENG

009 Duplex:Plain:600dpi

*ENG

010 Duplex:M-Thick:600dpi

*ENG

011 Tray:Thick1:1200dpi

*ENG

012 Tray:M-Thick:1200dpi

*ENG

[–9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

[–9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Tray:Plain:600dpi

013 By-pass:Plain:M-Thick:1200dpi *ENG 014 By-pass:Plain:1200dpi

SM Appendix

*ENG

9-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 015 By-pass:Thick1:1200dpi

*ENG

016 By-pass:Thick2:1200dpi

*ENG

017 By-pass:Thick3:1200dpi

*ENG

018 By-pass:M-Thick:1200dpi

*ENG

019 Duplex:Plain:1200dpi

*ENG

020 Duplex:M-Thick:1200dpi

*ENG

[Side-to-Side Registration] 1002

Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each mode. 001 By-pass

*ENG

002 Paper Tray 1

*ENG

003 Paper Tray 2

*ENG

004 Paper Tray 3

*ENG

005 Paper Tray 4

*ENG

006 Duplex

*ENG

[–4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

[Paper Buckle] Paper Buckle Adjustment 1003

(Tray Location, Paper Type), Paper Type: N: Normal, TH: Thick Adjusts the amount of paper buckle at the registration roller by changing the paper feed timing. 001 Tray1:Plain:600dpi

*ENG

002 Tray1:Thick1:600dpi

*ENG

003 Tray1:M-Thick:600dpi

*ENG

004 Tray234:Plain:600dpi

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

9-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode *ENG

006 Tray234:M-Thick:600dpi

*ENG

007 By-pass:Plain:600dpi

*ENG

008 By-pass:Thick1:600dpi

*ENG

009 By-pass:Thick2:600dpi

*ENG

010 By-pass:Thick3:600dpi

*ENG

011 By-pass:M-Thick:600dpi

*ENG

012 Duplex:Plain:600dpi

*ENG

013 Duplex:M-Thick:600dpi

*ENG

014 Tray1:Plain:1200dpi

*ENG

015 Tray1:Thick1:1200dpi

*ENG

016 Tray1:M-Thick:1200dpi

*ENG

017 Tray1:Thick1:1200dpi

*ENG

018 Tray234:Thick1:1200dpi

*ENG

019 Tray234:M-Thick:1200dpi

*ENG

020 By-pass:Plain:1200dpi

*ENG

021 By-pass:Thick1:1200dpi

*ENG

022 By-pass:Thick2:1200dpi

*ENG

023 By-pass:Thick3:1200dpi

*ENG

024 By-pass:M-Thick:1200dpi

*ENG

025 Duplex:Plain:1200dpi

*ENG

026 Duplex:M-Thick:1200dpi

*ENG

[–5 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

005 Tray234:Thick1:600dpi

SM Appendix

9-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 1007

[By-Pass Size Detection] By-Pass Size Detection Display 0:LT SEF/ 1:LG

*ENG

-

Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass 001 tray. This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5”. 0: OFF (Letter/SEF), 1: ON (Legal/SEF)

1101

[Flicker Control] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 Flicker Control

*ENG

0: Flicker Control: OFF 1: Flicker Control: ON

1103

[Fusing Idling] Fusing Idling Adjustment

011 Idling Start Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 75 / 75 / 1 deg/step]

012 Forced Idling Stop

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

013 Forced Idling Stop Temp.

*ENG

[100 to 180 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

014 Minimum Idling Time

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 2 / 1 sec/step] Specifies how long the extra idling operation is executed for each

016 Extra Idling Time (L)

*ENG

environment. [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 sec/step] Each environment is determined with SP1112-001 and 002.

017 Extra Idling Time (H)

*ENG

018 Extra Idling Time (M)

*ENG

019 Ex Idling Temp:P-Roll

*ENG

[0 to 160 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

020 Control Switch Temp

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

9-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

1104

[Fusing Idling Before Job]

001 Environment Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]

002 Idling Temp:P-Roll

*ENG

[0 to 160 / 150 / 1 /step]

003 Idling Time: BW

*ENG

004 Idling Time: FC

*ENG

005 Idling Time: M-Thick: BW

*ENG

006 Idling Time: M-Thick: FC

*ENG

007 Paper Feed Temp:P-Roller

*ENG

008 P.Feed Temp:MThick:P-Roll:BW

*ENG

009 P.Feed Temp:MThick:P-Roll:FC

*ENG

010 Fusing Upper Limit Temp

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 15/ 1 deg/step]

011 Offset: Feed Start

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 25/ 1 deg/step]

012 Offset: Feed Start: M-Thick

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10/ 1 deg/step]

031 Offset:Feed Start:1200dpi

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 deg/step]

033 Offset: Feed Start: Glossy

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 15/ 1 deg/step]

1105

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

[0 to 10 / 2 / 1 sec/step]

[0 to 130 / 50/ 1 deg/step]

[Fusing Temperature] Fusing Temperature Adjustment (Printing Mode, Roller Type, [Color], Simplex/Duplex) Roller Type –> Center and Ends: Heating roller, Pressure –> Pressure roller Paper Type -> Plain, Thin, Thick, OHP, Middle Thick, Special

001

Fusing Ready Temp.

*ENG

[145 to 155 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

006

P-Roll Ready Target Temp.

SM Appendix

*ENG

[140 to 160 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

9-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Pressure Ready Temp

*ENG

[0 to 150 / 20 / 1 deg/step]

007 Sets the heating roller offset temperature at the end of the heating roller. This value is one of the thresholds to determine if the machine is at the heating roller target temperature during warm-up. 010 Stand-By: Center

* ENG

[140 to 170 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

011 Stand-By: End

* ENG

[140 to 170 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

* ENG

[135 to 165 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

Stand-By:P-Roller

012 Sets the pressure roller offset temperature. This value is one of the thresholds to determine if the machine is at the heating roller target temperature during warm-up. 013 Panel Off Mode: Center

* ENG

[100 to 150 / 130 / 1 deg /step]

014 Panel Off Mode: Ends

* ENG

[100 to 150 / 130 / 1 deg /step]

015 Panel Off Mode: P-Roller

*ENG

[135 to 165 / 150 / 1 deg /step]

016 Low Power: Center

*ENG

017 Low Power: Ends

*ENG

018 Low Power: P-Roller

*ENG

019 Off Mode: Center

*ENG

020 Off Mode: Ends

*ENG

021 Off Mode:P-Roller

*ENG

[0 to 170 / 0 / 1 deg /step]

030 Plain:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

[125 to 175 / 145 / 1 deg /step]

031 Plain: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

032 Plain:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

033 Plain: FC: Duplex: Ends

*ENG

034 Plain: BW: Simplex:Center

*ENG

035 Plain: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[30 to 100 / 40 / 1 deg /step]

[30 to 155 / 100 / 1 deg /step]

[0 to 180 / 0 / 1 deg /step]

9-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 036 Plain: BW: Duplex:Center

*ENG

037 Plain: BW: Duplex: Ends

*ENG

038 Thin: FC: Simplex:Center

*ENG

039 Thin: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

040 Thin:FC:Duplex:Center 041 Thin:FC:Duplex:Ends

[125 to 175 / 140 / 1 deg /step]

042 Thin: BW: Simplex:Center

*ENG

043 Thin: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

044 Thin: BW: Duplex:Center

*ENG

045 Thin:BW:Duplex:Ends 046 Thick 1: FC: Simplex:Center

*ENG

047 Thick 1: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

048 Thick 1: FC: Duplex:Center

*ENG

049 Thick 1: FC: Duplex:Ends

*ENG

050 Thick 1: BW: Simplex:Center

*ENG

051 Thick 1: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

052 Thick 1: BW: Duplex:Center

*ENG

[135 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg /step]

053 Thick 1:BW:Duplex:Ends 054 Thick 2: FC: Simplex:Center

*ENG

055 Thick 2: BW: Simplex:Center

*ENG

056 OHP: FC

*ENG

[125 to 175 / 160 / 1 deg /step]

057 OHP: BW

*ENG

[125 to 175 / 150 / 1 deg /step]

058 SP 1:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

[125 to 175 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

SM Appendix

9-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[135 to 180 / 160 / 1 deg /step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 059 SP 1:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

060 SP 1:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

061 SP 1:FC:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

062 SP 1:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

063 SP 1:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

064 SP 1:BW:Duplex:Center

*ENG

065 SP 1: BW: Duplex: Ends

*ENG

066 SP 2:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

067 SP 2: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

068 SP 2:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

069 SP 2:FC:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

070 SP 2:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

071 SP 2:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

072 SP 2:BW:Duplex:Center

*ENG

073 SP 2:BW:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

074 SP 3:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

075 SP 3:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

076 SP 3:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

077 SP 3:FC:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

078 SP 3:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

079 SP 3:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

080 SP 3:BW:Duplex:Center

*ENG

081 SP 3:BW:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[125 to 175 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

[125 to 175 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

9-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Target Temp. After Ready 082

*ENG

[140 to 165 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the target temperature for the maintain mode after the machine has reached the target temperature in warm-up mode. Recovery Target Temp.

083

*ENG

[140 to 160 / 155 / 1 deg /step]

Specifies the target temperature for the print mode without printing/copying job after the machine's recovery. *ENG

088 Thick 2: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

089 Thick 3: FC: Simplex: Center

*ENG

090 Thick 3: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

091 Thick 3: BW: Simplex: Center

*ENG

092 Thick 3: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

109 M-Thick:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

110 M-Thick:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

111 M-Thick: BW: Simplex:Center

*ENG

112 M-Thick: BW: Duplex:Center

*ENG

113 M-Thick: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

114 M-Thick: FC: Duplex: Ends

*ENG

115 M-Thick: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

116 M-Thick: BW: Duplex: Ends

*ENG

120 Plain2: FC: Simplex:Center

*ENG

121 Plain2: FC: Simplex:Ends

*ENG

122 Plain2: FC: Duplex:Center

*ENG

123 Plain2: FC: Duplex:Ends

*ENG

SM Appendix

[135 to 180 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

[135 to 180 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

[125 to 175 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

[125 to 175 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

9-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

087 Thick 2: FC: Simplex: Ends

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 124 Plain2: BW: Simplex:Center

*ENG

125 Plain2: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

126 Plain2: BW: Duplex:Center

*ENG

127 Plain2: BW: Duplex: Ends

*ENG

128 F: Plain1: FC : Simplex:Center

*ENG

129 F: Plain1: FC : Simplex: Ends

*ENG

130 F: Plain1: BW : Simplex:Center

*ENG

131 F: Plain1: BW : Simplex: Ends

*ENG

132 F: Plain2: FC: Simplex:Center

*ENG

133 F: Plain2: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

134 F: Plain2: BW: Simplex:Center

*ENG

135 F: Plain2: BW: Simplex: Ends

*ENG

136

137

138

139

F: Middle Thick: FC:

F: Middle Thick: FC: Simplex: Ends

*ENG [110 to 160 / 130 / 1 deg /step]

F: Middle Thick: BW:

*ENG

Simplex:Center F: Middle Thick: BW: Simplex:

*ENG

142 Glossy: Plain1:Center

*ENG

143 Glossy: Plain1: Ends

*ENG

144 Glossy: Plain2:Center

*ENG

145 Glossy: Plain2: Ends

*ENG

146 Glossy: MThick:Center

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[110 to 160 / 125 / 1 deg /step]

*ENG

Simplex:Center

Ends

[110 to 160 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

[110 to 160 / 125 / 1 deg/step]

[110 to 160 / 130 / 1 deg/step]

[110 to 160 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

9-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode *ENG

148 SP 4:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

149 SP 4:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

150 SP 4:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

151 SP 4:FC:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

152 SP 4:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

153 SP 4:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

154 SP 4:BW:Duplex:Center

*ENG

155 SP 4:BW:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

156 SP 5:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

157 SP 5:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

158 SP 5:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

159 SP 5:FC:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

160 SP 5:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

161 SP 5:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

162 SP 5:BW:Duplex:Center

*ENG

163 SP 5:BW:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

164 SP 6:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

165 SP 6:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

166 SP 6:FC:Duplex:Center

*ENG

167 SP 6:FC:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

168 SP 6:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

169 SP 6:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

SM Appendix

[135 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

[135 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

[135 to 180 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

[135 to 180 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

9-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

147 Glossy: MThick: Ends

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 170 SP 6:BW:Duplex:Center

*ENG

171 SP 6:BW:Duplex:Ends

*ENG

172 F:SP 1:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

173 F:SP 1:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

174 F:SP 1:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

175 F:SP 1:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

176 F:SP 2:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

177 F:SP 2:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

178 F:SP 2:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

179 F:SP 2:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

180 F:SP 3:FC:Simplex:Center

*ENG

181 F:SP 3:FC:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

182 F:SP 3:BW:Simplex:Center

*ENG

183 F:SP 3:BW:Simplex:Ends

*ENG

[110 to 160 / 130 / 1 deg/step]

[110 to 160 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

[110 to 160 / 125 / 1 deg/step]

[Fusing Temperature Display] Fusing Temperature Display (Heating or 1106

Pressure) Displays the current temperature of the heating and pressure rollers.

001 Fusing Roller: Center

-

[–20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

002 Fusing Roller: Ends

-

[–10 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

The heating roller has two lamps. One heats the center of the heating roller and the other heats both ends of the heating roller. 003 Pressure Roller: Center

-

[–10 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

004 Pressure Roller:Ends

-

[–10 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode The pressure roller has one lamp.

1108

[Ready Temp Setting] Japan use only

007 Ready Temp Time

1109

*ENG

[22 to 60 / 22 / 0.1 sec/step]

[Fusing Nip Band Check] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1] Executes the nip band measurement

001

Execute

between fusing belt and pressure roller.

-

If the nip band width is not 8 mm, and fusing is not good, replace the pressure roller or install a new fusing unit.

Pre-Idling Time

002

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the fusing rotation time before executing SP1109-001. Stop Time

003

* ENG

[5 to 30 / 20 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the time for measuring the nip.

1112

001

[Environmental Correct: Fusing] Temp.: Threshold: Low

*ENG

[10 to 23 / 17 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for low temperature condition.

002

Temp.: Threshold: High

*ENG

[24 to 40 / 30 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for high temperature condition. *ENG

[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

003 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller. When the low temperature condition (specified with SP1112-001) is detected, the value of this SP is added to the heating roller temperature.

SM Appendix

9-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Low Temp. Correction

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode High Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

004 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller. When the high temperature condition (specified with SP1112-002) is detected, the value of this SP is subtracted from the heating roller temperature. 005 Offset Temp:Low

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 6.5 / 0.1 deg/step]

006 Offset Temp:High

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 5 / 0.1 deg/step]

1113

[Stand-by Mode Setting]

001

Wait Time AF Ready

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 20 / 1 sec/step]

Wait Time AF Recovery

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

003

Specifies the time for keeping the target temperature after recovery (SP1105-083) without any jobs.

004

Wait Time AF Job

*ENG

005

P-Roll Thresh AF Ready

*ENG

006

P-Roll Thresh AF Job

*ENG

008

ON/OFF Time SW Timer

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 sec/step]

1115

[Stand-by Idling] *ENG

[0 to 240 / 60 / 1 min/step]

Interval 001

[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

[0 to 160 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the interval between idling during stand-by mode. This idling during the stand-by mode prevents the roller deformation.

002

Idling Time

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 2 / 0.1 sec/step]

Specifies the length of each idling operation during stand-by mode. 003 Idling Speed

1116

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 mm/sec/step]

[Fusing Temp Change]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Center Temp. 1: 226–

ENG

[-10 / 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

010 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-018. Ends Temp. 1: 226–

ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

011 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-018. Center Temp. 2: 226–

ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

012 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-019. Ends Temp. 2: 226–

ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

013 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-019. Center Temp. 3: –226

ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

014 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-020. Ends Temp. 3: –226

ENG

[-10 to 10 / -5 / 1 deg/step]

015 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-020. Center Temp. 4: –226

ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-021.

SM Appendix

9-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

016 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Ends Temp. 4: –226

ENG

[-10 to 10 / -10 / 1 deg/step]

017 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-021. Control Time 1: 226–

018

ENG

[0 to 250 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-010 and -011. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper. Control Time 2: 226–

019

ENG

[0 to 250 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-012 and -013. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper. Control Time 3: –226

020

ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-014 and -015. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper. Control Time 4: –226

021

ENG

[0 to 250 / 60 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-016 and -017. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper.

022 Center Temp.1:Duplex:226-

ENG

023 Ends Temp.1:Duplex:226-

ENG

024 Center Temp.2:Duplex:226-

ENG

025 Ends Temp.2:Duplex:226-

ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 026

027

Control Time 1 Duplex 226

ENG

Center Temp.3:MThick:-226 Control Time 2 Duplex 226

ENG

Ends Temp.3:MThick:-226

028 Center Temp.4:MThick:-226

ENG

029 Ends Temp.4:MThick:-226

ENG

030 Center Temp.1:Other:226-

ENG

031 Ends Temp.1:Other:226-

ENG

032 Center Temp.2:Other:226-

ENG

033 Ends Temp.2:Other:226-

ENG

034 Center Temp.3:Other:-226

ENG

035 Ends Temp.3:Other:-226

ENG

036 Center Temp.4:Other:-226

ENG

037 Ends Temp.4:Other:-226

ENG

1117

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

[-10 to 10 / -5 / 1 deg/step]

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

[Idling Time After Heater OFF] After Ready

001

[-10 to 10 / -5 / 1 deg/step]

ENG

[0 to 4 / 4 / 1 sec/step] DFU

Specifies the idling time without the lamp on after reaching the ready temperature. After Job End

002

ENG

[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the idling time without the lamp on after job end. This idling prevents the heating roller overheating after job end.

[Curl Temp Correction]

001 Operation Pattern

SM Appendix

*ENG

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1118

[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]

9-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Humidity Thresh 1

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %]

003 Humidity Thresh 2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %]

004 Pattern 1: MM: H-Roll

*ENG

[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]

005 Pattern 1: MM: P-Roll

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

006 Pattern 1: HM: H-Roll

*ENG

[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]

007 Pattern 1: HM: P-Roll

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

008 Pattern 2: MM: H-Roll

*ENG

[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]

009 Pattern 2: MM: P-Roll

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

010 Pattern 2: HM: H-Roll

*ENG

[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]

011 Pattern 2: HM: P-Roll

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]

1119

[Fusing FF Correct]

001 Plain: Center

*ENG

002 Plain: Ends

*ENG

003 Thin: Center

*ENG

004 Thin: Ends

*ENG

005 M-Thick: Center

*ENG

006 M-Thick: Ends

*ENG

007 Thick1: Center

*ENG

008 Thick1: Ends

*ENG

009 Thick2: Center

*ENG

010 Thick2: Ends

*ENG

011 Thick3: Center

*ENG

012 Thick3: Ends

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %]

[0 to 100 / 50 / 1 %]

[0 to 100 / 70 / 1 %]

9-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 013 OHP: Center

*ENG

014 OHP: Ends

*ENG

015 SP 1: Center

*ENG

016 SP 1: Ends

*ENG

017 SP 2: Center

*ENG

018 SP 2: Ends

*ENG

019 SP 3:: Center

*ENG

020 SP 3: Ends

*ENG

021 Envir. Correct:Low

*ENG

022 Envir. Correct:High

*ENG

023 Envir. Correct: Center

*ENG

024 FF Correct:Ends

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 40 / 1 %]

[0 to 100 / 70 / 1 %]

[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %]

[-100 to 100 / 10 / 1 %]

[-100 to 100 / 0 / 1 %]

[FF Correct Time] 025 FF Correct Time

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 sec]

[FF Control thresh] 026 Offset:Center

*ENG

027 Offset:Ends

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 25 / 1 deg]

[FF Start Time] *ENG

[0 to 10000 / 1900 / 1msec]

029 Fgate Timer:BW:Full

*ENG

[0 to 10000 / 5300 / 100msec]

030 Fgate Timer:BW:Full

*ENG

[0 to 10000 / 0 / 100msec]

031 Fgate Timer:BW:Half

*ENG

[0 to 10000 / 400 / 100msec] Appendix: SP Mode Tables

028 Fgate Timer:FC:Full

[FF Correct Time]

SM Appendix

9-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 032 Time Set:Full

*ENG

033 Time Set:Half

*ENG

034 SP 4:Center

*ENG

035 SP 4:Ends

*ENG

036 SP 5:Center

*ENG

037 SP 5:Ends

*ENG

038 SP 6:Center

*ENG

039 SP 6:Ends

*ENG

1120

[100 to 0 / 70 / 1msec]

[100 to 0 / 60 / 1msec]

[Multi-Print Mode] Feed Condition

001

[-5000 to 5000 / 0 / 100msec]

*ENG

[0 or 2 / 0 / 1]

Selects the paper feed timing. 0: Productivity priority, 1: Fusing quality priory

1159

[Fusing Jam Detection] SC Display

001

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]

Enables or disables the fusing consecutive jam (three times) SC detection. 0: No detection, 1: Detection

1801

[Motor Speed Adjust] FA

001 Regist Mot:60:Thick

*ENG

002 Regist Mot:120

*ENG

003 Bk OpcDevMot:120

*ENG

004 Bk OpcDevMot:60:Thick

*ENG

005 Color OpcMot:120

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[–4 to 4 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]

[–4 to 4 / –0.4 / 0.01 %/step]

[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 %/step]

9-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 006 Color OpcMot:60

*ENG

007 Fusing Mot:120

*ENG

[–6 to 6 / -0.4 / 0.01 %/step]

008 Fusing Mot:60:Thick

*ENG

[–6 to 6 / -0.05 / 0.01 %/step]

009 Transfer Mot:120

*ENG

[–4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %/step]

010 TransferMot:60:Thick

*ENG

[–4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %/step]

011 Feed1:CW60:Thick

*ENG

012 Feed1:CW120

*ENG

013 Feed1:CCW60:Thick

*ENG

014 Feed1:CCW120

*ENG

015 Feed12:CW60:Thick

*ENG

016 Feed12:CW120

*ENG

017 Feed12:CCW60:Thick

*ENG

018 Feed12:CCW120

*ENG

019 By-pass:60:Thick

*ENG

020 By-pass:120

*ENG

021 Reverse:CW60:Thick

*ENG

022 Reverse:CW120

*ENG

023 Reverse:CCW60:Thick

*ENG

024 Reverse:CCW120

*ENG

025 Duplex Entrance:60

*ENG

026 Duplex Entrance:120

*ENG

027 Duplex Exit:60

*ENG

028 Duplex Exit:120

*ENG

SM Appendix

[–2 to 2 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]

[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.05 %/step]

9-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[–2 to 2 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 029 R-Tray Exit Motor

*ENG

[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.05 %/step]

030 Fine Adj. Control

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 /1]

031 Offset:120:Color

*ENG

032 Offset:60:Color

*ENG

033 Regist Mot:60:1200dpi

*ENG

034 Feed1:CW60:1200dpi

*ENG

035 Feed1:CCW60:1200dpi

*ENG

036 Feed12:CW60:1200dpi

*ENG

037 Feed12:CCW60:1200dpi

*ENG

038 By-pass:60:1200dpi

*ENG

039 Reverse:CW60:1200dpi

*ENG

040 Reverse:CCW60:1200dpi

*ENG

041 Fusing:Thin Nrml Mid

*ENG

[–6 to 6 / -0.05 / 0.01 %/step]

042 BkOpcDevMot:60:1200dpi

*ENG

[–4 to 4 / -0.4 / 0.01 %/step]

043 TransferMot:60:1200dpi

*ENG

[–4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %/step]

1802

[–4 to 4 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]

[–2 to 2 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]

[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.05 %/step]

[CPM Setting]

001 -

1803

[-7 to 7 / 0 /1step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

[Sub Mag ADJ]

001 Plain:600dpi:input

*ENG

002 Plain:1200dpi:input

*ENG

003 Thick:input

*ENG

004 Plain:600dpi:result

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

9-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 005 Plain:1200dpi:result

*ENG

006 Thick:result

*ENG

1902

[Drum Phase Adj.]

001 Execute

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]

-

Execute drum phase adjustment. [0 to 3 / 0 / 1] Displays the result of drum phase

002 Result

*ENG

adjustment. 0: Successfully done 2: Sampling failure 3: Insufficient detection number [0 or 1 / 1 / 1]

003 Auto Execution

*ENG

Turns the automatic drum phase adjustment on or off. 0: Off, 1: On

1907

[Inverter Timing Adj]

001 Inverter Position Adj.

*ENG

[–10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Feed Timing Adj] 002 R-Tray J-Gate SOL:ON

*ENG

003 R-Tray J-Gate SOL:OFF

*ENG

[Fan Cooling Time Set]

001 Development Fan1

*ENG

002 Development Fan2

*ENG

003 Imaging Fan

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 600 / 0 / 1sec/step]

9-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1950

[–10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004 Fusing Exit Sn Fan

*ENG

005 Fusing Exit Fan

*ENG

006 Electrical Fan

*ENG

007 PSU Fan

*ENG

008 Solenoid Cooling Fan

*ENG

SP2-XXX (Drum) [Charge DC V:Fixed] 2005

(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color) Paper Type –> Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2 Adjusts the DC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes. Charge bias (DC component) is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, adjusting these settings does not effect while process control mode (SP3-041-1 Default: ON) is activated. When deactivating process control mode with SP3-041-1, the values in these SP modes are used for printing.

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: C

*ENG

003 Plain: M

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

007 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

008 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 600 / 10 –V/step]

[Charge DC V:Fixed] 2006

(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color) Paper Type –> Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the AC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes. Charge bias (AC component) is adjusted by environment correction (SP2-007-xxx to SP2-011-xxx). These SPs are activated only when SP2-012-1 is set to "1: manual control". 001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: C

*ENG

003 Plain: M

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

011 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

012 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 2100 / 10V/step]

[Charge AC A: LL] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for LL 2007

(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for LL environment (Low temperature and Low humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 760 / 10 ųA/step]

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 750 / 10 ųA/step]

[0 to 3000 / 710 / 10 ųA/step]

[Charge AC A: ML] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MM (Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for ML environment (Middle temperature and Low humidity). DFU

SM Appendix

9-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2008

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 760 / 10 ųA/step]

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 750 / 10 ųA/step]

[0 to 3000 / 740 / 10 ųA/step]

[Charge AC A: MM] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MM 2009

(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MM environment (Middle temperature and Middle humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 790 / 10 ųA/step]

[0 to 3000 / 850 / 10 ųA/step]

[Charge AC A: MH] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MH 2010

(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MH environment (Middle temperature and High humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 840 / 10 ųA/step]

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 880 / 10 ųA/step]

[0 to 3000 / 820 / 10 ųA/step]

[Charge AC A: HH] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for HH 2011

(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for HH environment

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode (High temperature and High humidity). DFU 001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 840 / 10 ųA/step]

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 940 / 10 ųA/step]

2012

[0 to 3000 / 860 / 10 ųA/step]

[Charge Output Control] Selects the AC voltage control type. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 AC Voltage

*ENG

0: Process control 1: Manual control (AC voltages are decided with SP2006.)

2013

[Envir. Correct:PCU] Displays the environmental condition, which is measured in absolute humidity. [1 to 5 / – / 1 /step]

001 Envir. Range:FC:Display

*ENG

1: LL (LL <= 4.3 g/m3) 2: ML (4.3 < ML <= 11.3 g/m3) 3: MM (11.3 < MM <= 18.0 g/m3) 4: MH (18.0 < MH <= 24.0 g/m3) 5: HH (24.0 g/m3 < HH) Selects the environmental condition manually.

002 Forced Setting

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: The environmental condition is 1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH

003 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 1

SM Appendix

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold

9-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

determined automatically.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode between LL and ML. [0 to 100 / 4.3 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Changes the humidity threshold 004 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 2

*ENG

between ML and MM. [0 to 100 / 11.3 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Changes the humidity threshold

005 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 3

*ENG

between MM and MH. [0 to 100 / 18.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Changes the humidity threshold

006 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 4

*ENG

between MH and HH. [0 to 100 / 24.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

007 Current Temp.: Display

*ENG

008 Relative Humidity: Display

*ENG

009 Absolute Humidity: Display

*ENG

Displays the current temperature. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step] Displays the current relative humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step] Displays the absolute humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Displays the previous environmental

010

condition, which is measured in

Previous Envir. Range:

*ENG

Display

absolute humidity. [1 to 5 / – / 1 /step] 1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH

011 Previous Temp.: Display

*ENG

Displays the previous temperature. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step] Displays the previous relative

012 Relative Humidity: Display

*ENG

humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step] Displays the previous absolute

013 Absolute Humidity: Display

*ENG

humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

2014

[Charge AC Control: Setting]

001 Main Interval: Power ON

*ENG

002 Main Interval: Print

*ENG

003 Sub: Interval

*ENG

[0 to 500 / 10 / 1 page/step]

004 Sub:Thresh Temp

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 25 / 1 deg/step]

005 Sub:R-Humid Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

006 Sub:A-Humid Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 12 / 1 g/m3/step]

007 Main:Temp Change Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 deg/step]

008 Main:RH Change Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

009 Main:AH Change Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

010 Sub:Temp Change Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 deg/step]

011 Sub:RH Change Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 5 / 1 %RH/step]

012 Sub:AH Change Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 g/m3/step]

013 Non-use Time

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 10 min/step]

014 Correction Coeff.

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 1 / 0.01 kV/mA/step]

2015

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

[Charge AC Adj: Result] *ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 M

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Bk

SM Appendix

9-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [Color Regist Adjust] FA These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment 2101

and are adjusted at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.

001 Bk: Main Scan: Dot

*ENG

002 C Main Scan: Dot

*ENG

003 M Main Scan: Dot

*ENG

004 Y Main Scan: Dot

*ENG

013 Bk: Sub Scan: Line

*ENG

014 C: Sub Scan: Line

*ENG

015 M: Sub Scan: Line

*ENG

016 Y: Sub Scan: Line

*ENG

2102

[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

[Magnification Adjust] DFU

001 Main Mag.: Bk:High Spd

*ENG

003 Main Mag.: Bk:Low Spd

*ENG

004 Main Mag.: C:High Spd

*ENG

006 Main Mag.: C:Low Spd

*ENG

007 Main Mag.: M:High Spd

*ENG

009 Main Mag.: M:Low Spd

*ENG

010 Main Mag.: Y:High Spd

*ENG

012 Main Mag.: Y:Low Spd

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

These are results of the main scan length adjustment. [0 to 560 / 280 / 1 /step]

9-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 2103

[Erase Margin Adjust] (Area, Paper Size) Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins.

001 Lead Edge

*ENG

002 Trailing Edge

*ENG

003 Left

*ENG

004 Right

*ENG

2104

[0 to 9.9 / 2 / 0.1 mm/step]

[LD Initial Power Adjust]

001 Bk

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 M

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

2105

[0 to 9.9 / 4.2 / 0.1 mm/step]

[80 to 120 / 100 / 1 %/step]

[LD Power Adjust] (Process Speed, Color) Adjusts the LD power of each color for each process speed. Each LD power setting is decided by process control. High Speed: 120 mm/sec,Low Speed: 60 mm/sec *ENG

002 C: High Speed

*ENG

003 M: High Speed

*ENG

004 Y: High Speed

*ENG

009 Bk: Low Speed

*ENG

010 C: Low Speed

*ENG

011 M: Low Speed

*ENG

012 Y: Low Speed

*ENG

SM Appendix

[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step] Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the output. Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the output.

9-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Bk: High Speed

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

2106

[Polygon Rotation Time] Adjusts the time of the polygon motor rotation. DFU

001 Warming-Up

*ENG

002 Job End

*ENG

2107

[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

[Image Parameter] DFU

001 Image Gamma Flag

*ENG

002 Shading Correction Flag

*ENG

2109

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]

[Test Pattern] Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD. [0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step] 0 None 1: Vertical Line (1dot) 2: Vertical Line (2dot) 3: Horizontal (1dot) 4: Horizontal (2dot) 5: Grid Vertical Line 6: Grid Horizontal Line

003 Pattern Selection

-

7: Grid pattern Small 8: Grid pattern Large 9: Argyle Pattern Small 10: Argyle Pattern Large 11. Independent Pattern (1dot) 12. Independent Pattern (2dot) 13. Independent Pattern (4dot) 14. Trimming Area 16: Hound’s Tooth Check (Horizontal)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 17: Band (Horizontal) 18: Band (Vertical) 19: Checker Flag Pattern 20: Grayscale Vertical Margin 21: Grayscale Horizontal Margin 23: Full Dot Pattern Specifies the color for the test pattern. 005 Color Selection

[1 to 4 / 1 / 1/step]

-

1: All colors, 2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan

006 Density: Bk

-

007 Density: C

-

008 Density: M

-

009 Density: Y

-

2111

Specifies the color density for the test pattern. [0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step] 0: Lightest density 15: Darkest density

[Line Pos. Ajust] Executes the fine line position adjustment twice.

001 Execute: Mode a

-

If this SP is not completed (NG is displayed), do SP2111-003 first and then try this SP again. Executes the fine line position adjustment

002 Execute:Mode b

-

once. If this SP is not completed, do SP2111-003 first and then try this SP again. Executes the rough line position adjustment once.

-

After doing this SP, make sure to execute SP2111-001 or -002. Otherwise, the line position adjustment is not perfectly done.

SM Appendix

9-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Execute:Mode c

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 2112

[TM/P Sensor Test] ID Sensor Check FA This SP is used to check the ID sensors at

001 Execute

the factory. The results of this SP are displayed in SP2140 to SP2145.

[Skew Adjustment]

2117

Specifies a skew adjustment value for the skew motor M, C or Y. These SPs must be used when a new laser optics housing unit is installed or when SC285 occurs. For details, see “Laser Optics Housing Unit” in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section.

001 Pulse: C

*ENG

002 Pulse: M

*ENG

003 Pulse: Y

*ENG

2118

[–75 to 75 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[Skew Adjustment]

001 Execute: C

*ENG

002 Execute: M

*ENG

Changes the current skew adjustment values to the values specified with SP2117. These SPs must be used when a new laser optics housing unit is installed or when

003 Execute: Y

SC285 occurs. For details, see “Laser

*ENG

Optics Housing Unit” in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section.

2119

[Skew Adjustment Display] Displays the current skew adjustment value for each skew motor.

001 C

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 Y

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[–75 to 75 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

9-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [P-Sensor Test] 2140

Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 PWM

*ENG

[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 PWM: Front

*ENG

006 PWM: Center

*ENG

007 PWM: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 1024 / 0 / 1/step]

[P-Sensor Test] 2141

Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 Average

*ENG

[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Average: Front

*ENG

006 Average: Center

*ENG

007 Average: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[P-Sensor Test] DFU 2142

Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control

001 Maximum

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[TM-Sensor Test] DFU

SM Appendix

9-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 005 Maximum: Front

*ENG

006 Maximum: Center

*ENG

007 Maximum: Rear

*ENG

[P-Sensor Test] DFU 2143

Displays the minimum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 Minimum

*ENG

[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Minimum: Front

*ENG

006 Minimum: Center

*ENG

007 Minimum: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[P-Sensor Test] DFU 2144

Displays the maximum result 2 values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 Maximum 2:

*ENG

[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Maximum 2: Front

*ENG

006 Maximum 2: Center

*ENG

007 Maximum 2: Rear

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

9-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [P-Sensor Test] DFU 2145

Displays the minimum result 2 values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 Minimum 2

*ENG

[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Minimum 2: Front

*ENG

006 Minimum 2: Center

*ENG

007 Minimum 2: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[Area Mag. Correction] LD Pulse Area Correction (Color, Area) FA Adjusts the magnification for each area. The main scan (297 mm) is divided 2150

into 8 areas. Area 1 is at the front side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 8 is at the rear side of the machine (right side of the image). Decreasing a value makes the image shift to the left side on the print. Increasing a value makes the image shift to the right side on the print. 1 pulse = 1/16 dot *ENG

028 Bk: Area1

*ENG

029 Bk: Area2

*ENG

030 Bk: Area3

*ENG

031 Bk: Area4

*ENG

032 Bk: Area5

*ENG

033 Bk: Area6

*ENG

034 Bk: Area7

*ENG

035 Bk: Area8

*ENG

SM Appendix

[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step ]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

027 Bk: Area0

9-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 079 C: Area0

*ENG

080 C: Area

*ENG

081 C: Area2

*ENG

082 C: Area3

*ENG

083 C: Area4

*ENG

084 C: Area5

*ENG

085 C: Area6

*ENG

086 C: Area7

*ENG

087 C: Area8

*ENG

131 M: Area0

*ENG

132 M: Area1

*ENG

133 M: Area2

*ENG

134 M: Area3

*ENG

135 M: Area4

*ENG

136 M: Area5

*ENG

137 M: Area6

*ENG

138 M: Area7

*ENG

139 M: Area8

*ENG

183 Y: Area0

*ENG

[–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

184 Y: Area1

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.

185 Y: Area2

*ENG

186 Y: Area3

*ENG

187 Y: Area4

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [–255 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

[–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

9-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 188 Y: Area5

*ENG

189 Y: Area6

*ENG

190 Y: Area7

*ENG

191 Y: Area8

*ENG

[Shading Correct Setting] FA Adjusts the area correction value for each LD power. The main scan is divided into 16 areas. However, the image areas are limited 2152

from area 1 to area 14. For BK and Magenta, area 1 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 14 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image). For Cyan and Yellow, area 1 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image) and area 14 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image). *ENG

002 Bk: Area 1

*ENG

003 Bk: Area 2

*ENG

004 Bk: Area 3

*ENG

005 Bk: Area 4

*ENG

006 Bk: Area 5

*ENG

007 Bk: Area 6

*ENG

008 Bk: Area 7

*ENG

009 Bk: Area 8

*ENG

010 Bk: Area 9

*ENG

011 Bk: Area 10

*ENG

012 Bk: Area 11

*ENG

013 Bk: Area 12

*ENG

SM Appendix

This is for the synchronizing detection board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Bk: Area 0

9-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 014 Bk: Area 13

*ENG

015 Bk: Area 14

*ENG

016 Bk: Area 15

*ENG

033 C: Area 0

*ENG

034 C: Area 1

*ENG

035 C: Area 2

*ENG

036 C: Area 3

*ENG

037 C: Area 4

*ENG

038 C: Area 5

*ENG

039 C: Area 6

*ENG

040 C: Area 7

*ENG

041 C: Area 8

*ENG

042 C: Area 9

*ENG

043 C: Area 10

*ENG

044 C: Area 11

*ENG

045 C: Area 12

*ENG

046 C: Area 13

*ENG

047 C: Area 14

*ENG

048 C: Area 15

*ENG

This is out of the image area. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is for the synchronizing detection board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step] This is for the synchronizing detection

065 M: Area 0

*ENG

board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

066 M: Area 1

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

9-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 067 M: Area 2

*ENG

068 M: Area 3

*ENG

069 M: Area 4

*ENG

070 M: Area 5

*ENG

071 M: Area 6

*ENG

072 M: Area 7

*ENG

073 M: Area 8

*ENG

074 M: Area 9

*ENG

075 M: Area 10

*ENG

076 M: Area 11

*ENG

077 M: Area 12

*ENG

078 M: Area 13

*ENG

079 M: Area 14

*ENG

080 M: Area 15

*ENG

This is out of the image area. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step] This is for the synchronizing detection

097 Y: Area 0

*ENG

board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

*ENG

099 Y: Area 2

*ENG

100 Y: Area 3

*ENG

101 Y: Area 4

*ENG

102 Y: Area 5

*ENG

103 Y: Area 6

*ENG

SM Appendix

[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

098 Y: Area 1

9-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 104 Y: Area 7

*ENG

105 Y: Area 8

*ENG

106 Y: Area 9

*ENG

107 Y: Area 10

*ENG

108 Y: Area 11

*ENG

109 Y: Area 12

*ENG

110 Y: Area 13

*ENG

111 Y: Area 14

*ENG

112 Y: Area 15

*ENG

2160

[Vertical Line Width] DFU

001 600dpi:Bk

*ENG

002 600dpi:C

*ENG

003 600dpi:M

*ENG

004 600dpi:Y

*ENG

005 1200dpi:Bk

*ENG

006 1200dpi:C

*ENG

007 1200dpi:M

*ENG

008 1200dpi:Y

*ENG

2180

This is out of the image area.

[10 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

[Line Pos. Adj. Clear]

001 Color Regist.

-

003 MUSIC Result

-

004 Area Mag. Correction

-

D037/D038/D040/D041

DFU

9-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

2181

[Line Pos. Adj. Result] Displays the values for each correction. ƒ

"Paper Int. Mag: Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value between two sheets of paper.

ƒ

"Mag.Cor. Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value.

ƒ

"M. Scan Erro." indicates the shift correction value in the main scan direction.

ƒ

"S. Scan Erro." Indicates the shift correction value in the sub scan direction.

ƒ

"M. Cor.: Dot" indicates the dot correction value in the main scan direction.

ƒ

"M. Cor.: Subdot" indicates the sub dot correction value in the main scan direction. Bk: Black, M: Magenta, C: Cyan, Y: Yellow

001 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Bk

*ENG

[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

002 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Bk

*ENG

[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

003 Skew: C

*ENG

004 Bent: C

*ENG

005 M. Scan Shift: Left: C

*ENG

006 M. Scan Shift: Center: C

*ENG

007 M. Scan Shift: Right: C

*ENG

008 S. Scan Shift: Left: C

*ENG

009 S. Scan Shift: Center: C

*ENG

010 S. Scan Shift: Right: C

*ENG

011 M. Cor.: Dot: C

*ENG

[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

012 M. Cor.: Subdot: C

*ENG

[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

013 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: C

*ENG

[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

014 Mag.Cor. Subdot: C

*ENG

SM Appendix

[–5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

9-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

ƒ

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 015 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

016 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

017 S. Cor.: 600 Line: C

*ENG

[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

018 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot: C

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

019 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: C

*ENG

[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

020 S. Cor.: 1200 Subdot: C

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

021 Skew: M

*ENG

022 Bent: M

*ENG

023 M. Scan Shift: Left: M

*ENG

024 M. Scan Shift: Center: M

*ENG

025 M. Scan Shift: Right: M

*ENG

026 S. Scan Shift: Left: M

*ENG

027 S. Scan Shift: Center: M

*ENG

028 S. Scan Shift: Right: M

*ENG

029 M. Cor.: Dot: M

*ENG

[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

030 M. Cor.: Subdot: M

*ENG

[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

031 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: M

*ENG

032 Mag.Cor. Subdot: M

*ENG

033 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

034 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

035 S. Cor.: 600 Line: M

*ENG

[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

036 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot: M

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

037 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: M

*ENG

[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

[–5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

9-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 038 S. Cor.: 1200 Subdot: M

*ENG

039 Skew: Y

*ENG

040 Bent: Y

*ENG

041 M. Scan Shift: Left: Y

*ENG

042 M. Scan Shift: Center: Y

*ENG

043 M. Scan Shift: Right: Y

*ENG

044 S. Scan Shift: Left: Y

*ENG

045 S. Scan Shift: Center: Y

*ENG

046 S. Scan Shift: Right: Y

*ENG

047 M. Cor.: Dot: Y

*ENG

[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

048 M. Cor.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

049 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Y

*ENG

050 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Y

*ENG

051 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

052 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

053 S. Cor.: 600 Line: Y

*ENG

[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

054 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot: Y

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

055 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: Y

*ENG

[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

056 S. Cor.: 1200 Subdot: Y

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

057 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

058 Drum Cor.:600:Subdot

*ENG

[–7 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

059 S. Cor.:1200 Subdot

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

060 Drum Cor.:1200:Subdot

*ENG

[–7 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

SM Appendix

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

[–5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

9-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [Line Position Adj. Offset] 2182

(Color) M. Scan: Main scan, S. Scan: Sub-scan High / Medium: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 C Magnification

*ENG

002 M Magnification

*ENG

Adjusts the line position manually. [-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001%/step] When line shifts are not corrected by the automatic line position adjustment, do this SP.

003 Y Magnification

*ENG

Increasing a value reduces the image in the main scan direction. Decreasing a value enlarges the image in the main scan direction.

004 M. Scan: High: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

005 M. Scan: High: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

008 M. Scan: Low: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

009 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

010 M. Scan: High: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

011 M. Scan: High: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

014 M. Scan: Low: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

015 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

016 M. Scan: High: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

017 M. Scan: High: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

020 M. Scan: Low: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

021 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

022 S. Scan: High: Dot: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]

023 S. Scan: High: Subdot: C

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

026 S. Scan: Low: Dot: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 027 S. Scan: Low: Subdot: C

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

028 S. Scan: High: Dot: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]

029 S. Scan: High: Subdot: M

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

032 S. Scan: Low: Dot: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]

033 S. Scan: Low: Subdot: M

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

034 S. Scan: High: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]

035 S. Scan: High: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

038 S. Scan: Low: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]

039 S. Scan: Low: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

040 C:Skew

*ENG

041 M:Skew

*ENG

042 Y:Skew

*ENG

[Line Pos. Adj. Mode]

001 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: Bk

*ENG

002 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

003 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

004 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

005 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

006 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

007 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

008 Area Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

009 Area Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

010 Area Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

SM Appendix

DFU [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 boolean/step]

DFU [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 boolean /step] 0: Disable correction 1: Enable correction

DFU [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 boolean /step]

9-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2190

[-50 to 50 / 0 / 1um]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode DFU [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 boolean /step] 011 S. Scan Cor. Setting

*ENG

0: Adjusted with Bk 1: Adjusted in minimum shift among four colors

2191

[MUSIC Coeff Setting] Line Position Adjustment: Coefficient Setting DFU ch 0: ID sensor at rear, ch 1: ID sensor at center, ch 2: ID sensor at front

001 ch 0: Filter: Front: a1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]

002 ch 0: Filter: Front: a2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / –60488 / 1 bit/step]

003 ch 0: Filter: Front: b0

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

004 ch 0: Filter: Front: b1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]

005 ch 0: Filter: Front: b2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

006 ch 0: Filter: Rear: a1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]

007 ch 0: Filter: Rear: a2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / –63398 / 1 bit/step]

008 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b0

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

009 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]

010 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

011 ch 1: Filter: Front: a1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]

012 ch 1: Filter: Front: a2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / –60488 / 1 bit/step]

013 ch 1: Filter: Front: b0

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

014 ch 1: Filter: Front: b1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]

015 ch 1: Filter: Front: b2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

016 ch 1: Filter: Rear: a1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]

017 ch 1: Filter: Rear: a2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / –63398 / 1 bit/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 018 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b0

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

019 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]

020 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

021 ch 2: Filter: Front: a1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]

022 ch 2: Filter: Front: a2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / –60488 / 1 bit/step]

023 ch 2: Filter: Front: b0

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

024 ch 2: Filter: Front: b1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]

025 ch 2: Filter: Front: b2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

026 ch 2: Filter: Rear: a1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]

027 ch 2: Filter: Rear: a2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / –63398 / 1 bit/step]

028 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b0

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

029 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b1

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]

030 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b2

*ENG

[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

031 Q Format Selection

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]

[MUSIC Threshold Setting] Line Position Adjustment: Threshold Setting DFU ch 0: ID sensor at rear, ch 1: ID sensor at center, ch 2: ID sensor at front

001 ch 0: 1st

*ENG

002 ch 0: 2nd

*ENG

003 ch 0: 3rd

*ENG

004 ch 0: 4th

*ENG

005 ch 1: 1st

*ENG

006 ch 1: 2nd

*ENG

007 ch 1: 3rd

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0.5 to 3 / 1.4 / 0.1 V/step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2192

9-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 008 ch 1: 4th

*ENG

009 ch 2: 1st

*ENG

010 ch 2: 2nd

*ENG

011 ch 2: 3rd

*ENG

012 ch 2: 4th

*ENG

2193

001

[MUSIC Condition] Line Position Adjustment: Condition Setting Auto Execution

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

Enables/disables the automatic line position adjustment Page: Job End: BW+FC 002

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 500 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode after job end. Page: Job End: FC

003

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode after job end. Page: Interrupt: BW+FC

004

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode during job. Page: Interrupt: FC

005

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode during jobs. Page: Standby: BW + FC

006

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode. The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW printing mode reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is satisfied.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Page: Standby: FC

007

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode. The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in color printing mode reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is satisfied. Temp Change

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1deg/step]

008 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. Section Descriptions" section. Elapse Time

*ENG

[1 to 1440 / 300 / 1 minute/step]

009 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. Temp Change 2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1deg/step]

011 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. Elapse Time 2

*ENG

[1 to 9999 / 600 / 1 minute/step]

012 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. 016 Page: Power ON:BW+FC

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

[MUSIC Exe Result] Line Position Adjustment: Execution Result

001 Year

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 year/step]

002 Month

*ENG

[1 to 12 / 1 / 1 month/step]

003 Date

*ENG

[1 to 31 / 1 / 1 day/step]

SM Appendix

9-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2194

*ENG

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004 Hour

*ENG

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1 hour/step]

005 Minute

*ENG

[0 to 59 / 0 / 1 minute/step]

006 Temperature

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

007 Execution Result

*ENG

008 Number of Execution

*ENG

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]

009 Number of Failure

*ENG

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]

010 Error Counter: C

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]

011 Error Counter: M

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed

0: Not done 1: Completed successfully 2: Cannot detect patterns 3: Fewer lines on the pattern than the target

012 Error Counter: Y

*ENG

4: Not used 5: Out of the adjustment range 6 to 9: Not used

2197

[MUSIC Exe Time] DFU

001 Execution Time

*ENG

[10 to 40 / 20 / 10ms/step]

002 TM Sensor Position

*ENG

[48.2 to 500 / 48.2 / 0.1mm/step]

*ENG

[7.5 to 20 / 10 / 0.1 μs/step]

*ENG

[0.1 to 9.9 / 4 / 0.1 sec /step]

2198

[Music A/D Interval]

001 ADC Trigger Counter

2199

[Music Time Setting] DFU

001 Error Time Set

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 2220

[Skew Origin Set]

001 C:Skew Motor

*ENG -

002 M:Skew Motor 003 Y:Skew Motor

[LD Power: Fixed] LD Power Control 2221

Adjusts the fixed LD power for each line speed and color. These SPs are activated only when SP3-041-002 is set to "0". Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Bk:Normal Spd

*ENG

002 C:Normal Spd

*ENG

003 M:Normal Spd

*ENG

004 Y:Normal Spd

*ENG

009 Bk:Low Spd

*ENG

010 C:Low Spd

*ENG

011 M:Low Spd

*ENG

012 Y:Low Spd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1%/step] Increasing this value makes the image density darker.

[Dev. DC Bias:Fixed] Development DC Bias Adjustment Adjusts the development bias. Development bias is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, 2229

adjusting these settings has no effect while Process Control (SP3-041-001 Default: ON) is activated. After deactivating Process Control with SP3-041-001, the values in these SP Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Plain: Bk

SM Appendix

*ENG

[0 to 800 / 450 / 10 –V/step]

9-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

modes are used for printing.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2: Y

*ENG

2241

[Ambient Temp/Hum:Display] Displays the environment temperature and humidity.

001 Temperature

-

[–1280 to 1270 / - / 0.1deg/step]

002 Relative Humidity

-

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 %RH/step]

003 Absolute Humidity

-

[0 to 100 / - / 0.1 g/m3/step]

2302

[Env. Correct:Transfer] Environmental Correction: Image Transfer Belt Unit Forced Setting

*ENG

[0 to 6 / 0 / 1 /step]

Sets the environment condition manually. 0: Automatic environment control 002 1: LL (Low temperature/ Low humidity) 2: ML (Middle temperature/ Low humidity) 3: MM (Middle temperature/ Middle humidity) 4: MH (Middle temperature/ High humidity) 5: HH (High temperature/ High humidity)

003

Absolute Humidity: Threshold 1

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 4 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

Adjusts the threshold value between LL and ML.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004

Absolute Humidity: Threshold 2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 8 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

Adjusts the threshold value between ML and MM.

005

Absolute Humidity: Threshold 3

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 16 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

Adjusts the threshold value between MM and MH.

006

Absolute Humidity: Threshold 4

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 24 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

Adjusts the threshold value between MH and HH. 007 Temp Threshold

2308

*ENG

[–5 to 30 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

[Paper Size Correction] Adjusts the threshold value for the paper size correction. [0 to 350 / 290 / 1 mm/step]

001 Threshold 1

*ENG

Threshold 1 ≤ paper: Paper is detected as "S1" size. [0 to 350 / 250 / 1 mm/step]

002 Threshold 2

*ENG

Threshold 2 ≤ paper ≤ Threshold 1: Paper is detected as "S2" size. [0 to 350 / 194 / 1 mm/step]

003 Threshold 3

*ENG

Threshold 3 ≤ paper ≤ Threshold 2: Paper is detected as "S3" size. [0 to 350 / 150 / 1 mm/step] Threshold 4 ≤ paper ≤ Threshold 3:

004 Threshold 4

*ENG

Paper is detected as "S4" size. Paper ≤ Threshold 4:

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Paper is detected as "S5" size.

SM Appendix

9-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

2311

[Non Image Area: Bias] Adjusts the bias of the image transfer belt

001 Image Transfer

*ENG

between images. This value is added to the value of the image transfer belt bias. [10 to 250 / 100 / 5 %/step] Adjusts the bias of the paper transfer roller

002 Paper Transfer

*ENG

between images. [0 to 130 / 5 / 1 μA/step]

2316

[Power ON:Bias]

001 Image Transfer

2326

[0 to 60 / 5 / 1 μA /step]

[Transfer Roller CL: Bias] Transfer Roller Cleaning: Bias Adjustment Positive:before and

001

*ENG

after JOB

*ENG

[0 to 2100 / 250 / 10 V /step]

Adjusts the positive voltage of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller. Negative:before and 002

after JOB

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]

Adjusts the negative current of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller. Positive:after JAM 003

*ENG

[0 to 2100 / 2000 / 10 V/step]

Adjusts the positive current limit of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.

004 Negative:after JAM

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]

9-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 2351

001

[Common: BW: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: B/W: Bias Adjustment Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Image Transfer:Standard Speed

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 25 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for plain paper.

003

Image Transfer:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 13 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 1 paper.

2357

[Common: FC: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: Full Color: Bias Adjustment Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Image Transfer: Standard Spd:Bk

001

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 23 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer:: Standard Spd:C

002

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 22 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer: Standard Spd:M

003

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 25 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer: Standard Spd:Y

004

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 29 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer: Low Speed:Bk

009

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 13 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for

010

Image Transfer: Low Speed:C

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 12 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for

SM Appendix

9-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

thick 1 paper.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode thick 1 paper. Image Transfer: Low Speed:M 011

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 13 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for thick 1 paper. Image Transfer: Low Speed:Y

012

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 14 / 1 μA]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for thick 1 paper.

2360

-

[Common: BW Env. Correction Table] 001 Image Transfer: Standard

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 42 / 1 /step]

003 Image Transfer: Low

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 38 / 1 /step]

004 Image Transfer: Standard Spd:BK

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 25 / 1 /step]

005 Image Transfer: Standard Spd: C

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 46 / 1 /step]

006 Image Transfer: Standard Spd:M

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 43 / 1 /step]

007 Image Transfer:: Standard Spd:Y

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 45 / 1 /step]

012 Image Transfer: Low Speed:Bk

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 26 / 1 /step]

013 Image Transfer: Low Speed:C

*ENG

014 Image Transfer: Low Speed:M

*ENG

015 Image Transfer: Low Speed:Y

*ENG

[Common: FC Env. Correction Table]

[1 to 50 / 38 / 1 /step]

[1 to 50 / 45 / 1 /step]

[Plain: Bias: BW] 2403

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 23 / 1 –μA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 12 / 1 –μA /step]

[Plain: Bias: FC] 2407

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]

[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:BW] 2411

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)

005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

SM Appendix

9-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [100 to 4000 / 165 / 5%/step] 006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step]

007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 290 / 5%/step]

012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step]

014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step]

015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [100 to 4000 / 360 / 5%/step] 016 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5

*ENG

019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5

*ENG

020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 200 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 340 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 420 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:FC] 2412

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard l: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)

[100 to 4000 / 130 / 5%/step] 005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm

[100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step] 007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

SM Appendix

9-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

(Paper width)

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step] 008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step]

011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 320 / 5%/step]

012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step]

014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 465 / 5%/step]

016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2st Side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[100 to 4000 / 220 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 355 / 5%/step]

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5

*ENG

020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 565 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Plain-T:Size-Env.Correct:BW] 2413

Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)

[1 to 50 / 23 / 1/step] 005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 34 / 1/step]

007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 26 / 1/step]

008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm

[1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step] 009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

SM Appendix

9-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

(Paper width)

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step] 010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step]

011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]

012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]

014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]

015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]

016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2st Side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]

017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5

*ENG

150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]

018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5

*ENG

150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 41 / 1/step]

019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5

*ENG

150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step] 020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5

*ENG

150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Plain-T:Size-Env.Correct:FC] 2414

Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)

[1 to 50 / 37 / 1/step] 005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 16 / 1/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 32 / 1/step]

007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 24 / 1/step]

008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm

010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

SM Appendix

*ENG

9-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step] 250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

(Paper width)

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step] 011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 18 / 1/step]

012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step]

014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 22 / 1/step]

015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]

016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2st Side: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5

*ENG

019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5

*ENG

020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5

*ENG

2421

[1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Plain:L-Edge Correction]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2422.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Plain: Sw Timing: L-Edge]

2422

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Plain: T-Edge Correction] Plain Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the 2423

paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.

ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2424.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

SM Appendix

*ENG

9-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[Plain: Switch Timing: T-Edge]

2424

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

2430

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Plain: Environment Correction]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 39 / 1 /step]

004 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 26 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 39 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 33 / 1 /step]

009 PaperTransfer:BW:Low:1st

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: BW:Low:2nd

*ENG

011 Paper Transfer: FC: Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 45 / 1 /step]

012 Paper Transfer: FC: Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 31 / 1 /step]

2453

[1 to 50 / 25 / 1 /step]

[Thin: Bias: BW]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 –μA /step]

[Thin: Bias: FC] 2457

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 23 / 1 –μA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]

[Thin: L-Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2471

edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

2472

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

9-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

[Thin: T-Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the 2473

paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2474.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Switch Timing: T-Edge]

2474

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

2480

[-100 to 0 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thin: Env. Correct Table]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 24 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 38 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 32 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 44 / 1 /step]

2482

[Glossy: Bias: BW]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

9-70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 2483

[Glossy: Bias: FC]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

2485

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Glossy: Trailing Edge Correction] *ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5 %/step]

[Glossy: Trailing Edge Correction]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

2489

[10 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

*ENG

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

2488

*ENG

[Glossy: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

2487

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[Glossy: L-Edge Correction]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

2486

*ENG

*ENG

[-100 to 0 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Glossy: Environment Correction Table]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 17 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 21 / 1 /step]

[Thick 1: Bias: BW] 2502

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]

SM Appendix

9-71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Thick: 60 mm/sec

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [Thick 1: Bias: FC] 2507

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[Thick-T:Size Correct:BW] 2511

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 125 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 225 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 450 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 275 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 825 / 5%/step]

9-72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer:: 2nd: S5

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 400 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 1200 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick-T:Size Correct:FC] 2512

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 110 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 115 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 335 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 405 / 5%/step]

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4

SM Appendix

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 665 / 5%/step]

9-73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer:: 2nd: S5

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 690 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 1000 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick-T:Size-Env.Correct:BW] 2513

Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]

005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 21 / 1/step]

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 40 / 1/step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 8 / 1/step]

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step]

013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 5 / 1/step]

9-74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S5

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 20 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 3 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick-T:Size-Env.Correct:FC] 2514

Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 49 / 1/step]

005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 21 / 1/step]

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 50 / 1/step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 8 / 1/step]

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4

SM Appendix

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]

9-75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S5

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 6 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 3 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick 1:L-Edge Correct] Thick 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2521

edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2522.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 1: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

2522

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 1: T-Edge Correction] Thick 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2523

Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2524.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 1: Switch Timing: T-Edge]

2524

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

2530

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 1: Env. Correct Table]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 17 / 1 /step]

004 Paper Transfer: BW:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 15 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 29 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 19 / 1 /step]

[Thick 2: Bias: BW] 2553

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]

2558

[Thick 2: Bias: FC]

SM Appendix

9-77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Thick: 60 mm/sec

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in full color mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[Thick 2: L-Edge Correct] Thick 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2571

edge in each mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 2: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

2572

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2mm/step]

[Thick 2: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2573

edge in each mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2574.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick2:T-Edge Correct]

2574

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

2580

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 2 Env. Correct Table]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 36 / 1 /step]

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 13 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 23 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 19 / 1 /step]

[OHP: Bias: BW] 2603

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer

2608

*ENG

[0 to 200 / NA: 15, EU/AA: 13 / 1 –μA /step]

[OHP: Bias: FC]

001 Paper Transfer

SM Appendix

*ENG

[0 to 200 / NA: 24, EU/AA: 20 / 1 –μA /step]

9-79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in full color mode.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [OHP: L-Edge Correct] OHP: Leading Edge Correction

2621

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values. ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[OHP: Switch Timing: L-Edge] 2622

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[OHP: T-Edge Correct] OHP: Trailing Edge Correction

2623

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values. ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2624.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[OHP: Trailing Edge Correction] 2624

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer

2630

*ENG

[–100 to 0 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[OHP: Env. Correct Table]

002 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[1 to 50 / NA: 39, EU/AA: 26 / 1 /step]

9-80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 003 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / NA: 7, EU/AA: 47 / 1 /step]

[Thick 3: Bias: BW] 2651

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in black-and-white mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]

[Thick 3: Bias: FC] 2652

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in full color mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[Thick 3: L-Edge Correct] Thick 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2654

edge in each mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

2655

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image

SM Appendix

9-81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Thick 3: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode area. Thick: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 3: T-Edge Correct] Thick 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2656

edge in each mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2657.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 3: Trailing Edge Correction]

2657

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 3: Env. Correct Table] Thick 3 Paper: MM Environment Coefficient 2660

Adjustment Thick: 60 mm/sec

003 Paper Transfer:BW:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 36 / 1 /step]

004 Paper Transfer:BW:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 13 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 23 / 1 /step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd

[1 to 50 / 19 / 1 /step]

[M-Thick:Bias:BW] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11 / 1-uA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1-uA /step]

2707

[0 to 200 / 20 / 1-uA /step]

[M-Thick:Bias:FC] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 25 / 1-uA /step]

002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 28 / 1-uA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11/ 1-uA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 14 / 1-uA /step]

2721

[M-Thick:L-Edge Correct] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

2722

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5-uA /step]

[M-Thick:SwTiming:L-Edge] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st

SM Appendix

*ENG

9-83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2-uA /step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2703

*ENG

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

2723

[M-Thick:T-Edge Correct] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

2724

[M-Thick:SwTiming:T-Edge] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

2730

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5-uA /step]

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2-uA /step]

[M-Thick:Env.Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]

004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]

005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]

006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]

009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]

011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]

012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]

[SP 1: Bias: BW] 2753

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]

[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP 1: Bias: FC] 2757

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:BW] Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

SM Appendix

9-85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2761

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001

002

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

*ENG

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1

*ENG

005

006

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)

[100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step] *ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

[100 to 4000 / 165 / 5%/step] *ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step]

007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

009

010

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

[100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

[100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 290 / 5%/step]

012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

013

014

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

[100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step] *ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4

[100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step] *ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step]

015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 360 / 5%/step]

016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017

018

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5

*ENG

*ENG

019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5

*ENG

020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 200 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 340 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 420 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:FC] 2762

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

002

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

SM Appendix

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001

*ENG

9-87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1

*ENG

005

006

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

[100 to 4000 / 130 / 5%/step] *ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

[100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step] *ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step]

007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step]

008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

009

010

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

[100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

[100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step]

011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 320 / 5%/step]

012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

013

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd:

D037/D038/D040/D041

[100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step]

9-88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode S4

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]

015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 465 / 5%/step]

016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017

018

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5

*ENG

*ENG

019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5

*ENG

020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 220 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 355 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 565 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP1,2,3-T:Size Env.Correct:BW] 2763

Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

002

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

*ENG

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1

*ENG

005

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

SM Appendix

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)

[1 to 50 / 23 / 1%/step] 290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper

9-89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode width)

006

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

[1 to 50 / 9 / 1%/step] *ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 34 / 1%/step]

007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 26 / 1%/step]

008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

009

010

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

[1 to 50 / 10 / 1%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

[1 to 50 / 15 / 1%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 12 / 1%/step]

011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1%/step]

012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

013

014

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4

[1 to 50 / 15 / 1%/step] *ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4

D037/D038/D040/D041

[1 to 50 / 10 / 1%/step]

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 35 / 1%/step] 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper

9-90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1%/step] 016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017

018

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st:

*ENG

S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd:

*ENG

S5

019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5

*ENG

020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 29 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 15 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 41 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP1,2,3-T:Size Env.Correct:FC] 2764

Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

002

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1

*ENG

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1

*ENG

005

006

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2

SM Appendix

S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)

[1 to 50 / 37 / 1%/step] *ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step]

[1 to 50 / 16 / 1%/step] *ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

9-91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [1 to 50 / 32 / 1%/step] 007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 24 / 1%/step]

008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

009

010

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3

[1 to 50 / 36 / 1%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3

[1 to 50 / 9 / 1%/step] *ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1%/step]

011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 18 / 1%/step]

012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

013

014

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4

[1 to 50 / 29 / 1%/step] *ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4

[1 to 50 / 7 / 1%/step] *ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 22 / 1%/step]

015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1%/step]

016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 017

018

Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5

*ENG

*ENG

019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5

*ENG

020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 12 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 7 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP1: L-Edge Correct] Special 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2771

edge in each mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 1: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

2772

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec *ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

9-93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[SP1: T-Edge Correct] Special 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2773

edge in each mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2774.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 1: Switch Timing: T-Edge]

2774

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

2780

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[SP 1: Env. Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]

004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]

006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]

009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]

010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]

011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]

012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]

[SP 4: Bias: BW] 2783

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP 4: Bias: FC] 2787

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP4,5,6-T:Size Correct:BW] 2791

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec *ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Normal: S2

*ENG

SM Appendix

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 125 / 5%/step] 290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper

9-95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Paper Transfer: Normal S1

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step] 009 Paper Transfer: Normal: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 275 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 400 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP4,5,6-T:Size Correct:FC] 2792

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Normal: S1

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 110 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Normal:S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 115 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Normal:S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 405 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5

2793

*ENG

[100 to 4000 / 690 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP4,5,6-T:Size Env.Correct:BW]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Normal:S1

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 36 / 1%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Normal: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 40 / 1%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Normal: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4

*ENG

194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)

017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 20 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP4,5,6-T:Size Env.Correct:FC] 2794

Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Normal:S1

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 49 / 1%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Normal: S2

*ENG

290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)

009 Paper Transfer: Normal: S3

*ENG

250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)

013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4

SM Appendix

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 35 / 1%/step]

9-97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[1 to 50 / 50 / 1%/step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 6 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)

[SP4: L-Edge Correct] Special 4 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2795

edge in each mode. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2796.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 4: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

2796

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[SP4: T-Edge Correct] Special 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2797

edge in each mode. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2798.

001 Paper Transfer

2798

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 4: Sw Timing: T-Edge]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

003 Paper Transfer:BW: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 17 / 1-uA /step]

005 Paper Transfer:FC: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 29 / 1-uA /step]

2799

[SP 4: Env. Correct Table]

[SP 2: Bias: BW] 2803

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]

[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP2: Bias: FC] 2807

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]

SM Appendix

9-99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

[SP 2: L-Edge Correct] Special 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2821

edge in each mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 2: SW Timing: L-Edge]

2822

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[SP 2: T-Edge Correct] Special 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2823

edge in each mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2824.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 2: SwTiming: T-Edge]

2824

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[SP 2: Env. Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]

004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]

005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]

006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]

009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]

010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]

011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]

012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]

SM Appendix

9-101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2830

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [SP 5: Bias: BW] 2833

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 5 in black-and-white mode. Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP 5: Bias: FC] 2837

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 5 in full color mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP5: L-Edge Correct] Special 5Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2845

edge in each mode. SP2833 and SP2837 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2846.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 5: Switch Timing: L-Edge]

2846

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

2847

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[SP5: T-Edge Correct] Special 5 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2833 and SP2837 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2848.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 5: Sw Timing: T-Edge]

2848

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

003 Paper Transfer:BW: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 17 / 1-uA /step]

005 Paper Transfer:FC: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 29 / 1-uA /step]

2849

[SP 5: Env. Correct Table]

[SP3: Bias: BW] 2852

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step] Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2857

[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]

[Special 3: Bias: FC]

SM Appendix

9-103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP 3: L-Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2871

edge in each mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5% /step]

[Special 3: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]

2872

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[SP 3: T-Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2873

edge in each mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2874.

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 3: Sw Timing: T-Edge]

2874

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd

*ENG

[SP 3: Env. Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]

004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]

SM Appendix

9-105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2880

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]

006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]

009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]

010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]

011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]

012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]

[SP 6: Bias: BW] 2883

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 6 in black-and-white mode. Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP 6: Bias: FC] 2887

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 6 in full color mode. Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]

[SP6: L-Edge Correct] Special 5Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2895

edge in each mode. SP2883 and SP2887 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2896.

001 Paper Transfer

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

9-106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [SP 6: Sw Timing: L-Edge]

2896

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[SP6: T-Edge Correct] Special 5 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2897

edge in each mode. SP2883 and SP2887 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec ƒ

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2898.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[SP 6: Sw Timing: T-Edge]

2898

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

003 Paper Transfer:BW: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 17 / 1-uA /step]

005 Paper Transfer:FC: 1st

*ENG

[1 to 50 / 29 / 1-uA /step]

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 5 / 1sec /step]

2900

[SP 5: Env. Correct Table]

[Drum Idling Time]

003 Normal Speed

SM Appendix

9-107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2899

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 005 Low Speed

2902

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 5 / 1sec /step]

[OPC Drum Rev Time] Adjusts the time for how long the OPC drum motor reverses after job end. DFU

001 All: BW

*ENG

[0to 200 / 60 / 10 msec/step]

002 All: FC

*ENG

[0to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]

003 DevRev: FC

*ENG

[0to 200 / 70 / 10 msec/step]

004 DevRev: Bk

*ENG

[0to 200 / 200 / 10 msec/step]

[ImageTrunsferRevTime] 2904

Adjusts the time for how long the image transfer belt motor reverses after job end. DFU

003 All

2906

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]

[Drum Stop Angle] DFU

001 Color

*ENG

002 Bk

*ENG

2908

[0 to 359 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

[GainAdj:TransferM] Gain Adjustment of Image Transfer Belt Motor DFU [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

001 120 mm/sec

*ENG

0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed

002 60 mm/sec

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] 0: GAIN: High speed

9-108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 1: GAIN: Low speed

2915

[GainAdj:BkOpcDevM] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

001 120 mm/sec

*ENG

0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]

002 60 mm/sec

*ENG

0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed

2916

[GainAdj:ColorOpcM] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

001 120 mm/sec

*ENG

0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]

002 60 mm/sec

*ENG

0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed

2920

[Transfer Motor Ctrl] [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]

001 TransferMotorCtrl

*ENG

0: FG Control 1: ENC Control

002 SC443 Count

2921

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 /step]

[ITB Speed Control] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ] *ENG

0: Disavailable Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 On/Off

1: Available 002 Execute

SM Appendix

*ENG

-

9-109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 003 Execution Interval

*ENG

[1 or 6000 / 600 / 1 min /step]

004 Correct Delay Time

*ENG

[2 or 20 / 2 / 0.01 sec /step]

020 Amp. Correct 1

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]

021 Amp. Correct 2

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]

022 Amp. Correct 3

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]

030 Pha. Correct 1

*ENG

[0 or 359 / 0 / 1 /step]

031 Pha. Correct 2

*ENG

[0 or 359 / 0 / 1 /step]

032 Pha. Correct 3

*ENG

[0 or 359 / 0 / 1 /step]

040 Amp. Error Thresh

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 65535 / 1 /step]

041 Amp. Error Counter

*ENG

[0 or 1000 / 0 / 1 /step]

050 Amp. Coeff 1:120

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 18681 / 1 /step]

051 Amp. Coeff 2:120

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 26048 / 1 /step]

052 Amp. Coeff 3:120

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 31468 / 1 /step]

053 Amp. Coeff 1:60

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 9341 / 1 /step]

054 Amp. Coeff 2:60

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 13024 / 1 /step]

055 Amp. Coeff 3:60

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 15734 / 1 /step]

056 Pha. Coeff 1

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 35987 / 1 /step]

057 Pha. Coeff 2

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 27263 / 1 /step]

058 Pha. Coeff 3

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 21464 / 1 /step]

059 Pha. Coeff 1 LPF

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 5280 / 1 /step]

060 Pha. Coeff 2 LPF

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 10560 / 1 /step]

061 Pha. Coeff 3 LPF

*ENG

[0 or 65535 / 15840 / 1 /step]

2922

[ITB SP Ctrl Counter]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Counter

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 /step]

002 Internal Counter

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 1 / 1 /step]

[P-Transfer:Bias Limit] Paper Transfer Roller Feed-back: Threshold 2930

Adjustment Adjusts the threshold between high resistance (division 1) and low resistance (division 2) at the paper transfer roller. This SP affects SP2931 to SP2939.

001 Bias

*ENG

[0 to 7000 / 6000 / 10 –V/step]

001 T1:Standard Speed

*ENG

[-500 to 1000 / 0 / 10 msec /step]

002 T1:Low Speed

*ENG

[-500 to 1000 / -80 / -80 msec /step]

001 T5:Bk:Normal

*ENG

[-140 to 140 / 0 / 10 msec /step]

002 T7:FC:Normal

*ENG

[-140 to 140 / 0 / 10 msec /step]

003 T5:Bk:Low

*ENG

[-210 to 210 / 0 / 10 msec /step]

004 T7: FC: Low

*ENG

[-210 to 210 / 0 / 10 msec /step]

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

001 No Refresh

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

002 Refresh

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]

2941

2960

[Charge Bias On Timing]

[Dev. Bias Down Mode]

[Process Interval]

001 Additional Time

2970

[Cleaning After JOB]

SM Appendix

9-111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2940

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 2971

[BW Non-Image:Bias ON]

001 T1 BW:Bias On:Normal

*ENG

003 T1 BW:Bias On:Low

*ENG

[-360 to 180 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

SP3-XXX (Process)

3011

[Process Cont. Manual Execution] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] Executes the normal process control

001 Normal Procon

-

manually (potential control). Check the result with SP3-325-001 after executing this SP. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ]

002 Toner Density Adjust

-

Executes the toner density adjustment manually. Check the result with SP3-325-001 after executing this SP. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ] Executes the process control that is

003 Procon BF-ACC

-

normally done before ACC. The type of process control is selected with SP3-041-004. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ] Executes the process control that is

004 With Full MUSIC

-

normally done at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the MUSIC (line position adjustment) twice. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ] Executes the process control that is

005 With Normal MUSIC

-

normally done at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the MUSIC (line position adjustment) once.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-112 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

[Process Cont. Check Result] Process Control Self-check Result Displays the result of the latest process control self-check. 3012

All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order “Y C M K” e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were successful. See the “Error Condition Tables” in the Process Control Error section for details.

001 History: Latest

*ENG

002 Result: Latest 1

*ENG

003 Result: Latest 2

*ENG

004 Result: Latest 3

*ENG

005 Result: Latest 4

*ENG

006 Result: Latest 5

*ENG

007 Result: Latest 6

*ENG

008 Result: Latest 7

*ENG

009 Result: Latest 8

*ENG

010 Result: Latest 9

*ENG

[TD Sen Initial Setting] Developer Initialization Setting

001 Execution: ALL

-

002 Execution: COL

-

003 Execution: Bk

-

004 Execution: C

-

005 Execution: M

-

006 Execution: Y

-

SM Appendix

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

9-113 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3013

[11111111 to 99999999 / - / 1/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

3014

[TD Sen Initial Set Result] Developer Initialization Result: Display [0000 to 9999 / - / 1 /step ] Display: YCMK

*ENG

1: Success 2 to 9: Failure

001 Displays the developer initialization result. See the “Error Condition Tables” in the Process Control Error section for details on the meaning of each code. All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y C M Bk. e.g., 1 (Y) 2 (C) 1 (M) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.

3015

[Forced Toner Supply] Forced Toner Supply ([Color])

001 Execution: ALL

-

002 Execution: COL

-

003 Execution: Bk

-

004 Execution: C

-

005 Execution: M

-

006 Execution: Y

-

3016

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] Executes the manual toner supply to the development unit.

[Forced Toner Supply Cntl] Forced Toner Supply Setting ([Color]) Specifies the manual toner supply time for each color.

001 Supply Time: Bk

*ENG

002 Supply Time: C

*ENG

003 Supply Time: M

*ENG

004 Supply Time: Y

*ENG

3020

[0 to 30 / 4 / 1 sec/step]

[Vt Limit Error]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-114 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode DFU 001 Delta Vt Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 5 / 0.01 V/step]

002 Upper Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4.7 / 0.01 V/step]

003 Upper Error Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 20 / 1 time/step]

004 Lower Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Lower Error Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 times/step]

006 Upper Counter: Bk

*ENG

007 Upper Counter: C

*ENG

008 Upper Counter: M

*ENG

009 Upper Counter: Y

*ENG

010 Lower Counter: Bk

*ENG

011 Lower Counter: C

*ENG

012 Lower Counter: M

*ENG

013 Lower Counter: Y

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 times/step]

[TD Sensor Initial Set] Developer Initialization Setting 3021

Specifies the developer agitation time for each color at the developer initialization. DFU *ENG

002 Agitation Time: C

*ENG

003 Agitation Time: M

*ENG

004 Agitation Time: Y

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

005-008 Sets the execution flag of the developer initialization for each color. DFU 005 Execution Flag: Bk

SM Appendix

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

9-115 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Agitation Time: Bk

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 006 Execution Flag: C

*ENG

007 Execution Flag: M

*ENG

008 Execution Flag: Y

*ENG

0: Flag OFF, 1: Flag ON This flag is cleared after executing TD sensor initialization.

Enables or disables developer 009 Initial Setting Off

*ENG

initialization. DFU [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Enable, 1: Disable

3022

[Toner Replenishment Mode] DFU Specifies the toner supply time for each color in the toner supply mode.

005 Execution Flag: Bk

*ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

006 Execution Flag: C

*ENG

007 Execution Flag: M

*ENG

008 Execution Flag: Y

*ENG

3041

0: Flag OFF, 1: Flag ON This flag is cleared after executing TD sensor initialization.

[Process Control Type] [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step ] Alphanumeric 0: FIXED (Use the fixed values for the charge

001

Voltage Control

*ENG

DC bias and development DC bias set with SP2-005 and SP2-229.) 1: CONTROL

Enables or disables potential control. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] Alphanumeric 002

LD Power Control

*ENG

0: FIXED (at the value in SP2221-xxx) 1: CONTROL (adjusted by process control)

Selects the LD power control mode. 004

Pre-ACC Process

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]

9-116 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Control

0: Not Executed 1: Process Control 2: TC Control

Selects the process control mode that is done before ACC. [0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step] 005 P-Pattern Selection

*ENG

0: FIXED 1: INITIALIZED 2: CALCULATED

3043

[TD Adjustment Mode] Repeat Number: Power ON

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at power on. 001 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat Number: Initial

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at the developer initialization. 002 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat Number: Non-use

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment in Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003

*ENG

stand by mode. 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)

SM Appendix

9-117 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat Number: ACC

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at ACC. 004 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled

005

Repeat Number: Recovery

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]

Not used Repeat Number: Job End

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at job end. 006 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat: Interrupt 007

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment during printing. DFU Toner Supply Coeff.

008

*ENG

[0 to 25.5 / 10 / 0.1 sec/step]

Adjusts the time for the toner supply mode when a toner density is detected to be low.

009

C-pattern: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the black toner density

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-118 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment. C-pattern: C 010

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the magenta toner density when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment. C-pattern: M

011

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the cyan toner density when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment. C-pattern: Y

012

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the yellow toner density when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.

013

T1 Bias: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Black.

014

T2 Bias: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Cyan.

015

T3 Bias: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Magenta.

016

T4 Bias: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Yellow.

017

Developer Agitation Time

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the developer mixing time at the toner density adjustment. C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-001) exceed the target values (SP3611-005) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009).

SM Appendix

9-119 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

018 adjustment.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: C

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density 019 adjustment. In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-002) exceed the target values (SP3611-006) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009). C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: M

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density 020 adjustment. In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-003) exceed the target values (SP3611-007) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009). C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: Y

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density 021 adjustment. In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-004) exceed the target values (SP3611-008) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009).

3044

[Toner Supply Type] Toner Supply Type ([Color]) Selects the toner supply method type.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 M

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 4 / 1/step] Alphanumeric 0: FIXED (with the supply rates stored with SP 3401) 1: PID (Vtref_Fixed) 2: PID (Vtref_Control)

004 Y

*ENG

3: MBD (Vtref_Fixed) 4: MBD (Vtref_Control)

3045

[Toner End Detection: Set]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-120 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Enables/disables the toner alert display on the LCD. 001 ON/OFF

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Detect, 1: Not Detect [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

002 NE Detection

*ENG

0: ALL 1: TE Sensor

[Toner End/Near End]

3101

Displays the amount of each color toner. DFU 001 Toner Replenishment: Bk

*ENG

002 Toner Replenishment: C

*ENG

003 Toner Replenishment: M

*ENG

004 Toner Replenishment: Y

*ENG

[1 to 600 / 235 / 1 g/step]

005-008 Displays the consumed amount of each color toner. 005 Toner Consumption: Bk

*ENG

006 Toner Consumption: C

*ENG

007 Toner Consumption: M

*ENG

008 Toner Consumption: Y

*ENG

Displays the remaining amount of each color toner. These are calculated by the operating times of the toner supply motors.

009 Toner Remaining: Bk

*ENG

010 Toner Remaining: C

*ENG

011 Toner Remaining: M

*ENG

012 Toner Remaining: Y

*ENG

[–50000 to 600 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

013-016 Adjusts the threshold of toner near end for each color. The toner near end

SM Appendix

9-121 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

009-012

[0 to 3000 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode message appears on the LCD when the remaining toner amount reaches this threshold. When one of these SPs (SP3-101-009 to 012 or -032 to -035) reaches this threshold, toner near end is detected. 013 Near End Threshold: Bk

*ENG

014 Near End Threshold: C

*ENG

015 Near End Threshold: M

*ENG

016 Near End Threshold: Y

*ENG

Delta Vt Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 600 / 13 / 1 g/step]

[0 to 600 / 3 / 1 g/step]

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step]

021 This SP is the threshold for toner end. Delta Vt: Vt-Vtref When both this SP and SP3-101-026 occur at same time, toner end is determined. 022-025

Displays the total delta Vt (Vt-Vtref) value for each color.These are calculated by pixel counting.

022 Delta Vt Sum: Bk

*ENG

023 Delta Vt Sum: C

*ENG

024 Delta Vt Sum: M

*ENG

025 Delta Vt Sum: Y

*ENG

026 Delta Vt Sum Threshold

*ENG

028-031

[0 to 655 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / 10 / 1 V/step]

Displays the consumed toner amount calculated with the pixel count for each color.

028 Pixel: Consumption: Bk

*ENG

029 Pixel: Consumption: C

*ENG

030 Pixel: Consumption: M

*ENG

031 Pixel: Consumption: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

032-035 Displays the remaining toner amount for each color, using pixel count.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-122 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 032 Pixel: Remaining : Bk

*ENG

033 Pixel: Remaining : C

*ENG

034 Pixel: Remaining : M

*ENG

035 Pixel: Remaining : Y

*ENG

[-50000 to 600 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

040-043 Displays the pixel M/A for each color. 040 Pixel M/A: Bk

*ENG

041 Pixel M/A: C

*ENG

042 Pixel M/A: M

*ENG

043 Pixel M/A: Y

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.05 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]

[0 to 1 / 0.6 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step] Adjusts the delta Vt (Vt – Vtref) of toner

044 Delta Vt Threshold BF NE

*ENG

end before toner near end is detected. [0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step] Adjusts the total delta Vt (Vt – Vtref) of

045

Delta Vt Sum Threshold BF NE

*ENG

toner end before toner near end is detected. [0 to 255 / 10 / 1 V/step]

046-049 Displays the latest mohno off time. 046 Bottle Motor Off Time: Bk

*ENG

047 Bottle Motor Off Time: C

*ENG

048 Bottle Motor Off Time: M

*ENG

049 Bottle Motor Off Time: Y

*ENG

[0 to 0 x FFFFFFFF / 0 / 1 sec/step]

050-053 *ENG

051 TE Sn Detect Thresh:C

*ENG

052 TE Sn Detect Thresh:M

*ENG

SM Appendix

[1 to 600 / 33 / 1 g/step]

9-123 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

050 TE Sn Detect Thresh:Bk

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 053 TE Sn Detect Thresh:Y

*ENG

[Toner End Recovery] Not used 3102

Adjusts the number of times toner supply is attempted for each color when the TD sensor continues to detect toner end during toner recovery.

001 Repeat: Bk

*ENG

002 Repeat: C

*ENG

003 Repeat: M

*ENG

004 Repeat: Y

*ENG

3131

[1 to 20 / 5 / 1 time/step]

[TE Count m: Display] Display the number of toner end detections for each color.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 M

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3201

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]

[TD Sensor: Vt Display] Display the current voltage of the TD sensor for each color.

001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: C

*ENG

003 Current: M

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

3211

[0 to 5.5 / 0.01 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vt Shift: Display/Set]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-124 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the Vt correction value for each line speed. Thick 1 and Thick 2&Fine: 77 mm/sec 001 Med Speed Shift:Bk

*ENG

002 Med Speed Shift:C

*ENG

003 Med Speed Shift:M

*ENG

004 Med Speed Shift:Y

*ENG

005 Low Speed Shift:Bk

*ENG

006 Low Speed Shift:C

*ENG

007 Low Speed Shift:M

*ENG

008 Low Speed Shift:Y

*ENG

3221

[0 to 5 / 0.29 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtcnt: Display/Set] Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.

001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: C

*ENG

003 Current: M

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

005-008

Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization. DFU *ENG

006 Initial: C

*ENG

007 Initial: M

*ENG

008 Initial: Y

*ENG

[2 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

005 Initial: Bk

3222

[2 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref: Display/Set]

SM Appendix

9-125 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color. 001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: C

*ENG

003 Current: M

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

005-008

[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]

Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization. DFU

005 Initial: Bk

*ENG

006 Initial: C

*ENG

007 Initial: M

*ENG

008 Initial: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]

009-012 Displays and adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color. DFU 009 Pixel Correction: Bk

*ENG

010 Pixel Correction: C

*ENG

011 Pixel Correction: M

*ENG

012 Pixel Correction: Y

*ENG

3223

[-5 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[-5 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref U/Lower: Set] DFU Adjusts the lower or upper limit value of Vtref for each color.

001 Lower: Bk

*ENG

002 Lower: C

*ENG

003 Lower: M

*ENG

004 Lower: Y

*ENG

005 Upper: Bk

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

9-126 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 006 Upper: C

*ENG

007 Upper: M

*ENG

008 Upper: Y

*ENG

009 Initial TC

*ENG

Adjusts the initial toner concentration. [1 to 15 / 7 / 0.1 wt%/step] Adjusts the upper limit of the toner

010 Upper: TC

*ENG

concentration. [1 to 15 / 9.5 / 0.1 wt%/step] Adjusts the lower limit of the toner

011 Lower: TC

*ENG

concentration. [1 to 15 / 4 / 0.1 wt%/step] Adjusts the upper limit of the TD sensor

012 Upper Sensitivity

*ENG

sensitivity. [0.2 to 0.5 / 0.44 / 0.001 V/wt% /step] Adjusts the lower limit of the TD sensor

013 Lower Sensitivity

*ENG

sensitivity. [0.2 to 0.5 / 0.209 / 0.001 V/wt% /step]

014

015

3224

Toner Density Between H /M Toner Density Between M /L

*ENG

[1 to 10 / 3.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]

*ENG

[1 to 10 / 3.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]

[Vtref Correct: Pixel] DFU Adjusts the coefficient of Vtref correction for each coverage and color. *ENG

002 Low Coverage Coeff.C

*ENG

003 Low Coverage Coeffi.M

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 5 / 0.2 / 0.1 /step]

9-127 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Low Coverage Coeffi. Bk

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004 Low Coverage Coeff. Y

*ENG

005 High Coverage Coeff, Bk

*ENG

006 High Coverage Coeff, C

*ENG

007 High Coverage Coeff, M

*ENG

008 High Coverage Coeff, Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.3 / 0.01 V/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the low 009 Low Coverage: Threshold

*ENG

coverage. [0 to 20 / 3 / 0.1 %/step] Adjusts the threshold of the high

010 High Coverage: Threshold:M

*ENG

coverage. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %/step]

011 TC Upper Limit Correction

*ENG

012 Upper Limit TC: Display: Bk

*ENG

013 Upper Limit TC: Display: C

*ENG

014 Upper Limit TC: Display: M

*ENG

015 Upper Limit TC: Display: Y

*ENG

016

Process Control Execution Threshold:M

017 High Coverage: Threshold:H

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]

[1 to 15 / 9.5 / 0.1 wt% /step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 50 / 1 time/step]

*ENG

Adjusts the threshold of the high coverage.

018 High Coverage: Threshold:L

*ENG

019 Process Control Thresh:H

*ENG

020 Process Control Thresh:L

*ENG

021 Initial ProCon Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 6 / 1 time/step]

022 High Coverage Thresh:LS

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 %/step]

023 Process Control Thresh:LS

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 4 / 1 time/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]

[0 to 255 / 14 / 1 time/step]

9-128 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

[Toner Supply MBD]

001 ADD:TIME

*ENG

002 ADD:K

*ENG

003 ADD:C

*ENG

004 ADD:M

*ENG

005 ADD:Y

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 200 / 10 msec/step]

[0.01 to 2 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

006 ADD:LowSpd

*ENG

[0.01 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

007 MSEC:V

*ENG

[0.001 to 1 / 0.08 / 0.001 / step]

011 PID:I:K

*ENG

012 PID:I:C

*ENG

013 PID:I:M

*ENG

014 PID:I:Y

*ENG

015 PID:I:K

*ENG

016 PID:I:C

*ENG

017 PID:I:M

*ENG

018 PID:I:Y

*ENG

019 PID:I:LowSpd

*ENG

020 PID:P:LowSpd

*ENG

021 AWILOW:K

*ENG

022 AWILOW:C

*ENG

023 AWILOW:M

*ENG

024 AWILOW:Y

*ENG

025 AWPUP:K

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 100 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 100 / 8 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

[-1 to 1 / 0.125 / 0.0001 /step]

[-1 to 1 / 0.125 / 0.0001 /step]

9-129 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3230

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 026 AWPUP:C

*ENG

027 AWPUP:M

*ENG

028 AWPUP:Y

*ENG

029 AWILOW:LowSpd

*ENG

030 AWPUP:LowSpd

*ENG

031 SMITH:K

*ENG

032 SMITH:C

*ENG

033 SMITH:M

*ENG

034 SMITH:Y

*ENG

035 SMITH:LowSpd

*ENG

041 ANC:Hori.:K

*ENG

042 ANC:Hori.:C

*ENG

043 ANC:Hori.:M

*ENG

044 ANC:Hori.:Y

*ENG

045 ANC:Ver.:K

*ENG

046 ANC:Ver.:K

*ENG

047 ANC:Ver.:K

*ENG

048 ANC:Ver.:K

*ENG

049 ANC:Hori.:LowSpd

*ENG

050 ANC:Ver.:LowSpd

*ENG

051 ANCG:Long:A:K

*ENG

052 ANCG:Long:A:C

*ENG

053 ANCG:Long:A:M

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 100 / 2 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 2 / 0.8 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 10 / 2.8 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 10 / 1.9 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 5 / 0.6 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 10 / 0.66 / 0.01 /step]

9-130 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 054 ANCG:Long:A:Y

*ENG

055 ANCG:Long:B:K

*ENG

056 ANCG:Long:B:C

*ENG

057 ANCG:Long:B:M

*ENG

058 ANCG:Long:B:Y

*ENG

059 ANCG:Long:A:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

060 ANCG:Long:B:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.35 / 0.01 /step]

061 AWPNI:K

*ENG

062 AWPNI:C

*ENG

063 AWPNI:M

*ENG

064 AWPNI:Y

*ENG

071 PID

*ENG

080 PIX:TBL:1

*ENG

081 PIX:TBL:2

*ENG

082 PIX:TBL:3

*ENG

083 PIX:TBL:4

*ENG

084 PIX:TBL:5

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.96 / 0.01 /step]

085 PIX:TBL:6

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 /step]

086 PIX:TBL:7

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.86 / 0.01 /step]

087 PIX:TBL:8

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.85 / 0.01 /step]

088 PIX:TBL:9

*ENG

089 PIX:TBL:10

*ENG

090 PIX:TBL:11

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 10 / 0.4 / 0.01 /step]

[-10 to 10 / 0.1 / 0.001 /step]

9-131 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 091 PIX:TBL:12

*ENG

092 PIX:COR:K

*ENG

093 PIX:COR:C

*ENG

094 PIX:COR:M

*ENG

095 PIX:COR:Y

*ENG

096 PIX:AVE:Select

*ENG

[1 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]

101 PID:I:LIM:Normal

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.125 / 0.001 /step]

102 PID:I:LIM:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.063 / 0.001 /step]

103 PID:I:Nrml to Low

*ENG

104 PID:I:Low to Nrml

*ENG

3231

[0 to 5 / 0.75 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[Toner Supply: Setting] Adjusts the coefficient of the toner supply time for each color. DFU

001 Conversion Coeff.:Bk

*ENG

002 Conversion Coeff.:C

*ENG

003 Conversion Coeff.:M

*ENG

004 Conversion Coeff.:Y

*ENG

3232

[0.5 to 9.99 / 3.33 / 0.01 /step]

[T - Supply Coeff.: Setting] DFU

001 Vt Proportion: Bk

*ENG

002 Vt Proportion: C

*ENG

003 Vt Proportion: M

*ENG

004 Vt Proportion: Y

*ENG

005 Pixel Proportion: Bk

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 2550 / 50 / 1 /step]

[0 to 2.55 / 0.47 / 0.01 /step]

9-132 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 006 Pixel Proportion: C

*ENG

007 Pixel Proportion: M

*ENG

008 Pixel Proportion: Y

*ENG

009 Vt Integral Control: Bk

*ENG

010 Vt Integral Control: C

*ENG

011 Vt Integral Control: M

*ENG

012 Vt Integral Control: Y

*ENG

013 Vt Sum Times: Bk

*ENG

014 Vt Sum Times: C

*ENG

015 Vt Sum Times: M

*ENG

016 Vt Sum Times: Y

*ENG

3233

[0 to 2550 / 500 / 1 /step]

[1 to 255 / 20 / 1 time/step]

[Pixel-Prop. Coeff.2:Set] DFU

001 Correction Coeff.:1

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

002 Correction Coeff.:2

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

003 Correction Coeff.:3

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 /step]

004 Correction Coeff.:4

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0.25 / 0.01 /step]

005 Correction Coeff.:5

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

3234

[Pixel-Prop. Coeff.3:Set] DFU *ENG

[-0.1 to 0 / -0.01 / 0.01 /step]

002 Correction Value 2

*ENG

[0 to 0.1 / 0.01 / 0.01 /step]

3235

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Correction Value 1

[Toner Supply Coeff.: Display] DFU

SM Appendix

9-133 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Pixel Proportion 2: Bk

*ENG

002 Pixel Proportion 2: C

*ENG

003 Pixel Proportion 2: M

*ENG

004 Pixel Proportion 2: Y

*ENG

005 Pixel Proportion 3: Bk

*ENG

006 Pixel Proportion 3: C

*ENG

007 Pixel Proportion 3: M

*ENG

008 Pixel Proportion 3: Y

*ENG

009 Vt Integral Value: Bk

*ENG

010 Vt Integral Value: C

*ENG

011 Vt Integral Value: M

*ENG

012 Vt Integral Value: Y

*ENG

3236

[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[0.7 to 1.3 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[-255 to 255 / 0 / 0.01 /step]

[Toner Supply Consum.: Display] DFU Displays the toner amount of the latest toner supply for each color.

001 Latest: Bk

*ENG

002 Latest: C

*ENG

003 Latest: M

*ENG

004 Latest: Y

*ENG

3237

[0 to 40000 / 0 / 0.1 mg/step]

[Developer Agitation Setting] Displays the toner amount of the latest toner supply for each color. DFU

001 Agitation Time

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 sec/step]

9-134 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 3238

[Vt Target: Setting] Displays the Vt target value at developer initialization. DFU

001 Bk

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 M

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3239

[0 to 5 / 2.7 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref Correction: Setting] Adjusts the parameter for Vtref correction at the process control. 001 (+)Consumption: Bk

*ENG

002 (+)Consumption: C

*ENG

003 (+)Consumption: M

*ENG

004 (+)Consumption: Y

*ENG

005 (-)Consumption: Bk

*ENG

006 (-)Consumption: C

*ENG

007 (-)Consumption: M

*ENG

008 (-)Consumption: Y

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.05 / 0.01 V/step]

009 P Rank 1 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0.15 / 0.01 /step]

010 P Rank 2 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 /step]

011 P Rank 3 Threshold

*ENG

[-2 to 0 / -0.1 / 0.1 /step]

012 P Rank 4 Threshold

*ENG

[-2 to 0 / -0.15 / 0.01 /step]

013-014 Threshold for image density rank on the image transfer belt. 013 T Rank 1 Threshold

SM Appendix

*ENG

[-1 to 0 / -0.2 / 0.01 V/step]

9-135 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

009-012 Threshold for development gamma rank.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 014 T Rank 2 Threshold

3241

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 V/step]

[Background Potential Setting]

001 Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

002 Coefficient: C

*ENG

003 Coefficient: M

*ENG

These are parameters for calculating the charge bias referring to the development bias at process control. [-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 1 /step] DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 +

004 Coefficient: Y

*ENG

0.001 x these vales) + SP3-241-005 to -008

005 Offset: Bk

*ENG

These are additional values for calculating

006 Offset: C

*ENG

007 Offset: M

*ENG

the charge bias referring to the development bias at process control. [0 to 255 / 140 / 1 V/step] DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 +

008 Offset: Y

*ENG

0.001 x SP3-241-001 to -004) + these values

3242

[LD Power Setting] Adjusts the coefficient for LD power control value at the process control.

001 Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

002 Coefficient: C

*ENG

003 Coefficient: M

*ENG

004 Coefficient: Y

*ENG

005 Offset: Bk

*ENG

006 Offset: C

*ENG

007 Offset: M

*ENG

008 Offset: Y

*ENG

017 Low Speed Coeff.:Bk

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[-1000 to 1000 / 128 / 1 /step]

[-1000 to 1000 / 27 / 1 /step]

[-1000 to 1000 / 128 / 1 /step]

9-136 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 018 Low Speed Coeff.:C

*ENG

019 Low Speed Coeff.:M

*ENG

020 Low Speed Coeff.:Y

*ENG

021 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:Bk

*ENG

022 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:C

*ENG

023 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:M

*ENG

024 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:Y

*ENG

3251

[-1000 to 1000 / 58 / 1 /step]

[Coverage] These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012. 001 Latest: Pixcel Bk

*ENG

002 Latest: Pixcel C

*ENG

003 Latest: Pixcel M

*ENG

004 Latest: Pixcel Y

*ENG

Displays the latest coverage for each color. [0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction. 005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number specified with SP3251-017. 005 Average S: Bk

*ENG

006 Average S: C

*ENG

007 Average S: M

*ENG

008 Average S: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction. the number specified with SP3251-018. 009 Average M: Bk

SM Appendix

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

9-137 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 010 Average M: C

*ENG

011 Average M: M

*ENG

012 Average M: Y

*ENG

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction. 013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number specified with SP3-251-019. 013 Average L: Bk

*ENG

014 Average L: C

*ENG

015 Average L: M

*ENG

016 Average L: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

017-019 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-005 to -016. 017 Total Page Setting: S

*ENG

[1 to 100 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

018 Total Page Setting: M

*ENG

[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

019 Total Page Setting: L

*ENG

[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]

020-022 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-024 to -027. 020 Total Page Setting: S2

*ENG

[1 to 100 / 20 / 1 sheet/step]

021 Total Page Setting: M2

*ENG

[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

022 Total Page Setting: L2

*ENG

[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]

024-027 Displays the latest coverage ratio for each color. 024 Latest Coverage: Bk

*ENG

025 Latest Coverage: C

*ENG

026 Latest Coverage: M

*ENG

027 Latest Coverage: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / - / 0.01 %/step]

028 Displays the threshold of whether to perform developer churning or not.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-138 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode DevAgi. Theresh BF

*ENG

ProCon

3311

[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]

[ID Sn Detection Value] Displays the ID sensor (regular) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments. 001 Voffset reg: Bk

*ENG

002 Voffset reg: C

*ENG

003 Voffset reg: M

*ENG

004 Voffset reg: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments. 005 Voffset dif: C

*ENG

006 Voffset dif: M

*ENG

007 Voffset dif: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

008-010 Displays the ID sensor offset voltage for Vsg adjustments. *ENG

009 Voffset TM (Center)

*ENG

010 Voffset TM (Rear)

*ENG

[Vsg Adjustment: Execution]

010 P/TM Sensor All

3322

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

-

Execute the ID sensor initialization setting for all sensors

[Vsg Adjust. Result: Vsg] Displays the result value of the Vsg adjustment for each sensor.

001 Vsg reg: Bk

SM Appendix

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

9-139 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3321

008 Voffset TM (Front)

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Vsg reg: C

*ENG

003 Vsg reg: M

*ENG

004 Vsg reg: Y

*ENG

005 Vsg dif: C

*ENG

006 Vsg dif: M

*ENG

007 Vsg dif: Y

*ENG

008 Vsg TM (Front)

*ENG

009 Vsg TM (Center)

*ENG

010 Vsg TM (Rear)

*ENG

3323

[Vsg Adjust. Result: Ifsg] DFU

001 Ifsg: Bk

*ENG

002 Ifsg: C

*ENG

003 Ifsg: M

*ENG

004 Ifsg: Y

*ENG

005 Ifsg TM (Front)

*ENG

006 Ifsg TM (Center)

*ENG

007 Ifsg TM (Rear)

*ENG

3324

[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]

[Vsg Adjustment: Set] DFU

003 Vofset Error Counter

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 0.1 time/step]

004 Vofset Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Vsg Upper Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4.5 / 0.01 V/step]

006 Vsg Lower Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3.5 / 0.01 V/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-140 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

[Vsg Adjustment Result]

3325

Displays the result of the Vsg adjustment. The displayed numbers mean the result of each sensor (sensor for Front, sensor for Bk, sensor for Cyan, sensor for Center, sensor for Magenta, sensor for Yellow and sensor for Rear).

001 Latest

*ENG

002 Latest 1

*ENG

003 Latest 2

*ENG

004 Latest 3

*ENG

005 Latest 4

*ENG

006 Latest 5

*ENG

007 Latest 6

*ENG

008 Latest 7

*ENG

009 Latest 8

*ENG

010 Latest 9

*ENG

3: Offset voltage error 2: Vsg adjustment value error 1: O.K

[ID Sensor Sensitivity: Display] Not Used

003 K2C (Latest)

*ENG

004 K5C (Latest)

*ENG

3362

9: Unexpected error

[ID Sn Sensitivity] DFU

003 K5: Upper

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 5 / 0.01 /step]

004 K5: Lower

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

005 Kn: Upper

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01 /step]

SM Appendix

9-141 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3361

[111 to 999 / 999 / 1 /step]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 006 Kn: Lower

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

007 K5 Edit Point

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.15 / 0.01 /step]

008 K5 Target Voltage

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.63 / 0.01 V/step]

009 K5 Approximate Method

*ENG

010 K2: U/L Limit Coeff. 1

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0 / 0.01 /step]

*ENG

[–0.2 to 0.4 / 0.07 / 0.01 /step]

*ENG

[–0.2 to 0.4 / –0.07 / 0.01 /step]

013 Diffusion Correction

*ENG

[0.75 to 1.35 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

016 K2: Check

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.001 /step]

011

012

3363

K2: Upper Limit Correction K2: Lower Limit Correction

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 /step] 0:Linear, 1: Curve

[ID Pattern Timing Setting] DFU Adjusts the detection timing for the

001 Scan YCMBk

*ENG

process control pattern. [-500 to 500 / 0 / 1 mm/step] Adjusts the timing when the paper

002 Detection Delay Time

*ENG

transfer unit is kept away from the image transfer belt. [0 to 2500 / 400 / 1 msec/step] Adjusts the processing timing for the

003 Delay Time

*ENG

process control pattern. [0 to 2500 / 1335 / 1 msec/step] Adjusts the processing timing for the

004 MUSIC Delay Time

*ENG

pattern that is used for the line position adjustment. [-2500 to 2500 / 300 / 1 msec/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-142 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 3371

[M/A Calculation] DFU

001 Correction Coeff.: Bk

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 0.99 / 0.01 /step]

002 Correction Coeff.: C

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

003 Correction Coeff.: M

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

004 Correction Coeff.: Y

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

005 Color Correct Coeff.:Bk [0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

006 Color Correct Coeff.:C 007 Color Correct Coeff.:M 008 Color Correct Coeff.:Y

3401

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1.03 / 0.01 /step]

[Fixed Supply Mode] Adjusts the toner supply rate in the fixed toner supply mode.

001 Fixed Rate: Bk

*ENG

002 Fixed Rate: C

*ENG

003 Fixed Rate: M

*ENG

004 Fixed Rate: Y

*ENG

3411

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 %/step] These SPs are used only when SP3-044 is set to "1".

[Toner Supply Rate: Display] Displays the current toner supply rate. *ENG

002 Latest: C

*ENG

003 Latest: M

*ENG

004 Latest: Y

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 100 / - / 1 %/step]

9-143 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Latest: Bk

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 3421

[Toner Supply Range]

001 Upper Limit: Bk

*ENG

002 Upper Limit: C

*ENG

003 Upper Limit: M

*ENG

004 Upper Limit: Y

*ENG

005 Minimum Supply Time: Bk

*ENG

006 Minimum Supply Time: C

*ENG

007 Minimum Supply Time: M

*ENG

008 Minimum Supply Time: Y

*ENG

3451

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 M

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 100 / 1%/step]

Adjusts the minimum toner supply time. [0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]

[0 to 10000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]

[Toner Supply Carry Over: Setting] DFU

001 Maximum: Bk

*ENG

002 Maximum: C

*ENG

003 Maximum: M

*ENG

004 Maximum: Y

*ENG

3501

printing.

[T-Supply Carry Over: Display] DFU

001 Bk

3452

Adjusts the toner supply rate during

[0 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 msec/step]

[Process Control Target M/A] Adjusts the target M/A.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-144 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Maximum M/A: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.45 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]

002 Maximum M/A: C

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.445 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]

003 Maximum M/A: M

*ENG

004 Maximum M/A: Y

*ENG

3510

[Image Adj. Counter:Display] Displays the total page counter for each adjustment mode.

001 Potential Control: BW

*ENG

002 Potential Control: FC

*ENG

003 Power ON: BW

*ENG

004 Power ON: FC

*ENG

005 MUSIC: BW

*ENG

006 MUSIC: FC

*ENG

007 Vsg Adj.

*ENG

008 Charge AC Control

*ENG

009 MUSIC: Power ON: BW

*ENG

010 MUSIC: Power ON: FC

*ENG

3511

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

[Execution Interval: Setting]

001 Job End: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]

002 Job End: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]

003 Interrupt: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

004 Interrupt: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

SM Appendix

9-145 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Adjusts the threshold for each adjustment mode.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 005 Initial: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]

006 Initial: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]

007 Vsg Adj. Counter

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

008 Charge AC Control Counter

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

019

Environmental Correction: ON/OFF

*ENG [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]

020 Gamma Correction: ON/OFF

*ENG

0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)

021

Non-use Time Correction: ON/OFF

*ENG

022 Correction Coeff. 1: JE: BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 page/step]

023 Correction Coeff. 2: JE: BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

024 Correction Coeff. 1: JE: FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]

025 Correction Coeff. 2: JE: FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01/step]

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.01/step]

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 2 / 1/step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]

026

027

028

029

030

031

Correction Coeff. 1: Interrupt: BW Correction Coeff. 2: Interrupt: BW Correction Coeff. 1: Interrupt: FC Correction Coeff. 2: Interrupt: FC Max. Number Correction Threshold Max. Number Correction Counter

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-146 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 3512

[Image Adj.: Interval] Adjusts the timing for execution of process control and line position adjustment.

001 During Job

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 page/step]

002 During Stand-by

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 minute/step]

[PCU Motor Stop Time: Bk] 3513

Displays the last time that the PCU motors stopped. These are used for process control execution timing.

001 Year

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1/step]

002 Month

*ENG

[1 to 12 / 1 / 1/step]

003 Date

*ENG

[1 to 31 / 1 / 1/step]

004 Hour

*ENG

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]

005 Minute

*ENG

[0 to 59 / 0 / 1/step]

[Environmental Displ: Job End] 3514

Displays the environmental conditions for the last job. These are used for process control execution timing.

001 Temperature

*ENG

[-1280 to 1270 / 0 / 0.1°C/step]

002 Relative Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1%RH/step]

003 Absolute Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 g/cm3/step]

[Execution Interval: Display] Displays the current interval for process control execution. When the machine calculates the timing for process control, it uses a number of conditions. These are the results after considering all the conditions. 001 Job End: Potential

SM Appendix

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]

9-147 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3515

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Control: BW 002

003

004

Job End: Potential Control: FC Interrupt: Potential Control: BW Interrupt: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

[Refresh Mode] DFU While making prints with low coverage, the developer is agitated with less 3516

toner consumption and the toner carrier attraction tends to increase. This may cause low image density or poor transfer (white dots). To prevent this, the coagulated toner or overcharged toner has to be consumed by performing the refresh mode.

001 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: Bk

*ENG

002 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: C

*ENG

003 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: M

*ENG

004 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: Y

*ENG

005 Rotation Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 0.1 / 1 m/step]

006 Pixel Coverage Sum: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]

007 Pixel Coverage Sum: C

*ENG

008 Pixel Coverage Sum: M

*ENG

009 Pixel Coverage Sum: Y

*ENG

010 Required Area: Bk

*ENG

011 Required Area: C

*ENG

012 Required Area: M

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-148 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[0 to 1000 / 0 / 0.1 m/step]

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 013 Required Area: Y

*ENG

014 Refresh Threshold: Bk

*ENG

015 Refresh Threshold: C

*ENG

016 Refresh Threshold: M

*ENG

017 Refresh Threshold: Y

*ENG

018 Pattern Number: Bk

*ENG

019 Pattern Number: C

*ENG

020 Pattern Number: M

*ENG

021 Pattern Number: Y

*ENG

022 Pattern Number: Upper limit

*ENG

023 Toner Consumption Pattern Area

*ENG

024 Supply Coefficient

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01/step]

025 Job End Area Coefficient

*ENG

[0.1 to 25.5 / 1 / 0.1/step]

026 Job End Vb Coefficient

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1%/step]

027 Job End Length

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 19 / 1mm/step]

028 Job End Supply Amt

*ENG

029 Refresh:Page Thresh

*ENG

030 Mode Counter:Bk

*ENG

031 Mode Counter:FC

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 49 / 1 cm2/m/step]

[0 to 255 / 25 / 1 cm2/m/step]

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 time/step]

[10 to 2550 / 280 / 10 cm2/step]

[0 to 1 / 0.45 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]

[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

3517

Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this

SM Appendix

9-149 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Blade Damage Prevention]

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode value, toner is applied to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over. 001

3518

Execution Temp.

*ENG

Threshold

[0 to 50/ 40 / 1°C/step]

[Image Adj. Execution Flag] DFU

001 Toner End Recovery: Bk

*ENG

002 Toner End Recovery: C

*ENG

003 Toner End Recovery: M

*ENG

004 Toner End Recovery: Y

*ENG

005 Vsg Adjustment

*ENG

006 Developer Agitation

*ENG

007 Process Control

*ENG

008 MUSIC

*ENG

009 Drum Phase Adj.

*ENG

010 Charge AC Control

*ENG

011 Blade Damage Prevention

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice) [0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice)

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] Sets “1”, when the following values shows. 012 Vsg Average Error

*ENG

Vsg_reg_ave: 3.5 ≤ Vsg_reg_ave ≤ 4.5 or Vsg_dif_ave: 0.0 ≤ Vsg_dif_ave ≤ 0.5

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-150 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 3519

[Toner End Prohibition Setting] Enables or disables each adjustment at toner near end.

001 Process Control

*ENG

002 MUSIC

*ENG

003 TC Adjustment

*ENG

3520

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] 0: Permit (adjustment is done even toner near end condition) 1: Forbid (adjustment is not done at toner near end condition)

[ITB Idling Rotation]

001 Temperature: High

*ENG

002 Temperature: Medium

*ENG

003 Temperature: Low

*ENG

004 Temperature: L: Power ON

*ENG

005 Temp. Range Thresh:T2

*ENG

[20 or 30 / 30 / 1 deg/step]

006 Temp. Range Thresh:T2

*ENG

[0 or 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

010

011

Temp. Thresh Temp. Thresh:High Temp. Thresh Temp. Thresh:Low

[0 or 3 / 0 / 1 revolution/step]

*ENG

[0 or 50 / 30 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 or 50 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

[Initial Process Control Setting]

3522

Adjusts the threshold for the process control at power on. When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process

002 Non-use Time Setting

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]

003 Temperature Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1°C/step]

SM Appendix

9-151 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

control at power on is executed.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004 Relative Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

005 Absolute Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

100

[Rapi_timer] [Time Setting]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

[Non-use Time Process Control Setting]

3531

Adjusts the threshold for the process control at stand-by. When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process control at stand-by is executed.

001 Non-use Time Setting

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]

002 Temp. Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1°C/step]

003 Relative Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

004 Absolute Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

005

3611

Maximum Execution Number

Adjusts the maximum execution time for *ENG

the process control at stand-by. [0 to 99 / 10 / 1 time/step]

[Dev. Gamma: Display/Set] Displays the current development gamma

001 Bk (Current)

*ENG

for Bk [0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

002 C (Current)

*ENG

003 M (Current)

*ENG

Displays the current development gamma for C/M/Y. [0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

004 Y (Current)

*ENG

005 Bk (Target Display)

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

Displays the target development gamma for Bk.

9-152 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step] Displays the target development gamma 006 C (Target Display)

*ENG

for C/M/Y. [0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

007 M (Target Display)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

008 Y (Target Display)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.77 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step] Displays the standard target development

009 Bk (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

gamma for each color. [0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

010 C (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

011 V (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

012 Y (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

Turns on or off the environmental correction for target development 013 Environmental Correction

*ENG

gamma. [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not Correct, 1: Correct

*ENG

015 C (Max Correction)

*ENG

016 M (Max Correction)

*ENG

017 Y (Max Correction)

*ENG

018 K (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

019 C (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

020 M (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

021 Y (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 5 / 0.1 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kv/step]

[1 to 99 / 15 / 1 g/m3/step]

9-153 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

014 K (Max Correction)

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 3612

[Vk Display] Displays Vk for each color.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 M

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[-300 to 300 / - / 1 V/step]

[Dev. DC Control:Display] 3621

Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 70 mm/sec Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and color.

001 Standard Speed:Bk

*ENG

002 Standard Speed:C

*ENG

003 Standard Speed:M

*ENG

004 Standard Speed:Y

*ENG

009 Low Speed:Bk

*ENG

010 Low Speed:C

*ENG

011 Low Speed:M

*ENG

012 Low Speed:Y

*ENG

[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]

[Charge DC Control: Display] 3631

Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Displays the charge DC voltage adjusted with the process control for each line speed and color.

001 Standard Speed:Bk

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]

9-154 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Standard Speed:C

*ENG

003 Standard Speed:M

*ENG

004 Standard Speed:Y

*ENG

009 Low Speed:Bk

*ENG

010 Low Speed:C

*ENG

011 Low Speed:M

*ENG

012 Low Speed:Y

*ENG

[Charge DC Control: Display] 3641

Standard: 120 mm/sec Displays the charge AC voltage adjusted with the process control for each color.

001 Standard Speed:Bk

*ENG

002 Standard Speed:C

*ENG

003 Standard Speed:M

*ENG

004 Standard Speed:Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.75 / 0.01 kV/step]

[LD Power Control: Display] 3651

Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Displays the LD power adjusted for each environment. *ENG

002 Standard Speed:C

*ENG

003 Standard Speed:M

*ENG

004 Standard Speed:Y

*ENG

009 Low Speed:Bk

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]

9-155 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Standard Speed:Bk

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 010 Low Speed:C

*ENG

011 Low Speed:M

*ENG

012 Low Speed:Y

*ENG

[HST Controll Setting] 3710

TD Sensor: Toner Concentration Control Setting Selects the toner concentration control method by HST memory, which is in the TD sensor.

001 Control Selection

3711

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not Use, 1: Use

[HST Control: Bk] Displays the factory settings of the black PCU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.5 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

9-156 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3712

[HST Control: C] Displays the factory settings of the magenta PCU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.5 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

[HST Control: M]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3713

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

Displays the factory settings of the cyan PCU.

SM Appendix

9-157 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3714

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

[HST Concentration Control: Y] Displays the factory settings of the yellow PCU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.5 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-158 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

[Toner Collection Bttl Full] 3800

Displays/ adjusts the toner collection bottle detection settings. These SPs are used for NRS.

001 Condition

*CTL

[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]

002 Detection Times

*CTL

[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]

003 Print Page AF Near Full

*CTL

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

004 Pixel Count AF Near Full

*CTL

[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step] Displays the pixel counter after

005 Pixel Count Af Replacement

*CTL

replacement of toner collection bottle. [0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]

008 Coefficient

*ENG

[0.1 to 1 / 1 / 0.1 /step] Enables or disables the calling for @Remote.

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Enable @Remote calling 1: Disable @Remote calling

SM Appendix

9-159 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

011 Notice Setting

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode NOTE: If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full. In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1". Day Thresh:NF

*ENG

[1 to 30 / 10 / 1 day/step]

012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection bottle. Displays the total amount of the used 013 Total Collected Toner

*ENG

toner. [0 to 999999999 / 1 / 1]

014 Full Detected Date

3810

Displays the date of the full detection

*ENG

for the toner collection bottle.

[ITB T-Collection Bttl Full]

001 Condition

*CTL

[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]

002 Detection Times

*CTL

[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]

003 Print Page Af Near Full

*CTL

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

*CTL

[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]

004

005

Pixel Count After Near Full Pixel Count Af Replacement

008 Coefficient

Displays the pixel counter after *CTL

replacement of toner collection bottle. [0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]

*ENG

[0.1 to 1 / 1 / 0.1 /step] Enables or disables the calling for @Remote.

011 Notice Setting

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Enable @Remote calling 1: Disable @Remote calling

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-160 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode NOTE: If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full. In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1". Day Thresh:NF

*ENG

[1 to 30 / 10 / 1 day/step]

012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection bottle. Displays the total amount of the used 013 Total Collected Toner

*ENG

toner. [0 to 999999999 / 1 / 1]

014 Full Detected Date

3901

*ENG

Displays the date of the full detection fot the toner collection bottle.

[New PCU Detection] Turns new PCU detection on or off.

001 ON/OFF Setting

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

[Manual New Unit Set] 3902

Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off. The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section 3 (Replacement and Adjustment). *ENG

002 Development Unit: C

*ENG

003 Development Unit: M

*ENG

004 Development Unit: Y

*ENG

005 Developer: Bk

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Development Unit: Bk

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

9-161 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 006 Developer: C

*ENG

007 Developer: M

*ENG

008 Developer: Y

*ENG

009 PCU: Bk

*ENG

010 PCU: C

*ENG

011 PCU: M

*ENG

012 PCU: Y

*ENG

013 ITB Unit

*ENG

014 Fusing Unit

*ENG

015 Fusing Roller

*ENG

016 Fusing Belt

*ENG

017 ITB Cleaning Unit

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON Do not use 3902-013 if you only change the cleaning unit. 3902-015: This is for the image transfer belt cleaning unit.

018 PTR Unit 019

020

PCU Toner Collection Bottle ITB Toner Collection Bottle

*ENG *ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

*ENG

SP4-XXX (Scanner)

4008

[Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment] Adjusts the sub-scan magnification by changing the scanner motor speed.

001

Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[-1.0 to 1.0 / 0 / 0.1%/step] FA

9-162 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [L-Edge Regist Adjustment] 4010

Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the scanning start timing in the sub-scan direction.

001

*ENG

[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step] FA

[S-to-S Regist Adjustment] 4011

Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the scanning start timing in the main scan direction.

001 -

*ENG

[-2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

[Scanner Erase Margin: Scale] Scanner: Erase Margin: Scale 4012

Sets the blank margin at each side for erasing the original shadow caused by the gap between the original and the scale.

001 Book: Leading Edge 002 Book: Trailing Edge

*ENG

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

*ENG

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

003 Book: Left 004 Book: Right 005 ADF: Leading Edge 007 ADF: Left 008 ADF: Right

[Scanner Free Run] 4013

Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.

001 Lamp: OFF

SM Appendix

*ENG

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT [0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

9-163 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Lamp: ON

4014

0: OFF, 1: ON

[Scan] Execute the scanner free fun with each mode.

001 HP Detection Enable

-

002 HP Detection Disable

-

4020

Scanner free run with HP sensor check. Scanner free run without HP sensor check.

[Dust Check] Turns the ADF scan glass dust check on/

001 Detection: ON/OFF

*ENG

off. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: OFF, 1: ON Selects the detect level.

002 Dust Detect: Level

*ENG

[0 to 8 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: lowest detection level 8: highest detection level Selects the level of the sub scan line correction when using the ARDF. [0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]

003 Correction Level

*ENG

0: Off 1: Weakest 2: Weak 3: Strong 4: Strongest

[APS Operation Check] 4301

Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. (See "Input Check Table".)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-164 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 APS Operation Check

-

-

[APS Min Size] 4303

Specifies the result of the detection when the outputs from the original sensors are all OFF. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

001

APS Min. Size

*ENG

(A5/HLT/16K)

0: No Original 1: A5-Lengthwise (16K SEF if 4305 is set to 3)

[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Normal Detection (the machine detects A4/LT size as A4 or LT, depending on the 4305

*ENG

[8K/16K Detection]

paper size setting) 1: A4-Sideways LT-Lengthwise 2: LT-Sideways A4-Lengthwise 3: 8K 16K

001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.

4308

[Scan Size Detection]

001 Detection: ON/OFF

4309

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: OFF, 1: ON

[Scan Size Deted Setting]

001 Original Density Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 32 / 1 digit /step]

002 Detection Time

*ENG

[20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec /step]

003 Lamp ON:Delay Time

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4310

[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec /step]

[Scan Size Detect Value]

SM Appendix

9-165 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 S1:R

*ENG

002 S1:G

*ENG

003 S1:B

*ENG

004 S2:R

*ENG

005 S2:G

*ENG

006 S2:B

*ENG

007 S3:R

*ENG

008 S3:G

*ENG

009 S3:B

*ENG

[Scanner Erase Margin] 4400

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit /step]

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit /step]

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit /step]

*ENG

Set the Mask for Original. These SPs set the area to be masked during platen (book) mode scanning. 001 Book: Leading Edge 002 Book: Trailing Edge 003 Book: Left [0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]

004 Book: Right 005 ADF: Leading Edge 007 ADF: Left 008 ADF: Right

4417

[IPU Test Pattern] Selects the IPU test pattern.

001

Test Pattern

[0 to 24 / 0 / 1/step ]

13: Grid pattern CMYK

Selection

0: Scanned image

14: Color patch CMYK

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-166 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 1: Gradation main scan A

15: Gray pattern (1)

2: Gradation main scan B

16: Gray pattern (2)

3: Gradation main scan C

17: Gray Pattern (3)

4: Gradation main scan D

18: Shading pattern

5: Gradation sub scan (1)

19: Thin line pattern

6: Grid pattern

20: Scanned + Grid pattern

7: Slant grid pattern

21: Scanned + Gray scale

8: Gradation RGBCMYK

22: Scanned + Color patch

9: UCR pattern

23: Scanned + Slant Grid C

10: Color patch 16 (1)

24: Scanned + Slant Grid D

11: Color patch 16 (2) 12: Color patch 64

4429

[Illegal Copy Output]

001 Copy *ENG

002 Scanner

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

003 Fax

4440

[Saturation Adjustment] Adjusts the level of saturation for copying. [0 to 5 / 3 / 1 /step] 0: High 1: Lowest

001 -

*ENG

2: Lower 3: Default 4: Higher 5: Highest

[Scan Image Path Selection] 001 Black Subtraction ON/OFF

SM Appendix

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4450

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

9-167 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Uses or does not use the black reduction image path.

002

SH ON/OFF

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: ON, 1: OFF

Uses or does not use the shading image path.

[Digital AE Set] DFU 4460

Specifies the level of deleting the background in the ADS mode. You can adjust its level for each scanning method (platen, ADF).

001 Lower Limit

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 364 / 4 digit/step]

002 Background Level

*ENG

[512 to 1532 / 932 / 1 digit/step]

4501

[ACC Target Density] Selects the ACC result.

001 Copy: Bk: Text

*ENG

002 Copy: C: Text

*ENG

003 Copy: M: Text

*ENG

004 Copy: Y: Text

*ENG

005 Copy: Bk: Photo

*ENG

006 Copy: C: Photo

*ENG

007 Copy: M: Photo

*ENG

008 Copy: Y: Photo

*ENG

4505

[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step] 10: Darkest density

[ACC Correction:Bright] Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.

001 Master:K

*ENG

002 Master:C

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

9-168 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 003 Master:M

*ENG

004 Master:Y

*ENG

005 Slave:K

*ENG

006 Slave:C

*ENG

007 Slave:M

*ENG

008 Slave:Y

*ENG

4506

Reserved

[ACC Correction: Dark] Adjusts the offset correction for dark areas of the ACC pattern.

001 Master:K

*ENG

002 Master:C

*ENG

003 Master:M

*ENG

004 Master:Y

*ENG

005 Slave:K

*ENG

006 Slave:C

*ENG

007 Slave:M

*ENG

008 Slave:Y

*ENG

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

Reserved

[Printer Vector Correction] 4540

This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 Colors [R, G, B, Option]) for a total of 48 parameters. *ENG

Specifies the printer vector correction value.

005-008 YR Phase: Option/R/G/B

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

009-012 YG Phase: Option/R/G/B

SM Appendix

9-169 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001-004 RY Phase: Option/R/G/B

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 013-016 GY Phase: Option/R/G/B 017-020 GC Phase: Option/R/G/B 021-024 CG Phase: Option/R/G/B 025-028 CB Phase: Option/R/G/B 029-032 BC Phase: Option/R/G/B 033-036 BM Phase: Option/R/G/B 037-040 MB Phase: Option/R/G/B 041-044 MR Phase: Option/R/G/B 045-048 RM Phase: Option/R/G/B

4550

[Scanner Appl.:Text/Chart] DFU

4551

[Scanner Appl.: Text] DFU

4552

[Scanner Appl.:Txt Dropout] DFU

4553

[Scanner Appl.:Text/Photo] DFU

4554

[Scanner Appl.: Photo] DFU

4565

[Scanner Appl.: GrayScale] DFU

4570

[Scan Appl.: Color: Text-Photo] DFU

4571

[Scan Appl.: Color: Glossy Photo] DFU

4572

[Scan Appl.: AutoColor] DFU MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)

*ENG

-005

[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step] 0: MTF Off

Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. -006 Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

9-170 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.

-007

Brightness: 1–255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.

-008

Contrast: 1–255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast. I Dot Erase :0 (x1) 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 0: Not activated

4581

[FAX Appl.: Text/Chart] DFU

4582

[FAX Appl.: Text/Photo] DFU

4583

[FAX Appl.: Photo] DFU MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)

*ENG

-005

[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step] 0: MTF Off

Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.

-006

Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]

Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.

-007

Brightness: 1–255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.

-008

Contrast: 1–255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

-009

I Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of

SM Appendix

9-171 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 0: Not activated Texture Erase: 0

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]

-010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. This SP (suffix "-010") only exists in SP4580, 4582 and 4583. 0: Not activated

4581

[FAX Appl.: Text] DFU

4584

[FAX Appl.: Original 1] DFU

4585

[FAX Appl.: Original 2] DFU MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)

*ENG

-005

[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step] 0: MTF Off

Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.

-006

Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]

Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.

-007

Brightness: 1–255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.

-008

Contrast: 1–255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast. I Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 0: Not activated

4600

[SBU Version Display]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-172 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]

001 SBU_ID

-

002 GASBU-N_ID

-

[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]

003 VSP5100_ID

-

[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]

4602

[Scanner Memory Access]

001 Scanner Memory Access

-

002 Address Set

-

003 Data Set

-

4603

Displays the ID of the SBU.

Enables the read and write check for the SBU registers.

Not used

[AGC Execution]

001 HP Detection Enable

-

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] Executes the AGC.

002 HP Detection Disable

-

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] DFU

4604

[FGATE Open/Close] DFU Opens or closes the FGATE signal. This SP automatically returns to the default

001 -

-

status (close) after exiting this SP. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF, 1: ON

4609

[Gray Balance Set: R] -

[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]

002 DF Scan

-

[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]

4610

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Book Scan

[Gray Balance Set: G]

SM Appendix

9-173 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Book Scan

-

[-512 to 511 / -20 / 1 digit/step]

002 DF Scan

-

[-512 to 511 / -20/ 1 digit/step]

001 Book Scan

-

[-512 to 511 / -28 / 1 digit/step]

002 DF Scan

-

[-512 to 511 / -28 / 1 digit/step]

4611

4623

[Gray Balance Set: B]

[Black Level Adj. Display] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough

001 Latest: RE Color

-

adjustment) for the even red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough

002 Latest: RO Color

-

adjustment) for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4624

[Black Level Adj. Display] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in

001 Latest: GE Color

-

the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough

002 Latest: GO Color

-

adjustment) for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-174 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 4625

[Black Level Adj. Display] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough

001 Latest: BE Color

-

adjustment) for the even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough

002 Latest: BO Color

-

adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4628

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

001 Latest: R Color

4629

-

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Latest: G Color

4630

-

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Latest: B Color

4631

-

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjust]

001 Latest: RE Color

-

002 Latest: RO Color

-

SM Appendix

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

9-175 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

4632

[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Latest: GE Color

-

002 Latest: GO Color

-

4633

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Latest: BE Color

-

002 Latest: BO Color

-

4645

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Scan Adjust Error] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller.

001 Black Offset Corr 1

-

002 Black Offset Corr 2

-

4647

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Read Hard Error] Displays the result of the SBU connection check. [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 Power-ON

-

0: OK, Other: SBU connection check failure If the SBU connection check fails, SC144 occurs.

4654

001

[Black Level Adj. Display] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Last Correct Value: RE Color

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the

9-176 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough 002

Last Correct Value: RO Color

*ENG

adjustment) for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4655

[Black Level Adj. Display] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough

001

Last Correct Value: GE Color

adjustment) for the even green signal in *ENG

the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough

002

Last Correct Value: GO Color

*ENG

adjustment) for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4656

[Black Level Adj. Display] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough

001

Last Correct Value: BE Color

*ENG

adjustment) for the even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough

002

Last Correct Value: BO Color

*ENG

adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed).

4658

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjust]

SM Appendix

9-177 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. 001 Last Correct Value: RE Color

4659

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Last Correct Value: GE Color

4660

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Last Correct Value: BE Color

4661

*ENG

[Digital Gain Adjust] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: RE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: RO Color

*ENG

4662

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjust] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: GE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: GO Color

*ENG

4663

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjust] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: BE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: BO Color

*ENG

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

9-178 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 4673

[Black Level Adj. Display] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Displays the factory setting values of the

001

Factory Setting: RE Color

black level adjustment for the even red *ENG

signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed).. [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the factory setting values of the

002

Factory Setting: RO Color

black level adjustment (rough adjustment) *ENG

for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4674

[Black Level Adj. Display] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Displays the factory setting values of the

001

Factory Setting: GE Color

black level adjustment (rough adjustment) *ENG

for the even green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the factory setting values of the

002

Factory Setting: GO Color

black level adjustment (rough adjustment) *ENG

for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4675

[Black Level Adj. Display] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001

Factory Setting: BE Color

*ENG

black level adjustment (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed).

SM Appendix

9-179 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Displays the factory setting values of the

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the factory setting values of the 002

black level adjustment (rough adjustment)

Factory Setting: BO

*ENG

Color

for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4677

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red.

001 Factory Setting: RE Color

4678

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green.

001 Factory Setting: GE Color

4679

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue.

001 Factory Setting: BE Color

4680

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

001 Latest: RE Color

*ENG

002 Latest: RO Color

*ENG

4681

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-180 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 Latest: GE Color

*ENG

002 Latest: GO Color

*ENG

4682

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Latest: BE Color

*ENG

002 Latest: BO Color

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[DF: Density Adjustment] 4688

Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF. Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.

001 -

4690

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 100 / 1%/ step ]

[White Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.

001 RE

-

002 RO

-

4691

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[White Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. -

002 GO

-

4692

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 GE

[White Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.

SM Appendix

9-181 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 BE

-

002 BO

-

4693

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 RE

-

002 RO

-

4694

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 GE

-

002 GO

-

4695

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 BE

-

002 BO

-

4802

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[DF Shading FreeRun]

001 Lamp ON

Executes the scanner free run of shading -

002 Lamp OFF

movement with exposure lamp on or off. Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free run lasts.

4804

[Home Position Opetation]

001 -

D037/D038/D040/D041

-

Executes the scanner HP detection.

9-182 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

4806

[Carriage Move] Moves the carriage from the scanner home position.

001 -

Dust may fall through the DF exposure

-

glass. Therefore, do this SP when you transport the machine a long distance.

4807

[SBU Test Pattern Change]

001 -

4808

-

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

-

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

[Factory Setting Input]

002 Execution Flag

[ACC Data Display] 4902

This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution. A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 R DATA1

*ENG

Photo C Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

002 G DATA1

*ENG

Photo M Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

003 B DATA1

*ENG

Photo Y Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

004 R DATA2

*ENG

Photo C Patch Level 17 (8-bit)

005 G DATA2

*ENG

Photo M Patch Level 17(8-bit)

006 B DATA2

*ENG

Photo Y Patch Level 17 (8-bit)

001

[IPU Board Test] Test1

SM Appendix

-

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4904

Bit0: TAURUS register

9-183 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Bit1: ORION register Bit2: LUPUS register Bit3 to 11: Not used Bit12: Ri20 Bit13 to 15: Not used 0: OK, 1: Error Performs a write and read check of the ASICs on the BCU board and displays the result. Bit0: Image path from SBU to TAURUS Bit1: Image path from TAURUS to ORION Bit2: Image path from ORION to TAURUS Bit3: Image path from TAURUS to LUPUS 002

Test2

Bit4 to 11: Not used

-

Bit12: Image path from LUPUS to Ri20 Bit13: Image path from Ri20 to GAVD Bit14 and 15: Not used 0: OK, 1: Error Performs an image path check on the BCU board and displays the result.

4905

[Dither Selection] DFU Changes the parameters for error diffusion.

001 Dither Selection

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step] DFU

4909

[Man Gamma:Photo:Mono Bk] DFU

4910

[Man Gamma:Text:Bk]

4911

[Man Gamma:Text:C]

4912

[Man Gamma:Text:M]

4913

[Man Gamma:Text:Y]

001 Offset:Highlight

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 15 / 1 /step]

9-184 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 Offset:Middle

*ENG

003 Offset:Shadow

*ENG

004 Offset:Idmax

*ENG

005 Option:Highlight

*ENG

006 Option:Middle

*ENG

007 Option:Shadow

*ENG

008 Option:Idmax

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

4914

[Man Gamma: Text:Mono Bk] DFU

4915

[Man Gamma:Photo:Bk]

4916

[Man Gamma:Photo:C]

4917

[Man Gamma:Photo:M]

4918

[Man Gamma:Photo:Y]

001 Offset:Highlight

*ENG

002 Offset:Middle

*ENG

003 Offset:Shadow

*ENG

004 Offset:Idmax

*ENG

005 Option:Highlight

*ENG

006 Option:Middle

*ENG

007 Option:Shadow

*ENG

008 Option:Idmax

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

[ACC History: Latest]

001 YY/MM/DD

*ENG

-

002 HH/MM/SS

*ENG

-

SM Appendix

9-185 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4948

[0 to 30 / 15 / 1 /step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

4949

[ACC History: Previous]

001 YY/MM/DD

4954

*ENG

-

[Read/Restore Standard] -

001 Scan New Chart *ENG

002 Recall Previous Chart

[0 or 1 / 0 / - /step]

004 Set Standard Chart

[IPU Image Path Selection ] 4991

Selects the image path. Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key pad. RGB Frame Memory

*ENG

[0 to 11 / 2 / 1 /step ]

0: Scanner input RGB images 1: Scanner I/F RGB images 2: RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset ON) 3: Shading data 001

4: Inner pattern data: Gray scale 5: RGB images done by Line skipping correction 6: RGB images done by Digital AE 7: RGB images done by Vertical line correction 8: RGB image done by Scanner gamma correction 9: RGB image done by Filtering correction 10: RGB images done by Full color ADS 11: RGB image done by Color correction

4993

[High Light Correction]

001 Sensitivity Selection

D037/D038/D040/D041

*ENG

Selects the Highlight correction level.

9-186 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest sensitivity 9: strongest sensitivity Selects the range level of Highlight correction. 002 Range Selection

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest skew correction, 9: strongest skew correction

4994

[Text/Photo Detection Level Adj.] Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression PDF. [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]

001

High Compression PDFvity Level text/photo

*ENG

0: Text priority 1: Normal 2: Photo priority

SP5-XXX (Mode)

5024

[mm/inch Display Selection] Display units (mm or inch) for custom paper sizes.

001 0:mm 1:inch

*CTL

0: mm (Europe/Asia) 1: inch (USA)

[Accounting Counter] 5045

Selects the counting method. NOTE: The counting method can be changed only once, regardless of whether

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

the counter value is negative or positive. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 001 Counter Method

*CTL 0: Developments 1: Prints

SM Appendix

9-187 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

5047

[Paper Display] Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.

001 -

5051

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

[Toner Refill Detection Display] Enables or disables the toner refill detection display.

5051 1

5055

Toner Refill Detection Display

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] Alphanumeric *CTL 0: ON 1: OFF

[Display IP Address] Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.

001 -

5056

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF 1: ON

[Coverage Counter Display] Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD.

001 -

5061

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Not display, 1: Display

[Toner Remaining Icon Display] Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD.

001 -

D037/D038/D040/D041

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Not display, 1: Display

9-188 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5062

[Parts PM System Setting] Display or does not display the PM part yield on the LCD.

001 PCU:Bk

*CTL

002 PCU:M

*CTL

003 PCU:C

*CTL

004 PCU:Y

*CTL

005 Dev Unit:Bk

*CTL

006 Dev Unit:M

*CTL

007 Dev Unit:C

*CTL 0: Not display, 1: Display

008 Dev Unit:Y

*CTL

009 Fusing Unit

*CTL

010 Fusing Roller

*CTL

011 Fusing Belt

*CTL

012

5066

PCU Toner Collection Bottle

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

*CTL

[Parts PM Menu Display Setting] Display or does not display the “PM parts” button on the LCD.

001 -

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not display, 1: Display

[Parts PM System Setting] 5067

Selects the service maintenance or user maintenance for each PM parts.

001 PCU:Bk

SM Appendix

*CTL [0: Service] or [1: User]

9-189 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

If the user service is selected, PM alert is displayed on the LCD.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002 PCU:M

*CTL

003 PCU:C

*CTL

004 PCU:Y

*CTL

005 Dev Unit:Bk

*CTL

006 Dev Unit:M

*CTL

007 Dev Unit:C

*CTL

008 Dev Unit:Y

*CTL

009 Fusing Unit

*CTL

010 Fusing Roller

*CTL

011 Fusing Belt

*CTL

012

5113

PCU Toner Collection

[0: Service] or [1: User]

[0: Service] or [1: User]

*CTL

Bottle

[Optional Counter Type] This program specifies the counter type. 0: None, 1: Key card (RK 3, 4)

001

Default Optional Counter Type

*CTL

2: Key card (down), 3: Prepaid card 4: Coin rack, 5: MF key card 8: Key counter + Vendor 9: Bar-code Printer This program specifies the external counter type.

002

External Optional Counter Type

*CTL

0: None 1: Expansion Device 1 2: Expansion Device 2 3: Expansion Device 3

5114

[Optional Counter I/F]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-190 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001 MF Key Card Extension

5118

*CTL

[0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning accounting)]

*CTL [0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]

[Disable Copying]

001 This program disables copying.

5120

001

5121 001

[Mode Clear Opt.

*CTL

Counter Removal]

[0: Yes (removed)/ 1: Standby (installed but not used)/ 2: No (not removed)]

This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove an optional counter, check the settings.

*CTL [0: Feed/ 1: Exit]

[Counter Up Timing]

This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to “paper feed” and “paper exit” respectively.

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step] 5126

0: 8 1/2" x 13" (Foolscap)

*ENG

[F Size Original Setting]

1: 8 1/4" x 13" (Folio) 2: 8" x 13" (F)

001 Selects F size original setting.

5127

[APS Mode]

*CTL

[0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]

001 This program disables the APS.

5128

[Code Mode With Key/Card Option]

*CTL -

5131

[Paper Size Type Selection]

SM Appendix

*ENG

[0: JP (Japan)/ 1: NA / 2: EU]

9-191 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 DFU

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 001

5150

The program selects a paper size system from the following alternatives: the AB system (0), the LT system (1), and the AF system (2).

*CTL

[By-Pass Length Setting]

[0: OFF/ 1: ON]

Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not. 001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600 mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.

5162

[App. Switch Method]

*CTL [0: Soft Key Set/ 1: Hard Key Set]

001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.

[Fax Printing Mode at Optional] 5167

Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. This SP is used when the receiving fax is accounted by an external accounting device.

001

Fax Printing Mode at Optional Counter Off

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] *CTL

0: Automatic printing 1: No automatic printing

[CE Login] 5169

If you will change the printer bit switches, you must ‘log in’ to service mode with this SP before you go into the printer SP mode. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

001 CE Login

*CTL

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

5179

[By-pass Size Error Detection] Turns on or off the by-pass tray size error message.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-192 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF 001 -

*ENG

1: ON (Paper size error message is displayed when the paper jam occurs due to the wrong direction of set paper in by-pass mode.)

5181

[Size Adjust] Adjusts the paper size for each tray. *ENG

002 TRAY 1: 2

*ENG

003 TRAY 1: 3

*ENG

004 TRAY 1: 4

*ENG

005 TRAY 2: 1

*ENG

006 TRAY 2: 2

*ENG

007 TRAY 2: 3

*ENG

008 TRAY 2: 4

*ENG

009 TRAY 3: 1

*ENG

010 TRAY 3: 2

*ENG

SM Appendix

[0 to 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / 1 /step] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT

9-193 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 TRAY 1:1

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 011 TRAY 3: 3

*ENG

012 TRAY 3: 4

*ENG

013 TRAY 4: 1

*ENG

014 TRAY 4: 2

*ENG

015 TRAY 4: 3

*ENG

016 TRAY 4: 4

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF [0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF

[RK 4 Disconnect Operation] 5186

Enables or disables the prevention for RK4 (accounting device) disconnection. If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

001 -

*ENG

0: Disable 1: Enable

5188

[Copy NV Version] Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.

001 -

5195

-

-

-

-

[Limitless SW] DFU

001 -

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-194 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5196

[90 degree rotation (copy)]

001 -

5212

-

[Page Numbering]

*CTL

This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers. A "– value" moves the page number positions to the left edge. A "+ value" moves the page number positions to the right edge. 003 Duplex Printout Right/Left Position

[–10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

004 Duplex Printout High/Low Position

[Set Time] Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone. Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.) 5302

DOM: +540 (Tokyo) NA: -300 (New York) EU: + 60 (Paris) CH: +480 (Peking) TW: +480 (Taipei) AS: +480 (Hong Kong)

002 Time Difference

5307

*CTL#

[-1440 to 1440 / Area / 1 min./step ]

[Summer Time] [ 0 to 1 / NA, EU, ASIA / 1 /step] Setting

-

0: Disabled 1: Enabled NA and EUR: 1, ASIA: 0

001

ƒ

SM Appendix

Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise,

9-195 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Enables or disables the summer time mode.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode this SP is not activated even if this SP is set to "1". Rule Set (Start)

-

Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the first digit, so the eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5] 003 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] 7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour

/step]

8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step] For example: 3500010 (EU default) The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March ƒ

The digits are counted from the left.

ƒ

Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".

Rule Set (End)

-

-

Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 004 3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5] 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00". ƒ

The digits are counted from the left.

ƒ

Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".

[Access Control] 5401

When installing the SDK application, SAS (VAS) adjusts the following settings. DFU Whenever a new login user is added to 103 Default Document ACL

*CTL

the address book in external certification mode (for Windows, LDAP, RDH), the

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-196 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode default document ACL is updated according to this SP setting. [0 to 3 / 0 / 1] 0: View 1: Edit 2: Edit/Delete 3: Full control Note: This SP setting is ignored on a machine that is not using document server. 162

Extend Certification

-

Detail

200 SDK1 Unique ID 201

*CTL

SDK1 Certification

*CTL

Method

210 SDK2 Unique ID 211

*CTL

SDK2 Certification

*CTL

Method

"SDK" is the "Software Development Kit". This data can be converted from SAS (VAS) when installed or uninstalled. (DFU)

220 SDK3 Unique ID 221

SDK3 Certification

230 SDK certification device

*CTL

240 Detail Option

*CTL

-

[User Code Counter Clear] 001 UCodeCtrClr

5411

*CTL

Method

*CTL

Clears all counters for users. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5404

*CTL

[LDAP Certification]

SM Appendix

9-197 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Determines whether easy LDAP 004 Easy Certification

*CTL

certification is done. [0 to 1/1/1] 1: On, 0: Off This SP is referenced only when

005

Password Null Not Permit

SP5411-4 is set to "1" (On). *CTL

[0 to 1/0/1] 0: Password NULL not permitted. 1: Password NULL permitted.

5413

[Lockout Setting] Switches on/off the lock on the local 001 Lockout On/Off

*CTL

address book account. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On Sets a limit on the frequency of lockouts

002 Lockout Threshold

*CTL

for account lockouts. [1 to 10 / 5 / 1] Determines whether the system waits the prescribed time for input of a correct user ID and password after an account lockout has occurred.

003 Cancellation On/Off

*CTL

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off (no wait time, lockout not cancelled) 1: On (system waits, cancels lockout if correct user ID and password are entered. Determines the length of time that the system waits for correct input of the user

004 Cancellation Time

*CTL

ID and password after a lockout has occurred. This setting is used only if SP5413-3 is set to "1" (on).

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-198 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [1 to 999 / 60 / 1 min.] 005 Counter Clear Time

5414

Not Used

[Access Mitigation] Switches on/off masking of continuously used IDs and passwords that are 001 Mitigation On/Off

*CTL

identical. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: Off 1: On Sets the length of time for excluding

002 Mitigation Time

*CTL

continuous access for identical user IDs and passwords. [0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min.]

5415

[Password Attack] Sets the number of attempts to attack the 001 Permissible Number

*CTL

system with random passwords to gain illegal access to the system. [0 to 100 / 30 / 1 attempt] Sets the time limit to stop a password

002 Detect Time

*CTL

attack once such an attack has been detected. [1 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec.]

5416

[Access Information] Limits the number of users used by the Access User Max Number

*CTL

access exclusion and password attack detection functions. [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 users]

SM Appendix

9-199 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Limits the number of passwords used by 002

Access Password Max Number

*CTL

the access exclusion and password attack detection functions. [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 passwords] Sets the processing time interval for

003 Monitor Interval

*CTL

referencing user ID and password information. [1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec.]

5417

[Access Attack] Sets a limit on access attempts when an 001

Access Permissible

*CTL

Number

excessive number of attempts are detected for MFP features. [0 to 500 / 100 / 1] Sets the length of time for monitoring the

002 Attack Detect Time

*CTL

frequency of access to MFP features. [10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec.] Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of certification when an excessive

003 Productivity Fall Wait

*CTL

number of access attempts have been detected. [0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec.] Sets a limit on the number of requests received for certification in order to slow

004 Attack Max Number

*CTL

down the certification speed when an excessive number of access attempts have been detected. [50 to 200 / 200 /1 attempt]

5420

[User Authentication] These settings should be done with the System Administrator.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-200 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Note: These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been enabled. Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the copy 001 Copy

*CTL

applications. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off

002 Color Security Setting

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the

011 Document Server

*CTL

document server. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the fax

021 Fax

*CTL

application. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the scan

031 Scanner

*CTL

applications. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the printer

041 Printer

*CTL

applications. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: On, 1: Off

051 SDK1

071 SDK3

SM Appendix

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the SDK application.

9-201 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

061 SDK2

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

5481

[Authentication Error Code] These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed. Determines whether an error code appears in the system log after a user 001 System Log Disp

*CTL

authentication failure occurs. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On Determines whether an error code appears on the operation panel after a

002 Panel Disp

*CTL

user authentication failure occurs. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 1: On, 0: Off

5490

[MF Key Card (Japan only)] Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 001 -

*CTL

0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user code. 1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code.

002 Count Mode Setting

5501

*CTL

-

[PM Alarm] Sets the PM alarm interval 001 PM Alarm Level

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1k printouts / step] 0: No PM Alarm

002 Original Count Alarm

D037/D038/D040/D041

*CTL

-

9-202 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5504

*CTL

[Jam Alarm]

-

Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included). [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step] 001 0: Zero (Off) 1: Low (2.5K jams) 2: Medium (3K jams) 3: High (6K jams)

[Error Alarm] Sets the error alarm level. 5505

The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a set number of copied sheets (for example, default 1500 sheets). The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5". 001 -

5507

[Supply Alarm]

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 255 / 20 / 100 copies /step]

-

001 Paper Supply Alarm

0: Off, 1: On, DFU

002 Staple Supply Alarm

0: Off, 1: On, Japan only

003 Toner Supply Alarm

0: Off, 1: On, DFU Changes the timing of the “Toner Supply Call” via the @Remote, when the following conditions

080 Toner Call Timing

occur. 0: At replacement 1: At near end [250 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 /step] DFU Appendix: SP Mode Tables

128 Interval :Others 132 Interval :A3 133 Interval :A4

SM Appendix

9-203 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 134 Interval :A5 141 Interval :B4 142 Interval :B5 160 Interval :DLT 164 Interval :LG 166 Interval :LT 172 Interval :HLT

5508*

001*

*CTL

[CC Call] Jam Remains

-

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call for an unattended paper jam.

002*

Continuous Jams

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call for consecutive paper jams.

003*

Continuous Door Open

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call when the front door remains open. Jam Detection: Time Length 011*

[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute /step]

Sets the time a jam must remain before it becomes an “unattended paper jam”. This setting is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1". Jam Detection: Continuous Count

012*

[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]

Sets the number of consecutive paper jams required to initiate a call. This setting is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1". Door Open: Time Length

[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 /step]

013* Sets the length of time the door remains open before the machine initiates a call. This setting is enabled only when SP5-508-004 is set to "1".

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-204 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5515

5610

5611

001

[SC Alarm Setting] 001 SC Call

-

002 Service Parts Near End Call

-

003 Service Parts End Call

-

004 User Call

-

006 Communication Test Call

-

007 Machine Information Notice

-

008 Alarm Notice

-

009 Non Genuin Tonner Alarm

-

010 Supply Automatic Ordering Call

-

011 Supply Manegement Report Call

-

012 Jam/Door Open Call

-

[Base Gamma Cutl P: Command] 004 Recall Factory Setting

-

005 Restore Factory Setting

-

006 Restore Prev. Setting

-

[Toner Color in 2C] B-C

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step] 128: Darkest density

002

B-M

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step] 128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.

SM Appendix

9-205 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode G-C

003

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]

*ENG

128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the green signal in two-color mode. G-Y

004

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]

*ENG

128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the green signal in two-color mode. R-M

005

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]

*ENG

128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the red signal in two-color mode. R-Y

006

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]

*ENG

128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the red signal in two-color mode.

5618

[Color Mode Display Selection] [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 001

-

*CTL

0: ACS, Color, Black & White, Two Color, Single color 1: ACD, Full Color, Black & White

Selects the color selection display on the LCD.

ƒ

Memory Clear (SP5-801)

ƒ

The following tables list the items that are cleared. The serial number information, meter charge setting and meter charge counters (SP8-581, 582, 583, 584, and 586) are not cleared.

5792

[MCS Debug SW] 001 1

-

002 2

-

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-206 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

5792

003 3

-

004 4

-

[ECS Debug SW] 001 1

5801

-

[Memory Clear] Resets all correction data for process control and 001 All Clear

all software counters, and returns all modes and adjustments to their default values.

002 Engine [ENG]

Clears the engine settings. Initializes default system settings, SCS (System

003 SCS

Control Service) settings, operation display coordinates, and ROM update information.

004 IMH Memory Clr

-

005 MCS

-

006 Copier application

Initializes all copier application settings. Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX

007 Fax application

settings, local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer. The following service settings: Bit switches

ƒ

Gamma settings (User & Service)

ƒ

Toner Limit

The following user settings: ƒ

Tray Priority

ƒ

Menu Protect

ƒ

System Setting except for setting of Energy Saver

SM Appendix

9-207 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

008 Printer application

ƒ

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

009 Scanner application

010 Web Service

011 NCS

012 R-Fax

014 Clear DCS Settings

015 Clear UCS Settings

016 MIRS Setting

017 CCS

018 SRM Memory Clr

ƒ

I/F Setup (I/O Buffer and I/O Timeout)

ƒ

PCL Menu

Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the scanner SP modes. Deletes the network file application management files and thumbnails, and initializes the job login ID. All setting of Network Setup (User Menu) (NCS: Network Control Service) Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers. Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings. Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service) settings. Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report Service) settings. Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control Service) settings. Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings.

019 LCS

-

020 Web Uapli

Initializes the web user application settings.

021 ECS

Initializes the ECS settings.

5803

[Input Check]

See "Input Check Table" in this section.

5804

[Output Check]

See "Output Check Table" in this section.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-208 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5807

[Area Selection] 002 -

1: Japan, 2: NA, 3: EU, 4: Taiwan

-

5: Asia, 6: Chaina, 7: Korea

[SC Reset] Resets a type A service call condition.

5810

ƒ

Turn the main switch off and on after resetting the SC code.

001 Fusing SC Reset

5811

-

-

[Machine Serial] Machine Serial Number Display 002 Display

*ENG

Displays the machine serial number.

004 BCU

-

Inputs the serial number for the BCU.

005 FRAM

-

Displays the serial number for the BCU.

5812

[Service Tel. No. Setting] Service

*CTL

-

Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is 001 printed on the Counter List, which can be printed with the user’s “Counter” menu. This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input). Facsimile

002

*CTL

-

Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the Counter List. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input). 003 Supply

SM Appendix

*CTL

-

9-209 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number and press #. Operation 004

*CTL

-

Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press #.

5816

*CTL

[Remote Service]

-

I/F Setting Selects the remote service setting. 001 [0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step] 0: Remote service off 1: CSS remote service on 2: @Remote service on CE Call Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service. 002 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Start of the service 1: End of the service NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to “2”. Function Flag

003

Enables or disables the remote service function. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disabled 1: Enabled

004 Comunication Test Call 005 Device Information Call SSL Disable 007

Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-210 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 0: Uses the RCG certification 1: Does no use the RCG certification RCG Connect Timeout 008

Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 90 / 10 / 1 second /step] RCG Write Timeout

009

Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] RCG Read Timeout

010

Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] Port 80 Enable

011

Enables/disables access via port 80 to the SOAP method. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Disabled 1: Enabled

012 @Remote Communication Permission Setting 013 RFU Timing RCG – C Registed 021 This SP displays the Cumin installation end flag. 0: Installation not completed 1: Installation completed RCG – C Registed Detail

022

This SP displays the Cumin installation status. 0: Basil not registered Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1: Basil registered 2: Device registered 023 Connect Type (N/M)

SM Appendix

9-211 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode This SP displays and selects the Cumin connection method. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step 0: Internet connection 1: Dial-up connection

061

Cert. Expire Timing DFU Proximity of the expiration of the certification. Use Proxy

062

This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine communicates with the service center. Proxy Host This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between Cumin-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the

063

customer proxy server address. The address is necessary to set up Cumin-N. ƒ

The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128 character are ignored.

ƒ

This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.

Proxy Port Number This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication 064

between Cumin-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up Cumin-N. ƒ

This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.

Proxy User Name

065

This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name. ƒ

The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-212 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode ƒ

This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.

Proxy Password This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password. 066

ƒ

The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored.

ƒ

This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.

067 CERT: Up State Displays the status of the certification update. 0 1

2

3

4

11

12

The certification used by Cumin is set correctly. The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW URL and certification is presently being updated. The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the successful update. The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update. The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being sent to the GW URL. A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting is in progress for the rescue GW connection. The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the certification update request. The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully, and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW URL.

14

SM Appendix

The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW controller, and the certification is being stored.

9-213 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

13

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 15

16

The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful completion of this event. The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of this event. The certification update request has been received from the GW URL,

17

the GW URL was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but a certification error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.

18

The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of the certification update.

CERT: Error Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the certification. 0 1 068

2

3

Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress. Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired. An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired. Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual certification.

4

Notification of a common certification without ID2.

5

Notification that no certification was issued.

6

Notification that GW URL does not exist.

069 CERT: Up ID

The ID of the request for certification.

083 Firmware Up Status

Displays the status of the firmware update. This setting determines if the firmware can be

084 Non-HDD Firm Up

updated, even without the HDD installed. 0: Not allowed update

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-214 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 1: Allowed update This SP setting determines if the operator can confirm the previous version of the firmware before the firmware update execution. If the 085 Firm Up User Check

option to confirm the previous version is selected, a notification is sent to the system manager and the firmware update is done with the firmware files from the URL. Allows the service technician to confirm the size

086 Firmware Size

of the firmware data files during the firmware update execution.

087 CERT: Macro Version

088 CERT: PAC Version

Displays the macro version of the NRS certification. Displays the PAC version of the NRS certification. Displays ID2 for the NRS certification. Spaces

089 CERT: ID2 Code

are displayed as underscores (_). Asteriskes () indicate that no NRS certification exists. Displays the common name of the NRS

090 CERT: Subject

certification subject. CN = the following 17 bytes. Spaces are displayed as underscores (_). Asterisks () indicate that no DESS exists.

091 CERT: Serial Number

Displays serial number for the NRS certification. Asterisks () indicate that no DESS exists. Displays the common name of the issuer of the

092 CERT: Issuer

NRS certification. CN = the following 30 bytes. Asteriskes () indicate that no DESS exists.

094 CERT: Valid End

SM Appendix

Displays the start time of the period for which the current NRS certification is enabled. Displays the end time of the period for which the

9-215 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

093 CERT: Valid Start

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode current NRS certification is enabled. 095 Service CN Check 096 GW Host 097 GW URL Path 099 Debug Rescueg/WURL/set Selection Country Select from the list the name of the country where Cumin-M is installed in the machine. After selecting the country, you must also set the following SP 150

codes for Cumin-M: ƒ

SP5816-153

ƒ

SP5816-154

ƒ

SP5816-161

0: Japan, 1: USA, 2: Canada, 3: UK, 4: Germany, 5: France, 6: Italy, 7: Netherlands, 8: Belgium, 9: Luxembourg, 10: Spain Line Type Authentication Judgment Touch [Execute]. Setting this SP classifies the telephone line where Cumin-M is connected as either dial-up or push type, so Cumin-M can automatically distinguish the 151 number that connects to the outside line. ƒ

The current progress, success, or failure of this execution can be displayed with SP5816-152.

ƒ

If the execution succeeded, SP5816-153 will display the result for confirmation and SP5816-154 will display the telephone number for the connection to the outside line.

Line Type Judgment Result Displays a number to show the result of the execution of SP5816 151. Here is 152 a list of what the numbers mean. 0: Success 1: In progress (no result yet). Please wait. 2: Line abnormal

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-216 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 3: Cannot detect dial tone automatically 4: Line is disconnected 5: Insufficient electrical power supply 6: Line classification not supported 7: Error because fax transmission in progress – ioctl() occurred. 8: Other error occurred 9: Line classification still in progress. Please wait. Selection Dial/Push This SP displays the classification (tone or pulse) of the telephone line to the access point for Cumin-M. The numbered displayed (0 or 1) is the result of the execution of SP5816 151. However, this setting can also be changed manually. 153 [0 to 1/ 0 / 1 /step] 0: Tone Dialing Phone 1: Pulse Dialing Phone Inside Japan "2" may also be displayed: 0: Tone Dialing Phone 1: Pulse Dialing Phone 10PPS 2: Pulse Dialing Phone 20PPS Outside Line/Outgoing Number The SP sets the number that switches to PSTN for the outside connection for Cumin-M in a system that employs a PBX (internal line). ƒ 154

If the execution of SP5816 151 has succeeded and Cumin-M has connected to the external line, this SP display is completely blank.

ƒ

If Cumin-M has connected to an internal line, then the number of the connection to the external line is displayed.

ƒ

If Cumin-M has connected to an external line, a comma is displayed with the number. The comma is inserted for a 2 sec. pause.

ƒ

The number setting for the external line can be entered manually

156

Dial Up User Name Use this SP to set a user name for access to remote dial up. Follow these

SM Appendix

9-217 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

(including commas).

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode rules when setting a user name: ƒ

Name length: Up to 32 characters

ƒ

Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation marks (").

Dial Up Password Use this SP to set a password for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules 157 when setting a user name: ƒ

Name length: Up to 32 characters

ƒ

Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation marks (").

Local Phone Number

161

Use this SP to set the telephone number of the line where Cumin-M is connected. This number is transmitted to and used by the Call Center to return calls. Limit: 24 numbers (numbers only) Connection Timing Adjustment: Incoming When the Call Center calls out to a Cumin-M modem, it sends a repeating ID

162

tone (*#1#). This SP sets the line remains open to send these ID tones after the number of the Cumin-M modem is dialed up and connected. [0 to 24 / 1 / 1 /step] The actual amount of time is this setting x 2 sec. For example, if you set "2" the line will remain open for 4 sec. Access Point This is the number of the dial-up access point for Cumin-M. If no setting is

163 done for this SP code, then a preset value (determined by the country selected) is used. Default: 0 Allowed: Up to 16 alphanumeric characters 164 Line Connecting This SP sets the connection conditions for the customer. This setting

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-218 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode dedicates the line to Cumin-M only, or sets the line for sharing between Cumin-M and a fax unit. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Sharing Fax 1: No Sharing Fax ƒ

If this setting is changed, the copier must be cycled off and on.

ƒ

SP5816 187 determines whether the off-hook button can be used to interrupt a Cumin-M transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction.

173 Modem Serial Number

This SP displays the serial number registered for the Cumin-M.

Retransmission Limit Normally, it is best to allow unlimited time for certification and ID2 update 174

requests, and for the notification that the certification has been completed. However, Cumin-M generates charges based on transmission time for the customer, so a limit is placed upon the time allowed for these transactions. If these transactions cannot be completed within the allowed time, do this SP to cancel the time restriction.

186 RCG-CM DebugbitSW FAX TX Priority

-

This SP determines whether pushing the off-hook button will interrupt a 187 Cumin-M transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction. This SP can be used only if SP5816 164 is set to "0". [0 or 1/ 0 / - ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable 200 Manual Polling

-

Executes the manual polling.

201 Displays a number that indicates the status of the NRS service device. 0: Neither the NRS device nor Cumin device are set. 1: The Cumin device is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this

SM Appendix

9-219 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Regist: Status

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode status the Basil unit cannot answer a polling request. 2: The Cumin device is set. In this status the Basil unit cannot answer a polling request. 3: The NRS device is being set. In this status the Cumin device cannot be set. 4: The NRS module has not started. Allows entry of the number of the request needed

202 Letter Number

for the Cumin device.

203 Confirm Execute

Executes the inquiry request to the NRS GW URL.

204 Confirm Result Displays a number that indicates the result of the inquiry executed with SP5816 203. 0: Succeeded 1: Inquiry number error 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled) 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Inquiry executing Confirm Place 205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the GW URL in answer to the inquiry request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the GW URL. 206 Register Execute

Executes Cumin Registration.

Register Result

207

Displays a number that indicates the registration result. 0: Succeeded 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-220 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Registration executing 208 Error Code Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either SP5816-204 or SP5816-207 was executed.

Illegal Modem Parameter

Code

Meaning

-11001

Chat parameter error

-11002

Chat execution error

-11003

Unexpected error

-12002

Operation Error, Incorrect Setting

-12003

of an inquiry and no previous registration.

Error Caused by

Attempted setting with illegal entries for certification and ID2. Attempted dial up overseas without the

-2385

URL

SM Appendix

acquiring device status. Attempted registration without execution

-12004

Response from GW

Inquiry, registration attempted without

correct international prefix for the telephone number.

-2387

Not supported at the Service Center

-2389

Database out of service

-2390

Program out of service

-2391

Two registrations for same device

-2392

Parameter error

9-221 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Cause

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode -2393

Basil not managed

-2394

Device not managed

-2395

Box ID for Basil is illegal

-2396

Device ID for Basil is illegal

-2397

Incorrect ID2 format

-2398

Incorrect request number format

209 @Remote Setting Clear Releases the machine from its Cumin setup. 250 CommLog Print

5821

Prints the communication log.

[Remote Service Address] Sets the IP address of the RCG 002 RCG IP Address

*CTL

(Remote Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center.

[NV-RAM Data Upload]

5824

Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the “System Maintenance Reference” of the Field Service Manual. 001 NV-RAM Data Upload

#

-

[NV-RAM Data Download] 5825

Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the “System Maintenance Reference” of the Field Service Manual. 001 NV-RAM Download

D037/D038/D040/D041

#

-

9-222 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5828

*CTL

[Network Setting] 001

002

003

006

-

IPv4 Address (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) IPv4 Subnet Mask (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) IPv4 Default Gateway (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) Not Used

DHCP (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)

021 Active IPv4 Address 022 Active IPv4 Subnet Mask 023

050

Active IPv4 Gateway Address Enables or disables 1284 Compatibility.

1284 Compatibility

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]

(Centro)

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Enables or disables ECP Compatibility. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

052 ECP (Centro)

ƒ

This SP is activated only when SP5-828-50 is set to "1".

Enables/disables Job Spooling. 065 Job Spooling

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

066

Job Spooling Clear: Start

power on.

Time

0: ON (Data is cleared) 1: OFF (Automatically printed)

SM Appendix

9-223 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Treatment of the job when a spooled job exists at

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Validates or invalidates the job spooling function for each protocol. 0: Validates 1: Invalidates bit0: LPR 069 Job Spooling (Protocol)

bit1: FTP bit2: IPP bit3: SMB bit4: BMLinkS bit5: DIPRINT bit6: sftp bit7: (Reserved) Enables or disables the Telnet protocol.

090 TELNET (0: OFF 1: ON)

[0 or 1 / 1 / – ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable Enables or disables the Web operation.

091 Web (0: OFF 1: ON)

[0 or 1 / 1 / – ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable This is the IPv6 local address link referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the

145

Active IPv6 Link Local

format:

Address

"Link Local Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.

147

149

151

153

Active IPv6 Stateless

These SPs are the IPv6 status addresses (1 to 5)

Address 1

referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN

Active IPv6 Stateless Address 2 Active IPv6 Stateless

(802.11b) in the format: "Status Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.

Address 3 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 4

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-224 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 155

Active IPv6 Stateless Address 5 This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:

156 IPv6 Manual Address

"Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced

158 IPv6 Gateway Address

on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b). The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. Enables or disables the automatic setting for

161

IPv6 Stateless Auto

IPv6 stateless.

Setting

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable Displays or does not display the Web system items. [0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed

236 Web Item visible

bit0: Net RICOH bit1: Consumable Supplier bit2-15: Reserved (all) Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top page and link page of the web 237 Web shopping link visible

system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display

238 Web supplies Link visible

Consumable Supplier on the top page and link page of the web system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1]

SM Appendix

9-225 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Displays or does not display the link to

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 0: Not display, 1:Display This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on 239 Web Link1 Name

the link page of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL name are 31 characters. This SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on

240 Web URL

the link page of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL are 127 characters. Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page of the web system.

241 Web visible

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display

242 Web Link2 Name

Same as "-239"

243 Web Link2 URL

Same as "-240"

244 Web Link2 visible

Same as "-241"

5832

*CTL

[HDD] HDD Initialization

Initializes the hard disk. Use this SP

001 HDD Formatting (ALL)

mode only if there is a hard disk error.

002 HDD Formatting (IMH) 003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail) 004 HDD Formatting (Job Log) 005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts) 006 HDD Formatting (User Info) 007 Mail RX Data 008 Mail TX Data 009

HDD Formatting (Data for a Design)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-226 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 010 HDD Formatting (Log) 011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F)

5836

001

[Capture Settings]

*CTL

Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)

0: Disable, 1: Enable

With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot be initialized, displayed, or selected.

002

Panel Setting

0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed

Displays or does not display the capture function buttons. 5836-71 to 5836-76, Copier and Printer Document Reduction The following 6 SP modes set the default reduction for stored documents sent to the document management server via the MLB. Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed. 071 Reduction for Copy Color

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

074 Reduction for Printer Color

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

075 Reduction for Printer B&W

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

076 Reduction for Printer B&W HQ

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

5836-81 to 5836-86, Stored document format The following 6 SP modes set Sets the default format for stored documents sent to the document management server via the MLB. Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed. 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

ƒ

SM Appendix

9-227 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

This SP is not used in this

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR

081 Format for Copy Color

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode model. 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

082 Format for Copy B&W Text

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

083 Format Copy B&W Other

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR

084 Format for Printer Color ƒ

This SP is not used in this model.

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

085 Format for Printer B&W

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

086 Format for Printer B&W HQ

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR

Default for JPEG

[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]

091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via the MLB with JPEG selected as the format. Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed. Sets the IP address for the primary capture 101 Primary srv IP address

server. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

102 Primary srv scheme 103

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

Primary srv port

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

number

104 Primary srv URL path

111

Sets the IP address for the secondary capture

Secondary srv IP

server. This is basically adjusted by the remote

address

system.

112 Secondary srv scheme

D037/D038/D040/D041

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

9-228 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 113

114

120

Secondary srv port number Secondary srv URL path Default Reso Rate Switch Reso: Copy (Color)

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]

121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi Reso: Copy (Mono)

[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]

122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi Reso: Print (Color) 123

This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for color print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi Reso: Print (Color)

124

This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi

[IEEE 802.11b] [1 to 11 or 13 / 11 or 13 / 1 /step] 006 Channel MAX

*CTL

Europe/Asia: 1 to 13 NA/ Asia: 1 to 11

SM Appendix

9-229 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5840

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN. The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum number of channels. DFU ƒ

Do not change the setting. [1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]

Channel MIN

*CTL

Europe: 1 to 13 NA/ Asia: 1 to 11

007

Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN. The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum number of channels. DFU ƒ

Do not change the setting. [0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -] 0 x FF to Auto [Default] 0 x 11 – 55M Fix 0 x 10 – 48M Fix 0 x 0F – 36M Fix 0 x 0E – 18M Fix 0 x 0D – 12M Fix

008 Transmission Speed

*CTL

0 x 0B – 9M Fix 0 x 0A – 6M Fix 0 x 07 – 11M Fix 0 x 05 – 5.5M Fix 0 x 08 – 1M Fix 0 x 13 – 0 x FE (reserved) 0 x 12 – 72M (reserved) 0 x 09 – 22M (reserved) Selects the WEP key.

011 WEP key Select

*CTL

[00 to 11 / 00 / 1 binary] 00: Key #1

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-230 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 01: Key #2 (Reserved) 10: Key #3 (Reserved) 11: Key #4 (Reserved) Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11 card. 042 Fragment Thresh

*CTL

[256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1] This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. Determines whether the CTS self function is turned on or off.

043 1g CTS to Self

*CTL

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.

044 11g Slot Time

*CTL

Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 µm, 1: 9 µm Selects the debug level for WPA authentication application.

045 WPA Debug Lvl

*CTL

[1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.

5841

[Supply Name Setting] 001 Toner Name Setting: Black

*CTL

Specifies supply names. These appear on the screen when the

002 Toner Name Setting: Cyan

user presses the Inquiry button in the user tools screen.

003 Toner Name Setting: Yellow 004 Toner Name Setting: Magenta

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

007 OrgStamp 011 Staple Std1 012 Staple Std2

SM Appendix

9-231 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 013 Staple Std3 014 Staple Std4

5842

[GWWS Analysis Mode] DFU Default: 00000000 – do not change 001 Setting 1

*CTL

Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software Adjusts the debug program modesetting. Bit7: 5682 mmseg-log setting

002 Setting 2

*CTL

0: Date/Hour/Minute/Second 1: Minute/Second/Msec. 0 to 6: Not used

5844

[USB]

001

Transfer Rate

*CTL

0x01: Full speed 0x04: Auto Change

Adjusts the USB transfer rate. 002 Vendor ID

*CTL

Displays the vendor ID. DFU

003 Product ID

*CTL

Displays the product ID. DFU

004

Device Release

*CTL

Number

100 Notify Unsupport

5845

*CTL

[Delivery Server Setting]

Displays the development release version number. DFU -

*CTL

-

Provides items for delivery server settings. 001 FTP Port No.

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1 /step]

9-232 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Sets the FTP port number used when image files to the Scan Router Server. Range: 000.000.000.000 to

IP Address (Primary)

255.255.255.255

002

Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab can be referenced by the initial system setting. Delivery Error Display Time

[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 second /step]

006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external device. IP Address (Secondary) 008

Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255

Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without reference to the DNS setting. Delivery Server Model

[0 to 4/ 0 / 1 /step]

Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device. 009

0: Unknown 1: SG1 Provided 2: SG1 Package 3: SG2 Provided 4: SG2 Package

010 Delivery Svr Capability

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered. Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists

SM Appendix

9-233 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to “0”) Delivery Svr Capability (Ext)

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered. 011 Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user) Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link Bit5 to 0: Not used

013

Server Scheme (Primary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.

014

Server Port Number (Primary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.

015

Server URL Path (Primary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.

016

Server Scheme (Secondary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.

017

Server Port Number (Secondary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.

018

Server URL Path (Secondary) DFU This is used for the scan router program. Rapid Sending Control

022

Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error. [0 to 1 / 0 / -] 0: Disable, 1: Enable

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-234 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5846

*CTL

[UCS Settings]

-

Machine ID (For Delivery Server)

001

Displays ID

Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary. Machine ID Clear (For Delivery Server)

002

Clears ID

Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on. Maximum Entries

[2000 to 20000/ 2000 /1 /step]

003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle. If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the data (excluding user code information) is displayed. Delivery Server Retry Timer 006

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. Delivery Server Retry Times

007

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. Delivery Server Maximum Entries

008

[2000 to 50000 / 2000 / 1/step]

Sets the maximum number account entries of the delivery server user information managed by UCS. LDAP Search Timeout

[1 to 255 / 60 / 1 /step]

Sets the length of the timeout for the search of the LDAP server. 040 Addr Book Migration (SD => HDD)

SM Appendix

9-235 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

010

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Not used in this machine. Fill Addr Acl Info. This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician 041

immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users. Procedure 1. Turn the machine off. 2. Install the new HDD. 3. Turn the machine on. 4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically. 5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system administrator or key operator. 6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes successfully, any user can access the address book. Displays the slot number where an address book data is in. [0 to 30 / - /1] 0: Unconfirmed 1: SD Slot 1

043 Addr Book Media

2: SD Slot 2 4: USB Flash ROM 20: HDD 30: Nothing 046 Initialize All Setting & Addr 047 Initialize Local Addr Book

048

Clears the local address book information, including the user code.

Initialize Delivery Addr

Clears the distribution address book

Book

information, except the user code.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-236 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 049 Initialize LDAP Addr Book

050 Initialize All Addr Book

Clears the LDAP address book information, except the user code. Clears all directory information managed by UCS, including all user codes. Uploads all directory information to the SD

051 Backup All Addr Book

card.

052 Restore All Addr Book

Downloads all directory information from the SD card. Deletes the address book data from the SD card in the service slot. Deletes only the files that were uploaded from this machine. This feature does not work if the card is

053 Clear Backup Info

write-protected. ƒ

After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, and then turn the power off.

ƒ

Do not remove the SD card until the Power LED stops flashing.

Search Option This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book. 060

Bit: Meaning 0: Checks both upper/lower case characters 1: Japan Only 2: Japan Only 3: Japan Only 4 to 7: Not Used

062

Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case

SM Appendix

9-237 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Complexity Option 1

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode and sets the length of the password. [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step] ƒ

This SP does not normally require adjustment.

ƒ

This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book.

063 Complexity Option 2 DFU 064 Complexity Option 3 DFU 065 Complexity Option 4 DFU Specifies the FTP port for getting a 091 FTP Auth Port Setting

distribution server address book that is used in the identification mode. [0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1 /step] Shows the status of the encryption function

094 Encryption Stat

for the address book data.

*CTL

[Rep Resolution Reduction]

-

5847 1 through 5847 8 changes the default settings of image data transferred externally by the Net File page reference function. 5847

[ 0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step] 5847 21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile. “Net files” are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software. 001 Rate for Copy Color

0: 1x 1: 1/2x

002 Rate for Copy B&W Text

2: 1/3x

003 Rate for Copy B&W Other

3: 1/4x 4: 1/6x

004 Rate for Printer Color

5: 1/8x 005 Rate for Printer B&W

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-238 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Network Quality Default for JPEG

021

Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. This function is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed. [5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]

*CTL

[Web Service]

-

5848 2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. Setting

5848

of 0001 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router. 5848 100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The default is equal to 1 gigabyte.

003

004

007

009

011

021

022

Lower 4 bits)

0000: No access control 0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder. 0010: No writing control

Access Control: Doc. Svr. Print (Lower 4 bits) Access Control: User Directory (only Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: Comm. Log Fax (Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: Job Ctrl (Lower 4 bits)

Switches access control on and off. 0000: No access control 0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder.

Access Ctrl: Device management (Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: uAdministration Appendix: SP Mode Tables

002

Access Ctrl: Repository (only

(Lower 4bits)

099 Repository: Download Image -

SM Appendix

9-239 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Setting

100

Repository: Download Image Max. Size

Specifies the max size of the image data that the machine can download. [1 to 1024 / 1024 / 1 MB /step]

210 Setting: LogType: Job1 211 Setting: LogType: Job2 212 Setting: LogType: Access 213 Setting: Primary Srv

NIA

214 Setting: Secondary Srv 215 Setting: Start Time 216 Setting: Interval Time 217 Setting: Timing

5849

[Installation Date]

5849 1 Display

*CTL

-

The “Counter Clear Day” has been changed to “Installation Date” or “Inst. Date”. Determines whether the installation date is printed on the printout for the total counter.

5849 2 Switch to Print

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF (No Print) 1: ON (Print)

003 Total Counter

-

[Bluetooth Mode] 5851

Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key. [0:Public] [1: Private]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-240 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [Stamp Data Download] Use this SP to download the fixed stamp data stored in the firmware of the ROM and copy it to the HDD. This SP can be executed as many times as

5853

required. This SP must be executed after replacing or formatting the hard disks. ƒ

This SP can be executed only with the hard disks installed.

[Remote ROM Update] 5856

Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware using a local port (IEEE1284) when updating the remote ROM. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step] 002 Local Port

*CTL

0: Disable 1: Enable

5857

*CTL

[Save Debug Log] On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF) 001

-

0: OFF, 1: ON

Switches the debug log feature on and off. The debug log cannot be captured until this feature is switched on. Target (2: HDD 3: SD)

2: HDD, 3: SD Card

002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with SP5-858 are satisfied. [ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step] Save to HDD

005

Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD. A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on Appendix: SP Mode Tables

the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to each SD Card. 006 Save to SD Card

SM Appendix

9-241 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card. 009 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB) 010 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB Any Key) 011 Erase HDD Debug Data 012 Erase SD Card Debug Data 013 Free Space on SD Card 014 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB) 015 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB Any Key) 016 Make HDD Debug 017 Make SD Debug

[Debug Save When]

5858

*CTL

-

These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination selected by SP5857-002. SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes. Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes

001 Engine SC Error

generated by copier engine errors. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step] 0: OFF, 1: ON Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes

002 Controller SC Error

generated by GW controller errors. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step] 0: OFF, 1: ON

003 Any SC Error 004 Jam

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step] Turns on/off the debug save for jam errors. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]

9-242 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 0: OFF, 1: ON

5859

*CTL

[Debug Save Key No.]

-

001 Key 1 002 Key 2 003 Key 3 004 Key 4

These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log

005 Key 5

files for functions that use common memory on the controller board.

006 Key 6

[–9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / – ]

007 Key 7 008 Key 8 009 Key 9 010 Key 10

5860

*CTL

[SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]

-

020 Partial Mail Receive Timeout

[1 to 168 / 72 / – ]

Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this prescribed time. 021 MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance

[0 to 1 / 1 / – ]

Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply mail. 0: No 1: Yes [0 to 1 / 0 / – ]

Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account after the SMTP server is validated.

SM Appendix

9-243 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

022 SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 0: No. “From” item not switched. 1: Yes. “From item switched. 025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting

[0 or 1 / 0 / – ]

Selects the authentication method for SMTP. Bit switch: • Bit 0: LOGIN • Bit 1: PLAIN • Bit 2: CRAM MD5 • Bit 3: DIGEST MD5 • Bit 4 to 7: Not used ƒ

This SP is activated only when SMTP authorization is enabled by UP mode. Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent by S/MIME.

026

S/MIME: MIME Header

-

Setting

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard 1: Internet Draft standard 2: RFC standard

5866

[E-mail Alert] Not Used

001 Report Validity

*CTL

Adds or does not add the date field to

005 Add Date Field

*CTL

the header of the alert mail. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Not added, 1: Added

5870

[Common Key Info Writing] Writes to flash ROM the common proof

001 Writing

*CTL

for validating the device for NRS specifications.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-244 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 003 Initialize

5873

*CTL

-

[SD Card Appli Move] This SP copies the application programs from the original

001 Move Exec

SD card in SD card slot 2 to an SD card in SD card slot 1 (slot 1 has the priority to be copied). This SP copies back the application programs from an SD card in SD Card Slot 2 to the original SD card in SD card slot

002 Undo Exec

1 (slot 1 has the priority to be copied). Use this menu when you have mistakenly copied some programs by using "Move Exec" (SP5873-1).

5875

[SC Auto Reboot] Enables or disables the automatic reboot function when an SC error occurs. [0 or 1/ 0 / – ] 0: The machine reboots automatically when the machine issues an SC error and logs the SC

001 Reboot Setting

*CTL

error code. If the same SC occurs again, the machine does not reboot. 1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error occurs. The reboot is not executed for Type A or C SC codes. Selects the reboot method for SC.

002 Reboot Type

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot

[Security Clear] DFU

001 All Clear

*ENG

-

011 Clear NCS Security

*ENG

-

SM Appendix

9-245 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5876

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 015 Clear UCS Security

5878

*ENG

-

[Option Setup] Enables the Data Overwrite Security unit.

001 Data Overwrite Security

-

Press "EXECUTE" on the operation panel. Then turn the machine off and on.

002 HDD Encryption

5881

*ENG

-

*ENG

-

[CPM Set] DFU

001 -

5884

Installs the HDD Encryption unit.

[Fixed Phrase Block erasing]

001 -

5882

-

[Plain 1/2 Setting]

001 By-pass Table

*ENG

002 Tray 1

*ENG

003 Tray 2

*ENG

004 Tray 3

*ENG

005 Tray 4

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: Plain Paper 1 1: Plain Paper 2

5885

[WIM Settings] Web Image Monitor Settings Close or disclose the functions of web image monitor. 0: OFF, 1: ON

020

Document Server ACC Ctrl

*CTL

Bit Meaning 0: Forbid all document server access (1) 1: Forbid user mode access (1)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-246 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 2: Forbid print function (1) 3: Forbid fax TX (1) 4: Forbid scan sending (1) 5: Forbid downloading (1) 6: Forbid delete (1) 7: Reserved Selects the display type for the document box list.

050 DocSvr Format

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details Sets the number of documents to be

051 DocSvr Trans

displayed in the document box list. [5 to 20 / 10 / 1]

100 Set Signature

Determines whether the scanned documents with the WIM are encrypted when they are transmitted by an e-mail.

101 Set Encryption

[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption 200 Detect Mem Leak

-

201 DocSur Timeout

-

5887

[SD Get Counter] This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated. This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). The operation stores. The file is stored in *CTL

a folder created in the root directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER. The file is saved as a text file (*.txt) prefixed with the number of the machine.

SM Appendix

9-247 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 -

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 1.

Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot).

2.

Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].

Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted.

5888

[Personal Information Protect] Selects the protection level for logs. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1}

001 -

0: No authentication, No protection for

*CTL

logs 1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an administrator can see the logs)

5894

[External Charge Unit Setting] -

001 Switch Charge Mode

5896

*ENG

[Copy/PrinterPriority]

001 -

5907

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]

-

[Plug & Play Maker/Model Name] Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these

001 names should be registered again. After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting is completed, the beeper sounds five times.

5913

[Switchover Permission Time]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-248 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Print Application Timer

*CTL

[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second /step]

002 Sets the amount of time to elapse while the machine is in standby mode (and the operation panel keys have not been used) before another application can gain control of the display.

5967

*CTL

[Copy Server Set Function]

0: ON, 1: OFF

Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that 001

prevents image data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.

5974

[Cherry Server] Specifies which version of ScanRouter, “Lite” or “Full”, is installed. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ]

001 Cherry Server

*CTL

0: Lite 1: Full

[Device Setting] 5985

The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller board, these SP codes must be set to "1". [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication. ƒ

Other network applications than NRS or LDAP/NT authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even though you can change the initial settings of those

SM Appendix

9-249 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 On Board NIC

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode network applications, the settings do not work. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

002 On Board USB

5987

0: Disable, 1: Enable

[Mech. Counter Protection] This SP detects that a mechanical counter device

001 0: OFF / 1: ON

5990

is removed. If it is detected, SC610 occurs.

[SP print mode] Prints out the SMC sheets. 001 All (Data List)

-

002 SP (Mode Data List)

-

003 User Program

-

004 Logging Data

-

005 Diagnostic Report

-

006 Non-Default

-

007 NIB Summary

-

008 Capture Log

-

021 Copier User Program

-

022 Scanner SP

-

023 Scanner User Program

-

-

SP6-XXX (Peripherals)

6006

[ADF Adjustment]

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-250 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Adjusts the side-to-side and leading registration of originals with the ARDF. 001 S-to-S Registration 1st

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] *ENG

002 S-to-S Registration 2nd 003 Leading Edge Registration

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides. 005 Buckle: Duplex: 1st

*ENG

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

006 Buckle: Duplex: 2nd Adjusts the erase margin at the original trailing edge. 007 Trailing Edge Erase

*ENG

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

[ADF Input Check] 6007

Displays the signals received from the sensors and switches of the ARDF. Only Bit 0 is used for ADF input check ( “Iutput Check Table” in this section").

[ADF Output Check] 6008

Activates the electrical components for functional check. It is not possible to activate more than one component at the same time ( “Output Check Table” in this section")

6009

[ADF Free Run] Performs a DF free run in simplex, duplex mode or stamp mode.

6010

-

[Stamp Position Adj.] Fax Stamp Position Adjustment Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals.

SM Appendix

9-251 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

002 Free Run Duplex Mode

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 6010 1 Stamp Position Adj.

*ENG

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Original Size Detection Priority] Original Size Detection Priority 6016

Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors cannot recognize all sizes. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] *ENG

0: Setting 1 1: Setting 2

001

Original Size Detection

NA

Priority

EU/ ASIA

6017

Setting 1

Setting 2

DLT SEF

Folio SEF 11" x 15"

LG SEF

Foolscap SEF

LT SEF

US EXE 8" x 10"

LT LEF

US EXE LEF

DLT SEF

8K 267 x 390 mm

LT SEF

16K 195 x 267 mm

LT LEF

16K 267 x 195 mm

[DF Magnification Adj.] DF Magnification Adjustment Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for the ARDF.

001 DF Magnification Adj.

*CTL

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

[Staple Position Adjustment] 6101

Adjusts the staple position for finisher. + Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side. - Value: Moves the staple position to the front side.

001 -

D037/D038/D040/D041

ENG

[-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.2mm/step]

9-252 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

6102

[Punch Position Adjustment] Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction.

001 Leading Edge Adjustment

6103

ENG

[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.1mm/step]

ENG

[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.1mm/step]

[Jogger Position Adjustment] Adjusts the jogger position

001 -

6104

[Punch Position Adjustment] Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction.

001 Side-to-Side Adjustment

ENG

[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.2mm/step]

[Finisher Input Check] Finisher (D429) 6120

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the finisher. ( “Iutput Check Table” in this section")

[Finisher Output Check] Finisher (D429) 6121

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the finisher. ( “Output Check Table” in this section")

SP7-XXX (Data Log)

[Total SC Counter] Displays the number of SC codes detected.

001 SC Counter

SM Appendix

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step ]

9-253 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

7401

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [SC History] 7403

Logs the SC codes detected. The 10 most recently detected SC Codes are not displayed on the screen, but can be seen on the SMC (logging) outputs.

001 Latest 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4

*CTL

-

006 Latest 5 007 Latest 6 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 010 Latest 9

7502

[Total Paper Jam Counter] Displays the total number of jams detected.

001 Total Jam

7503

* CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

[Total Original Jam Counter] Displays the total number of original jams.

001 Original Jam counter

7504

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 original/step ]

[Paper Jam Location] ON: On check, OFF: Off Check

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-254 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Displays the number of jams according to the location where jams were detected. NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station. *CTL

003 Tray 1: ON

*CTL

004 Tray 2: ON

*CTL

005 Tray 3: ON

*CTL

006 Tray 4: ON

*CTL

008 Bypass: ON

*CTL

009 Duplex: ON

*CTL

011 Vertical Transport 1: ON

*CTL

012 Vertical Transport 2: ON

*CTL

017 Registration: ON

*CTL

018 Fusing Entrance: ON

*CTL

019 Fusing Exit: ON

*CTL

020 Paper Exit: ON

*CTL

021 Relay Exit: ON

*CTL

022 Relay Transport: ON

*CTL

025 Duplex Exit: ON

*CTL

026 Duplex Reverse: ON

*CTL

027 Duplex Entrance: ON

*CTL

028 1 Bin Exit Sensor

*CTL

051 SEF Sensor 1

*CTL

052 SEF Sensor 2

*CTL

SM Appendix

9-255 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

For details, the "Jam Detection" in the Appendix Jam Detection.

For details, the "Jam Detection" in the Appendix Jam Detection.

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 At Power On

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

7505

053 Bank SEF Sensor 1

*CTL

057 Regist Sensor

*CTL

059 Fusing Exit Sensor

*CTL

060 Exit Sensor

*CTL

062 Relay Sensor

*CTL

065 Duplex Exit Sensor

*CTL

068 1-Bin Exit: ON

*CTL

240 Finisher Entrance

*CTL

241 Finisher Shift Tray Exit

*CTL

242 Finisher Staple

*CTL

243 Finisher Exit

*CTL

244 Finisher Drive Motor

*CTL

245 Finisher Tray Lift Motor

*CTL

246 Finisher Jogger Motor

*CTL

247 Finisher Shift Motor

*CTL

248 Finisher Staple Motor

*CTL

249 Finisher Exit Motor

*CTL

250 Finisher Entrance

*CTL

251 Finisher Proof Exit

*CTL

For details, the "Jam Detection" in the Appendix Jam Detection.

[Original Jam Detection] Displays the total number of original jams by location.

001 At Power On

*CTL

-

003 Skew Correction: ON

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-256 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 004 Registration: ON 005 Paper Exit: ON 053 Skew Correction: OFF 054 Registration: OFF 055 Paper Exit: OFF

7506

[Jam Count by Paper Size] Displays the number of jams according to the paper size. 005 A4 LEF 006 A5 LEF 014 B5 LEF 038 LT LEF 044 HLT LEF 132 A3 SEF 133 A4 SEF 134 A5 SEF

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

141 B4 SEF 142 B5 SEF 160 DLT SEF 164 LG SEF 166 LT SEF

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

172 HLT SEF 255 Others

SM Appendix

9-257 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 7507

[Plotter Jam History] Displays the 10 most recently detected paper jams.

001 Latest 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4

*CTL

-

006 Latest 5 007 Latest 6 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 010 Latest 9

7508

[Original Jam History] Displays the 10 most recently detected original jams. 001 Latest

*CTL

-

002 Latest-1 003 Latest-2 004 Latest-3 005 Latest-4 006 Latest-5 007 Latest-6 008 Latest-7 009 Latest-8

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-258 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 010 Latest-9

7624

[Parts PM Use Setting] 001 PCU:Bk

*CTL

002 PCU:M

*CTL

003 PCU:C

*CTL

004 PCU:Y

*CTL

005 Dev Unit:Bk

*CTL

006 Dev Unit:M

*CTL

007 Dev Unit:C

*CTL

008 Dev Unit:Y

*CTL

009 Fusing Unit

*CTL

010 Fusing Roller

*CTL

011 Fusing Belt

*CTL

012

7801

PCU Toner Collection

*CTL

Bottle

[ROM No./Firmware Version] 255 Engine

7803

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

*CTL

-

[PM Counter Display] (Page, Unit, [Color])

PM counters click up based on the number of A4 (LT) LEF size sheets printed. Therefore, the A3 (DLT) Double Count is activated. The Double Count cannot be deactivated.

SM Appendix

9-259 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Displays the number of sheets printed for each current maintenance unit.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed. Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous (SP7-906-1 to 10) and is reset to “0”. The total number of sheets printed with the last unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-1 to 10. NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station. 001 Paper 002 Page: PCU: Bk 003 Page: PCU: C 004 Page: PCU: M 005 Page: PCU: Y 006 Page: Development Unit: Bk 007 Page: Development Unit: C 008 Page: Development Unit: M 009 Page: Development Unit: Y 010 Page: Developer: Bk 011 Page: Developer: C 012 Page: Developer: M 013 Page: Developer: Y 014 Page: ITB Unit 015 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit 016 Page: Fusing Unit 017 Page: Fusing Roller 018 Page: Fusing Belt 019 Page:PTR Unit

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-260 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 020 Page:ITB T-Collect Bottle 021 Page:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the number of revolutions of motors or clutches for each current maintenance unit. [ 0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 revolution/step ] When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed. Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous (SP7-906-11 to 20) and is reset to “0”. The total number of revolutions made with the last unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-11 to 20. 031 Rotation: PCU: Bk 032 Rotation: PCU: C 033 Rotation: PCU: M 034 Rotation: PCU: Y 035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk 036 Rotation: Development Unit: C 037 Rotation: Development Unit: M 038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y 039 Rotation: Developer: Bk 040 Rotation: Developer: C 041 Rotation: Developer: M 042 Rotation: Developer: Y 043 Rotation:ITB Unit

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

044 Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit 045 Rotation: Fusing Unit 046 Rotation: Fusing Roller

SM Appendix

9-261 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 047 Rotation: Fusing Belt 048 Rotation: PTR Unit [0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ] Displays the value given by the following formula: (Current revolution ÷ Target revolution) × 100. This shows how much of the unit’s expected lifetime has been used up. The Rotation% counter is based on rotations, not prints. If the number of rotations reaches the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the print count lifetime is reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the R% counter is still less than 100%. 049 Amount:ITB T-Collect Bottle 050 Amount:PCU T-Collect Bottle [0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ] *ENG

061 Rotation (%): PCU: Bk

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

062 Rotation (%): PCU: C 063 Rotation (%): PCU: M 064 Rotation (%): PCU: Y 065 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Bk 066 Rotation (%): Development Unit: C 067 Rotation (%): Development Unit:M 068 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Y 069 Rotation (%): Developer: Bk 070 Rotation (%): Developer: C 071 Rotation (%): Developer: M 072 Rotation (%): Developer: Y 073 Rotation (%): ITB Unit

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-262 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 074 Rotation (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit 076 Rotation (%): Fusing Roller 077 Rotation (%): Fusing Belt 078 Rotation (%):PTR Unit Displays the value given by the following formula: (Current printouts ÷ Target printouts) × 100. This shows how much of the unit’s expected lifetime has been used up. The Page% counter is based on printouts, not revolutions. If the number of printouts reaches the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the revolution count lifetime is reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the Page% counter is still less than 100%. 079 Amt(%):ITB T-Collect Bottle 080 Amt(%):PCU T-Collect Bottle [0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step] 091 Page (%): PCU: Bk 092 Page (%): PCU: C 093 Page (%): PCU: M 094 Page (%): PCU: Y 095 Page (%): Development Unit: Bk 096

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

Page (%): Development Unit: C 097 Page (%): Development Unit: M 098 Page (%): Development Unit: Y

100 Page (%): Developer: C

SM Appendix

9-263 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

099 Page (%): Developer: Bk

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 101 Page (%): Developer: M 102 Page (%): Developer: Y 103 Page (%): ITB Unit 104 Page (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 105 Page (%): Fusing Unit 106 Page (%): Fusing Roller 107 Page (%): Fusing Belt 108 Page (%): PTR Unit

7804

[PM Counter Reset] PM Counter Clear (Unit, [Color]) Clears the PM counter. Press the Enter key after the machine asks “Execute?”, which will store the PM counter value in SP7-906 (PM Counter - Previous) and reset the value of the current PM counter (SP7-803) to “0”. 001 Paper 002 PCU: Bk 003 PCU: C 004 PCU: M 005 PCU: Y 006 PCU: All 007 Development Unit: Bk 008 Development Unit: C 009 Development Unit: M 010 Development Unit: Y

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-264 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 011 Development Unit: All 012 Developer: Bk 013 Developer: C 014 Developer: M 015 Developer: Y 016 Developer: All 017 ITB Unit 018 ITB Cleaning Unit 019 Fusing Unit 020 Fusing Roller 021 Fusing Belt 022 PTR Unit 023 ITB T-Collect Bottle 024 PCU T-Collect Bottle 100 All

7807

[SC/Jam Counter Reset] Clears the counters related to SC codes and paper jams.

001 SC/Jam Clear

-

[MF Error Counter] Japan Only

001 Error Total

*CTL

-

002 Error Staple

*CTL

-

SM Appendix

9-265 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

7826

*CTL

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 7827

[MF Error Counter Clear] Japan Only *CTL

-

7832

-

[Self-Diagnose Result Display] Displays the result of the diagnostics.

001 Diag. Result

*CTL

-

001 Copy ACC

-

-

002 Printer ACC

--

7835

7836

[ACC Counter]

Total Memory Size (CTL) Displays the memory capacity of the controller system. -

*CTL

-

[DF Glass Dust Check] 7852

Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1 (ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.

7853

001 Dust Detection Counter

*CTL

002 Dust Detection Clear Counter

*CTL

[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]

[Replacement Counter] Displays the PM parts replacement number. 001 PCU: Bk

*CTL

002 PCU: C

*CTL

D037/D038/D040/D041

[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]

9-266 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 003 PCU: M

*CTL

004 PCU: Y

*CTL

005 Development Unit: Bk

*CTL

006 Development Unit: C

*CTL

007 Development Unit: M

*CTL

008 Development Unit: Y

*CTL

009 Developer: Bk

*CTL

010 Developer: C

*CTL

011 Developer: M

*CTL

012 Developer: Y

*CTL

013 ITB Unit

*CTL

014 ITB Cleaning Unit

*CTL

015 Fusing Unit

*CTL

016 Fusing Roller

*CTL

017 Fusing Belt

*CTL

018 PTR Unit

*CTL

019 ITB T-Collect Bottle

*CTL

020 PCU T-Collect Bottle

*CTL

[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]

[Coverage Range] Sets the color coverage threshold. 7855

Coverage rate = Coverage per page / A4 full coverage (dots) x 100 ƒ

[A] 5% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-001.

ƒ

[B] 20% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-002.

SM Appendix

9-267 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

There are three coverage counters: Color 1, Color 2, and Color 3

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

The setting value [B] must be set larger than [A].

The total numbers of printouts (BW printing plus color printing) for each coverage range are displayed with the following SPs. ƒ

Color1 counter: SP8601-021

ƒ

Color2 counter: SP8601-022

ƒ

Color3 counter: SP8601-023

001 Coverage Range 1

*CTL

[1 to 200 / 5 /1]

002 Coverage Range 2

*CTL

[1 to 200 / 20 /1]

[Assert Info] 7901

Records the location where a problem is detected in the program. The data stored in this SP is used for problem analysis. DFU 001 File Name *CTL

002 Number of Lines

-

003 Location

[Prev. Unit PM Counter] 7906

(Page or Rotations, Unit, [Color]), Dev.: Development Unit

*ENG

Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance units. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ] 001 Page: PCU: Bk 002 Page: PCU: C 003 Page: PCU: M 004 Page: PCU: Y

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-268 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 005 Page: Development Unit: Bk 006 Page: Development Unit: C 007 Page: Development Unit: M 008 Page: Development Unit: Y 009 Page: Developer: Bk 010 Page: Developer: C 011 Page: Developer: M 012 Page: Developer: Y 013 Page: ITB Unit 014 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit 015 Page: Fusing Unit 016 Page: Fusing Roller 017 Page: Fusing Belt 018 Page: PTR Unit 019 Page:ITB T-Collect Bottle 020 Page:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ] 031 Rotation: PCU: Bk 032 Rotation: PCU: C 033 Rotation: PCU: M Appendix: SP Mode Tables

034 Rotation: PCU: Y 035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk

SM Appendix

9-269 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 036 Rotation: Development Unit: C 037 Rotation: Development Unit: M 038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y 039 Rotation: Developer: Bk 040 Rotation: Developer: C 041 Rotation: Developer: M 042 Rotation: Developer: Y 043 Rotation: ITB Unit 044 Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit 045 Rotation: Fusing Unit 046 Rotation: Fusing Roller 047 Rotation: Fusing Belt 048 Rotation: PTR Unit 049 Rotation:ITB T-Collect Bottle 050 Rotation:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ] 061 Rotation (%): PCU: Bk 062 Rotation (%): PCU: C 063 Rotation (%): PCU: M 064 Rotation (%): PCU: Y 065 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Bk 066 Rotation (%): Development Unit: C

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-270 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 067 Rotation (%): Development Unit: M 068 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Y 069 Rotation (%): Developer: Bk 070 Rotation (%): Developer: C 071 Rotation (%): Developer: M 072 Rotation (%): Developer: Y 073 Rotation (%): ITB Unit 074 Rotation (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit 076 Rotation (%): Fusing Roller 077 Rotation (%): Fusing Belt 078 Rotation (%): PTU Unit 079 Rotation %:ITB T-Collect Bottle 080 Rotation %:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the value given by the following formula: (Current count ÷ Yield count) x 100, where “Current count” is the current values in the counter for the part, and “Yield count” is the recommended yield. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ] 091 Page (%): PCU: Bk 092 Page (%): PCU: C 093 Page (%): PCU: M 094 Page (%): PCU: Y

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

095 Page (%): Development Unit: Bk 096 Page (%): Development Unit: C

SM Appendix

9-271 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 097 Page (%): Development Unit: M 098 Page (%): Development Unit: Y 099 Page (%): Developer: Bk 100 Page (%): Developer: C 101 Page (%): Developer: M 102 Page (%): Developer: Y 103 Page (%): ITB Unit 104 Page (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 105 Page (%): Fusing Unit 106 Page (%): Fusing Roller 107 Page (%): Fusing Belt 108 Page (%): PTR Unit

7931

[Toner Bottle Bk] Displays the toner bottle information for Bk. 001 Machine Serial ID

*ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*EGN

003 Brand ID

*EGN

004 Area ID

*EGN

005 Product ID

*EGN

006 Color ID

*EGN

007 Maintenance ID

*EGN

008 New Product Information

*EGN

009 Recycle Counter

*EGN

D037/D038/D040/D041

-

9-272 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

7932

010 Date

*EGN

011 Serial No.

*EGN

012 Toner Remaining

*EGN

013 EDP Code

*EGN

014 End History

*EGN

015 Refill Information

*EGN

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*EGN

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*EGN

018 End: Total Counter

*EGN

019 End: Color Counter

*EGN

020 Attachment Date

*EGN

021 End Date

*EGN

[Toner Bottle M] Displays the toner bottle information for M. *ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*EGN

003 Brand ID

*EGN

004 Area ID

*EGN

005 Product ID

*EGN

006 Color ID

*EGN

007 Maintenance ID

*EGN

008 New Product Information

*EGN

009 Recycle Counter

*EGN

SM Appendix

-

9-273 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Machine Serial ID

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 010 Date

*EGN

011 Serial No.

*EGN

012 Toner Remaining

*EGN

013 EDP Code

*EGN

014 End History

*EGN

015 Refill Information

*EGN

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*EGN

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*EGN

018 End: Total Counter

*EGN

019 End: Color Counter

*EGN

020 Attachment Date

*EGN

021 End Date

7933

[Toner Bottle C] Displays the toner bottle information for C. 001 Machine Serial ID

*ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*EGN

003 Brand ID

*EGN

004 Area ID

*EGN

005 Product ID

*EGN

006 Color ID

*EGN

007 Maintenance ID

*EGN

008 New Product Information

*EGN

009 Recycle Counter

*EGN

D037/D038/D040/D041

-

9-274 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

7934

010 Date

*EGN

011 Serial No.

*EGN

012 Toner Remaining

*EGN

013 EDP Code

*EGN

014 End History

*EGN

015 Refill Information

*EGN

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*EGN

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*EGN

018 End: Total Counter

*EGN

019 End: Color Counter

*EGN

020 Attachment Date

*EGN

021 End Date

*EGN

[Toner Bottle Y] Displays the toner bottle information for Y. *ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*EGN

003 Brand ID

*EGN

004 Area ID

*EGN

005 Product ID

*EGN

006 Color ID

*EGN

007 Maintenance ID

*EGN

008 New Product Information

*EGN

009 Recycle Counter

*EGN

SM Appendix

-

9-275 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Machine Serial ID

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

7935

010 Date

*EGN

011 Serial No.

*EGN

012 Toner Remaining

*EGN

013 EDP Code

*EGN

014 End History

*EGN

015 Refill Information

*EGN

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*EGN

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*EGN

018 End: Total Counter

*EGN

019 End: Color Counter

*EGN

020 Attachment Date

*EGN

021 End Date

*EGN

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: Bk] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date

*ENG

003 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for Bk.

004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date

*ENG

007 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for Bk.

008 Refill Information 009 Serial No.

*ENG

information log 3 for Bk.

010 Attachment Date

D037/D038/D040/D041

Displays the toner bottle

9-276 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 011 Attachment: Total Counter 012 Refill Information 013 Serial No. 014 Attachment Date

*ENG

015 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for Bk.

016 Refill Information 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date

*ENG

019 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for Bk.

020 Refill Information

7936

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: M] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date

*ENG

003 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for M.

004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date

*ENG

007 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for M.

008 Refill Information 009 Serial No.

*ENG

011 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for M.

012 Refill Information

SM Appendix

9-277 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

010 Attachment Date

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 013 Serial No. 014 Attachment Date

*ENG

015 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for M.

016 Refill Information 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date

*ENG

019 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for M.

020 Refill Information

7937

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: C] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date

*ENG

003 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for C.

004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date

*ENG

007 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for C.

008 Refill Information 009 Serial No. 010 Attachment Date

*ENG

011 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for C.

012 Refill Information 013 Serial No.

*ENG

information log 4 for C.

014 Attachment Date

D037/D038/D040/D041

Displays the toner bottle

9-278 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 015 Attachment: Total Counter 016 Refill Information 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date

*ENG

019 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for C.

020 Refill Information

7938

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: Y] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date

*ENG

003 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for Y.

004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date

*ENG

007 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for Y.

008 Refill Information 009 Serial No. 010 Attachment Date

*ENG

011 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for Y.

012 Refill Information 013 Serial No.

*ENG

015 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for Y.

016 Refill Information

SM Appendix

9-279 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

014 Attachment Date

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date

*ENG

019 Attachment: Total Counter

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for Y.

020 Refill Information

7950

[Unit Replacement Date] Displays the replacement date of each PM unit. 001 ITB Unit

*ENG

002 ITB Cleaning Unit

*EGN

003 PTR Unit

*EGN

004 Fusing Unit

*EGN

005 Fusing Roller

*EGN

006 Fusing Belt

*EGN

013 PCU: Bk

*EGN

014 PCU: C

*EGN

015 PCU: M

*EGN

016 PCU: Y

*EGN

017 Development Unit:Bk

*EGN

018 Development Unit:C

*EGN

019 Development Unit:M

*EGN

020 Development Unit:Y

*EGN

021 Developer:Bk

*EGN

022 Developer:C

*EGN

023 Developer:M

*EGN

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-280 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 024 Developer:Y

*EGN

[Remaining Day Counter] 7951

*ENG

Displays the remaining unit life of each PM unit. [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step] 001 Page: PCU: Bk 002 Page: PCU: C 003 Page: PCU: M 004 Page: PCU: Y 005 Page: Development Unit: Bk 006 Page: Development Unit: C 007 Page: Development Unit: M 008 Page: Development Unit: Y 009 Page: Developer: Bk 010 Page: Developer: C 011 Page: Developer: M 012 Page: Developer: Y 013 Page: ITB Unit 014 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit 015 Page: Fusing Unit 016 Page: Fusing Roller 017 Page: Fusing Belt Appendix: SP Mode Tables

018 Page: PTR Unit 031 Rotation: PCU: Bk

SM Appendix

9-281 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 032 Rotation: PCU: C 033 Rotation: PCU: M 034 Rotation: PCU: Y 035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk 036 Rotation: Development Unit: C 037 Rotation: Development Unit: M 038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y 039 Rotation: Developer: Bk 040 Rotation: Developer: C 041 Rotation: Developer: M 042 Rotation: Developer: Y 043 Rotation: ITB Unit 044 Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit 045 Rotation: Fusing Unit 046 Rotation: Fusing Roller 047 Rotation: Fusing Belt 048 Rotation:PTR Unit 049 Rotation:ITB T-Collect Bottle 050 Rotation:PCU T-Collect Bottle

7952

[PM Yield Setting] Adjusts the unit yield of each PM unit. 001 Rotation: ITB Unit

D037/D038/D040/D041

*EGN

[0 to 999999999 / 172177000 / 1000 mm/step]

9-282 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 002

Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit

*EGN

003 Rotation: Fusing Unit

*EGN

004 Rotation: Fusing Roller

*EGN

005 Rotation: Fusing Belt

*EGN

006 Rotation:PTR Unit

*EGN

007

008

[0 to 999999999 / 129133000 / 1 mm/step]

[0 to 999999999 / 87264000 / 1000 mm/step]

[0 to 999999999 / 172177000 / 1000 mm/step]

Amount:ITB T-Collect Bottle

*EGN

Amount:PCU T-Collect

[0 to 999999999 / 300000 / 1000 mg/step]

Bottle

011 Page: ITB Unit

*EGN

[0 to 999999 / 240000 / 1000 sheet/step]

012 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit

*EGN

[0 to 999999 / 180000 / 1 sheet/step]

013 Page: Fusing Unit

*EGN

014 Page: Fusing Roller

*EGN

015 Page: Fusing Belt

*EGN

016 Page: PTR Unit

*EGN

Day Threshold: PCU:

*EGN

Bk

022 Day Threshold: PCU: C

*EGN

023 Day Threshold: PCU: M

*EGN

024 Day Threshold: PCU: Y

*EGN

025

026

Day Threshold: Development Unit: Bk Day Threshold: Development Unit: C

SM Appendix

[0 to 999999 / 240000 / 1 sheet/step] Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each PM unit. [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step] These threshold days are used for NRS alarms.

*EGN Appendix: SP Mode Tables

021

[0 to 999999 / 144000 / 1 sheet/step]

*EGN

9-283 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 027

028

029

030

031

032

Day Threshold:

*EGN

Development Unit: M Day Threshold:

*EGN

Development Unit: Y Day Threshold:

*EGN

Developer: Bk Day Threshold:

*EGN

Developer: C Day Threshold:

*EGN

Developer: M Day Threshold:

*EGN

Developer: Y

033 Day Threshold: ITB Unit 034

035

036

037

Day Threshold: ITB

*EGN *EGN

Cleaning Unit Day Threshold: Fusing Unit Day Threshold: Fusing Roller Day Threshold: Fusing Belt

038 Rotation: PCU: Bk

*EGN

*EGN

*EGN

*EGN

039 Rotation: PCU: C

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

040 Rotation: PCU: M 041 Rotation: PCU: Y 042

Rotation: Development Unit: Bk

D037/D038/D040/D041

*EGN

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

9-284 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 043

044

045

Rotation: Development Unit: C Rotation: Development Unit: M Rotation: Development Unit: Y

*EGN

*EGN

*EGN

046 Rotation: Developer: Bk 047 Rotation: Developer: C

*EGN

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

*EGN

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

*EGN

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

*EGN

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

048 Rotation: Developer: M 049 Rotation: Developer: Y 050 Page: PCU: Bk 051 Page: PCU: C 052 Page: PCU: M 053 Page: PCU: Y 054

055

056

057

Page: Development Unit: Bk Page: Development Unit: C Page: Development Unit: M Page: Development Unit: Y

059 Page: Developer: C

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

058 Page: Developer: Bk

060 Page: Developer: M 061 Page: Developer: Y

SM Appendix

9-285 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 062

063

064

7953

Day Threshold:PTR Adjusts the threshold day for the near end

Unit

fro each PM unit.

Day Thresh:ITB

*EGN

T-Collect Bttl

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step] These threshold days are used for NRS alarms.

Day Thresh:PCU T-Collect Bttl

[Operation Env. Log: PCU: Bk] Displays the PCU rotation distance in each specified operation environment. T: Temperature (°C), H: Relative Humidity (%) *CTL

001 T<=0

[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]

002 0
D037/D038/D040/D041

9-286 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 016 25<=T<30: 80<=H<=100 017 30<=T: 0<=H<30 018 30<=T: 30<=H<55 019 30<=T: 55<=H<80 020 30<=T: 80<=H<=100

7954

[Operation Env. Log Clear] Clears the operation environment log. 001 -

SP8-xxx: Data Log2 Many of these counters are provided for features that are currently not available, such as sending color faxes, and so on. However, here are some Group 8 codes that when used in combination with others, can provide useful information.

SP Numbers

What They Do

SP8 211 to SP8 216

The number of pages scanned to the document server.

SP8 401 to SP8 406

The number of pages printed from the document server

SP8 691 to SP8 696

The number of pages sent from the document server

Specifically, the following questions can be answered: ƒ

How is the document server actually being used?

ƒ

What application is using the document server most frequently?

ƒ

What data in the document server is being reused?

Most of the SPs in this group are prefixed with a letter that indicates the mode of operation Service Table, make sure that you understand what these prefixes mean.

SM Appendix

9-287 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

(the mode of operation is referred to as an “application”). Before reading the Group 8

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Prefixes

What it means

T:

Total: (Grand Total).

C:

Copy application.

F:

Fax application.

P:

Print application.

S:

Scan application.

Grand total of the items counted for all applications (C, F, P, etc.).

Totals (pages, jobs, etc.) executed for each application when the job was not stored on the document server.

Totals (jobs, pages, etc.) for the document server. The L: counters work differently case by case. Sometimes, they count jobs/pages stored on the document server; this can be in document server Local storage

L:

(document server)

mode (from the document server window), or from another mode, such as from a printer driver or by pressing the Store File button in the Copy mode window. Sometimes, they include occasions when the user uses a file that is already on the document server. Each counter will be discussed case by case.

O:

Other applications

Refers to network applications such as Web Image

(external network

Monitor. Utilities developed with the SDK (Software

applications, for

Development Kit) will also be counted with this

example)

group in the future.

The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on the small LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations below and refer to it again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand. Key for Abbreviations

Abbreviation /

D037/D038/D040/D041

What it means “By”, e.g. “T:Jobs/Apl” = Total Jobs “by” Application

9-288 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Abbreviation

What it means

>

More (2> “2 or more”, 4> “4 or more”

AddBook

Address Book

Apl

Application

B/W

Black & White

Bk

Black

C

Cyan

ColCr

Color Create

ColMode

Color Mode

Comb

Combine

Comp

Compression

Deliv

Delivery Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan,

DesApl

Print) used to store the job on the document server, for

Dev Counter

Development Count, no. of pages developed.

Dup, Duplex

Duplex, printing on both sides

Emul

Emulation

FC

Full Color

FIN

Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.)

Full Bleed

No Margins

GenCopy

Generation Copy Mode Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does

GPC

not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page

SM Appendix

9-289 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

example.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Abbreviation

What it means job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1)

IFax ImgEdt

Internet Fax Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.

K

Black (YMCK)

LS

Local Storage. Refers to the document server.

LSize

Large (paper) Size

Mag

Magnification

MC

One color (monochrome) New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor

NRS

machines remotely. “NRS” is used overseas, “CSS” is used in Japan.

Org

Original for scanning

OrgJam

Original Jam Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows

Palm 2

print jobs to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats.

PC

Personal Computer Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original.

PGS

Duplex pages count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT counter SP is switched ON.

PJob

Print Jobs

Ppr

Paper

PrtJam

Printer (plotter) Jam

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-290 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Abbreviation PrtPGS

What it means Print Pages Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2

R

only. This machine is under development and currently not available.

Rez

Resolution

SC

Service Code (Error SC code displayed)

Scn

Scan

Sim, Simplex

Simplex, printing on 1 side.

S-to-Email

Scan-to-E-mail SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8 counters

SMC

are recorded in the SMC report.

Svr

Server

TonEnd

Toner End

TonSave

Toner Save

TXJob

Send, Transmission

YMC

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan

YMCK

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, Black

ƒ

All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.

*CTL

8 002

C:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 003

F:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 001

SM Appendix

These SPs count the number of times each application is used to do a job. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the other applications are used to send a job to the

9-291 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

T:Total Jobs

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

8 004

P:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 005

S:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 006

L:Total Jobs

*CTL

document server, plus the number of times a file already on the document server is used.

These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed.

ƒ

When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.

ƒ

Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.

ƒ

Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the SP modes are not counted.

ƒ

When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at the time when either “Delete Data” or “Specify Output” is specified.

ƒ

A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.

ƒ

When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the document server is not used).

ƒ

A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are not counted separately).

ƒ

A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been completed.

ƒ

A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.

ƒ

The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.

ƒ

When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.

ƒ

When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both increment.

ƒ

When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.

ƒ

When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the L: counter increments.

ƒ

When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.

ƒ

When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.

ƒ

When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-292 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

8 011

T:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 012

C:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 013

F:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 014

P:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 015

S:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 016

L:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 017

O:Jobs/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the document server by each application, to reveal how local storage is being used for input. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored

ƒ

from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.

When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.

ƒ

When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.

ƒ

When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.

ƒ

When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.

ƒ

When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.

8 021

T:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 022

C:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 023

F:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 024

P:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 025

S:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 026

L:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 027

O:Pjob/LS

*CTL

These SPs reveal how files printed from the document server were stored on the document server originally. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs screen at the operation panel.

When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter increments.

ƒ

When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the

SM Appendix

9-293 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

ƒ

stored from within the document server mode

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode document server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment. ƒ

When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter increments.

ƒ

When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter increments.

ƒ

When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed with another application, the O: counter increments.

ƒ

When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.

ƒ

When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.

8 031

T:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 032

C:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 033

F:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 034

P:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 035

S:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 036

L:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 037

O:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

These SPs reveal what applications were used to output documents from the document server. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs

ƒ

printed from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.

When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application that started the print job is incremented.

ƒ

When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.) the L: counter increments.

8 041

T:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 042

C:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 043

F:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

D037/D038/D040/D041

These SPs count the applications that stored files on the document server that were later accessed for transmission over the telephone line or over a network

9-294 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 044

P:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 045

S:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 046

L:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

(attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. The L: counter counts the number of jobs

8 047

O:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

scanned from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.

ƒ

When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.

ƒ

When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an e-mail, the O: counter increments.

ƒ

8 051

T:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 052

C:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 053

F:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 054

P:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 055

S:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 056

L:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 057

O:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

These SPs count the applications used to send files from the document server over the telephone line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.

If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter increments.

T:FIN Jobs 8 061

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by

C:FIN Jobs 8 062

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application.

SM Appendix

9-295 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

the application.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode F:FIN Jobs 8 063

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time. P:FIN Jobs

8 064

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. S:FIN Jobs

8 065

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time. L:FIN Jobs

8 066

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window within document server mode. O:FIN Jobs

8 067

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the application. Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored copy job

8 06x 1 Sort

is set for Sort and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments. (See SP8 066 1)

8 06x 2 Stack

Number of jobs started out of Sort mode.

8 06x 3 Staple

Number of jobs started in Staple mode.

8 06x 4 Booklet

8 06x 5 Z-Fold

D037/D038/D040/D041

Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the machine is in staple mode, the Staple counter also increments. Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set for folding (Z-fold).

9-296 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 06x 6 Punch 8 06x 7 Other

Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job, the P: counter increments. (See SP8 064 6.) Reserved. Not used.

T:Jobs/PGS 8 071

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job, regardless of which application was used. C:Jobs/PGS

8 072

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. F:Jobs/PGS

8 073

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. P:Jobs/PGS

8 074

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. S:Jobs/PGS

8 075

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. L:Jobs/PGS

8 076

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job. O:Jobs/PGS

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of “Other” application jobs (Web Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job.

SM Appendix

9-297 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 077

*CTL

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

8 07x 1 1 Page

8 07x 8

21 to 50 Pages

8 07x 2 2 Pages

8 07x 9

51 to 100 Pages

8 07x 3 3 Pages

8 07x 10

101 to 300 Pages

8 07x 4 4 Pages

8 07x 11

301 to 500 Pages

8 07x 5 5 Pages

8 07x 12

501 to 700 Pages

8 07x 6 6 to 10 Pages

8 07x 13

701 to 1000 Pages

8 07x 7 11 to 20 Pages

8 07x 14

1001 to Pages

For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.

ƒ

Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).

ƒ

Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.

ƒ

If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.

ƒ

If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the error occurs.

ƒ

For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)

ƒ

The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the copy job (SP 8072).

ƒ

When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted.

T:FAX TX Jobs

8 111

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.

8 113

F: FAX TX Jobs

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-298 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode fax directly on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 8 11x 1 B/W 8 11x 2 Color

ƒ

These counters count jobs, not pages.

ƒ

This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored on the document server.

ƒ

If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started.

ƒ

If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (8 12x) also increments.

ƒ

The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.

T:IFAX TX Jobs

8 121

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. F: IFAX TX Jobs

8 123

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not stored on the document server), as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.

8 12x 1 B/W

ƒ

These counters count jobs, not pages.

ƒ

The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time.

ƒ

The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.

SM Appendix

9-299 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 12x 2 Color

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

T:S-to-Email Jobs 8 131

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not. S: S-to-Email Jobs

8 135

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached to e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.

8 13x 1 B/W 8 13x 2 Color 8 13x 3 ACS

ƒ

These counters count jobs, not pages.

ƒ

If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or black-and-white then counted.

ƒ

If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.

ƒ

If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.

ƒ

If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-to-Email and once for Scan-to-PC).

T:Deliv Jobs/Svr 8 141

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent to a Scan Router server. S: Deliv Jobs/Svr

8 145

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned in scanner mode and sent to a Scan Router server.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-300 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 14x 1 B/W 8 14x 2 Color 8 14x 3 ACS

ƒ

These counters count jobs, not pages.

ƒ

The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server cannot be confirmed.

ƒ

If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a “Color” job.

ƒ

If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be delivered, the job is not counted.

ƒ

If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.

ƒ

Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

T:Deliv Jobs/PC 8 151

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC). Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts. S:Deliv Jobs/PC

8 155

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent with Scan-to-PC.

8 15x 1 B/W 8 15x 2 Color

ƒ

These counters count jobs, not pages.

ƒ

If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted.

ƒ

If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.

ƒ

If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.

SM Appendix

9-301 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 15x 3 ACS

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode ƒ

Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

8 161

T:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

These SPs count the number of PC Fax transmission jobs. A job is counted from when it is registered for sending, not when it is sent.

8 163

F:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts.

ƒ

This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the destination from the PC through the copier.

8 161

T:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

8 163

F:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

8 175

S: Dvliv Jobs/WSD

*CTL

8 181

T: Scan to Media Jobs

*CTL

8 185

S: Scan to Media Jobs

*CTL

-

x 1 B/W x 2 Color x 3 ACS

ƒ

SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.

ƒ

These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.

ƒ

Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.

ƒ

A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.

ƒ

Scans made in SP mode are not counted.

Examples ƒ

If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored,

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-302 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode the S: count is 4. ƒ

If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.

ƒ

If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.

ƒ

If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.

T:LSize Scan PGS

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan and copy jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax

8 201

transmission are not counted. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display. F: LSize Scan PGS

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for

8 203

fax transmission. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display. S:LSize Scan PGS

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan jobs only.

8 205

Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission

are not counted. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.

T:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 212

C:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 213

F:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 215

S:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 216

L:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

SM Appendix

These SPs count the number of pages scanned into the document server . [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen

9-303 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 211

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

Reading user stamp data is not counted.

ƒ

If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted.

ƒ

If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.

ƒ

If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.

ƒ

If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.

ƒ

If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.

ADF Org Feeds 8 221

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side scanning. Number of front sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for either

8 221 1

Front

simplex or duplex scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.) Number of rear sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex

8 221 2

Back

scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning.

ƒ

When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.

ƒ

If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-304 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

Scan PGS/Mode 8 231

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the work load on the ADF.

8 231 1 Large Volume

8 231 2 SADF

8 231 3 Mixed Size 8 231 4 Custom Size 8 231 5 Platen 8 231 6 Mixed 1side/2side

ƒ

Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in the ADF at one time. Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the ADF. Selectable. Select “Mixed Sizes” on the operation panel. Selectable. Originals of non-standard size. Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original directly on the platen. -

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.

ƒ

The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original’s page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.

ƒ

If the user selects “Mixed Sizes” for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled.

ƒ

In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.

T:Scan PGS/Org 8 241

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all

C:Scan PGS/Org 8 242

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs.

SM Appendix

9-305 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

jobs, regardless of which application was used.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode F:Scan PGS/Org 8 243

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs. S:Scan PGS/Org

8 245

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs. L:Scan PGS/Org

8 246

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen 8 241

ƒ

8 242

8 243

8 245

8 246

8 24x 1: Text

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 2: Text/Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 3: Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 4: GenCopy, Pale

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

8 24x 5: Map

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

8 24x 6: Normal/Detail

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

8 24x 7: Fine/Super Fine

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

8 24x 8: Binary

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 9: Grayscale

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 10: Color

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 11: Other

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-306 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 251

T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 252

C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 254

P:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 256

L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 257

O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

These SPs show how many times Image Edit features have been selected at the operation panel for each application. Some examples of these editing features are: ƒ

Erase> Border

ƒ

Erase> Center

ƒ

Image Repeat

ƒ

Centering

ƒ

Positive/Negative

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: The count totals the number of times the edit features have been used. A detailed breakdown of exactly which features have been used is not given.

The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.

8 261

T:Scan PGS/ColCr

*CTL

-

8 262

C:Scan PGS/ ColCr

*CTL

-

8 266

L:Scn PGS/ColCr

*CTL

-

8 26x 1 Color Conversion These SPs show how many times color

8 26x 2 Color Erase

creation features have been selected at the

8 26x 3 Background

operation panel.

8 26x 4 Other

T:Scan PGS/TWAIN

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages scanned using a TWAIN driver. These

8 285

S:Scan PGS/TWAIN

*CTL

counters reveal how the TWAIN driver is used for delivery functions.

SM Appendix

9-307 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 281

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts.

8 291

T:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

8 293

F:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages stamped with the stamp in the ADF unit. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode

8 295

S:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen

T:Scan PGS/Size 8 301

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-441]. C:Scan PGS/Size

8 302

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-442]. F:Scan PGS/Size

8 303

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443]. S:Scan PGS/Size

8 305

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-445].

8 306

L:Scan PGS/Size

D037/D038/D040/D041

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

9-308 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446]. 8 30x 1 A3 8 30x 2 A4 8 30x 3 A5 8 30x 4 B4 8 30x 5 B5 8 30x 6 DLT

-

8 30x 7 LG 8 30x 8 LT 8 30x 9 HLT 8 30x 10 Full Bleed 8 30x 254 Other (Standard) 8 30x 255 Other (Custom)

T:Scan PGS/Rez 8 311

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications that can specify resolution settings. S: Scan PGS/Rez

8 315

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.

8 31x 1 1200dpi <

SM Appendix

9-309 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

by applications that can specify resolution settings.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 31x 2 600dpi to 1199dpi 8 31x 3 400dpi to 599dpi 8 31x 4 200dpi to 399dpi 8 31x 5 < 199dpi

ƒ

Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted.

ƒ

The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done for the Fax application.

ƒ

8 381

T:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 382

C:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 383

F:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 384

P:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 385

S:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 386

L:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 387

O:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed by the customer. The counter for the application used for storing the pages increments. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.

When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as 2.

ƒ

When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them.

ƒ

These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages are not counted as printed pages: - Blank pages in a duplex printing job. - Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets. - Reports printed to confirm counts. - All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.) - Test prints for machine image adjustment. - Error notification reports.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-310 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode - Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.

LSize PrtPGS 8 391

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger. Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.

8 401

T:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 402

C:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 403

F:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 404

P:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 405

S:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 406

L:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed from the document server. The counter for the application used to print the pages is incremented. The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

ƒ

Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.

ƒ

Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.

This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. 8 411

Prints/Duplex

*CTL

Last pages printed only on one side are not counted. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8 421

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.

8 422

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the copier application.

SM Appendix

9-311 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8 423

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 424

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the printer application. S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 425

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 426

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 427

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by Other applications

8 42x 1 Simplex> Duplex 8 42x 2 Duplex> Duplex 8 42x 3 Book> Duplex 8 42x 4 Simplex Combine 8 42x 5 Duplex Combine 8 42x 6 2>

2 pages on 1 side (2-Up)

8 42x 7 4>

4 pages on 1 side (4-Up)

8 42x 8 6>

6 pages on 1 side (6-Up)

8 42x 9 8>

8 pages on 1 side (8-Up)

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-312 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 42x 10 9>

9 pages on 1 side (9-Up)

8 42x 11 16>

16 pages on 1 side (16-Up)

8 42x 12 Booklet 8 42x 13 Magazine

ƒ

These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.

ƒ

Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.

ƒ

Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:

Booklet

Magazine

Original Pages

Count

Original Pages

Count

1

1

1

1

2

2

2

2

3

2

3

2

4

2

4

2

5

3

5

4

6

4

6

4

7

4

7

4

8

4

8

4

T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8 431

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features

8 432

C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features

SM Appendix

9-313 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

below, regardless of which application was used.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode below with the copy application. P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8 434

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the print application. L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 436

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode window at the operation panel with the three features below. O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 437

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with Other applications. Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The

8 43x 1 Cover/Slip Sheet

count for a cover printed on both sides counts 2. The number of pages printed in series (one side) or

8 43x 2 Series/Book

printed as a book with booklet right/left pagination. The number of pages printed where stamps were

8 43x 3 User Stamp

applied, including page numbering and date stamping.

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8 441

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications. C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 442

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy application.

8 443

F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-314 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode application. P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8 444

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer application. S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 445

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 446

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 447

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other applications.

8 44x 1 A3 8 44x 2 A4 8 44x 3 A5 8 44x 4 B4 8 44x 5 B5 8 44x 6 DLT 8 44x 7 LG 8 44x 8 LT 8 44x 9 HLT

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 44x 10 Full Bleed 8 44x 254 Other (Standard) 8 44x 255 Other (Custom)

SM Appendix

9-315 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF.

8 451

PrtPGS/Ppr Tray

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station. 8 451 1 Bypass

Bypass Tray

8 451 2 Tray 1

Copier

8 451 3 Tray 2

Copier

8 451 4 Tray 3

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

8 451 5 Tray 4

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

8 451 6 Tray 5

LCT (Option)

8 451 7 Tray 6

Currently not used.

8 451 8 Tray 7

Currently not used.

8 451 9 Tray 8

Currently not used.

8 451 10 Tray 9

Currently not used.

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications. 8 461

ƒ

These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing.

ƒ

Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.

ƒ

During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed on one side counts as 1.

8 462

C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-316 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode application. F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8 463

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8 464

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8 466

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel.

8 46x 1 Normal 8 46x 2 Recycled 8 46x 3 Special 8 46x 4 Thick 8 46x 5 Normal (Back) 8 46x 6 Thick (Back) 8 46x 7 OHP 8 46x 8 Other

8 471

PrtPGS/Mag

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed. 8 471 1 < 49%

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 471 2 50% to 99% 8 471 3 100% 8 471 4 101% to 200%

SM Appendix

9-317 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 471 5 201% <

ƒ

Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as well.

ƒ

Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also counted.

ƒ

Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server are not counted.

ƒ

Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are counted.

ƒ

The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of 100%.

8 481

T:PrtPGS/TonSave

*CTL

8 484

P:PrtPGS/TonSave

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on. Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

8 491

T:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 492

C:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 493

F:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 496

L:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 497

O:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed in the Color Mode by each application.

8 49x 1 B/W 8 49x 2 Single Color 8 49x 3 Two Color

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-318 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 49x 4 Full Color

8 501

T:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 504

P:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 057

O:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed in the Color Mode by the print application.

8 50x 1 B/W 8 50x 2 Mono Color 8 50x 3 Full Color 8 50x 4 Single Color 8 50x 5 Two Color

T:PrtPGS/Emul 8 511

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed. P:PrtPGS/Emul

8 514

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages

8 514 1

RPCS

8 514 2

RPDL

8 514 3

PS3

8 514 4

R98

8 514 5

R16

8 514 6

GL/GL2

8 514 7

R55

8 514 8

RTIFF

SM Appendix

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

printed.

9-319 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

8 514 9

PDF

8 514 10

PCL5e/5c

8 514 11

PCL XL

8 514 12

IPDL-C

8 514 13

BM-Links

8 514 14

Other

Japan Only

SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.

ƒ

Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.

T:PrtPGS/FIN 8 521

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications. C:PrtPGS/FIN

8 522

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy application. F:PrtPGS/FIN

8 523

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax application. NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available. P:PrtPGS/FIN

8 524

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print application. S:PrtPGS/FIN

8 525

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner application.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-320 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode L:PrtPGS/FIN 8 526

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel.

8 52x 1 Sort 8 52x 2 Stack 8 52x 3 Staple 8 52x 4 Booklet 8 52x 5 Z-Fold 8 52x 6 Punch 8 52x 7 Other

ƒ

If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still counted.

ƒ

The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted.

This SP counts the amount of staples used by 8 531

Staples

*CTL

the machine. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

T:Counter

8 581

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 581 1 Total 8 581 2 Total: Full Color

SM Appendix

9-321 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 581 3 B&W/Single Color 8 581 4 Development: CMY 8 581 5 Development: K 8 581 6 Copy: Color 8 581 7 Copy: B/W 8 581 8 Print: Color 8 581 9 Print: B/W 8 581 10 Total: Color 8 581 11 Total: B/W 8 581 12 Full Color: A3 8 581 13 Full Color: B4 JIS or Smaller 8 581 14 Full Color Print 8 581 15 Mono Color Print 8 581 16 Full Color GPC

8 582

C:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the copy application broken down by color output. 8 582 1 B/W 8 582 2 Single Color 8 582 3 Two Color 8 582 4 Full Color

8 583

F:Counter

D037/D038/D040/D041

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

9-322 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode These SPs count the total output of the fax application broken down by color output. 8 583 1 B/W 8 583 2 Single Color

8 584

P:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the print application broken down by color output. 8 584 1 B/W 8 584 2 Mono Color 8 584 3 Full Color 8 584 4 Single Color 8 584 5 Two Color

8 586

L:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the local storage broken down by color output. 8 582 1 B/W 8 582 2 Single Color 8 582 3 Two Color 8 582 4 Full Color

8 591

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only.

SM Appendix

9-323 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

O:Counter

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 591 1 A3/DLT

-

8 591 2 Duplex

Coverage Counter 8 601

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total coverage for each color and the total printout pages for each printing mode.

8 601 1 B/W 8 601 2 Color 8 601 11 B/W Printing Pages 8 601 12 Color Printing Pages

T:FAX TX PGS 8 631

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number. F:FAX TX PGS

8 633

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.

8 63x 1 B/W 8 63x 2 Color

ƒ

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color.

ƒ

At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are the same.

ƒ

The counts include error pages.

ƒ

If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for each destination.

ƒ

Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.

ƒ

Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-324 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode destination.

T:IFAX TX PGS 8 641

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using I-Fax. F:IFAX TX PGS

8 643

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using I-Fax.

8 64x 1 B/W 8 64x 2 Color

ƒ

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color.

ƒ

At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are the same.

ƒ

The counts include error pages.

ƒ

If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for each destination.

ƒ

Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.

ƒ

Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.

T:S-to-Email PGS 8 651

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications. S-to-Email PGS

8 655

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an Appendix: SP Mode Tables

e-mail for the Scan application only. 8 65x 1 B/W 8 65x 2 Color

SM Appendix

9-325 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.

ƒ

If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are sent to the same SMTP server together).

ƒ

If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).

ƒ

Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20.).

T:Deliv PGS/Svr 8 661

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by both Scan and LS applications. Deliv PGS/Svr

8 665

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by the Scan application.

8 66x 1 B/W 8 66x 2 Color

ƒ

The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router server.

ƒ

If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done.

ƒ

The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server.

8 671

T:Deliv PGS/PC

D037/D038/D040/D041

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

9-326 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications. Deliv PGS/PC 8 675

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the Scan application.

8 67x 1 B/W 8 67x 2 Color

8 681

T:PCFAX TXPGS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC Fax. These SPs are provided for the Fax application only, so the counts for SP8

8 683

F:PCFAX TXPGS

*CTL

681 and SP8 683 are the same. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

ƒ

This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the destination.

ƒ

When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes up by 10, not 20.)

8 691

T:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 692

C:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 693

F:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 694

P:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 695

S:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages sent from the document server. The counter for the application that was used to store the pages is incremented. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. Pages stored

L:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.

SM Appendix

9-327 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 696

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ƒ

Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.

ƒ

If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them.

ƒ

When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages sent to each destination. TX PGS/Port

8 701

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12.

8 701 1 PSTN-1 8 701 2 PSTN-2 8 701 3 PSTN-3 8 701 4 ISDN (G3,G4) 8 701 5 Network

8 711

8 715

T:Scan PGS/Comp

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

S:Scan PGS/Comp

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by each compression mode. 8 715 1 JPEG/JPEG2000 8 715 2 TIFF(Multi/Single) 8 715 3 PDF 8 715 4 Other

8 725

S: Dvliv PGS/WSD

*CTL

8 731

T: Scan to PGS/Media

*CTL

D037/D038/D040/D041

-

9-328 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 735

S: Scan to PGS/Media

*CTL

x 1 B/W x 2 Color

RX PGS/Port 8 741

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them.

8 741 1 PSTN-1 8 741 2 PSTN-2 8 741 3 PSTN-3 8 741 4 ISDN (G3,G4) 8 741 5 Network

Dev Counter 8 771

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the development rollers) for black and other color toners.

8 771 1 Total 8 771 2 K 8 771 3 Y 8 771 4 M 8 771 5 C

8 781

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of already replaced toner bottles. NOTE: Currently, the data in SP7-833-011 through 014 and the data in SP8-781-001 through 004 are the same.

SM Appendix

9-329 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Toner Bottle Info.

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 781 1 Toner: BK

The number of black-toner bottles

8 781 2 Toner: Y

The number of yellow-toner bottles

8 781 3 Toner: M

The number of magenta-toner bottles

8 781 4 Toner: C

The number of cyan-toner bottles

This SP displays the percent of space 8 791

LS Memory Remain

available on the document server for

*CTL

storing documents. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

Toner Remain

*CTL

[0 to 100/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP 8 801

allows the user to check the toner supply at any time. Note: This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps).

8 801 1 K 8 801 2 Y 8 801 3 M 8 801 4 C

Coverage Count: 0-10% 8 851

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is from 0% to 10%.

8 851 11 0 to 2%: BK

8 851 31 5 to 7%: BK

8 851 12 0 to 2%: Y

8 851 32 5 to 7%: Y

8 851 13 0 to 2%: M

8 851 33 5 to 7%: M

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-330 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 851 14 0 to 2%: C

8 851 34 5 to 7%: C

8 851 21 3 to 4%: BK

8 851 41 8 to 10%: BK

8 851 22 3 to 4%: Y

8 851 42 8 to 10%: Y

8 851 23 3 to 4%: M

8 851 43 8 to 10%: M

8 851 24 3 to 4%: C

8 851 44 8 to 10%: C

Coverage Count: 11-20% 8 861

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is from 11% to 20%.

8 861 1 BK 8 861 2 Y 8 861 3 M 8 861 4 C

Coverage Count: 21-30% 8 871

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is from 21% to 30%.

8 871 1 BK 8 871 2 Y 8 871 3 M 8 871 4 C

8 881

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is 31% or higher.

SM Appendix

9-331 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Coverage Count: 31%-

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 881 1 BK 8 881 2 Y 8 881 3 M 8 881 4 C

Printing PGS: Present Ink 8 891

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner for each color.

8 891 1 BK 8 891 2 Y 8 891 3 M 8 891 4 C

Printing PGS: Log: Latest 1 8 901

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner for each color.

8 901 1 BK 8 901 2 Y 8 901 3 M 8 901 4 C

Printing PGS: Log: Latest 2 8 911

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner for each color. 8 911 1 BK

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-332 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 911 2 Y 8 911 3 M 8 911 4 C

8 921

Coverage Count: Total

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 8 921 1 BK (%) 8 921 2 Y (%) 8 921 3 M (%) 8 921 4 C (%) 8 921 14 BK (Page) 8 921 15 Y (Page) 8 921 16 M (Page) 8 921 17 C (Page)

Machine Status

8 941

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards. Engine operation time. Does not include time while

8 941 1 Operation Time

controller is saving data to HDD (while engine is not operating).

8 941 2 Standby Time

saves data to HDD. Does not include time spent in Energy Save, Low Power, or Off modes.

SM Appendix

9-333 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Engine not operating. Includes time while controller

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 941 3 Energy Save Time

Includes time while the machine is performing background printing. Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on.

8 941 4 Low Power Time

Includes time while machine is performing background printing. Includes time while machine is performing

8 941 5 Off Mode Time

background printing. Does not include time machine remains powered off with the power switches.

8 941 6 SC 8 941 7 PrtJam

8 941 8 OrgJam

Total time when SC errors have been staying. Total time when paper jams have been staying during printing. Total time when original jams have been staying during scanning.

8 941 9 Supply PM Unit End Total time when toner end has been staying

AddBook Register 8 951

*CTL

These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration.

8 951 1 User Code 8 951 2 Mail Address

8 951 3 Fax Destination

8 951 4 Group

8 951 5 Transfer Request 8 951 6 F-Code

D037/D038/D040/D041

User code registrations. Mail address registrations. Fax destination registrations.

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Group destination registrations. Fax relay destination registrations for relay TX. F-Code box registrations.

9-334 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode Copy application registrations with the

8 951 7 Copy Program

Program (job settings) feature. Fax application registrations with the

8 951 8 Fax Program

Program (job settings) feature.

[0 to 255 / 0 / 255]

Printer application registrations with the

8 951 9 Printer Program

Program (job settings) feature. Scanner application registrations with the

8 951 10 Scanner Program

Program (job settings) feature.

8 999

Adomin. Counter List

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 8 999 1 Total 8 999 2 Copy: Full Color 8 999 3 Copy: BW 8 999 4 Copy: Single Color 8 999 5 Copy: Two Color 8 999 6 Printer Full Color

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 999 7 Printer BW 8 999 8 Printer Single Color 8 999 9 Printer Two Color

SM Appendix

9-335 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 8 999 10 Fax Print: BW 8 999 12 A3/DLT 8 999 13 Duplex 8 999 14 Coverage: Color (%) 8 999 15 Coverage: BW (%) 8 999 16 Coverage: Color Print Page (%) 8 999 17 Coverage: BW Print Page (%) 8 999 101 Transmission Total: Color 8 999 102 Transmission Total: BW 8 999 103 FAX Transmission 8 999 104 Scanner Transmission: Color 8 999 105 Scanner Transmission: BW

9.1.2 INPUT CHECK TABLE When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a different device as shown in the table.

Bit No.

7

6

5

4

3

2

1

0

Result

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-336 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

Copier

Reading

Description 0

1

5803 1 C-Dev. Mtr:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 2 C-Drum Mtr:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 3 Bk-Drum/Dev. Mtr:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 4 ITB Mtr:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 5 Fusing/P-Exit Mtr:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 6 Electrical FAN:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 7 Fusing Fan:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 8 Dev. Front Fan:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 9 Dev. Rear Fan:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 10 Fusing Exit Fan:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 11 LD Unit FAN:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 12 Jun. Gate SOL Fan:LOCK

Normal

Lock

5803 13 Fusing:New Detection

New

Not new

5803 14 Fusing:Area Detection

-

-

Not detected

Detected

Paper detected

No paper detected

5803 15 Zero Cross 5803 16 Regist Sensor

Actuator not

5803 17 Drum Phase Sn:Bk

detected Actuator not

5803 18 Drum Phase Sn:Color

SM Appendix

detected

9-337 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Actuator detected

Actuator detected

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5803

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5803 19 Inverter Sensor

Inverter gate open

Inverter gate close

5803 20 Duplex Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

5803 21 Duplex Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

Shutter open

Shutter close

5803 23 HVPS:CB

-

-

5803 24 HVPS:T

-

-

5803 25 Right Door Open SW

Door close

Door open

5803 26 Right Lower Cover OP SW

Cover close

Cover open

5803 27 Mechanical Counter:Bk

Not set

Set

5803 28 Mechanical Counter:FC

Not set

Set

5803 29 Key Counter Set Sensor

Set

Not set

5803 30 Key Card Set Sensor

Set

Not set

5803 31 Toner End Sensor: K

End

Not end

5803 32 Toner End Sensor: C

End

Not end

5803 33 Toner End Sensor: M

End

Not end

5803 34 Toner End Sensor: Y

End

Not end

5803 35 Fusing Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

5803 36 Fusing Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

5803 37 Paper Exit Sensor

Paper detected

No paper detected

5803 22 ID/MUSIC Sn Shutter HP Sn

5803 38 ITB Contact HP Sensor

HP (Contact)

Not HP (not contact)

5803 39 ITB T-Collect Bttl:Set SW

Set

Not set

5803 40 PCU T-Collect Bttl:Set SW

Set

Not set

5803 41 PCU T-Collect Bttl Full Sn

Full

Not full

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-338 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5803 42 Vertical Transport 1 Sn

Paper detected

No paper detected

5803 43 Vertical Transport 2 Sn

Paper detected

No paper detected

5803 44 Tray1 Size Detection SW

See "Table 1" below.

5803 45 Tray2 Size Detection SW

See "Table 1" below.

5803 46 Bypass Size Detection SW

See "Table 2" below. Not detect

Detected

5803 48 Bypass HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

5803 49 Tray1 Paper End Sensor

Not end

End

5803 50 Tray2 Paper End Sensor

Not end

End

5803 51 Bypass Paper End Sensor

Not end

End

5803 52 Tray1 Set SW

Set

Not set

5803 53 Tray2 Set SW

Set

Not set

5803 54 Interlock SW 1

Door close

Door open

5803 55 Interlock SW 2

Door close

Door open

5803 56 DIP SW

-

-

5803 57 BCU Version

-

-

Not set

Set

Lock

Normal

5803 58 PCU T-Collect Motor Set 5803 59 Reserve Fan:LOCK 5803 70 R-Tray Paper Exit Sensor

Paper detected

5803 71 R-Tray Set Sensor

Set

5803 72 1-Bin:Transport Sensor

Paper detected

5803 73 1-Bin:Paper Sensor

Paper detected

SM Appendix

9-339 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

No paper detected Not set No paper detected No paper

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5803 47 Bypass Length Detection Sn

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode detected 5803 74 1-Bin Set Detection

Set

Not set

5803 75 Shift Tray:Half Turn Sn

Not HP

HP

5803 76 Shift Tray Set Detection

Not set

Set

5803 77 1T PFU:Size Sensors

See "Table 4".

5803 78 1T PFU:Paper Lift Sn

Not upper limit

Upper limit

5803 79 1T PFU:Paper Height Sn

-

-

5803 80 1T PFU:Right Cover SW

Open

Close

5803 81 1T PFU:Set Detection

Not set

Set

5803 82 1T PFU:Paper End Sn

Not end

End

5803 83 2T PFU:Upper Size Sns

See "Table 4" below.

5803 84 2T PFU:Lower Size Sns 5803 85 2T PFU:Upper Paper Lift Sn

Not upper limit

Upper limit

5803 86 2T PFU:Lower Paper Lift Sn

Not upper limit

Upper limit

5803 87 2T PFU:Upper Paper Height Sn

-

-

5803 88 2T PFU:Lower Paper Height Sn

-

-

Open

Close

5803 90 2T PFU:Upper PE Sn

Not end

End

5803 91 2T PFU:Lower PE Sn

Not end

End

5803 89 2T PFU:Right Cover SW

No paper

5803 92 2T PFU:V-Transport Sn

Paper detected

5803 94 LD OFF Check:Factory

-

-

5803 200 Scanner HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

5803 201 Platen Cover Sensor

Open

Close

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-340 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

detected

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

ARDF (D366)

6007

Reading

Description 0

1

6007 1 Original Length Sn1 (B5 Sn)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 2 Original Length Sn2 (A4 Sn)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 3 Original Length Sn3 (LG Sn)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 4 Original Width Sn:S

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 5 Original Width Sn:M

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 6 Original Width Sn:L

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 7 Original Width Sn:LL

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 9 Original Set Sn

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 10 Trailing Edge Sn

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 11 Skew Correction Sn

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 13 Registration Sn

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 14 Exit Sn

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 15 Feed Cover SW

ADF cover close

ADF cover open

6007 16 Lift Up Sn

ADF cover close

ADF cover open

Internal Finisher (D429)

Reading

Description 0

1

6120 1 Staple Slide HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6120 2 Punch Slide HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

SM Appendix

9-341 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

6120

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 6120 3 Staple HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6120 4 Paper T-Edge Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 5 Pick Roller Lift Sensor

Up

Down

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Down

Up

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 9 Rear Jogger HP Sensor

HP

Not HP

6120 10 Front Jogger HP Sensor

HP

Not HP

Normal

Lock

Close

Open

6120 6 Paper Detection Sensor 6120 7 Belt Roller Lift Sensor 6120 8 Entrance Sensor

6120 11 Fan Lock Signal 6120 12 Finisher Open Switch 6120 13 Punch Unit:Area Detect2

See "Table 5" below.

6120 14 Punch Unit:Area Detect1 6120 15 Paper Stack Sensor 2

HP

Not HP

6120 16 Paper Stack Sensor 1

HP

Not HP

6120 17 Punch Position Sensor

Not HP

HP

6120 18 Paper Width Sensor:A3

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 19 Paper Width Sensor:LD

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 20 Paper Width Sensor:B4

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 21 Paper Width Sensor:A4

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 22 Paper Width Sensor:16K

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 23 Paper Width Sensor:B5

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Full

Not full

Upper

Not upper

6120 24 Punch Hopper Full Sensor 6120 25 Tray Upper Sensor

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-342 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 6120 26 Relay Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6120 27 Tray Lower Sensor

Lower

Not lower

6120 28 Jogger HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6120 29 Punch HP Sensor

Not rear

Rear Position

6120 30 Stapler Safety Sensor

No staple

Staple detected

6120 31 Staple Empty Sensor

No staple

Staple detected

Not set

Set

6120 32 Punch Unit Sensor

Table 1: Paper Size Switch (Tray 1/ 2) Switch 1 is used for tray set detection. 0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed

Bit

North America

Europe/Asia

2

1

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(A3 SEF)

(11" x 17" SEF)

1

0

0

8.5" x 14" SEF *2

B4 SEF *2

(B4 SEF)

(8.5" x 14" SEF)

0

0

0

A4 SEF

A4 SEF

0

1

1

8.5" x 11" SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

1

1

1

B5 SEF

B5 SEF

1

1

0

11" x 81/2" LEF*3

A4 LEF*3

(A4 LEF)

(11" x 81/2" LEF)

0

0

1

10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4

B5 LEF*4

(B5 LEF)

(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)

0

1

0

A5 LEF

A5 LEF

1

0

1

SM Appendix

9-343 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Models

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode *1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-006 (Tray 2). *2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-007 (Tray 2). *3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-001 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-005 (Tray 2). *4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-008 (Tray 2).

Table 2: Paper Size (By-pass Table) 0: ON, 1: OFF

By-pass Paper Size Sensor

Length Sensor

NA

EU/ASIA

bit3

Bit2

Bit1

Bit0

1

1

0

0

0

HLT SEF

B6 SEF

1

1

1

1

0

HLT SEF

A5 SEF

1

1

1

0

0

HLT SEF

A5 SEF

0

0

1

1

1

LT/LG SEF*1

A4 SEF

0

0

1

1

0

LT/LG SEF*1

A5 LEF

1

0

0

1

1

DLT SEF

A3 SEF

1

0

0

1

0

LT LEF

A4 LEF

*1: The paper size (LT or LG) can be selected with SP1-007-001.

Table 3: APS Original Size Detection

Original Size

Metric version

D037/D038/D040/D041

Width Sensor

Length Sensor

SP4-301 display

Inch version

W1

W2

W3

9-344 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

L1

L2

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode A3

11" x 17"

O

O

O

O

O

00000011

B4

10" x 14"

O

O

X

O

O

00000011

8.5” x 14”

O

X

X

O

O

00000011

A4 LEF

8.5" x 11"

O

O

O

X

X

00000000

B5 LEF

-

O

O

X

X

X

00000000

A4 SEF

11" x 8.5"

O

X

X

O

X

00000010

B5 SEF

-

X

X

X

O

X

00000010

X

X

X

X

X

00000000

F4 8.5" x 13", 8.25" x 13", or 8" x 13" SP 5126 controls the size that is detected

A5 LEF/ SEF

5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 5.5"

Table 4: Paper Size Switch (Tray 3/ 4) "Bit 0" is used for tray set detection. 0: Set, 1: Not set 0: Not Interrupted, 1: Interrupted

Bit

North America

Europe/Asia

3

2

1

0

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(A3 SEF)

(11" x 17" SEF)

0

1

1

0

8.5" x 14" SEF *2

B4 SEF *2

(B4 SEF)

(8.5" x 14" SEF)

1

1

1

0

A4 SEF

A4 SEF

1

0

0

0

B5 SEF

B5 SEF

0

0

1

1

8.5" x 11" SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

0

0

0

0

SM Appendix

9-345 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Models

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 11" x 81/2" LEF*3

A4 LEF*3

(A4 LEF)

(11" x 81/2" LEF)

10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4

B5 LEF*4

(B5 LEF)

(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)

A5 LEF A5 SEF

1

1

0

1

1

0

1

0

A5 LEF

0

1

0

0

A5 SEF

1

1

0

1

*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-010 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-014 (Tray 4). *2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-011 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-015 (Tray 4). *3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-009 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-013 (Tray 4). *4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-012 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-016 (Tray 4).

Table 5: Area Display The bit 0 of these SPs shows the punch unit type. 2: 2 Holes, 2/3: 2/3 Holes, 4 (EU): 4 Holes Europe, 4 (Scan.): 4 Holes Scandinavia

SP

2

2/3

4 (EU)

4 (Scan.)

6120-013

Punch Unit:Area Detect2

0

0

1

1

6120-014

Punch Unit:Area Detect2

0

1

0

1

9.1.3 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE Copier 5804

Display

Description

5804 1 Paper Feed M1:CW:190mm/s

-

5804 2 Paper Feed M1:CW:120mm/s

-

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-346 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

5804 3 Paper Feed M1:CW:60mm/s

-

5804 4 P-Feed M1:CW:60mm/s:Thick

-

5804 5 Paper Feed M1:CCW:190mm/s

-

5804 6 Paper Feed M1:CCW:120mm/s

-

5804 7 Paper Feed M1:CCW:60mm/s

-

5804 8 P-Feed M1:CCW:60mm/s:Thick

-

5804 9 Paper Feed M2:CW:190mm/s

-

5804 10 Paper Feed M2:CW:120mm/s

-

5804 11 Paper Feed M2:CW:60mm/s

-

5804 12 P-Feed M2:CW:60mm/s:Thick

-

5804 13 Paper Feed M2:CCW:190mm/s

-

5804 14 Paper Feed M2:CCW:120mm/s

-

5804 15 Paper Feed M2:CCW:60mm/s

-

5804 16 P-Feed M2:CCW:60mm/s:Thick

-

5804 17 Bypass M:CW:190mm/s

-

5804 18 Bypass M:CW:120mm/s

-

5804 19 Bypass M:CW:60mm/s:400mA

-

5804 20 Bypass M:CW:60mm/s:300mA

-

5804 21 Bypass M:CCW:190mm/s

-

5804 22 Bypass M:CCW:120mm/s

-

5804 23 Bypass M:CCW:60mm/s

-

5804 24 Registration M:120mm/s

-

5804 25 Registration M:60mm/s

-

SM Appendix

9-347 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

System Service Mode

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5804 26 Regist M:60mm/s:Thick

-

5804 27 Inverter M:CW:280mm/s

-

5804 29 Inverter M:CW:120mm/s

-

5804 31 Inverter M:CW:60mm/s

-

5804 33 Inverter M:280mm/s

-

5804 35 Inverter M:120mm/s

-

5804 36 Fusing Exit Motor: 56mm/s

-

5804 37 Inverter M:60mm/s

-

5804 39 Duplex Exit M:280mm/s

-

5804 40 Duplex Exit M:120mm/s

-

5804 41 Duplex Exit M:60mm/s

-

5804 42 Duplex Ent. M:280mm/s

-

5804 43 Duplex Ent. M:120mm/s

-

5804 44 Duplex Ent. M:60mm/s

-

5804 45 Color Dev. M:120mm/s

-

5804 46 Color Dev. M:60mm/s

-

5804 47 Color Drum. M:120mm/s

-

5804 48 Color Drum. M:60mm/s

-

5804 49 Bk Drum M:120mm/s

-

5804 50 Bk Drum M:60mm/s

-

5804 51 ITB Motor:120mm/s

-

5804 52 ITB Motor:60mm/s

-

5804 53 Fusing/P-Exit M:120mm/s

-

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-348 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

5804 54 Fusing/P-Exit M:60mm/s

-

5804 55 Electrical FAN:H

-

5804 56 Electrical FAN:L

-

5804 57 Fusing Fan:H

-

5804 58 Fusing Fan:L

-

5804 59 Dev. Front FAN:H

-

5804 60 Dev. Front FAN:L

-

5804 61 Dev. Rear FAN:H

-

5804 62 Dev. Rear FAN:L

-

5804 63 Fusing Exit Fan:H

-

5804 64 Fusing Exit Fan:L

-

5804 65 LD Unit Fan:H

-

5804 66 LD Unit Fan:L

-

5804 67 PSU Fan:H

-

5804 69 Junc. Gate SOL Fan:H

-

5804 70 Junc. Gate SOL Fan:L

-

5804 71 Toner Supply M:Bk

-

5804 72 Toner Supply M:C

-

5804 73 Toner Supply M:M

-

5804 74 Toner Supply M:Y

-

5804 75 PCU T-Collect Motor

-

5804 76 ID/MUSIC Sn Shutter Motor

-

5804 77 ITB Contact Motor

-

SM Appendix

9-349 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

System Service Mode

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5804 78 Bk Dev. Clutch

-

5804 79 Junction Gate SOL

-

5804 80 PWM:Potential Sn:Bk

-

5804 81 PWM:Potential Sn:C

-

5804 82 PWM:Potential Sn:M

-

5804 83 PWM:Potential Sn:Y

-

5804 84 HVPS:Charge AC:Bk:H

-

5804 85 HVPS:Charge AC:Bk:L

-

5804 86 HVPS:Charge AC:C:H

-

5804 87 HVPS:Charge AC:C:L

-

5804 88 HVPS:Charge AC:M:H

-

5804 89 HVPS:Charge AC:M:L

-

5804 90 HVPS:Charge AC:Y:H

-

5804 91 HVPS:Charge AC:Y:L

-

5804 92 HVPS:Charge DC:Bk

-

5804 93 HVPS:Charge DC:C

-

5804 94 HVPS:Charge DC:M

-

5804 95 HVPS:Charge DC:Y

-

5804 96 HVPS:Dev. Bias:Bk

-

5804 97 HVPS:Dev. Bias:C

-

5804 98 HVPS:Dev. Bias:M

-

5804 99 HVPS:Dev. Bias:Y

-

5804 100 HVPS:PTR Bias:- PWM

D037/D038/D040/D041

-

9-350 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

5804 101 HVPS:PTR Bias:+ PWM

-

5804 102 HVPS:ITR Bias:Bk

-

5804 103 HVPS:ITR Bias:C

-

5804 104 HVPS:ITR Bias:M

-

5804 105 HVPS:ITR Bias:Y

-

5804 106 MUSIC Sensor:R:PWM

-

5804 107 MUSIC Sensor:C:PWM

-

5804 108 MUSIC Sensor:F:PWM

-

5804 109 Reserve Fan:H

-

5804 110 Reserve Fan:LOCK

-

5804 111 Toner End Sn Power

-

5804 120 R-Tray M:280mm/s

-

5804 121 R-Tray M:120mm/s

-

5804 122 R-Tray SOL

-

5804 123 Shift Motor

-

5804 124 1T PFU:Tray Lift M

-

5804 125 1T PFU:Paper Feed M

-

5804 126 1T PFU:Paper Feed CL

-

5804 127 2T PFU:Relay CL

-

5804 128 2T PFU:Upper Feed CL

-

5804 129 2T PFU:Lower Feed CL

-

5804 130 2T PFU:P-Feed M:190mm/s

-

5804 131 2T PFU:P-Feed M:120mm/s

-

SM Appendix

9-351 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

System Service Mode

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 5804 132 2T PFU:P-Feed M:60mm/s

-

5804 133 PFU:Upper Tray Lift M

-

5804 134 2T PFU:Lower Tray Lift M

-

5804 192 RFID ON/OFF: Bk

-

5804 193 RFID ON/OFF: C

-

5804 194 RFID ON/OFF: M

-

5804 195 RFID ON/OFF: Y

-

5804 196 RFID COM ON: Bk

-

5804 197 RFID COM ON: C

-

5804 198 RFID COM ON: M

-

5804 199 RFID COM ON: Y

-

5804 202 Scanner Lamp

-

5804 210 Polygon Motor

-

5804 216 LD1: Bk

-

5804 218 LDI: C

-

5804 220 LD1: M

-

5804 222 LD1: Y

-

Internal Finisher (D429)

6121

Description

Description

6121 1 Transport Motor

-

6121 2 Front Jogger Motor

-

6121 3 Rear Jogger Motor

-

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-352 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 6121 4 Stapler Slide Motor

-

6121 5 Stack Feed-out Motor

-

6121 6 Pick Roller Lift Motor

-

6121 7 Staple Motor

-

6121 8 Tray Lift Motor

-

6121 9 Paper Detection SOL

-

6121 10 Paddle Rotation SOL

-

6121 11 Belt Roller SOL

-

6121 12 Junction Gate SOL

-

6121 13 Fan Motor

-

6120 14 Punch Motor

-

6120 15 Punch Slide Motor

-

6120 16 Inverter Roller SOL

-

ARDF (D366)

6008

Display

Description

6008 3 Feed Motor: Forward

Feed Motor-Forward rotation

6008 4 Feed Motor: Reverse

Feed Motor-Reverse rotation

6008 5 Relay Motor: Forward

Transport Motor- Forward rotation

Transport Motor: Forward

Transport Motor- Reverse rotation

Relay Motor Reverse

Transport Motor- Reverse rotation

6008 9 Feed Clutch 6008 10 Pick-up Solenoid

SM Appendix

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

6008 6

-

9-353 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode 6008 11 Junction Gate Solenoid

-

6008 12 Stamp Solenoid

Stamp Solenoid

9.1.4 TEST PATTERN PRINTING Printing Test pattern: SP2-109 Some of these test patterns are used for copy image adjustments but most are used primarily for design testing. ƒ

Do not operate the machine until the test pattern is printed out completely. Otherwise, an SC occurs.

1.

Enter the SP mode and select SP2-109-003.

2.

Enter the number for the test pattern that you want to print and press [#].

3.

When you want to select the single color of Magenta, Yellow or Cyan for printing a test pattern, select the color with SP2-109-005 (2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan).

4.

When you want to change the density of printing a test pattern, select the density with SP2-109-006 to -009 for each color. ƒ

If you select "0" with SP2-109-006 to -009, the color to be adjusted to "0" does not come up on a test pattern.

5.

When you are prompted to confirm your selection, touch "Yes" to select the test pattern for printing.

6.

Touch "Copy Window" to open the copy window, then select the settings for the test print (paper size etc.). ƒ

If you want to use black and white printing, touch "Black & White" on the LCD. If you want to use color printing, touch "Full Colour" on the LCD.

7.

Press the "Start" key to start the test print.

8.

After checking the test pattern, touch "SP Mode" on the LCD to return to the SP mode display.

9.

Reset all settings to the default values.

10. Touch "Exit" twice to exit SP mode.

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-354 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

System Service Mode

No.

Pattern

No.

Pattern

None

11

Independent Pattern (1dot)

1

Vertical Line (1dot)

12

Independent Pattern (2dot)

2

Vertical Line (2dot)

13

Independent Pattern (4dot)

3

Horizontal Line (1dot)

14

Ttrimming Area

4

Horizontal Line (2dot)

16

Hound's Tooth Check (Horizontal)

5

Grid Vertical Line

17

Band (Horizontal)

6

Grid Horizontal Line

18

Band (Vertical)

7

Grid Pattern Small

19

Checkered Flag Pattern

8

Grid Pattern Large

20

Grayscale (Vertical Margin)

9

Argyle Patter Small

21

Grayscale (Horizontal Margin)

10

Argyle Patter Large

23

Full Dot Pattern

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

0

SM Appendix

9-355 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Service Mode

9.2 PRINTER SERVICE MODE 9.2.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE)

1001

Bit Switch

001 Bit Switch 1

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

DFU

-

-

bit 3

No I/O Timeout

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur. bit 4

0: Disable

SD Card Save Mode

1: Enable

Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot ( “Card Save Function” in the System Maintenance Reference of the Field Service Manual). bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

[RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the printable area.

1001

Bit Switch

002 Bit Switch 2

0

1

bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-356 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Service Mode bit 2

Applying a collation Type

Shift

Normal

Collate

Collate

A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a ‘Collate Type’ configured. ƒ bit 3

If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.

[PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching

0: Enable

1: Disable

Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job. Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly.

1001

bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

0

1

Bit Switch

003 Bit Switch 3 bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

[PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000. In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A")

bit 3

DFU

-

-

bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

SM Appendix

9-357 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

will be changed to "<ESC>*r1A"

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Service Mode

1001

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

-

-

0

1

Disable

Enable

Bit Switch

004 Bit Switch 4 DFU

1001

Bit Switch

005 Bit Switch 5 Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and "Punch Type" buttons on the operation panel. bit 0

If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured options. After enabling the function, the settings will appear under: "User Tools > Printer Features > System"

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

DFU

-

-

bit 3

[PS] PS Criteria

Pattern3

Pattern1

Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to determine whether a job is PS data or not. Pattern3: includes most PS commands. Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers bit 4

Increase max number of the stored jobs

Disable

Enable (1000)

(100)

to 1000 jobs.

Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job Type settings to 1000. The default is 100. bit 5

Disable

Face-up output

D037/D038/D040/D041

9-358 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Enable

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Service Mode Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.

1001

bit 6

DFU

-

-

bit 7

DFU

-

-

-

-

-

-

0

1

Bit Switch

006 Bit Switch 6 DFU

1001

Bit Switch

007 Bit Switch 7 DFU

1001

Bit Switch

008 Bit Switch 8 bit 0

DFU

-

-

bit 1

DFU

-

-

bit 2

DFU

-

-

bit 3

[PCL,PS]: Allow BW jobs to print without

Disable

Enable

requiring User Code

Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode authentication is enabled. Color jobs will not be printed without a valid user code.

bit 4

DFU

-

-

bit 5

DFU

-

-

bit 6

[PS]: Orientation Auto Detect Function

Enable

Disable

Disable: Automatically chooses page orientations of PostScript jobs (Landscape or Portrait) based on the content printed on the page.

SM Appendix

9-359 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

ƒ

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Service Mode bit 7

[PDF]: Orientation Auto Detect Function

Enable

Disable

Automatically chooses page orientations of PDF jobs (Landscape or Portrait) based on the content printed on the page.

1003

1003 1

[Clear Setting] Initialize Printer System Initializes settings in the “System” menu of the user mode.

1003 3 Delete Program

1004

1004 1

[Print Summary] Print Summary Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).

1005

1005 1

[Display Version] Disp. Version Displays the version of the controller firmware.

1006

[Sample/Locked Print]

*CTL

0: Linked, 1: On

Enables and disables the document server. When you select “0,” the document 1006 1

server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select “1,” the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.

[Data Recall] 1101

Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous setting, or c) the current setting.

1101 1 Factory

D037/D038/D040/D041

*CTL

9-360 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Service Mode 1101 2 Previous 1101 3 Current 1101 4 ACC

1102

[Resolution Setting] Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.

1102 1

2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text, 600x600 Text

[Test Page] 1103

Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.

1103 1 Color Gray Scale 1103 2 Color Pattern

[Gamma Adjustment] 1104

Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the “Mode Selection” menu.

1104 1 Black: Highlight

*CTL

[0 to 30 / 15 / 1/step ]

1104 2 Black: Shadow 1104 3 Black: Middle 1104 4 Black: IDmax 1104 21 Cyan: Highlight

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1104 22 Cyan: Shadow 1104 23 Cyan: Middle

SM Appendix

9-361 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Printer Service Mode 1104 24 Cyan: IDmax 1104 41 Magenta: Highlight 1104 42 Magenta: Shadow 1104 43 Magenta: Middle 1104 44 Magenta: IDmax 1104 61 Yellow: Highlight 1104 62 Yellow: Shadow 1104 63 Yellow: Middle 1104 64 Yellow: IDmax

[Save Tone Control Value]

1105

Stores the print gamma adjusted with the “Gamma Adj.” menu item as the current setting. Before the machine stores the new “current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the “current setting” to the “previous setting” memory storage location.

1105 1 Save Tone Control Value

1106

[Toner Limit] Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.

1106 1 Toner Limit Value

D037/D038/D040/D041

*CTL [100 to 400 / 260 / 1 %/step ]

9-362 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner SP Mode

9.3 SCANNER SP MODE 9.3.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS) 1001

[Scan Nv Version]

1001 5 -

1004

*CTL

-

[Compression Type] Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.

1004 1 Compression Type

*CTL

[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ] 1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR

[Erase margin] 1005

Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image. If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.

1005 1 Range from 0 to 5 mm

1009

*CTL

[Remote scan disable]

*CTL

[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: enable, 1: disable

1009 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

1010

[Non Display Clear Light PDF]

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Display, 1: No display

1010 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

[Org count Disp]

SM Appendix

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1011

0: ON, 1: OFF

9-363 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D037/D038/D040/D041

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Scanner SP Mode 1011 1 Displays the original counter.

1012

1012 1

1013

*CTL

[UserInfo release]

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: No, 1: Yes

Release following settings: Address, Sender, Text / Subject, Filename

[Multimedia Function

*CTL

Setting]

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

1013 1 On or off multimedia function

9.3.2 SP2-XXX (SCANNING-IMAGE QUALITY) [Compression Level (Grayscale)] 2021

Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that can be selected at the operation panel.

2021 1 Comp 1: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

2021 2 Comp 2: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ] *CTL

2021 3 Comp 3: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 65 / 1 /step ]

2021 4 Comp 4: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 80 / 1 /step ]

2021 5 Comp 5: 5-95

[5 to 95 / 95 / 1 /step ]

[Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF] 2024

Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at the operation panel.

2024 1 Compression Ratio (Normal)

*CTL

2024 2 Compression Ratio (High)

D037/D038/D040/D041

[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ] [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

9-364 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM Appendix

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 D331 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER ............................................................................... 1 1.1.1 COVERS.............................................................................................. 1 1.1.2 FEED ROLLER .................................................................................... 2 1.2 DRIVE COMPONENTS ................................................................................ 3 1.2.1 UPPER FEED CLUTCH....................................................................... 3 1.2.2 LOWER FEED CLUTCH...................................................................... 3 1.2.3 RELAY CLUTCH.................................................................................. 4 1.2.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR ........................................................................ 4 1.2.5 LIFT MOTORS..................................................................................... 5 1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 6 1.3.1 1.3.2 1.3.3 1.3.4

VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR .................................................... 6 PAPER END SENSOR ........................................................................ 7 PAPER SIZE SENSORS ..................................................................... 7 TRAY MAIN BOARD............................................................................ 8

2. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS...........................................9 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................................................... 9 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT .............................................. 9 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................. 10 2.1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION ................................... 10 2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT................................................................................. 13 2.2 PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION MECHANISM ...................................... 14 2.3 PAPER LIFT MECHANISM......................................................................... 15 2.4 PAPER END DETECTION.......................................................................... 17 2.5 PAPER HEIGHT DETECTION.................................................................... 18 2.6 PAPER SIZE DETECTION ......................................................................... 19 2.7 SIDE AND END FENCES ........................................................................... 21 2.7.1 SIDE FENCES ................................................................................... 21 2.7.2 END FENCE ...................................................................................... 21

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.

Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.

: See or Refer to : Screws

: Connector : Clip ring : E-ring

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Covers and Roller

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT

ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.

1.1.1 COVERS

Rear Cover 1.

Hold brackets [A] ( x 1 each)

2.

Rear cover [B] ( x 3)

Right Cover 1.

Right side stopper [C] ( x 3)

2.

Right cover [D] ( x , knob screw x 2)

SM

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Covers and Roller

1.1.2 FEED ROLLER

1.

Pull out the tray [A].

2.

Release the lock lever [B].

3.

Feed roller [C]

D331

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Components

1.2 DRIVE COMPONENTS Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

ƒ

the procedures in this section.

1.2.1 UPPER FEED CLUTCH

1.

Rear cover ( "Covers")

2.

Bracket [A] ( x 2)

3.

Hold bracket [B] ( x 1, bushing x 1)

4.

Upper feed clutch [C] ( x 1)

1.2.2 LOWER FEED CLUTCH

1.

Rear cover ( "Covers")

2.

Lower feed clutch [A] ( x 1, = x 1, x 1)

SM

3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Components

1.2.3 RELAY CLUTCH

1.

Rear cover ( "Covers")

2.

Relay clutch [A] (= x 1, x 1)

1.2.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR

1.

Rear cover ( "Covers")

2.

Tray main board ( "Tray Main Board")

3.

Gear [A] ( x 1)

4.

Paper feed motor bracket [B] ( x 5)

5.

Paper feed motor [C] ( x 2)

D331

4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Drive Components

1.2.5 LIFT MOTORS

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

Upper Lift Motor

1.

Rear cover ( "Covers")

2.

Spring [A] (snap ring x 1, spacer x 1)

3.

Lift motor bracket [B] ( x 3, x 1)

4.

Upper lift motor [C] ( x 3)

Lower Lift Motor 1.

Rear cover ( "Covers")

2.

Spring (snap ring x 1, spacer x 1)

3.

Lift motor bracket ( x 4, x 1)

4.

Lower lift motor ( x 3)

SM

5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.

1.3.1 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR

1.

Open the tray cover [A]

2.

Guide plate [B] ( x 2)

3.

Sensor bracket [C] ( x 1, x 1)

4.

Vertical transport sensor [D] (hooks)

D331

6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

1.3.2 PAPER END SENSOR

1.

Pull out the tray [A]

2.

Sensor bracket [B] ( x 1, x 1)

3.

Paper end sensor [C] (hooks)

1.3.3 PAPER SIZE SENSORS

1.

Pull out the two trays.

2.

Sensor bracket cover [A] ( x 1)

3.

Sensor bracket [B] ( x 3,  x 2)

4.

Paper size sensors (hooks)

SM

7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

1.3.4 TRAY MAIN BOARD

1.

Rear cover ( "Covers")

2.

Tray main board [A] ( x 4, all 's)

D331

8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout

2. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

1. Upper paper feed roller 2. Lower paper feed roller 3. Lower bottom plate 4. Optional tray heater

SM

5. Lower tray 6. Upper tray 7. Upper bottom plate

9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout

2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

1. Paper feed motor

12. Lower paper height 1 sensor

2. Upper lift sensor

13. Vertical transport sensor

3. Upper lift motor

14. Lower tray set switch

4. Upper tray set switch

15. Lower paper end sensor

5. Upper paper height 2 sensor

16. Upper paper end sensor

6. Upper paper height 1 sensor

17. Optional tray heater

7. Upper paper feed clutch

18. Lower lift motor

8. Relay clutch

19. Lower paper size sensors

9. Tray cover switch

20. Lower lift sensor

10. Lower paper feed clutch

21. Upper paper size sensors

11. Lower paper height 2 sensor

22. Tray main board

2.1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION

Symbol

D331

Name

Function

10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Index No.

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout

M1

Paper Feed

Drives all rollers.

1

M2

Upper Lift

Lifts the upper tray bottom plate.

3

M3

Lower Lift

Lifts the lower tray bottom plate.

18

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

Motors

Sensors S1

Upper Lift

S2

Lower Lift

S3

Upper Paper End

S4

Lower Paper End

S5

S6

S7

S8

S9

S10 S11

SM

Vertical Transport Upper Paper Height 1 Upper Paper Height 2 Lower Paper Height 1 Lower Paper Height 2 Upper Paper Size Lower Paper

Detects when the paper in the upper tray is at the correct feed height. Detects when the paper in the lower tray is at the correct feed height. Informs the copier/printer when the upper tray runs out of paper. Informs the copier/printer when the lower tray runs out of paper.

2

20

16

15

Detects misfeeds.

13

Detects the amount of paper in the upper tray.

6

Detects the amount of paper in the upper tray.

5

Detects the amount of paper in the lower tray.

12

Detects the amount of paper in the lower tray.

11

Determines what paper size is in the upper tray.

21

Determines what paper size is in the lower tray.

19

11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout Size

Switches SW1

Tray Cover

SW2

Upper Tray Set

SW3

Lower Tray Set

Detects whether the tray cover is opened or not. Detects whether the upper tray is opened or not.

9 4

Detects whether the lower tray is opened or not.

14

Starts paper feed from the upper tray.

7

Starts paper feed from the lower tray.

10

Drives the relay rollers.

8

Magnetic Clutches MC1

MC2 MC3

Upper Paper Feed Lower Paper Feed Relay

PCBs PCB1

Tray Main

Controls the paper tray unit and communicates with the copier/printer.

22

Others H1

D331

Optional Tray Heater

Removes humidity from the paper in the trays.

12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

17

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT

1. Paper feed motor

5. Lower paper feed clutch

2. Drive belt

6. Upper paper feed roller

3. Upper paper feed clutch

7. Relay roller

4. Relay clutch

8. Lower paper feed roller

SM

13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Feed and Separation Mechanism

2.2 PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION MECHANISM

The paper tray holds 500 sheets. The paper feed roller [A] drives the top sheet of paper from the paper tray to the copier/printer. The friction pad [B] allows only one sheet to feed at a time. The friction pad applies pressure to the feed roller with a spring [C].

D331

14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Lift Mechanism

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

2.3 PAPER LIFT MECHANISM

The paper size switch detects when the tray is pushed in. When the paper tray is pushed into the machine, the pin [A] for the lift motor pressure shaft engages the lift motor coupling [B] and the pin [C] for the bottom plate lift shaft in the tray engages the bottom plate pressure lever coupling [D]. The pin [E] on the rear of the tray pushes the lock lever so that the lift motor can lift the bottom plate pressure lever. The lift motor turns on, and turns clockwise as viewed on the diagram. The main pressure spring [H] pulls the bottom plate pressure lever, and this lifts the tray bottom plate. When the top of the stack touches the feed roller, the motor cannot pull up the plate any more, so it pulls the actuator [G] into the lift sensor [F]. The pressure of the feed roller on the paper is now too high, so the lift motor reverses to reduce this pressure. It reverses for 300 ms or 600 ms, depending on the paper size. For smaller paper, it reverses the larger amount (600 ms) to reduce the pressure more. When the paper tray is pulled out, the pins [A, C] disengage from the couplings [B, D], and

SM

15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Lift Mechanism the bottom plate drops. To make it easier to push the tray in, the lift motor rotates backwards 1.7 seconds to return the bottom plate pressure lever coupling [D] to the original position.

D331

16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper End Detection

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

2.4 PAPER END DETECTION

If there is some paper in the paper tray, the paper stack raises the paper end feeler [A] and the paper end sensor [B] is deactivated. When the paper tray runs out of paper, the paper end feeler drops into the cutout [C] in the tray bottom plate and the paper end sensor is activated. When the paper tray is drawn out with no paper in the tray, the shape of the paper end feeler causes it to lift up.

SM

17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Height Detection

2.5 PAPER HEIGHT DETECTION

The amount of paper in the tray is detected by the combination of on/off signals from two paper height sensors [A] and [B]. When the amount of paper decreases, the bottom plate pressure lever [C] moves the actuator up. The following combination of sensor signals is sent to the copier/printer.

Amount of Paper

Paper Height Sensor 1

Paper Height Sensor 2

Near End

OFF

ON

30%

ON

ON

70%

ON

OFF

100%

OFF

OFF

When the tray contains paper of a small width, the paper feed pressure may become too low when the thickness of the remaining stack of paper has decreased. The lift motor rotates forward 300 ms after the sensor detects a certain amount of paper remaining in the tray to increase paper feed pressure, simulating the pressure generated by a full tray.

D331

18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Size Detection

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

2.6 PAPER SIZE DETECTION

There are three paper size sensors [A] (SN1, SN2 and SN3) on the paper tray unit. Each paper tray has its own actuator [B], with a unique combination of notches. This actuator is moved when the paper end fence [C] is adjusted for the installed paper. To determine which size has been installed, the CPU reads which paper size sensors the actuator has switched off. Refer to the size detection lists as shown below.

EU/ AISA Size

SN1

SN2

SN3

SP Setting

A6 SEF

148 x 105

OFF

ON

OFF

A5 LEF

B5 LEF

182 x 257

ON

OFF

ON

B6 SEF/ Exe LEF

A4 LEF

210 x 297

ON

ON

OFF

B5 SEF

257 x 182

OFF

OFF

ON

LT SEF

279 x 216

OFF

OFF

OFF

A4 SEF

297 x 210

ON

OFF

OFF

B4 SEF

364 x 257

ON

ON

ON

SM

19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

LT LEF/ A5 SEF/ HLT SEF

LG SEF

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Paper Size Detection A3 SEF

420 x 297 NA Size

OFF

ON

ON

SN1

SN2

SN3

DLT SEF SP Setting

A6 SEF

148 x 105

OFF

ON

OFF

A5 LEF

B5 LEF

182 x 257

ON

OFF

ON

Exe LEF/ B6 SEF

LT LEF

210 x 297

ON

ON

OFF

B5 SEF

257 x 182

OFF

OFF

ON

LT SEF

279 x 216

OFF

OFF

OFF

A4 SEF

297 x 210

ON

OFF

OFF

LG SEF

364 x 257

ON

ON

ON

DLT SEF

420 x 297

OFF

ON

ON

A4 LEF/ A5 SEF/ HLT SEF

A3 SEF

The CPU disables paper feed from a tray if the paper size cannot be detected. If the paper size actuator is broken, or if there is no tray installed, the Add Paper indicator will light.

D331

20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Side and End Fences

Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331

2.7 SIDE AND END FENCES

2.7.1 SIDE FENCES If the tray is full of paper and it is pushed in strongly, the fences may deform or bend. This may cause the paper to skew or the side-to-side registration to be incorrect. To correct this, each side fence has a stopper [A] attached to it. Each side fence can be secured with a screw [B], for customers who do not want to change the paper size.

2.7.2 END FENCE As the amount of paper in the tray decreases, the bottom plate [C] lifts up gradually. The end fence [D] is connected to the bottom plate. When the tray bottom plate rises, the end fence moves forward and pushes the back of the paper stack to keep it squared up.

SM

21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D331

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

ARDF DF3030 D366 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COVERS AND TRAY.................................................................................... 1 1.1.1 REAR COVER ..................................................................................... 1 1.1.2 FRONT COVER AND ORIGINAL TRAY.............................................. 1 1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS ............................................................ 2 1.2.1 ORIGINAL FEED UNIT ........................................................................ 2 1.2.2 PICK-UP ROLLER ............................................................................... 2 1.2.3 FEED BELT ......................................................................................... 3 1.2.4 SEPARATION ROLLER....................................................................... 4 1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 5 1.3.1 ARDF DRIVE BOARD AND DF POSITION SENSOR ......................... 5 1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE SENSOR..... 5 1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET SENSOR.................................................................... 6 1.3.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSORS AND SKEW CORRECTION SENSOR ... 6 1.3.5 STAMP SOLENOID AND ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR ......................... 7 1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE .............................................................................. 8 1.4.1 FEED MOTOR ..................................................................................... 8 1.4.2 PICK-UP SOLENOID ........................................................................... 8 1.4.3 INVERTER SOLENOID ....................................................................... 9 1.4.4 FEED CLUTCH.................................................................................. 10 1.4.5 TRANSPORT MOTOR....................................................................... 11

2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS..........................................................12 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................................................. 12 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................ 12 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................. 13 2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT................................................................................. 16 2.2 BASIC OPERATION ................................................................................... 17 2.2.1 ORIGINAL SET AND SIZE DETECTION........................................... 17 2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE......................................................... 18 2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION............................................................ 20 SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION ....................................................................... 21 2.2.5 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT ................................................. 22 2.2.6 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION .............................................. 23

3. SERVICE TABLES.........................................................................25 3.1 DIP SWITCHES .......................................................................................... 25

D366

ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.

Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Covers and Tray

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 COVERS AND TRAY 1.1.1 REAR COVER

1.

Open the left cover [A].

2.

Open the original tray [B].

3.

Rear cover [C] (

x 1, hook x 6)

1.1.2 FRONT COVER AND ORIGINAL TRAY

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Rear cover (

3.

Front cover [A] ( ƒ

4.

SM

"Rear Cover") x 1)

Keep the original tray open when you remove the front cover.

Original tray [B] (

x 1,

x 1)

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Document Feed Components

1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS 1.2.1 ORIGINAL FEED UNIT

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Original feed unit [A].

1.2.2 PICK-UP ROLLER

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Original feed unit (

3.

Pick-up roller [A] (

D366

"Original Feed Unit") x 1)

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Document Feed Components

1.2.3 FEED BELT

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Original feed unit (

3.

Feed belt cover [A] (spring x 1) ƒ

"Original Feed Unit")

When reassembling the feed belt cover, make sure that the projection [B] of the feed belt cover is on the guide plate rear [C].

4.

SM

Belt tension unit [D]

3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Document Feed Components

5.

Feed belt [E]

1.2.4 SEPARATION ROLLER

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Separation roller cover [A].

3.

Separation roller [B] (

D366

x 1)

4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Electrical Components

1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.3.1 ARDF DRIVE BOARD AND DF POSITION SENSOR

1.

Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")

2.

ARDF drive board [A] (

3.

DF position sensor with bracket [B] (

4.

DF position sensor [C] (hook x 2)

x 3, all

s) x 1,

x 1)

1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE SENSOR

1.

Original Tray (see "Front Cover and Original Tray")

2.

Tray cover [A] (

SM

x 3)

5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components 3.

Original trailing edge sensor [B] (

4.

Original length sensors [C] (

x 1)

x 1 each)

1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET SENSOR

1.

Open the left cover.

2.

Original feed unit (see the "Original Feed Unit")

3.

Original Tray (see the "Original Tray")

4.

Original feed-in guide plate [A] (

x 3).

5.

Original set sensor bracket [B] (

x 1)

6.

Original set sensor [C]

1.3.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSORS AND SKEW CORRECTION SENSOR

1.

Original feed-in guide plate (see "Original Set Sensor")

2.

Original turn guide plate [A] (hook x 1).

3.

Original width sensors [B] (

D366

x 1 each) and skew correction sensor [C] with bracket

6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Electrical Components (

x 1,

x 1)

1.3.5 STAMP SOLENOID AND ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR

1.

Open the ARDF.

2.

Remove the left edge of the platen sheet.

3.

Release the hook [A].

4.

Open the original exit guide plate [B]

5.

Stamp solenoid [C] (

6.

Original exit sensor [D] (

SM

x 1,

x 1) x 1, hook x 1)

7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Original Feed Drive

1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE 1.4.1 FEED MOTOR

1.

Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")

2.

Feed motor with bracket [A] (

3.

Feed motor [B] (

x 2,

x 1, spring x 1)

x 2)

1.4.2 PICK-UP SOLENOID

1.

Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")

2.

Harness guide [A] (all

D366

s)

8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Original Feed Drive

3.

Pick-up solenoid [B] (

x 2,

x 1)

1.4.3 INVERTER SOLENOID

1.

Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")

2.

Harness guide (see "Pick-up Solenoid")

3.

Inverter solenoid [A] (

SM

x 2,

x 1,

x 1, gear x 1, gear cover x 1)

9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Original Feed Drive

1.4.4 FEED CLUTCH

1.

Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")

2.

Harness guide (see "Pick-up Solenoid")

3.

Bracket [A] (

4.

Slide the bracket.

5.

Feed clutch [B] (

D366

x 2,

x 3,

x 1, bushing x 1, spring x 1)

x 1)

10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Original Feed Drive

1.4.5 TRANSPORT MOTOR

1.

Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")

2.

Harness guide (see "Pick-up Solenoid")

3.

Left cover sensor with bracket [A] (

4.

Transport motor with bracket [B] (

5.

Transport motor [C] (

SM

x 1, x 2,

x 1) x 1, spring x 1)

x 2)

11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout

2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT

1. Separation Roller 2. Paper Feed Belt 3. Pick-up Roller 4. Original Trailing Edge Sensor 5. Original Tray 6. Original Length Sensor 1 7. Original Length Sensor 2 8. Original Length Sensor 3 9. Inverter Roller

D366

10. Junction Gate 11. Exit Roller 12. Original Exit Sensor 13. Transport Roller 14. Registration Roller 15. Registration Sensor 16. Skew Correction Roller 17. Skew Correction Sensor

12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Component Layout

2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT Sensors

1. Original Width Sensor 2. Skew Correction Sensor 3. Registration Sensor 4. Cover Sensor 5. Original Set Sensor 6. Exit Sensor 7. Original Sensor 8. Original Length Sensor 9. DF Position Sensor

SM

13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout

Drive Components

1. Transport Motor 2. Feed Clutch 3. Pick-up Solenoid 4. Inverter Solenoid 5. Feed Motor 6. Main Board

Electrical Component Descriptions Symbol

Name

Function

Index No.

Motors M1

Feed

Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and reverse table rollers.

5

M2

Transport

Drives the transport and exit rollers

1

S9

DF Position

Detects whether the DF is lifted or not.

9

S5

Skew Correction

Detects the leading edge of the original to turn off the DF feed and transport motors.

2

S8

Registration

Detects the original exposure timing, and checks for original misfeeds.

3

S10

Cover Sensor

Detects whether the feed-in cover is opened or not.

4

Sensors

D366

14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Component Layout S1

Original Width Sensor - S

Detects the original width - S.

1

S2

Original Width Sensor - M

Detects the original width - M.

1

S3

Original Width Sensor - L

Detects the original width - L.

1

S4

Original Width Sensor - LL

Detects the original width - LL.

1

S14

Original Length S

Detects the original length - S.

8

S13

Original Length M

Detects the original length - M.

8

S12

Original Length L

Detects the original length - L.

8

S7

Original Set

Detects if an original is on the feed table.

5

Original Exit

Detects the leading edge of the original to turn on the junction gate solenoid and checks for original misfeeds. Detects the trailing edge of the original to turn off the transport and feed motor and junction gate solenoid. In single-sided mode, used to detect original misfeeds.

6

Original

Detects the trailing edge of the last original to stop copy paper feed and to turn off the transport motor, and checks for original misfeeds.

7

3

S6

S11

Solenoids SOL1

Pick-up

Controls the up-down movement of the original table.

SOL2

Stamp

Energizes the stamper to mark the original.

SOL3

Junction Gate

Opens and closes the junction gate.

4

Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and skew correction rollers

5

Magnetic Clutches MC1

SM

Feed

15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Component Layout PCBs PCB1

Main

Interfaces the sensor signals with the copier, and transfers the magnetic clutch, solenoid and motor drive signals from the copier.

6

2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT

1. Feed Motor 2. Pick-up Roller 3. Separation Roller 4. Feed Belt 5. Skew Correction Roller 6. Feed Clutch 7. Transport Motor 8. Exit Roller 9. Registration Roller ƒ

Feed Motor: Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and skew correction rollers.

ƒ

Transport Motor: Drives the registration and exit rollers.

D366

16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Basic Operation

2.2 BASIC OPERATION 2.2.1 ORIGINAL SET AND SIZE DETECTION

The original set sensor [A] detects if the original is set or not. The original sensor [B] detects if the original is on the original tray or not (this lets the machine know as early as possible, whether there is another original on the tray). The original size detection mechanism consists of the four original width sensors ([F]: Width Sensor S, [G]: Width Sensor M, [H] Width Sensor L, [I]: Width Sensor LL) and three original length sensors ([C]: Length Sensor S, [D]: Length Sensor M, [E]: Length Sensor L). Based on the combined output of the length sensors and the width sensors, the machine can detect the size of the original. This integrated detection mechanism is detailed in the table below. Width Sensor

Size

Length Sensor

Area

S

M

L

LL

S

M

L

LT

A/B

A3/SEF (297 x 420)

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

ON

O

O

B4/SEF (257 x 364)

ON

ON

-

-

ON

ON

ON

-

O

A4/SEF (210 x 297)

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

-

O

O

A4/LEF (297 x 210)

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

O

O

B5/SEF (182 x 257)

-

-

-

-

ON

-

-

-

O

B5/LEF (257 x 182)

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

A5/SEF (148 x 210)

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

A5/LEF (210 x 148)

ON

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

11" x 17"/SEF (DLT)

ON

ON

ON

-

ON

ON

ON

O1

O5

SM

17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Basic Operation 1

-

11" x 15"/SEF

ON

ON

ON

-

ON

ON

ON

10" x 14"/SEF

ON

ON

-

-

ON

ON

ON

O

-

8.5" x 14"/SEF (LG)

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

ON

O2

-

8.5" x 13"/SEF (F4)

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

ON

2

8.25" x 13"/SEF

ON

ON

ON

ON

-

-

8" x 13"/SEF (F)

ON

-

-

-

ON

ON

ON

-

-

8.5" x 11"/SEF (LT)

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

O3

O6

8.5" x 11"/LEF (LT)

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

O4

O7

7.25" x 10.5"/SEF (US EXE)

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

O

-

10.5" x 7.25"/SEF (US EXE)

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

4

-

10" x 8"/SEF

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

3

-

5.5" x 8.5"/SEF (HLT)

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

-

5.5" x 8.5"/LEF (HLT)

ON

-

-

-

-

-

-

O

-

267 mm x 390 mm

ON

ON

ON

-

ON

ON

ON

-

5

195 mm x 267 mm

ON

-

-

-

ON

-

-

-

6

267 mm x 195 mm

ON

ON

ON

-

-

-

-

-

7

O

Symbol O: Yes (Default),

: Yes (Can select this with SP mode), ON: Paper present, LT: North

America, A/B: Europe, Asia ƒ

For "O/ " mark, which has superscripted number, it is possible to change the original detection size with SP6-016. For example, instead of LT (O3), the machine can be set up to detect 10” x 8” (

3

).

ƒ

The F size can be selected with SP5-126. The default is 8.5" x 13"

ƒ

The machine cannot detect more than one size of original in the same job.

2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE This section explains what happens when the user selects mixed original size mode. Because this ARDF is a sheet-through document feeder, the method for original document width detection is the same as when the originals are the same size, but the document length detection method is different. Therefore, the scanning speed is slightly slower.

D366

18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Basic Operation

Document length detection From when the skew correction sensor switches on until it switches off, the CPU counts the transport motor pulses. The number of pulses determines the length of the original.

Feed-in cycle When the original size for the copy modes listed below cannot be determined, the image cannot be correctly scaled (reduced or enlarged) or processed until the original’s length has been accurately detected. The length must be determined before the image is scanned.

Auto Reduce/Enlarge Centering Erase Center/Border Booklet Image Repeat

The originals follow this path: Scanning glass

Inverter table

1.

Length detection

2.

Inverter table

Scanning glass

3.

Inverter table

Scanning glass (image scanned)

Inverter table (restores the original order) Exit tray

Normal feed-in In a copy mode other than those listed above, when the reduction/enlargement ratio has been determined, the originals are scanned normally. In order to store the scanned images, a large area of memory (the detected original width x 432 mm length) is prepared. Next, only the portion of the image up to the detected original length is read from memory and printed.

SM

19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Basic Operation

2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION

The original is set with the image facing up. The original pushes actuator and the original set sensor is activated. After pressing the start button, the feed clutch is activated and the original feed unit [A] moves down. At the same time, the pick-up solenoid is activated and the original table lifts until the original comes in contact with the pick-up roller [B]. The pick-up roller then feeds the top sheet of paper. After being fed from feed belt [C], the topmost sheet is separated from the stack by the separation roller [D] and sent to the skew correction roller. The mechanism is an FRR system, consisting of the original feed belt [C] and separation roller [D].

D366

20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Basic Operation

2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION

When an original is fed into the feeder, the feed motor [B] rotates forwards. At this time, the feed belt turns but the skew correction roller [C] does not. Because of this, when the leading edge of the paper gets to the skew correction roller, skew in the original is removed. A short time after the leading edge of the original turns on the skew correction sensor [A], the feed motor [B] turns off for 40 ms and rotates in reverse. At this time, the skew correction roller [C] and the feed belt both turn, and original feed continues. The original is fed by the skew correction roller after the feed clutch [D] has turned off.

SM

21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Basic Operation

2.2.5 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT Single-Sided Originals

The feed motor feeds the separated original to the skew correction roller [A] at maximum speed. After skew correction, the feed and transport motors feed the original through the scanning area at a lower speed (the scanning area contains the original exposure guide [B] and DF exposure glass [C]). After scanning, the original is fed out by the transport roller [D] and exit roller [E].

Double-Sided Originals

After skew correction, the feed and transport motors drive the skew correction roller [A], registration roller [B], transport roller [C] and the exit roller [D]. The front side of the original is then scanned. When the original exit sensor detects the leading edge of the original, the junction gate solenoid is activated and the junction gate [E] opens. The original is then transported

D366

22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Basic Operation towards the inverter table. Soon after the trailing edge of the original passes the exit sensor, the junction gate solenoid switches off and the junction gate [E] is closed. When the original has been fed onto the inverter table, the feed motor switches on in reverse. The original is then fed by the inverter roller [F], and then by the skew correction roller [A] and registration roller [B] to the scanning area (where the reverse side will be scanned).

The original is then sent to the inverter table again to be turned over. This is done so that the duplex copies will be properly stacked front side down in the exit tray [G] in the correct order.

Original Sensor During one-to-one copying, copy paper is fed to the skew correction roller in advance (while the original is still being scanned), to increase the copy speed. The original sensor monitors the stack of originals in the feeder, and detects when the trailing edge of the last page has been fed in. The main CPU then stops the copier from feeding an unwanted extra sheet of copy paper.

2.2.6 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION Jam Mode

Detection Timing When turning on the machine, the skew correction sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original.

Initial

When the cover is closed or DF is down, the skew correction sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original. When the cover is opened or DF is lifted up, the skew correction sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original.

SM

23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Basic Operation The skew correction sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by the maximum length of the original + 150 mm after the skew correction sensor turned on. Sensor stays on too long

The registration sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by its length x 1.5 after the registration sensor turned on. The exit sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by its length x 1.5 after the exit sensor turned on. The skew correction sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5.

Sensor does not come on

The registration sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on. The exit sensor does not turn on even the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on.

D366

24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Dip Switches

3. SERVICE TABLES 3.1 DIP SWITCHES

DIP-SW

Function

1

2

3

4

0

0

0

0

Normal operating mode (Default)

0

0

0

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 100% speed

0

0

1

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed

0

0

1

1

Free run: No original: One-sided mode: 100% speed

0

1

0

0

Free run: No original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed

0

1

0

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 32% speed

0

1

1

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 32% speed

0

1

1

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 70% speed

1

0

0

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 70% speed

1

0

0

1

Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 200% speed

1

0

1

0

Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 200% speed

1

0

1

1

Transport Motor On

1

1

0

0

Feed Motor On

1

1

0

1

Transport Motor On with random mode

1

1

1

0

Feed Motor On with random mode

1

1

1

1

SM

25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D366

ARDF DF3030 D366

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040 (D388)

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Internal Shift Tray SH3040 (D388) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 TRAY COVER............................................................................................... 1 – When Attaching the Tray Cover – ........................................................ 1 1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD................................... 2

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety

ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.

Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.

: See or Refer to : Screws

: Connector : Clip ring =: Clamp : E-ring

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Cover

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 TRAY COVER

1.

Remove the tray cover [A] by pressing on the two pawls [B] on the left side of the cover.

– When Attaching the Tray Cover – ƒ

The right side of the tray cover should be attached first.

1.

Fit the pawls [C] on the shift tray.

2.

Align the square [D] so that it fits into the groove in the underside of the tray cover and does not interfere with the attachment of the cover. Complete the attachment by inserting the left side pawls [B] into place.

Replacement and Adjustment

3.

SM

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D388

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Motor and Half Turn Sensor Board

1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD

1.

Top cover ( p.1 "Tray Cover")

2.

Slip disc [A]

3.

Tray motor [B] ( x 1)

4.

Half turn sensor board [C] ( x 1).

D388

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070 D425

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070 D425 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER ............................................................................... 1 1.1.1 COVERS.............................................................................................. 1 1.1.2 FEED ROLLER .................................................................................... 1 1.2 MOTORS AND CLUTCH .............................................................................. 2 1.2.1 PAPER FEED MOTOR ........................................................................ 2 1.2.2 TRANSPORT MOTOR......................................................................... 3 1.2.3 PAPER FEED CLUTCH....................................................................... 4 1.2.4 MAIN BOARD ...................................................................................... 4 1.3 SENSORS AND BOARD .............................................................................. 5 1.3.1 PAPER END SENSOR ........................................................................ 5 1.3.2 PAPER SIZE SENSORS ..................................................................... 5 1.3.3 TRAY MAIN BOARD............................................................................ 6

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D425

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Covers and Roller

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT

D425 Paper Feed Unit PB3070

1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER 1.1.1 COVERS

1.

Securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each)

2.

Rear cover [B] ( x 2)

3.

Rear right cover [C] ( x 1)

1.1.2 FEED ROLLER

1.

Pull out the tray [A]

2.

Release the lock lever [B]

3.

Feed roller [C]

SM

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D425

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Motors and Clutch

1.2 MOTORS AND CLUTCH ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.

1.2.1 PAPER FEED MOTOR 1.

Rear Cover ( Rear Cover)

2.

Release the harness [B] (= x 2).

3.

Paper feed motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 2, x 1))

Note:

Move the lever [B] in the red circle as shown above when removing the paper feed motor with the bracket.

D425

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D425 Paper Feed Unit PB3070

Motors and Clutch

4.

Paper feed motor bracket [A] ( x 3)

5.

Paper feed motor [B]

1.2.2 TRANSPORT MOTOR 1.

Pull out the Tray.

2.

Rear cover ( Rear Cover)

3.

Rear right cover ( Rear Right Cover)

4.

Stay [A] ( x 2)

5.

Rear right bracket [A] ( x 1)

6.

Tray end cover [B] ( x 1, = x 1)

SM

3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D425

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Motors and Clutch

7.

Transport motor [A] ( x 3, x 1)

1.2.3 PAPER FEED CLUTCH 1.

Rear Cover ( Rear Cover)

2.

Rear right bracket ( Transport Motor)

3.

Paper feed clutch [A] (= x 1, x 1,  x 1)

1.2.4 MAIN BOARD 1.

Rear cover ( Rear Cover)

2.

Main board [A] (All s,  x 4)

D425

4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Sensors and Board

1.3 SENSORS AND BOARD Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of D425 Paper Feed Unit PB3070

ƒ

the procedures in this section.

1.3.1 PAPER END SENSOR

1.

Pull out the tray [A]

2.

Sensor bracket [B] ( x 1, x 1)

3.

Paper end sensor [C] (hooks)

1.3.2 PAPER SIZE SENSORS

1.

Pull out the tray.

2.

Sensor bracket cover [A] ( x 1)

3.

Sensor bracket [B] ( x 3,  x 2)

4.

Paper size sensor (hooks)

SM

5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D425

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Sensors and Board

1.3.3 TRAY MAIN BOARD 1.

Rear cover ( Rear Cover)

2.

Main board [A] (All s,  x 4)

D425

6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

1 BIN TRAY BN3060 D426

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

1 BIN TRAY BN3060 D426 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 1 1.1.1 1-BIN TRAY EXIT SENSOR AND PAPER SENSOR .......................... 1 When reinstalling these sensors.............................................................. 2 1.1.2 1-BIN TRAY CONTROL BOARD ......................................................... 2 1.1.3 LED BOARD ........................................................................................ 3

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D426

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.1.1 1-BIN TRAY EXIT SENSOR AND PAPER SENSOR 1-Bin tray unit

2.

1-bin tray bottom cover [A] ( x 2)

3.

Sensor assembly [A] ( x 1, = x 2, x 2) D426 1 Bin Tray BN3060

1.

SM

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D426

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

4.

Sensors; ƒ

[A]: Paper sensor ( x 1)

ƒ

[B]: 1-bin tray exit sensor (hooks)

When reinstalling these sensors Both sensors have a 3-pin connector. Be careful to connect the correct harnesses from the 1-bin tray control board to each sensor. ƒ

The blue connector from the 1-bin tray control board must be connected to the paper sensor.

ƒ

The white connector from the 1-bin tray control board must be connected to the 1-bin tray exit sensor.

1.1.2 1-BIN TRAY CONTROL BOARD 1.

1-bin tray unit

2.

1-bin tray bottom cover ( 1-Bin Tray Exit Sensor and Paper Sensor)

3.

1-bin tray control board [A] ( x 1, x 3)

D426

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

1.1.3 LED BOARD 1-bin tray unit

2.

1-bin tray bottom cover ( 1-Bin Tray Exit Sensor and Paper Sensor)

3.

LED board ( x 1, x 1)

D426 1 Bin Tray BN3060

1.

SM

3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D426

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550 D427

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550 D427 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 1 1.1.1 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR ................................................................. 1 1.1.2 SIDE TRAY MOTOR............................................................................ 1 1.1.3 SIDE TRAY GATE SOLENOID............................................................ 2 1.1.4 SIDE TRAY BOARD ............................................................................ 3

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D427

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.1.1 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR 1.

Side tray paper exit unit

2.

Sensor assembly [A] ( x 2, = x 3, x 1)

3.

Side tray exit sensor [A] (hooks)]

1.

SM

D427 Side Tray Type C2550

1.1.2 SIDE TRAY MOTOR Side tray paper exit unit

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D427

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components

2.

Side tray upper cover [A] ( x 2, tab [B]) ƒ

3.

Release the tab [B] with a flat-head screwdriver.

Side tray motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)

1.1.3 SIDE TRAY GATE SOLENOID 1.

Side tray paper exit unit

2.

Side tray upper cover ( Side Tray Motor)

D427

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Electrical Components 3.

Side tray gate solenoid assembly [A] (= x 2,  x 1, x 1)

4.

Side tray gate solenoid [A] ( x 2, spring x 1)

1.1.4 SIDE TRAY BOARD Side tray paper exit unit

2.

Side tray upper cover ( Side Tray Motor)

3.

Side tray board [A] ( x 1, x all)

D427 Side Tray Type C2550

1.

SM

3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D427

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030 D428

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030 D428 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 TRAY COVER............................................................................................... 1 1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD................................... 2

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D428

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Cover

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 TRAY COVER

1.

Remove the tray cover [A] by pressing on the two pawls [B] on the left side of the cover.

– When Attaching the Tray Cover – ƒ

The right side of the tray cover should be attached first.

1.

Fit the pawls [C] on the shift tray.

2.

Align the square [D] so that it fits into the groove in the underside of the tray cover and does not interfere with the attachment of the cover. Complete the attachment by inserting the left side pawls [B] into place.

D428 Internal Shift Tray SH3030

3.

SM

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D428

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Tray Motor and Half Turn Sensor Board

1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD

1.

Top cover ( Tray Cover)

2.

Slip disc [A]

3.

Tray motor [B] ( x 1)

4.

Half turn sensor board [C] ( x 1).

D428

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550 D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550 D429 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COMMON PROCEDURES ........................................................................... 1 1.1.1 REAR, LEFT REAR AND REAR INNER COVER ................................ 1 1.1.2 FRONT COVER................................................................................... 2 1.1.3 OUTPUT TRAY LOWER COVER........................................................ 2 When installing the output tray lower cover ............................................. 2 1.1.4 OUTPUT TRAY UNIT .......................................................................... 3 1.2 MOTORS ...................................................................................................... 5 1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER CONTACT MOTOR............................................... 5 1.2.2 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MOTOR ............................................... 5 1.3 STAPLER UNIT ............................................................................................ 7 1.4 SENSORS .................................................................................................... 9 1.4.1 MAIN UNIT........................................................................................... 9 Relay Sensor........................................................................................... 9 Belt Roller Position Sensor...................................................................... 9 Stapler Safety Sensor ........................................................................... 10 Stapler Unit HP Sensor ......................................................................... 10 1.4.2 INVERTER UNIT ............................................................................... 11 Entrance Sensor.................................................................................... 11 1.5 FAN............................................................................................................. 12 1.5.1 FRONT FAN ...................................................................................... 12 1.6 MAIN BOARD ............................................................................................. 13 1.7 PUNCH UNIT .............................................................................................. 14 1.7.1 PUNCH SLIDER UNIT ....................................................................... 14

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.

Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.

: See or Refer to : Screws

: Connector : Clip ring : E-ring =: Clamp

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Common Procedures

1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 COMMON PROCEDURES ƒ

The finisher must be removed from the machine for these procedures except "Output Tray Lower Cover" removal procedure. The following covers cannot be removed while the finisher is attached to the machine.

D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

1.1.1 REAR, LEFT REAR AND REAR INNER COVER

1.

Rear cover [A] ( x 1)

2.

Left rear cover [B] ( x 2)

3.

Rear inner cover [C] ( x 1)

SM

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Common Procedures

1.1.2 FRONT COVER

1.

Remove the knob [A]

2.

Front cover [B] ( x 2)

1.1.3 OUTPUT TRAY LOWER COVER

1.

Output tray lower cover [A] ( x 3)

When installing the output tray lower cover

1.

The two projections [A] of the output tray lower cover (this plate is actually attached to

D429

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Common Procedures the output tray lower cover) must be inserted along with two guide rails [B] inside the output tray unit.

2.

Push the slide plate [A] to check if the output tray lower cover is correctly installed. The left side picture shows the correct result and right side picture shows the incorrect D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

result.

1.1.4 OUTPUT TRAY UNIT 1.

Output tray lower cover ( Output Tray Lower Cover)

2.

Rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)

3.

Left rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)

4.

Rear inner cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)

5.

Remove the screw [A].

SM

3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Common Procedures

6.

Disconnect the harness [A] (CN10), and make some slack in the cable.

7.

Output tray unit [A]

D429

4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Motors

1.2 MOTORS 1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER CONTACT MOTOR Front cover ( Front Cover)

2.

Loosen the harness guide [A] ( x 2)

3.

Bracket with pick-up roller contact motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)

4.

Pick-up roller contact motor [B] ( x 2)

D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

1.

1.2.2 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MOTOR 1.

SM

Front cover ( Front Cover)

5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Motors 2.

Bracket with stapler unit movement motor [A] ( x 2, spring x 1, belt)

3.

Two gears [A] ( x 1)

4.

Stapler unit movement motor [A] ( x 2)

D429

6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Stapler Unit

1.3 STAPLER UNIT Front cover ( Front Cover)

2.

White lever [A] (spring x 1, hook)

3.

Black lever [B] (hook)

4.

Shaft [A] ( x 1) ƒ

D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

1.

Remove the green stapler cartridge first, to make this step more easy.

5.

Move the stapler unit [A] to the center.

6.

Stand the internal finisher [B] as shown above.

7.

Remove two screws.

SM

7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Stapler Unit

Note:

Make sure that the end fences [A] are placed as shown above when replacing the stapler unit.

8.

Move the stapler unit to the rear side, and then remove the stapler unit [A] ( x 2).

D429

8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Sensors

1.4 SENSORS 1.4.1 MAIN UNIT

1.

D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

Relay Sensor

Relay sensor [A] (hook, x 1)

Belt Roller Position Sensor 1.

Rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)

2.

Front cover ( Front Cover)

3.

Top bracket [A] ( x 6)

SM

9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Sensors

4.

Belt roller position sensor with the bracket [A] ( x 1)

5.

Belt roller position sensor [B] (hook, x 1)

Stapler Safety Sensor 1.

Stapler unit ( Stapler Unit)

2.

Stapler safety sensor [A] ( x 1, hook)

Stapler Unit HP Sensor 1.

Front cover ( Front Cover)

2.

Bracket with stapler unit HP sensor ( x 1)

3.

Stapler unit HP sensor [A] (hook, x 1)

D429

10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Sensors

1.4.2 INVERTER UNIT Entrance Sensor

Bracket with entrance sensor ( x 1)

2.

Entrance sensor [A] ( x 1, hook) D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

1.

SM

11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fan

1.5 FAN 1.5.1 FRONT FAN

1.

Front fan [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)

D429

12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Main Board

1.6 MAIN BOARD Rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)

2.

Left rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)

3.

Main board ( x 2, clip x 2, x all)

SM

D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

1.

13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit

1.7 PUNCH UNIT ƒ

The punch unit must be removed from the internal finisher for this procedure.

1.7.1 PUNCH SLIDER UNIT

1.

Brackets [A] and ground plate [B] at the right side of the punch unit ( x 1 each)

2.

Brackets [A] at the left side of the punch unit ( x 1 each)

3.

Harness bracket [A] ( x 4)

4.

Wire guide cover [B] ( x 1)

D429

14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Punch Unit

Positioning pins [A] ( x 3, spring)

6.

Punch slider unit [A] ( x all)

D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550

5.

SM

15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D429

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530 D432/D433

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530 D432/D433 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................1 1.1 FAX OPTION (D432) INSTALLATION .......................................................... 1 1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................................ 1 1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ..................................... 2 1.2 FAX OPTION (D433) INSTALLATION .......................................................... 6 1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................................ 6 1.2.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ..................................... 6 1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS................................................................................... 10 1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578) (D432 ONLY)............................................... 10 1.3.2 HANDSET (B433) .............................................................................. 10 D037/D041 with the internal finisher...................................................... 13

2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ..........................................14 2.1 FCU............................................................................................................. 14

3. TROUBLESHOOTING ...................................................................15 3.1 ERROR CODES ......................................................................................... 15 3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................... 36 3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................... 39 3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION ................................................................... 39 Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name................................................ 39 Cannot send via VoIP Gateway............................................................. 40 Cannot send by Alias Fax number. ....................................................... 41 3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION ......................................................................... 42 Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name. .......................................... 42 Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway.......................................................... 43 Cannot receive by Alias Fax number..................................................... 44

4. SERVICE TABLE ...........................................................................46 4.1 BEFOREHAND ........................................................................................... 46

SM

i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

4.2 SERVICE TABLES...................................................................................... 47 4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES) ............................................................... 47 4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA) ...................................................................... 48 4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS) ...................................................... 48 4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS)............................................................. 49 4.2.5 SP5-XXX (INITIALIZING)................................................................... 49 4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS) ....................................................................... 50 4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS)............................................................................. 52 4.3 BIT SWITCHES........................................................................................... 53 4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES ........................................................................ 53 4.3.2 I-FAX SWITCHES.............................................................................. 66 4.3.3 PRINTER SWITCHES ....................................................................... 72 4.3.4 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES ........................................................ 79 4.3.5 G3 SWITCHES .................................................................................. 87 4.3.6 IP FAX SWITCHES............................................................................ 97 4.4 NCU PARAMETERS................................................................................. 105 4.5 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS........................................ 121 4.5.1 PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE ..................................................... 121 4.5.2 PARAMETERS ................................................................................ 121 Fax Parameters................................................................................... 121 E-mail Parameters............................................................................... 125 4.6 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES .................................................................. 129

5. SPECIFICATIONS........................................................................139 5.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS .................................................................. 139 5.1.1 FCU ................................................................................................. 139 5.1.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS ............................... 140 5.2 IFAX SPECIFICATIONS ........................................................................... 142 5.3 IP-FAX SPECIFICATIONS........................................................................ 144 5.4 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION................................................................... 145

D432/D433

ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety ƒ

Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.

Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.

: See or Refer to : Screws

: Connector : Clip ring : E-ring =: Clamp

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax Option (D432) Installation

1. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1.1 FAX OPTION (D432) INSTALLATION This fax option is only used for D038/D041 models.

1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

FCU

1

2

G3 Decal

1

3

Ferrite Core

1

4

Serial Number Decal

1

5

Fax Keytop

1

6

Data Display Decal Sheet (18 languages: ASIA only)

1

7

Handset Bracket (NA only)

1

8

Telephone Cord (NA only)

1

9

Handset Support Bracket (NA only)

1

10

Screw: M3x6 (NA only)

2

11

Clamp*1 (NA only)

1

12

FCC Decal (NA only)

1

TEL Cap (NA only)

1

-

*1: Item No. 11 is used only when the internal finisher (D429) is installed with NA models. (See "Handset Installation” in the Fax Field Service Manual.)

SM

1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax Option (D432) Installation

1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Before installation, print out all data in the printer buffer.

ƒ

Push the operation switch to put the machine in standby mode. Make sure the power LED is off, turn the main switch off, and then disconnect the power cord and the network cable.

ƒ

The copier must be connected to a properly grounded socket outlet.

1.

For NA models, attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe.

2.

Remove the FCU cover [A] ( x 2).

D432/D433

2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Fax Option (D432) Installation

3.

Press down the MBU [A]. ƒ

4.

Make sure that the MBU is seated correctly. If not, SC672 occurs.

Remove the jumper [B] (set to OFF) and set it to ON. ƒ

The machine may issue SC819 or SC820 if the jumper is not set to "ON" correctly. (Sometimes these SC codes are not issued.)

5.

Install the FCU [A] ( x 2; removed in step 3).

6.

Write the serial number of the fax unit on the serial number decal, and then attach this decal to the bracket [B] of the fax unit.

7.

SM

Attach the ferrite core to the telephone cord.

3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax Option (D432) Installation

ƒ

A telephone cord with the ferrite core must be used for RF interference suppression.

8.

Connect the telephone cord to the "LINE" jack.

9.

Only for NA models: Install the TEL cap in the "TEL" jack if the handset will not be installed.

10. Remove dummy keytop [A] and replace it with the Fax keytop [B].

11. Attach the Super G3 decal [A]. 12. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch. ƒ

After you turn the machine on, if you see a message that tells you the SRAM has been formatted due to a problem with SRAM, turn the machine off and on again to clear the message.

13. Enter the "User Tools" mode and set date and time.

D432/D433

4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Fax Option (D432) Installation 14. Do SP3102 in the fax SP mode and enter the serial number for the fax unit. 15. Enter the correct country code with SP1101-016 (System SW 0F, Country/area code for functional settings). 16. Exit the SP mode, and turn the machine off and on.

SM

5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax Option (D433) Installation

1.2 FAX OPTION (D433) INSTALLATION This fax option is only used for D037/D040 models.

1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.

No.

Description

Q’ty

1

FCU

1

2

G3 Decal

1

3

Serial Number Decal

1

4

Fax Operation Panel

1

-

Fax Operation Decal Sheet

1

1.2.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ƒ

Before installation, print out all data in the printer buffer.

ƒ

Push the operation switch to put the machine in standby mode. Make sure the power LED is off, turn the main switch off, and then disconnect the power cord and the network cable.

D432/D433

6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Fax Option (D433) Installation ƒ

The copier must be connected to a properly grounded socket outlet.

1.

Remove the FCU cover [A] ( x 2).

2.

Press down the MBU [A]. ƒ

3.

Make sure that the MBU is seated correctly. If not, SC672 occurs.

Remove the jumper [B] (set to OFF) and set it to ON. ƒ

The machine may issue SC819 or SC820 if the jumper is not set to "ON" correctly. (Sometimes these SC codes are not issued.)

SM

7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax Option (D433) Installation 4.

Install the FCU [A] ( x 2; removed in step 3).

5.

Write the serial number of the fax unit on the serial number decal, and then attach this decal to the bracket [B] of the fax unit.

6.

Connect the telephone cord to the "LINE" jack.

7.

Only for NA models, install the TEL cap in the "TEL" jack if the handset will not be installed.

8.

Slide the dummy cover [A] to the left side with a flat-head screwdriver, and then remove it (hooks).

9.

Put the fax operation panel [A] on the left edge of the copier's operation panel, and then slide it to the right side.

10. Attach the fax function decal at the location [B]. 11. Attach an appropriate fax operation decal at the location [C].

D432/D433

8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Fax Option (D433) Installation

12. Attach the Super G3 decal [A]. 13. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch. ƒ

After you turn the machine on, if you see a message that tells you the SRAM has been formatted due to a problem with SRAM, turn the machine off and on again to clear the message.

14. Enter the "User Tools" mode and set date and time. 15. Do SP3102 in the fax SP mode and enter the serial number for the fax unit. 16. Enter the correct country code with SP1101-016 (System SW 0F, Country/area code for functional settings). 17. Exit the SP mode, and turn the machine off and on.

SM

9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax Unit Options

1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS 1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578) (D432 ONLY) 1.

Remove the FCU from the machine.

2.

Install the memory option [A] on the FCU.

3.

Reinstall the FCU in the machine.

1.3.2 HANDSET (B433) ƒ

1.

The optional handset is available for the U.S. version only.

Remove the screw [A] first, and the rear cover [B] ( x7).

D432/D433

10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Fax Unit Options

2.

Remove the scanner left cover [C] ( x 2).

3.

Make two holes [D] in the scanner left cover.

4.

Attach the handset support bracket [E] inside the scanner left cover.

SM

11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Fax Unit Options 5.

Secure the handset bracket [F] ( x 2: M3x6 in the accesories of the FCU option).

6.

Reattach the scanner left cover to the machine.

7.

Remove the label [G] from the handset cradle [H].

8.

Attach the cradle to the handset bracket ( x 2: M3x8).

D432/D433

12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Fax Unit Options

9.

Set the handset on the handset bracket.

10. Put the ferrite core [I] on the handset core as shown. The length [J] must be 60 mm. 11. Connect the handset cable to the “TEL” jack at the rear of the machine.

D037/D041 with the internal finisher Do steps from 1 to 9 in the “Handset (B433)” installation procedure.

1.

Attach the clamp [A] to the scanner left cover.

2.

Set the telephone cable [B] as shown above.

3.

Put the ferrite core [C] on the handset core as shown. The length [D] must be 60 mm.

4.

Connect the handset cable to the “TEL” jack at the rear of the machine.

SM

13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

FCU

2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 2.1 FCU 1.

When you replace the FCU board, remove the MBU board from the old FCU board and install it on the new FCU board.

2.

Set the correct date and time with the User Tools: User Tools > System Settings > Timer Setting > Set Date/Time. ƒ

Do not turn off the battery switch (SW1).

ƒ

Do SP6101 to print the system parameters, and check the settings.

D432/D433

14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes

3. TROUBLESHOOTING 3.1 ERROR CODES If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to fix the problem as suggested below. Note that some error codes appear only in the error code display and on the service report.

Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

The machine at the other end may be incompatible.

DIS/NSF not detected 0-00

within 40 s of Start being

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

pressed

ƒ

Check for DIS/NSF with an oscilloscope.

ƒ

If the rx signal is weak, there may be a bad line.

ƒ 0-01

The other party is out of paper or has a jammed printer.

DCN received unexpectedly

ƒ

The other party pressed Stop during communication.

0-03

Incompatible modem at the other end

The other terminal is incompatible. ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Try changing the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.

0-04

CFR or FTT not received

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

The other terminal may be faulty; try sending to another machine.

after modem training ƒ

If the rx signal is weak or defective, there may be a bad line.

Cross reference Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)

SM

15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) Dedicated Tx parameters in Service Program Mode ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer.

Modem training fails even 0-05

G3 shifts down to 2400

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

bps.

ƒ

Check for line problems.

Cross reference See error code 0-04. ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.

0-06

The other terminal did not reply to DCS

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

The other end may be defective or incompatible; try sending to another machine.

ƒ

Check for line problems.

Cross reference See error code 0-04. ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

The other end may have jammed or run out of paper.

No post-message 0-07

response from the other

ƒ

The other end user may have disconnected the call.

end after a page was sent ƒ

Check for a bad line.

ƒ

The other end may be defective; try sending to another machine.

0-08

The other end sent RTN or ƒ

Check the line connection.

PIN after receiving a page,

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

because there were too

ƒ

The other end may have jammed, or run out of

many errors

D432/D433

paper or memory space.

16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.

ƒ

The other end may have a defective modem/FCU; try sending to another machine.

ƒ

Check for line problems and noise.

Cross reference ƒ

Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)

ƒ

Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)

ƒ

Dedicated Tx parameters in Service Program Mode

ƒ

Incompatible or defective remote terminal; try sending to another machine.

Non-standard post 0-14

message response code

ƒ

Noisy line: resend.

ƒ

Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.

received

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

Cross reference See error code 0-08. The other terminal is not capable of accepting the following functions, or the other terminal’s memory

The other terminal is not 0-15

is full.

capable of specific functions.

CFR or FTT not detected 0-16

ƒ

Confidential rx

ƒ

Transfer function

ƒ

SEP/SUB/PWD/SID

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.

after modem training in confidential or transfer

ƒ

The other end may have disconnected, or it may be defective; try calling another machine.

mode ƒ

If the rx signal level is too low, there may be a line problem.

SM

17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action Cross reference See error code 0-08.

0-20

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Check for line problems.

Facsimile data not

ƒ

Try calling another fax machine.

received within 6 s of

ƒ

Try adjusting the reconstruction time for the first line and/or rx cable equalizer setting.

retraining

Cross reference Reconstruction time - G3 Switch 0A, bit 6 Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) ƒ

Check the connections between the FCU and line.

EOL signal (end-of-line) 0-21

from the other end not received within 5 s of the previous EOL signal

ƒ

Check for line noise or other line problems.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

The remote machine may be defective or may have disconnected.

Cross reference Maximum interval between EOLs and between ECM frames - G3 Bit Switch 0A, bit 4

0-22

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

The signal from the other

ƒ

Defective remote terminal.

end was interrupted for

ƒ

Check for line noise or other line problems.

more than the acceptable

ƒ

Try adjusting the acceptable modem carrier drop time.

modem carrier drop time (default: 200 ms)

Cross reference Acceptable modem carrier drop time - G3 Switch 0A, bits 0 and 1

0-23

Too many errors during reception

D432/D433

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Defective remote terminal

18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

Check for line noise or other line problems.

ƒ

Try asking the other end to adjust their tx level.

ƒ

Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting and/or rx error criteria.

Cross reference Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) Rx error criteria - Communication Switch 02, bits 0 and 1

The other terminal did not 0-30

reply to NSS(A) in AI short protocol mode

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.

ƒ

The other terminal may not be compatible.

Cross reference Dedicated tx parameters - Section 4

The other terminal sent a 0-32

DCS, which contained functions that the receiving

ƒ

Check the protocol dump list.

ƒ

Ask the other party to contact the manufacturer.

machine cannot handle.

0-33

The data reception (not

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ECM) is not completed

ƒ

The other terminal may have a defective modem/FCU.

within 10 minutes. 0-52

0-55

Polarity changed during

ƒ

communication

Check the line connection. Retry communication.

FCU does not detect the

ƒ

FCU firmware or board defective.

SG3.

ƒ

SG3 firmware or board defective.

exceeds the capacity of the ƒ

SG3 firmware or board defective.

The stored message data 0-56

mailbox in the SG3. 0-70

SM

The communication mode specified in CM/JM was

ƒ

The other terminal did not have a compatible communication mode (e.g., the other terminal

19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

not available

was a V.34 data modem and not a fax

(V.8 calling and called

modem.)

terminal)

ƒ

A polling tx file was not ready at the other terminal when polling rx was initiated from the calling terminal.

ƒ

The calling terminal fell 0-74

The calling terminal could not detect ANSam due to noise, etc.

back to T.30 mode, because it could not detect ANSam after sending CI.

ƒ

ANSam was too short to detect.

ƒ

Check the line connection and condition.

ƒ

Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.

ƒ

The terminal could not detect ANSam.

The called terminal fell back to T.30 mode, 0-75

because it could not detect ƒ

Check the line connection and condition.

a CM in response to

ƒ

Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 fax.

ƒ

The called terminal could not detect a CM due

ANSam (ANSam timeout). The calling terminal fell back to T.30 mode, 0-76

because it could not detect a JM in response to CM (CM timeout). The called terminal fell because it could not detect a CJ in response to JM

Check the line connection and condition.

ƒ

Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.

ƒ

The calling terminal could not detect a JM due

ƒ

A network that has narrow bandwidth cannot pass JM to the other end.

ƒ

Check the line connection and condition.

ƒ

Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 fax.

The called terminal

ƒ

Check for line noise or other line problems.

detected CI while waiting

ƒ

If this error occurs, the called terminal falls

(JM timeout).

0-79

ƒ

to noise, etc.

back to T.30 mode, 0-77

to noise, etc.

for a V.21 signal.

D432/D433

back to T.30 mode.

20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

The line was disconnected 0-80

due to a timeout in V.34

ƒ

phases. Serious noise, narrow bandwidth, or

phase 2 – line probing.

0-81

low signal level can cause these errors.

The line was disconnected

If these errors happen at the transmitting terminal:

due to a timeout in V.34

ƒ

Try making a call at a later time.

phase 3 – equalizer

ƒ

Try using V.17 or a slower modem using

training.

dedicated tx parameters.

The line was disconnected 0-82

due to a timeout in the V.34 phase 4 – control channel start-up. The line was disconnected

0-83

The guard timer expired while starting these

ƒ

Try increasing the tx level.

ƒ

Try adjusting the tx cable equalizer setting.

If these errors happen at the receiving terminal: ƒ

Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting.

ƒ

Try increasing the tx level.

ƒ

Try using V.17 or a slower modem if the same

due to a timeout in the V.34

error is frequent when receiving from multiple

control channel restart

senders.

sequence. The line was disconnected 0-84

due to abnormal signaling in V.34 phase 4 – control channel start-up. The line was disconnected

0-85

due to abnormal signaling in V.34 control channel restart.

ƒ

The signal did not stop within 10 s.

ƒ

Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.

ƒ

If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU.

ƒ

The signal did not stop within 10 s.

ƒ

Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.

ƒ

If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU.

ƒ

The other terminal was incompatible.

ƒ

Ask the other party to contact the

The line was disconnected because the other terminal 0-86

requested a data rate using MPh that was not

manufacturer.

available in the currently selected symbol rate. 0-87

SM

The control channel started ƒ

The receiving terminal restarted the control

21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

after an unsuccessful

channel because data reception in the primary

primary channel.

channel was not successful. ƒ

This does not result in an error communication.

The line was disconnected because PPR was 0-88

ƒ

Try using a lower data rate at the start.

ƒ

Try adjusting the cable equalizer setting.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.

ƒ

Update the modem ROM.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.

ƒ

Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.

ƒ

JBIG data error

ƒ

Check the sender’s JBIG function.

ƒ

Update the MBU ROM.

JBIG trailing edge maker

ƒ

FCU defective

error

ƒ

Check the destination device.

transmitted/received 9 (default) times within the same ECM frame.

2-11 2-12

2-13

2-23 2-24 2-25

2-26

2-27

2-28

2-29

Only one V.21 connection flag was received Modem clock irregularity

Modem initialization error

JBIG compression or reconstruction error JBIG ASIC error JBIG data reconstruction error (BIH error) JBIG data reconstruction error (Float marker error) JBIG data reconstruction error (End marker error) JBIG data reconstruction error (Timeout)

D432/D433

22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

The machine resets itself 2-50

for a fatal FCU system

ƒ

the FCU.

error The machine resets itself 2-51

If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace

because of a fatal

ƒ

If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace the FCU.

communication error Snd msg() in the manual 2-53

task is an error because

ƒ

The user did the same operation many times, and this gave too much load to the machine.

the mailbox for the operation task is full.

4-01

Line current was cut

ƒ

Check the line connector.

ƒ

Check for line problems.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Get the ID Codes the same and/or the CSIs

Communication failed because of an ID Code mismatch (Closed 4-10

programmed correctly, then resend.

Network) or Tel. No./CSI

ƒ

mismatch (Protection

The machine at the other end may be defective.

against Wrong Connections) 5-10

DCR timer expired

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

because of a lack of

ƒ

Temporary memory shortage.

memory

ƒ

Test the SAF memory.

ƒ

Test the SAF memory.

ƒ

Ask the other end to resend the message.

ƒ

Replace an SD card or HDD.

Storage impossible 5-20

5-21

Memory overflow Print data error when

5-23

printing a substitute rx or confidential rx message

5-25

SM

SAF file access error

23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Check for a bad line or defective remote

G3 ECM - T1 time out 6-00

during reception of facsimile data

6-01

6-02

6-04

G3 ECM - no V.21 signal was received G3 ECM - EOR was received

G3 ECM - RTC not

terminal.

detected

G3 ECM - facsimile data 6-05

frame not received within 18 s of CFR, but there was no line fail

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Check for a bad line or defective remote terminal.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer

Cross reference ƒ

6-06

6-08

G3 ECM - coding/decoding ƒ

Defective FCU.

error

ƒ

The other terminal may be defective.

G3 ECM - PIP/PIN

ƒ

The other end pressed Stop during communication.

received in reply to PPS.NULL

6-09

G3 ECM - ERR received

ƒ

The other terminal may be defective.

ƒ

Check for a noisy line.

ƒ

Adjust the tx levels of the communicating machines.

ƒ 6-10

Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)

G3 ECM - error frames still ƒ

D432/D433

See code 6-05. Check for line noise.

24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

received at the other end

ƒ

the dedicated tx parameter for that address).

after all communication attempts at 2400 bps

V.21 flag detected during 6-21

high speed modem

ƒ

Check the line connection.

ƒ

Defective remote terminal.

ƒ

The other terminal may be defective or incompatible.

communication

6-22

The machine resets the

ƒ

Check for line noise.

sequence because of an

ƒ

If the same error occurs frequently, replace the

13-17

V.21 signal not stopped within 6 s SIP user name registration error

13-18

SIP server access error

13-24

SIP authentication error

13-25

Network I/F setting error

13-26

13-27

14-00

FCU.

abnormal handshake in the V.34 control channel

6-99

Adjust the tx level (use NCU parameter 01 or

IP address setting error

SMTP Send Error

Defective remote terminal.

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Double registration of the SIP user name.

ƒ

Capacity for user-name registration in the SIP server is not sufficient.

ƒ

Incorrect initial setting for the SIP server.

ƒ

Defective SIP server.

ƒ

Registered password in the device does not match the password in the SIP server.

Network I/F setting error at power on

ƒ

ƒ

IPV4 is not active in the active protocol setting.

ƒ

IP address of the device is not registered.

ƒ

Active protocol setting does not match the I/F setting for SIP server.

ƒ

IP address of the device is not registered.

ƒ

IP address of the device is not registered.

ƒ

Error occurred during sending to the SMTP server. Occurs for any error other than 14-01 to 16. For example, the mail address of the

SM

25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action system administrator is not registered. ƒ

Failed to connect to the SMTP server (timeout) because the server could not be found.

14-01

SMTP Connection Failed

ƒ

The PC is not ready to transfer files.

ƒ

SMTP server not functioning correctly.

ƒ

The DNS IP address is not registered.

ƒ

Network not operating correctly.

ƒ

Destination folder selection not correct.

ƒ

SMTP server operating incorrectly, or the destination for direct SMTP sending is not correct.

14-02

No Service by SMTP

ƒ

Contact the system administrator and check that the SMTP server has the correct settings

Service (421)

and operates correctly. ƒ

Contact the system administrator for direct SMTP sending and check the sending destination.

ƒ

Failed to access the SMTP server because the access is denied.

ƒ

SMTP server operating incorrectly. Contact the system administrator to determine if there is a problem with the SMTP server and to check that the SMTP server settings are

14-03

Access to SMTP Server Denied (450)

correct. ƒ

Folder send destination is incorrect. Contact the system administrator to determine that the SMTP server settings and path to the server are correct.

ƒ

Device settings incorrect. Confirm that the user name and password settings are correct.

ƒ

Direct SMTP destination incorrect. Contact the system administrator to determine if there is a

D432/D433

26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action problem at the destination at that the settings at the destination are correct.

14-04

Access to SMTP Server

ƒ

SMTP server operating incorrectly

Denied (550)

ƒ

Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly

ƒ

Failed to access the SMTP server because the HDD on the server is full.

ƒ

Insufficient free space on the HDD of the SMTP server. Contact the system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the SMTP server HDD.

ƒ 14-05

Insufficient free space on the HDD where the

SMTP Server HDD Full

destination folder is located. Contact the

(452)

system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the HDD where the target folder is located. ƒ

Insufficient free space on the HDD at the target destination for SMTP direct sending. Contact the system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the target HDD.

14-06

User Not Found on SMTP Server (551)

ƒ

The designated user does not exist.

ƒ

The designated user does not exist on the SMTP server.

ƒ

The designated address is not for use with direct SMTP sending.

ƒ

Failed to access the SMTP server because the transmission failed.

14-07

SM

Data Send to SMTP Server Failed (4XX)

ƒ

PC not operating correctly.

ƒ

SMTP server operating incorrectly

ƒ

Network not operating correctly.

ƒ

Destination folder setting incorrect.

ƒ

Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly.

27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

Failed to access the SMTP server because the transmission failed.

14-08

14-09

14-10

Data Send to SMTP Server ƒ

SMTP server operating incorrectly

Failed (5XX)

ƒ

Destination folder setting incorrect.

ƒ

Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly.

ƒ

Software application error.

ƒ

POP-Before-SMTP or SMTP authorization

Authorization Failed for Sending to SMTP Server

Addresses Exceeded

failed. ƒ

Incorrect setting for file transfer

ƒ

Number of broadcast addresses exceeded the limit for the SMTP server.

ƒ 14-11

The send buffer is full so the transmission could not be completed. Buffer is full due to

Buffer Full

using Scan-to-Email while the buffer is being used send mail at the same time. ƒ

14-12

Data Size Too Large

14-13

Send Cancelled

14-14

Security Locked File Error

detected size of the file was too large. ƒ

Processing is interrupted because the user pressed Stop.

ƒ

Update the software because of the defective software.

ƒ 14-15

Transmission was cancelled because the

The transmitting a mail is interrupted via DCS due to the incorrect data.

Mail Data Error

ƒ

Update the software because of the defective software.

ƒ 14-16

transmission and the division number of a mail

Maximum Division Number

are more than the specified number, the mail

Error

transmission is interrupted. ƒ

D432/D433

When a mail is divided for the mail

Update the software because of the defective

28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action software.

14-17

ƒ

Incorrect Ticket

software. ƒ

14-18

Update the software because of the defective

Access to MCS File Error

The access to MCS file is denied due to the no permission of access.

ƒ

Update the software because of the defective software.

Failed to create the MCS file because: ƒ 14-30

The number of files created with other applications on the Document Server has

MCS File Creation Failed

exceeded the limit. ƒ

HDD is full or not operating correctly.

ƒ

Software error.

UFS file could not be created: ƒ 14-31

14-32

14-33

Scan-to-Email and IFAX transmission.

UFS File Creation Failed

Cancelled the Mail Due to

ƒ

HDD full or not operating correctly.

ƒ

Software error.

ƒ

Error detected with NFAX and send was

Error Detected by NFAX

cancelled due to a software error. ƒ

No Mail Address For the

is registered.

domain for SMTP sending

ƒ ƒ

SM

Check the address selected in the address book for SMTP sending.

does not exist

Mail Job Task Error

Operational error in normal mail sending or direct SMTP sending.

Address designated in the

14-50

Neither the mail address of the machine nor the mail address of the network administrator

Machine ƒ

14-34

Not enough space in UFS area to handle both

Check the domain selection.

Due to an FCU mail job task error, the send was cancelled:

29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

Address book was being edited during creation of the notification mail.

ƒ

Software error.

Not even one return notification can be downloaded: 14-51

UCS Destination

ƒ

The address book was being edited.

Download Error

ƒ

The number for the specified destination does not exist (it was deleted or edited after the job was created).

14-60

14-61

ƒ

Send Cancel Failed

cancel the send operation.

Notification Mail Send Failed for All Destinations Transmission Error due to

14-62

15-01

15-02

15-03 15-10

The cancel operation by the user failed to

ƒ

All addresses for return notification mail failed.

ƒ

When the 0 line page exists in received pages

the existence of zero line

with G3 communication, the transmission is

page

interrupted.

POP3/IMAP4 Server Not

ƒ

At startup, the system detected that the IP address of the POP3/IMAP4 server has not

Registered

been registered in the machine.

POP3/IMAP4 Mail Account ƒ

The POP3/IMAP4 mail account has not been

Information Not Registered

registered.

Mail Address Not Registered DCS Mail Receive Error

ƒ

The mail address has not been registered.

ƒ

Error other than 15-11 to 15-18.

The DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server could not be found: 15-11

Connection Error

ƒ

The IP address for DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server is not stored in the machine.

ƒ

D432/D433

The DNS IP address is not registered.

30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

Network not operating correctly.

POP3/IMAP4 send authorization failed: 15-12

Authorization Error

ƒ

Incorrect IFAX user name or password.

ƒ

Access was attempted by another device, such as the PC.

15-13

ƒ

POP3/IMAP4 settings incorrect.

ƒ

Occurs only during manual reception. Transmission cannot be received due to

Receive Buffer Full

insufficient buffer space. The buffer is being used for mail send or Scan-to-Email.

15-14

Mail Header Format Error

ƒ

example, the Date line description is incorrect. ƒ

15-15

The mail header is not standard format. For

Mail Divide Error

The e-mail is not in standard format. There is no boundary between parts of the e-mail, including the header.

ƒ

15-16

Mail Size Receive Error

15-17

Receive Timeout

15-18

Incomplete Mail Received

large. ƒ

May occur during manual receiving only because the network is not operating correctly.

Final Destination for 15-31

The mail cannot be received because it is too

Transfer Request

ƒ

Only one portion of the mail was received.

ƒ

The format of the final destination for the transfer request was incorrect.

Reception Format Error

The transmission cannot be delivered to the final 15-39

Send/Delivery Destination Error

destination: ƒ

Destination file format is incorrect.

ƒ

Could not create the destination for the file transmission.

15-41

SM

SMTP Receive Error

ƒ

Reception rejected because the transaction

31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action exceeded the limit for the “Auth. E-mail RX” setting.

15-42

Off Ramp Gateway Error

15-43

Address Format Error

15-44

Addresses Over

15-61

ƒ

The delivery destination address was specified with Off Ramp Gateway OFF.

ƒ

Format error in the address of the Off Ramp Gateway.

ƒ

The number of addresses for the Off Ramp Gateway exceeded the limit of 30.

Attachment File Format

ƒ

Error

The attached file is not TIFF format.

Could not receive transmission due to: ƒ

Resolution error

ƒ

Image of resolution greater than 200 dpi without extended memory.

15-62

TIFF File Compatibility

ƒ

Resolution is not supported.

Error

ƒ

Page size error

ƒ

The page size was larger than A3.

ƒ

Compression error

ƒ

File was compressed with other than MH, MR, or MMR.

The TIFF file sent as the attachment could not be received because the TIFF header is incorrect: 15-63

ƒ

TIFF Parameter Error

The TIFF file attachment is a type not supported.

ƒ

The TIFF file attachment is corrupted.

ƒ

Software error.

The file received as an attachment caused the 15-64

TIFF Decompression Error

TIFF decompression error: ƒ

The TIFF format of the attachment is corrupted.

D432/D433

32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

15-71

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

Not Binary Image Data

ƒ

Software error.

ƒ

The file could not be received because the attachment was not binary image data.

ƒ 15-73

MDN Status Error

Could not find the Disposition line in the header of the Return Receipt, or there is a problem with the firmware.

ƒ 15-74

MDN Message ID Error

Could not find the Original Message ID line in the header of the Return Receipt, or there is a problem with the firmware.

ƒ

Could not receive the transmission because the destination buffer is full and the destination

15-80

could not be created (this error may occur

Mail Job Task Read Error

when receiving a transfer request or a request for notification of reception). ƒ 15-81

Could not repeat receive the transmission because the destination buffer is full and the

Repeated Destination

destination could not be created (this error

Registration Error

may occur when receiving a transfer request or a request for notification of reception). Could not receive the file for transfer to the final destination:

15-91

Send Registration Error

ƒ

The format of the final destination or the transfer destination is incorrect.

ƒ

Destinations are full so the final and transfer destinations could not be created.

15-92

Memory Overflow

15-93

Memory Access Error

SM

ƒ

Transmission could not be received because memory overflowed during the transaction.

ƒ

Transaction could not complete due to a malfunction of SAF memory.

33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action ƒ

15-94

The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for transfer request, because the ID code in the

Incorrect ID Code

incoming e-mail did not match the ID code registered in the machine. ƒ

15-95

Transfer Station Function

The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for transfer because the transfer function was unavailable.

22-00

22-01

Original length exceeded

ƒ

Divide the original into more than one page.

ƒ

Check the resolution used for scanning. Lower the scan resolution if possible.

the maximum scan length

Memory overflow while

ƒ

Add optional page memory.

ƒ

Wait for the files in the queue to be sent.

ƒ

Delete unnecessary files from memory.

ƒ

Transfer the substitute reception files to an another fax machine, if the machine’s printer is

receiving

busy or out of order. ƒ

Add an optional SAF memory card or hard disk.

Tx or rx job stalled due to 22-02

22-05

23-00

25-00

The job started normally but did not finish normally; data may or may not have been

line disconnection at the

received fully.

other end

22-04

ƒ

ƒ

Restart the machine.

The machine cannot store

ƒ

Update the ROM

received data in the SAF

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Defective FCU board or firmware.

Data read timeout during

ƒ

Restart the machine.

construction

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

The machine software

ƒ

Update the ROM

resets itself after a fatal

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

No G3 parameter confirmation answer

D432/D433

34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Error Codes Code

Meaning

Suggested Cause/Action

transmission error occurred F0-xx

F6-xx

SM

V.34 modem error

SG3 modem error

ƒ

Replace the FCU.

ƒ

Update the SG3 modem ROM.

ƒ

Replace the SG3 board.

ƒ

Check for line noise or other line problems.

ƒ

Try communicating another V.8/V.34 fax.

35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

IFAX Troubleshooting

3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING Use the following procedures to determine whether the machine or another part of the network is causing the problem. Communication Route

Item

Action [Remarks]

1. Connection with General LAN

the LAN

ƒ

the machine. ƒ

2. LAN activity

on the PC

Check that the LEDs on the hub are lit.

Check that other devices connected to the LAN can communicate through the LAN. ƒ

1. Network settings

Check that the LAN cable is connected to

Check the network settings on the PC.

[Is the IP address registered in the TCP/IP properties in the network setup correct? Check the IP address with the administrator of the network.]

2. Check that PC Between IFAX and

can connect with

PC

the machine

ƒ

Use the “ping” command on the PC to contact the machine.

[At the MS-DOS prompt, type ping then the IP address of the machine, then press Enter.] ƒ

Check the LAN parameters

ƒ

Check if there is an IP address conflict with other PCs.

3. LAN settings in

[Use the “Network” function in the User Tools.

the machine

If there is an IP address conflict, inform the administrator.]

Between machine

1. LAN settings in

and e-mail server

the machine

ƒ

Check the LAN parameters

ƒ

Check if there is an IP address conflict with other PCs.

[Use the “Network” function in the User Tools. If there is an IP address conflict, inform the administrator.]

D432/D433

36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

IFAX Troubleshooting

Communication Route

Item

Action [Remarks] ƒ

Make sure that the machine can log into the e-mail server.

2. E-mail account

ƒ

Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in

on the server

the machine. [Ask the administrator to check.] ƒ

Make sure that the client devices which have an account in the server can send/receive e-mail.

3. E-mail server

[Ask the administrator to check. Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned e-mail if the communication is performed successfully.] ƒ

Make sure that the PC can log into the e-mail server.

1. E-mail account

ƒ

Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in

on the Server

the machine. [Ask the administrator to check.] Between e-mail

ƒ

server and internet

Make sure that the client devices which have an account in the server can send/receive e-mail.

2. E-mail server

[Ask the administrator to check. Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned e-mail if the communication is performed successfully.]

SM

37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

IFAX Troubleshooting Communication Route

Item

Action [Remarks] ƒ

actually used.

3. Destination e-mail address

Make sure that the e-mail address is

ƒ

Check that the e-mail address contains no incorrect characters such as spaces.

ƒ

Use the “ping” command to contact the router.

4. Router settings

ƒ

Check that other devices connected to the router can sent data over the router.

[Ask the administrator of the server to check.] 5. Error message by

ƒ

another address on the same network,

e-mail from the network of the destination.

D432/D433

Check whether e-mail can be sent to using the application e-mail software.

ƒ

Check the error e-mail message.

[Inform the administrator of the LAN.]

38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting

3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING 3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name

Check Point

Action

1

LAN cable connected?

Check the LAN cable connection.

2

Specified IP address/host name correct?

Check the IP address/host name. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by

3

Firewall/NAT is installed?

using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)

4

Transmission sent manually?

Manual sending not supported.

5

IP address of local machine registered?

Register the IP address.

6

7

8

9

Remote terminal port number setting other than 1720?

Send by specifying the port number. Confirm the port number of the remote

Specified port number correct?

fax.

DNS server registered when host name specified?

Contact the network administrator. Check whether the remote fax is a T38

Remote fax a T.38 terminal?

terminal. Check that the remote fax is switched

10 Remote fax switched off or busy?

on. Request the network administrator to

11 Network bandwidth too narrow?

increase the bandwidth. Raise the delay level. IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3

SM

39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

IP-Fax Troubleshooting IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to 1. Check whether the remote fax

12 Remote fax cancelled transmission?

cancelled the transmission.

Cannot send via VoIP Gateway

Check Point

Action

1

LAN cable connected?

Check the LAN cable connection.

2

VoIP Gateway T.38 standard?

Contact the network administrator.

3

VoIP Gateway installed correctly?

Contact the network administrator.

4

VoIP Gateway power switched on?

Contact the network administrator.

5 6

Is the IP address/host name of the

Check the IP address/host name.

specified Gateway correct? Number of the specified fax correct?

Check the remote fax number. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by

7

Firewall/NAT is installed?

using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)

8

Transmission sent manually?

Manual sending not supported.

9

IP address of local fax registered?

Register the IP address.

10

DNS registered when host name

Contact the network administrator.

specified?

11 Remote fax a G3 fax?

Check that the remote fax is a G3 fax.

12 G3 fax is connected to VoIP gateway?

Check that G3 fax is connected.

13 Remote G3 fax turned on?

Check that G3 fax is switched on.

D432/D433

40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting Request the network administrator to increase the bandwidth. Raise the network delay level. 14 Network bandwidth too narrow?

IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3 IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to 1.

Cannot send by Alias Fax number.

Check Point

Action

1

LAN cable connected?

Check the LAN cable connection.

2

Number of specified Alias fax correct?

Confirm the Alias of the remote fax. Error Code: 13-14 Cannot breach the firewall. Send by

3

Firewall/NAT installed?

using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)

4

Transmission sent manually?

Manual sending not supported.

5

Gatekeeper installed correctly?

Contact the network administrator.

6

Gatekeeper power switched on?

Contact the network administrator.

7

8

9

IP address/host name of Gatekeeper

Check the IP address/host name.

correct? DNS server registered when Gatekeeper host name specified?

Contact the network administrator. Check the settings.

Enable H.323 SW is set to on?

See User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0

10 IP address of local fax registered?

Register the IP address of the local fax.

11 Alias number of local fax registered?

Register the Alias number of the local

SM

41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

IP-Fax Troubleshooting fax. 12 Remote fax registered in Gatekeeper?

Contact the network administrator. Check whether the remote fax is a T38

13 Remote fax a T.38 terminal?

terminal.

14 Remote fax switched off or busy?

Contact the network administrator. Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth. Raise the delay level.

15 Network bandwidth too narrow?

IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3 Lower the modem transmission baud rate. IPFAX SW 05 Check whether the remote fax

16 Remote fax cancelled transmission?

cancelled the transmission.

3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name.

Check Point

Action

1

LAN cable connected?

2

Firewall/NAT is installed?

3

IP address of local fax registered?

4

5

Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) Register the IP address.

Port number specified at remote sender Request the sender to specify the port fax (if required)?

number.

Specified port number correct (if

Request the sender to check the port

required)?

number.

D432/D433

42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting Contact the network administrator. 6

DNS server registered when host name specified on sender side?

ƒ

The sender machine displays this error code if the sender fax is a Ricoh model.

Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth. 7

Network bandwidth too narrow?

Lower the start modem reception baud rate on the receiving side. IPFAX SW06

8

Check whether the remote fax cancelled

Remote fax cancelled transmission?

the transmission.

Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway.

Check Point 1

Action

LAN cable connected?

Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot breach the firewall. Request the

2

Firewall/NAT is installed?

remote fax to send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)

3

VoIP Gateway installed correctly?

Contact the network administrator.

4

VoIP Gateway power switched on?

Contact the network administrator.

5

6

IP address/host name of specified VoIP Request the remote fax to check the IP Gateway correct on sender’s side? DNS server registered when host name specified on sender side?

7

Network bandwidth too narrow?

8

G3 fax connected?

SM

address/host name. Contact the network administrator. Request the network administrator to increase the bandwidth. Check that G3 fax is connected.

43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

IP-Fax Troubleshooting 9

G3 fax power switched on?

Check that G3 fax is switched on.

Cannot receive by Alias Fax number.

Check Point 1

Action

LAN cable connected?

Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot the breach firewall. Request the

2

Firewall/NAT is installed?

remote fax to send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) Contact the network administrator.

3

Gatekeeper installed correctly?

ƒ

The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.

Contact the network administrator. 4

Power to Gatekeeper switched on?

ƒ

The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.

Request the sender to check the IP address/host name. 5

IP address/host name of Gatekeeper correct on the sender’s side?

ƒ

The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.

Contact the network administrator. DNS server registered when 6

Gatekeeper host name specified on

ƒ

sender’s side?

The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.

7

Enable H.323 SW is set to on?

D432/D433

Request the sender to check the settings.

44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

IP-Fax Troubleshooting User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0 ƒ

Only if the remote sender fax is a Ricoh fax.

8

Local fax IP address registered?

Register the IP address.

9

Local fax Alias number registered?

Register the Alias number. Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth.

10 Network bandwidth too narrow?

Lower the start modem reception baud rate on the receiving side. IPFAX SW06

11 Remote fax cancelled transmission?

Check whether the remote fax cancelled the transmission. Contact the network administrator.

12 Local fax registered in Gatekeeper?

ƒ

The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.

SM

45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Beforehand

4. SERVICE TABLE 4.1 BEFOREHAND ƒ

Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.

ƒ

The main power LED (C) lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.

D432/D433

46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service Tables

4.2 SERVICE TABLES 4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES)

Bit Switches 1

Mode No.

Function

System Switch Change the bit switches for system settings for the

101 001 – 032

00 – 1F

fax option

"Bit Switches"

Ifax Switch Change the bit switches for internet fax settings for

102 001 – 016

00 – 0F

the fax option

"Bit Switches"

Printer Switch Change the bit switches for printer settings for the fax

103 001 – 016

00 – 0F

option

"Bit Switches"

Communication Switch Change the bit switches for communication settings

104 001 – 032

00 – 1F

for the fax option

"Bit Switches"

G3-1 Switch Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of

105 001 – 016

00 – 0F

the standard G3 board

"Bit Switches"

IP fax Switch Change the bit switches for optional IP fax

111 001 – 016

00 – 0F

parameters

"Bit Switches"

SM

47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Tables

4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA)

2

Mode No.

Function

RAM Read/Write 101

Change RAM data for the fax board directly.

001

"Service RAM Addresses"

Memory Dump 102 001

G3-1 Memory

Print out RAM data for the fax board.

Dump

"Service RAM Addresses"

G3-1 NCU Parameters 103 001 – 023

NCU parameter settings for the standard G3

CC, 01 – 22

board. "NCU Parameters"

4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS)

3

101

Mode No. Service Station 001

102

Function

Fax Number

Serial Number 000

103

Enter the fax number of the service station.

Enter the fax unit’s serial number.

PSTN-1 Port Settings Select the line type setting for the G3-1 line. If 001

Select Line

the machine is installed on a PABX line, select “PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”.

002

D432/D433

PSTN Access

Enter the PSTN access number for the

Number

G3-1 line.

48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service Tables 003

Memory Lock Disabled

Not used

IPFAX Port Settings

107

001

H323 Port

Sets the H323 port number.

002

SIP Port

Sets the SIP port number.

003

RAS Port

Sets the RAS port number.

004

Gatekeeper port

Sets the Gatekeeper port number.

005

T.38 Port

Sets the T.38 port number.

006

SIP Server Port

Sets the SIP port number.

007

201

IPFAX Protocol Priority

Select "H323" or "SIP".

FAX SW 001 – 032

00 – 1F

4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS)

4

Mode No.

Function

101

001

FCU ROM Version

Displays the FCU ROM version.

102

001

Error Codes

Displays the latest 64 fax error codes.

103

001

G3-1 ROM Version

Displays the G3-1 modem version.

4.2.5 SP5-XXX (INITIALIZING)

5 101

SM

Mode No.

Function

Initialize SRAM (except Secure)

49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Tables Initializes the bit switches and user parameters, user data in

000

102

the SRAM, files in the SAF memory, and clock.

Erase All Files 000

103

Erases all files stored in the SAF memory.

Reset Bit Switches (except Secure) 000

Resets the bit switches and user parameters.

Factory setting 104

Resets the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the

000

105

SRAM and files in the SAF memory.

Initialize All Bit Switches 000

Initializes all the current bit switch settings.

Initialize Security Bit Switches Initializes only the security bit switches. If you select

106 000

automatic output/display for the user parameter switches, the security settings are initialized.

4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS)

6

Mode No.

Function

System Parameter List 101 000

-

Touch the “ON” button to print the system parameter list.

Service Monitor Report 102 000 103

-

Touch the “ON” button to print the service monitor report.

G3 Protocol Dump List

D432/D433

50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service Tables 001

002

003

G3 All

Prints the protocol dump list of all

Communications

communications for all G3 lines.

G3-1 (All

Prints the protocol dump list of all

Communications)

communications for the G3-1 line.

G3-1

Prints the protocol dump list of the last

(1 Communication)

communication for the G3-1 line.

All Files print out Prints out all the user files in the SAF memory, including confidential messages. 105 000

ƒ

-

Do not use this function, unless the customer is having trouble printing confidential messages or recovering files stored using the memory lock feature.

Journal Print out

106

107

SM

001

All Journals

002

Specified Date

The machine prints all the communication records on the report. The machine prints all communication records after the specified date.

Log List Print out These log print out functions are for designer

001

All log files

002

Printer

003

SC/TRAP Stored

004

Decompression

005

Scanner

006

JOB/SAF

007

Reconstruction

use only.

51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service Tables 008

JBIG

009

Fax Driver

010

G3CCU

011

Fax Job

012

CCU

013

Scanner Condition

IP Protocol Dump List

108

001

All Communications

002

1 Communication

Prints the protocol dump list of all communications for the IP fax line. Prints the protocol dump list of the last communication for the IP fax line.

4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS) These are the test modes for PTT approval.

7

Function

101

G3-1 Modem Tests

102

G3-1 DTMF Tests

103

Ringer Test

104

G3-1 V34 (S2400baud)

105

G3-1 V34 (S2800baud)

106

G3-1 V34 (S3000baud)

107

G3-1 V34 (S3200baud)

108

G3-1 V34 (S3429baud)

109

Recorded Message Test

D432/D433

52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches

4.3 BIT SWITCHES ƒ

Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as “Not used”, as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.

ƒ

Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine.

4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES

System Switch 00 [SP No. 1-101-001] No

FUNCTION Dedicated transmission

0

parameter programming 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

1

SM

Not used

COMMENTS Set this bit to 1 before changing any dedicated transmission parameters. Reset this bit to 0 after programming dedicated transmission parameters. Do not change

53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches

System Switch 00 [SP No. 1-101-001] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Technical data printout on the Journal

1: Instead of the personal name, the following data are listed on the Journal for each G3

0: Disabled

communication.

1: Enabled

e.g. 0000 (1) // 32 (2) V34 (3) // 288 (4) // 264 (5) // L0100 (6) 03 (7) 04 (8) (1): EQM value (Line quality data). A larger number means more errors. (2): Symbol rate (V.34 only) (3): Final modem type used (4): Starting data rate (for example, 288 means 28.8 kbps) (5): Final data rate (6): Rx revel (refer to the note after this table for how to read the rx level) 2

(7): Total number of error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception. (8): Total number of burst error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception. ƒ

EQM and rx level are fixed at “FFFF” in tx mode.

ƒ

The seventh and eighth numbers are fixed at “00” for transmission records and ECM reception records.

Rx level calculation Example: 0000 // 32 V34 // 288/264 // L 01 00 03 04 The four-digit hexadecimal value (N) after “L” indicates the rx level. The high byte is given first, followed by the low byte. Divide the decimal value of N by -16 to get the rx level. In the above example, the decimal value of N (= 0100 [H]) is 256. So, the actual rx level is 256/-16 = -16 dB 3

4

5

Do not change this setting.

Not used

When "1" is selected, a line error mark is printed

Line error mark print

on the printout if a line error occurs during

0: OFF, 1: ON (print)

reception.

G3 communication parameter

D432/D433

This is a fault-finding aid. The LCD shows the key

54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches display

parameters (see below). This is normally disabled

0: Disabled

because it cancels the CSI display for the user.

1: Enabled

Be sure to reset this bit to 0 after testing. This is only used for communication

Protocol dump list output after 6

each communication

troubleshooting. It shows the content of the transmitted facsimile protocol signals. Always reset this bit to 0 after finishing testing.

0: Off

If system switch 09 bit 6 is at “1”, the list is only

1: On

printed if there was an error during the communication.

7

Not used

Do not change the setting.

System Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)

System Switch 02 [SP No. 1-101-003] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0-1 Not used

2

3

Do not change these settings.

Force after transmission stall

With this setting on, the machine resets itself

0: Off

automatically if a transmission stalls and fails to

1: On

complete the job.

Not used

Do not change these settings.

File retention time 4

0: Depends on User

1: A file that had a communication error will not be

Parameter 24 [18(H)]

erased unless the communication is successful.

1: No limit (until the year 2126) 5 6-7

SM

Not used

Do not change this setting.

Memory read/write by RDS

(0,0): All RDS systems are always locked out.

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0

(0,1), (1,0): Normally, RDS systems are locked

55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Always disabled

out, but the user can temporarily switch RDS on to

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1

allow RDS operations to take place. RDS will

User selectable

automatically be locked out again after a certain

Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0

time, which is stored in System Switch 03. Note

User selectable

that if an RDS operation takes place, RDS will not

Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1

switch off until this time limit has expired.

Always enabled

(1,1): At any time, an RDS system can access the machine.

System Switch 03 [SP No. 1-101-004] No

0-7

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Length of time that RDS is

00 - 99 hours (BCD).

temporarily switched on when

This setting is only valid if bits 6 and 7 of System

bits 6 and 7 of System Switch

Switch 02 are set to “User selectable”.

02 are set to “User selectable” The default setting is 24 hours.

System Switch 04 [SP No. 1-101-005] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0-2 Not used

Do not change these settings.

Printing dedicated tx parameters on Quick/Speed 3

Dial Lists 0: Disabled

1: Each Quick/Speed dial number on the list is printed with the dedicated tx parameters.

1: Enabled 4-7 Not used

Do not change these settings.

System Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)

D432/D433

56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches System Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)

System Switch 09 [SP No. 1-101-010] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Addition of image data from 0

confidential transmissions on the transmission result report 0: Disabled 1: Enabled

If this feature is enabled, the top half of the first page of confidential messages will be printed on transmission result reports. 0: Communications that reached phase C

Inclusion of communications 1

(message tx/rx) of the T.30 protocol are listed on

on the Journal when no image the Journal. data was exchanged.

1: Communications that reached phase A (call

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

setup) of T.30 protocol are listed on the Journal. This will include telephone calls.

2

Automatic error report printout 0: Disabled 1: Enabled

0: Error reports will not be printed. 1: Error reports will be printed automatically after failed communications.

Printing of the error code on 3

the error report

1: Error codes are printed on the error reports.

0: No 1: Yes 4

Do not change this setting.

Not used

1: A power failure report will be automatically 5

Power failure report

printed after the power is switched on if a fax

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

message disappeared from the memory when the power was turned off last.

Conditions for printing the

This switch becomes effective only when system

protocol dump list 6

0: Print for all communications 1: Print only when there is a communication error

SM

switch 00 bit 6 is set to 1. 1: Set this bit to 1 when you wish to print a protocol dump list only for communications with errors.

57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Priority given to various types

7

of remote terminal ID when

This bit determines which set of priorities the

printing reports

machine uses when listing remote terminal names

0: RTI > CSI > Dial label > Tel. on reports. Number

Dial Label: The name stored, by the user, for the

1: Dial label > Tel. number >

Quick/Speed Dial number.

RTI > CSI

System Switch 0A [SP No. 1-101-011] No

0

FUNCTION

COMMENTS When "1" is selected, a suitable port is

Automatic port selection

automatically selected if the selected port is not

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

used.

1-3 Not used

Do not change these settings. 0: Prevents dialing from the ten-key pad while the external telephone is off-hook. Use this setting

Dialing on the ten-key pad 4

when the external telephone is off-hook 0: Disabled 1: Enabled

when the external telephone is not by the machine, or if a wireless telephone is connected as an external telephone. 1: The user can dial on the machine’s ten-key pad when the handset is off-hook.

5

On hook dial 0: Disabled 1: Enabled

6-7 Not used

0: On hook dial is disabled. Do not change the factory settings

System Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)

D432/D433

58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches System Switch 0E [SP No. 1-101-015] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0-1 Not used

Do not change the settings. Direct sending cannot operate when the capture

Enable/disable for direct 2

function is on during sending. Setting this switch to

sending selection

"1" enables direct sending without capture. Setting

0: Direct sending off

this switch to "0" masks the direct sending function

1: Direct sending on

on the operation panel so it cannot be selected. 0: Manual tx and rx are possible while the external

3

Action when the external

handset is off-hook. However, memory tx is not

handset goes off-hook

possible.

0: Manual tx and rx operation

1: The display stays in standby mode even when

1: Memory tx and rx operation

the external handset is used, so that other people

(the display remains the

can use the machine for memory tx operation.

same)

Note that manual tx and rx are not possible with this setting.

4-7 Not used

Do not change these settings.

System Switch 0F [SP No. 1-101-016] No 0-7

SM

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Country/area code for functional

This country/area code determines the

settings (Hex)

factory settings of bit switches and RAM addresses. However, it has no effect on the

00: France

11: USA

01: Germany

12: Asia

02: UK

12: Asia

03: Italy

13: Japan

04: Austria

14: Hong Kong

05: Belgium

15: South Africa

NCU parameter settings and communication parameter RAM addresses. Cross reference NCU country code: SP No. 2-103-001 for G3-1 SP No. 2-104-001 for G3-2 SP No. 2-105-001 for G3-3

59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches 06: Denmark

16: Australia

07: Finland

17: New Zealand

08: Ireland

18: Singapore

09: Norway

19: Malaysia

0A: Sweden

1A: China

0B: Switzerland

1B: Formosa

0C: Portugal

1C: Korea

0D: Netherland

20: Turkey

0E: Spain

21: Greece

0F: Israel

22: Hungary

10: ---

23: Czech

11: USA

24: Poland

System Switch 10 [SP No. 1-101-017] No

0-7

FUNCTION

COMMENTS Threshold = N x 128 KB + 256 KB

Threshold memory level for parallel memory transmission

N can be between 00 - FF(H) Default setting: 02(H) = 512 KB

System Switch 11 [SP No. 1-101-018] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

TTI printing position 0

0: Superimposed on the page

Change this bit to 1 if the TTI overprints

data

information that the customer considers to be

1: Printed before the data

important (G3 transmissions).

leading edge

D432/D433

60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 1

Not used

Japan Only

2

Not used

Do not change the factory settings.

TTI printing type 3

0: Address unit

TTI printing unit can be selected.

1: File unit 4-6 Not used 7

Do not change the factory settings. Japan Only

Not used

System Switch 12 [SP No. 1-101-019] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS TTI: 08 to 92 (BCD) mm Input even numbers only. This setting determines the print start position for

0-7

TTI printing position in the

the TTI from the left edge of the paper. If the TTI is

main scan direction

moved too far to the right, it may overwrite the file number which is on the top right of the page. On an A4 page, if the TTI is moved over by more than 50 mm, it may overwrite the page number.

System Switch 13 - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 14 - Not used (do not change these settings)

System Switch 15 [SP No. 1-101-022] No 0

1

SM

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Going into the Energy Saver

1: The machine will restart from the Energy Saver

mode automatically

mode quickly, because the +5V power supply is

0: Enabled

active even in the Energy Saver mode.

61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches 1: Disabled 2-3 Not used

Do not change these settings.

Interval for preventing the machine from entering Energy Saver mode if there is a

4-5

pending transmission file.

If there is a file waiting for transmission, the

Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0

machine does not go to Energy Saver mode

1 min

during the selected period.

Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1

After transmitting the file, if there is no file waiting

30 min1

for transmission, the machine goes to the Energy

Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0

Saver mode.

1 hour Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 24 hours 6-7 Not used

Do not change

System Switch 16 [SP No. 1-101-023] No

FUNCTION

0-7 Not used

COMMENTS Do not change these settings.

System Switch 17 - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 18 - Not used (do not change these settings)

System Switch 19 [SP No. 1-101-026] No 0-6

7

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Special Original mode

1: If the customer frequently wishes to transmit a

0: Disabled

form or letterhead which has a colored or printed

1: Enabled

background, change this bit to “1”. “Original 1” and

D432/D433

62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches “Original 2” can be selected in addition to the “Text”, “Text/Photo” and “Photo” modes.

System Switch 1A [SP No. 1-101-027] No.

FUNCTION

COMMENTS Sets a value of 4K. If the amount of memory remaining falls below 4K,

0-7

LS RX memory remaining

documents received in memory are printed to

refresh value setting

create more space in memory. Initial value: 0x80 (512K) 00-FF (0-1020 KB: Hex)

System Switch 1B - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 1C - Not used (do not change these settings)

System Switch 1D [SP No. 1-101-030] No

0

1-7

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

RTI/CSI/CPS code display

0: RTI, CSI, CPS codes are displayed on the top

0: ON

line of the LCD panel during communication.

1: OFF

1: Codes are switched off (no display)

Not used

Do not change these settings.

System Switch 1E [SP No. 1-101-031] No

0

SM

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Communication after the

0: When this switch is on and the journal history

Journal data storage area has

becomes full, the next report prints. If the journal

become full

history is not deleted, the next transmission cannot

0: Impossible

be received. This prevents overwriting

1: Possible

communication records before the machine can

63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches print them. 1: If the buffer memory of the communication records for the Journal is full, fax communications are still possible. But the machine will overwrite the oldest communication records. Note: This setting is effective only when Automatic Journal printout is enabled but the machine cannot print the report (e.g., no paper).

0: If the SAF memory becomes full during Action when the SAF memory has become full during 1

scanning, the successfully scanned pages are transmitted. 1: If the SAF memory becomes full during

scanning 0: The current page is erased. 1: The entire file is erased.

scanning, the file is erased and no pages are transmitted. This bit switch is ignored for parallel memory transmission.

2

This bit determines which identifier, RTI or CSI, is

RTI/CSI display priority

displayed on the LCD while the machine is

0: RTI 1: CSI

communicating in G3 non-standard mode.

File No. printing 3

0: Enabled

1: File numbers are not printed on any reports.

1: Disabled If authorized reception is enabled but the user has stored no acceptable sender RTIs or CSIs, the

Action when authorized

machine will not be able to receive any fax

reception is enabled but authorized RTIs/CSIs are not 4

yet programmed 0: All fax reception is disabled 1: Faxes can be received if the sender has an RTI or CSI

messages. If the customer wishes to receive messages from any sender that includes an RTI or CSI, and to block messages from senders that do not include an RTI or CSI, change this bit to “1”, then enable Authorized Reception. Otherwise, keep this bit at “0 (default setting)”.

D432/D433

64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 5-7 Not used

Do not change the settings

System Switch 1F [SP No. 1-101-032] No 0

1

2

3

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Report printout after an

0: When an original jams, or the SAF memory

original jam during SAF

overflows during scanning, a report will be printed.

storage or if the SAF memory

Change this bit to “1” if the customer does not

fills up

want to have a report in these cases.

0: Enabled

Memory tx – Memory storage report

1: Disabled

Parallel memory tx – Transmission result report

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Received fax print start timing

0: The machine prints each page immediately after

(G3 reception)

the machine receives it.

0: After receiving each page

1: The machine prints the complete message after

1: After receiving all pages

the machine receives all the pages in the memory.

4-6 Not used

Do not change the factory settings. 0: When the fax unit detects a fax SC code other

Action when a fax SC has 7

occurred 0: Automatic reset 1: Fax unit stops

than SC1201 and SC1207, the fax unit automatically resets itself. 1: When the fax unit detects any fax SC code, the fax unit stops. Cross Reference Fax SC codes - See “Troubleshooting”

SM

65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches

4.3.2 I-FAX SWITCHES I-fax Switch 00 [SP No. 1-102-001] FUNCTION No

COMMENTS This setting sets the maximum size of the original

Original Width of TX

that the destination can receive. (Bits 3~7 are

Attachment File 0

A4

1

B4

2

A3

reserved for future use or not used.) 0: Off (not selected), 1: On (selected) If more than one of these three bits is set to “1”, the larger size has priority. For example, if both Bit 2 and Bit 1 are set to “1” then the maximum size is “A3” (Bit 2).

3-6 Reserved

When mail is sent, there is no negotiation with the receiving machine at the destination, so the sending machine cannot make a selection for the receiving capabilities (original width setting) of the receiving machine. The original width selected

7

with this switch is used as the RX machine’s

Not used

original width setting, and the original is reduced to this size before sending. The default is A4. If the width selected with this switch is higher than the receiving machine can accept, the machine detects this and this causes an error.

I-fax Switch 01 [SP No. 1-102-002] FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Original Line Resolution of TX

These settings set the maximum resolution of the

Attachment File

original that the destination can receive.

0

200x100 Standard

0: Not selected

1

200x200 Detail

2

200x400 Fine

No

D432/D433

1: Selected If more than one of these three bits is set to “1”, the higher resolution has priority. For example, if

66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 3

300 x 300 Reserve

4

400 x 400 Super Fine

5

600 x 600 Reserve

6

Reserve

both Bit 0 and Bit 2 are set to “1” then the resolution is set for "Bit 2 200 x 400.

mm/inch This setting selects mm/inch conversion for mail transmission. 0: Off (No conversion), 1: On (Conversion) When on (set to “1”), the machine converts millimeters to inches for sending mail. There is no switch for converting inches to millimeters. Unlike G3 fax transmissions which can negotiate between sender and receiver to determine the setting, mail cannot negotiate between terminals; the mm/inch selection is determined by the sender fax. 7

When this switch is Off (0): Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are sent in mm. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are transmitted in mm. When this switch is On (1): Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are converted to inches. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are converted to inches.

I-fax Switch 02 [SP No. 1-102-003] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

RX Text Mail Header Processing This setting determines whether the header information is printed with text e-mails 0

when they are received. 0: Prints only text mail. 1: Prints mail header information attached to text mail. When a text mail is received with this switch On (1), the “From” address and

SM

67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches “Subject” address are printed as header information. When a mail with only binary data is received (a TIFF-F file, for example), this setting is ignored and no header is printed. Output from Attached Document at E-mail TX Error This setting determines whether only the first page or all pages of an e-mail 1

attachment are printed at the sending station when a transmission error occurs. This allows the customer to see which documents have not reached their intended destinations if sent to the wrong e-mail addresses, for example. 0: Prints 1st page only. 1: Prints all pages. Text String for Return Receipt This setting determines the text string output for the Return Receipt that confirms the transmission was received normally at the destination. 00: “Dispatched” Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with “dispatched” in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; dispatched The “dispatched” string is included in the Subject string.

2-3

01: “Displayed” Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with “displayed” in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; displayed The “displayed” string is included in the Subject string. 10: Reserved 11: Reserved A mail requesting a Return Receipt sent from an IFAX with this switch set to “00” (for “dispatched”) received by Microsoft Outlook 2000 may cause an error. If any setting other than “displayed” (01) causes a problem, change the setting to “01” to enable normal sending of the Return Receipt. Media accept feature

4

This setting adds or does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail to confirm a reception.

D432/D433

68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 0: Does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail 1: Adds the media accept feature to the answer mail. Use this bit switch if a problem occurs when the machine receives an answer mail, which contains the media accept feature field. 5-6 Not Used Image Resolution of RX Text Mail This setting determines the image resolution of the received mail. 7

0: 200 x 200 1: 400 x 400 The “1” setting requires installation of the Function Upgrade Card in order to have enough SAF (Store and Forward) memory to receive images at 400 x 400 resolution.

I-fax Switch 03 - Not used (do not change the settings) [ SP No. 1-102-004]

I-fax Switch 04 [SP No. 1-102-005] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Subject for Delivery TX/Memory Transfer This setting determines whether the RTI/CSI registered on this machine or the RTI/CSI of the originator is used in the subject lines of transferred documents. 0

0: Puts the RTI/CSI of the originator in the Subject line. If this is used, either the RTI or CSI is used. Only one of these can be received for use in the subject line. 1: Puts the RTI/CSI registered on this machine in the Subject line. When this switch is used to transfer and deliver mail to a PC, the information in the Subject line that indicates where the transmission originated can be used to determine automatically the destination folder for each e-mail. Subject corresponding to mail post database 0: Standard subject

1

1: Mail post database subject The standard subject is replaced by the mail post database subject in the following three cases:

SM

69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches 1) When the service technician sets the service (software) switch. 2) When memory sending, delivery specified by F code or SMTP reception is done. 3) With relay broadcasting (1st stage without the Schmidt 4 function). ƒ

This switch does not apply for condition 3) when the RX system is set up for memory sending, delivery by F-code, sending with SMTP RX and when operators are using FOL (to prevent problems when receiving transmissions).

2-7 Not Used

I-fax Switch 05 [SP No. 1-102-006] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Mail Addresses of SMTP Broadcast Recipients Determines whether the e-mail addresses of the destinations that receive transmissions broadcasted using SMTP protocol are recorded in the Journal. 0

For example: "1st destination + Total number of destinations: 9" in the Journal indicates a broadcast to 9 destinations. 0: Not recorded 1: Recorded I-Fax Automatic Re-dial

1

Setting

Determines whether the I-fax automatically redials

0: OFF

when an error occurs.

1: ON 2-7 Not Used

I-fax Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-007] I-fax Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-008]

D432/D433

70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches I-fax Switch 08 [SP No. 1-102-009] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Memory Threshold for POP Mail Reception This setting determines the amount of SAF (Store and Forward) memory. (SAF stores fax messages to send later for transmission to more than one location, and also holds incoming messages if they cannot be printed.) When the amount of SAF 0-7 memory available falls below this setting, mail can no longer be received; received mail is then stored on the mail server. 00-FF (0 to 1024 KB: HEX) ƒ

The hexadecimal number you enter is multiplied by 4 KB to determine the amount of memory.

I-fax Switch 09 [SP No. 1-102-010] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0-3 Not used

Do not change the settings This setting determines the number of retries when connection and transmission fails due to

4-7 Restrict TX Retries

errors. 01-F (1-15 Hex)

I-fax Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-011] I-fax Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-012] I-fax Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-013] I-fax Switch 0D - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-014] I-fax Switch 0E - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-015]

I-fax Switch 0F [SP No. 1-102-016]

SM

71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Delivery Method for SMTP RX Files

0

This setting determines whether files received with SMTP protocol are delivered or output immediately. 0: Off. Files received via SMTP are output immediately without delivery. 1: On. Files received via SMTP are delivered immediately to their destinations. Signature for the SMTP

1

This setting determines whether a signature is put on an e-mail via SMTP. 0: No signature 1: Signature This setting determines whether an e-mail via SMTP is encrypted.

2

0: Not encrypted 1: Encrypted

3-7 Not used

4.3.3 PRINTER SWITCHES Printer Switch 00 [SP No. 1-103-001] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS 0: If a 2 page RX transmission is split, [*] is printed in the bottom right corner of the 1st page and only a [2] is printed in the upper right corner of the 2nd page.

Select page separation marks 0

0: Off 1: On

1: If a 2 page RX transmission is split into two pages, for example, [*] [2] is printed in the bottom right corner of the 1st page and only a [2] is printed in the upper right corner of the 2nd page. ƒ

This helps the user to identify pages that have been split because the size of the paper is smaller than the size of the

D432/D433

72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches document received. (When A5 is used to print an A4 size document, for example.)

1

Repetition of data when the

1: Default. 10 mm of the trailing edge of the

received page is longer than

previous page are repeated at the top of the next

the printer paper

page.

0: Off

0: The next page continues from where the

1: On

previous page stopped without any repeated text. This switch is only effective when user parameter

2

Prints the date and time on

02 - bit 2 (printing the received date and time on

received fax messages

received fax messages) is enabled.

0: Disabled

1: The machine prints the received and printed

1: Enabled

date and time at the bottom of each received page.

3-7 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Printer Switch 01 [SP No. 1-103-002] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0-2 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Maximum print width used in the setup protocol 3-4

Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 0 = Not used

These bits are only effective when bit 7 of printer

Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 1 = A3

switch 01 is “1”.

Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 0 = B4 Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 1 = A4 5-6 Not used

7

Do not change the settings.

Received message width

0: The machine informs the transmitting machine

restriction in the protocol

of the print width depending on the paper size

signal to the sender

available from the paper feed stations.

0: Disabled

Refer to the table on the next page for how the

1: Enabled

machine chooses the paper width used in the setup protocol (NSF/DIS).

SM

73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches 1: The machine informs the transmitting machine of the fixed paper width which is specified by bits 3 and 4 above.

Printer Switch 02 [SP No. 1-103-003] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

1st paper feed station usage 0

for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled

1

0: The paper feed station can be used to print fax

2nd paper feed station usage

messages and reports.

for fax printing

1: The specified paper feed station will not be used

0: Enabled

for printing fax messages and reports.

1: Disabled ƒ

3rd paper feed station usage 2

Do not disable usage for a paper feed station which has been specified by User

for fax printing

Parameter Switch 0F (15), or which is

0: Enabled

used for the Specified Cassette Selection

1: Disabled

feature.

4th paper feed station usage 3

for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled

4-7 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Printer Switch 03 [SP No. 1-103-004] No

0

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Length reduction of received

0: Incoming pages are printed without length

data

reduction.

0: Disabled

(Page separation threshold: Printer Switch 03, bits

1: Enabled

4 to 7)

D432/D433

74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 1: Incoming page length is reduced when printing. (Maximum reducible length: Printer Switches 04, bits 0 to 4) 1-3 Not used

Do not change the settings Page separation threshold (with reduction disabled with switch 03-0 above).

Page separation setting when

For example, if this setting is set to "10", and A4 is

sub scan compression is

the selected paper size: If the received document is 10 mm or less longer

4-7 forbidden 00-0F (0-15 mm: Hex)

than A4, then the 10 mm are cut and only 1 page

Default: 6 mm

prints. If the received document is 10 mm longer than A4, then the document is split into 2 pages.

Printer Switch 04 SP No. 1-103-005 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Maximum reducible length when length reduction is enabled with switch 03-0 above. <Maximum reducible length> = <Paper length> + (N x 5mm) “N” is the decimal value of the binary setting of bits 0 to 4.

0-4

Bit 4

Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

Setting

0

0

0

0

0

0 mm

0

0

0

0

1

5 mm

0

0

1

0

0

20 mm

1

1

1

1

1

155 mm

For A5 sideways and B5 sideways paper <Maximum reducible length> = <Paper length> + 0.75 x (N x 5mm) 5-6 Length of the duplicated image on the next page, when page separation has taken

SM

75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches place. Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = 4 mm Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = 10 mm Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = 15 mm Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = Not used 7

Do not change the setting.

Not used.

Printer Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings)

Printer Switch 06 [SP No. 1-103-007] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Printing while a paper cassette is pulled out, when the Just Size Printing feature is enabled. 0

Cross reference

0: Printing will not start 1: Printing will start if another

Just size printing on/off – User switch 05, bit 5

cassette has a suitable size of paper, based on the paper size selection priority tables. 1-7 Not used.

Do not change the settings.

Printer Switch 07 [SP No. 1-103-008] No

FUNCTION

0-3 Not used.

COMMENTS Do not change the settings.

List of destinations in the Communication Failure Report 1: Only destinations where communication failure 4

for broadcasting

occurred are printed on the Communication

0: All destinations

Failure Report.

1: Only destinations where

D432/D433

76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches communication failure occurred 5-7 Not used.

Do not change the settings.

Printer Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings)

Printer Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0D - Not used (do not change the settings)

Printer Switch 0E [SP No. 1-103-015] No

FUNCTION Paper size selection priority

0

0: Width 1: Length Paper size selected for

1

printing A4 width fax data 0: 8.5" x 11" size 1: A4 size

COMMENTS 0: A paper size that has the same width as the received data is selected first. 1: A paper size which has enough length to print all the received lines without reduction is selected first. This switch determines which paper size is selected for printing A4 width fax data, when the machine has both A4 and 8.5" x 11" size paper. 1: If all paper sizes in the machine require page

Page separation 2

0: Enabled 1: Disabled

separation to print a received fax message, the machine does not print the message (Substitute Reception is used). After a larger size of paper is set in a cassette, the machine automatically prints the fax message.

SM

77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Printing the sample image on reports Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 0

“Same size” means the sample image is printed at

= The upper half only

100%, even if page separation occurs.

Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 1 3-4 = 50% reduction in sub-scan only Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 0 = Same size

User Parameter Switch 19 (13H) bit 4 must be set to “0” to enable this switch. Refer to Detailed Section Descriptions for more on this feature.

Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 1 = Not used 5-6 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Equalizing the reduction ratio 0: When page separation has taken place, all the 7

among separated pages

pages are reduced with the same reduction ratio.

(Page Separation)

1: Only the last page is reduced to fit the selected

0: Enabled

paper size when page separation has taken place.

1: Disabled

Other pages are printed without reduction.

Printer Switch 0F [SP No. 1-103-016] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Smoothing feature 0-1

Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 0 = Disabled

(0, 0) (0, 1): Disable smoothing if the machine

Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 1 = Disabled

receives halftone images from other

Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 0 = Enabled

manufacturers fax machines frequently.

Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 1 = Not used Duplex printing 2

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

1: The machine always prints received fax messages in duplex printing mode:

Binding direction for Duplex 3

printing

0: Sets the binding for the left edge of the stack.

0: Left binding

1: Sets the binding for the top of the stack.

1: Top binding

D432/D433

78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 4-7

Do not change the settings.

Not used

4.3.4 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES

Communication Switch 00 [SP No. 1-104-001] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Compression modes available in receive mode These bits determine the compression capabilities

Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 0 = MH only

to be declared in phase B (handshaking) of the

0-1 Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 1 = MH/MR

Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 0 = MH/MR/MMR T.30 protocol. Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 1 = MH/MR/MMR/JBIG Compression modes available in transmit mode Bit 3: 0 Bit 2: 0 = MH only 2-3 Bit 3: 0 Bit 2: 1 = MH/MR

These bits determine the compression capabilities to be used in the transmission and to be declared

Bit 3: 1 Bit 2: 0 = MH/MR/MMR in phase B (handshaking) of the T.30 protocol. Bit 3: 1 Bit 2: 1 = MH/MR/MMR/JBIG 4

Not used

Do not change the settings.

JBIG compression method: Reception 5

0: Only basic supported 1: Basic and optional both

Change the setting when communication problems occur using JBIG compression.

supported JBIG compression method: 6

Transmission

Change the setting when communication

0: Basic mode priority

problems occur using JBIG compression.

1: Optional mode priority

SM

79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches 7

Do not change the settings.

Not used

Communication Switch 01 [SP No. 1-104-002] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS If this bit is set to 0, ECM is switched off for all

0

ECM

communications.

0: Off 1: On

In addition, V.8 protocol and JBIG compression are switched off automatically.

1

Do not change the settings.

Not used

(0,1) - The machine will disconnect the line without sending a fax message, if the last 8 digits of the received CSI do not match the last 8 digits of the dialed telephone number. This does not work Wrong connection prevention method 2-3

when manually dialed. (1,0) - The same as above, except that only the last 4 digits are compared.

Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = None Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = 8 digit CSI Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = 4 digit CSI Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = CSI/RTI

(1,1) - The machine will disconnect the line without sending a fax message, if the other end does not identify itself with an RTI or CSI. (0,0) - Nothing is checked; transmission will always go ahead. ƒ

This function does not work when dialing is done from the external telephone.

4-5 Not used

Do not change the setting.

Maximum printable page length available 6-7

The setting determined by these bits is informed to

Bit 7: 0 Bit 6: 0 = No limit Bit 7: 0 Bit 6: 1 = B4 (364 mm) Bit 7: 1 Bit 6: 0 = A4 (297 mm)

the transmitting terminal in the pre-message protocol exchange (in the DIS/NSF frames).

Bit 7: 1 Bit 6: 1 = Not used

D432/D433

80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches Communication Switch 02 [SP No. 1-104-003] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS If there are more consecutive error lines in the received page than the threshold, the machine will send a negative response. The Low and High threshold values depend on the sub-scan

0

1

resolution, and are as follows.

G3 Burst error threshold 0: Low 1: High

100 dpi

6(L) « 12(H)

200 dpi

12(L) « 24(H)

300 dpi

18(L) « 36(H)

400 dpi

24(L) « 48(H)

Acceptable total error line ratio If the error line ratio for a page exceeds the 0: 5% 1: 10%

acceptable ratio, RTN will be sent to the other end.

Treatment of pages received with errors during G3 2

reception

0: Pages received with errors are not printed.

0: Deleted from memory without printing 1: Printed

0: The next page will be sent even if RTN or PIN is

Hang-up decision when a negative code (RTN or PIN) is 3

received during G3 immediate transmission 0: No hang-up, 1: Hang-up

4-7 Not used

received. 1: The machine will send DCN and hang up if it receives RTN or PIN. This bit is ignored for memory transmissions or if ECM is being used. Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 03 [SP No. 1-104-004] No

SM

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Maximum number of page 0-7 retransmissions in a G3 memory transmission

00 - FF (Hex) times. This setting is not used if ECM is switched on. Default setting - 03(H)

Communication Switch 04 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)

Communication Switch 09 [SP No. 1-104-010] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS Adjusts the interval of the I-fax dialing. The interval of I-fax dialing is calculated by

0-7 IP-Fax dial interval setting

following formula. [Interval time = specified value with this switch x 0.2 msec]

Communication Switch 0A [SP No. 1-104-011] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Point of resumption of memory 0: The transmission begins from the page where 0

transmission upon redialing

transmission failed the previous time.

0: From the error page

1: Transmission begins from the first page, using

1: From page 1

normal memory transmission.

1-7 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 0B [SP No. 1-104-012] No

D432/D433

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 0-3 Not used 4

Do not change the settings.

Print setting when receiving a

0: The machine does not print fax data.

request to forward a fax

1: The machine prints fax data.

5-7 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings)

Communication Switch 0D [SP No. 1-104-014] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS 00 to FF (Hex), unit = 4 kbytes (e.g., 06(H) = 24 kbytes) One page is about 24 kbytes.

The available memory

The machine refers to this setting before each fax

threshold, below which ringing reception. If the amount of remaining memory is 0-7 detection (and therefore

below this threshold, the machine cannot receive

reception into memory) is

any fax messages.

disabled

If this setting is kept at 0, the machine will detect ringing signals and go into receive mode even if there is no memory available. This will result in communication failure.

Communication Switch 0E [SP No. 1-104-015] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS 06 to FF (Hex), unit = 2 s

0-7

Minimum interval between

(e.g., 06(H) = 12 s)

automatic dialing attempts

This value is the minimum time that the machine waits before it dials the next destination.

Communication Switch 0F – Not used (do not change the settings.)

SM

83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Communication Switch 10 [SP No. 1-104-017] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Memory transmission: 0-7

Maximum number of dialing

01 – FE (Hex) times

attempts to the same destination

Communication Switch 11 – Not used (do not change the settings.)

Communication Switch 12 [SP No. 1-104-019] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Memory transmission: Interval 0-7

between dialing attempts to

01 – FF (Hex) minutes

the same destination

Communication Switch 13 – Not used (do not change the settings.)

Communication Switch 14 [SP No. 1-104-021] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS 0: In immediate transmission, data scanned in inch format are transmitted without conversion. In memory transmission, data stored in the SAF memory in mm format are transmitted without

0

Inch-to-mm conversion during

conversion.

transmission

Note: When storing the scanned data into SAF

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

memory, the fax unit always converts the data into mm format. 1: The machine converts the scanned data or stored data in the SAF memory to the format which was specified in the set-up protocol

D432/D433

84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches (DIS/NSF) before transmission. 1-5 Not used

Do not change the factory settings.

Available unit of resolution in which fax messages are

For the best performance, do not change the

received 6-7

factory settings.

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0 = mm

The setting determined by these bits is informed to

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1 = inch Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0 = mm and inch (default)

the transmitting terminal in the pre-message protocol exchange (in the DIS/NSF frames).

Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1 = Not used

Communication Switch 15 – Not used (do not change the settings)

Communication Switch 16 [SP No. 1-104-023] No

FUNCTION

0-7 Not used

COMMENTS Do not change the factory settings.

Communication Switch 17 [SP No. 1-104-024] No

0

1

FUNCTION SEP reception

0: Polling transmission to another maker’s

0: Disabled

machine using the SEP (Selective Polling) signal

1: Enabled

is disabled.

SUB reception

0: Confidential reception to another maker’s

0: Disabled

machine using the SUB (Sub-address) signal is

1: Enabled

disabled.

PWD reception 2

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

3-6 Not used

SM

COMMENTS

0: Disables features that require PWD (Password) signal reception. Do not change the factory settings.

85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Action when there is no box with an F-code that matches 7

the received SUB code

Change this setting when the customer requires.

0: Disconnect the line 1: Receive the message (using normal reception mode)

Communication Switch 18 [SP No. 1-104-025] No

FUNCTION

0-4 Not used

COMMENTS Do not change the factory settings.

IP-Fax dial-in routing selection 1: Transfers receiving data to each IP-Fax dial-in 5

0: Off

number.

1: On

IP-Fax dial-in number is 4 digit-number.

6-7 Not used

Do not change the factory settings.

Communication Switch 19 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1A - Not used (do not change the settings)

Communication Switch 1B [SP No. 1-104-028] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS If the PABX does not support V.8/V.34 protocol

Extension access code (0 to 7) procedure, set this bit to “1” to disable V.8. to turn V.8 protocol On/Off 0-7 0: On 1: Off

Example: If “0” is the PSTN access code, set bit 0 to 1. When the machine detects “0” as the first dialed number, it automatically disables V.8 protocol. (Alternatively, if “3” is the PSTN access code, set bit 3 to 1.)

D432/D433

86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches Communication Switch 1C [SP No. 1-104-029] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS Refer to communication switch 1B.

0-1

Extension access code (8 and

Example: If “8” is the PSTN access code, set bit 0

9) to turn V.8 protocol On/Off

to 1. When the machine detects “8” as the first

0: On

dialed number, it automatically disables V.8

1: Off

protocol. (If “9” is the PSTN access code, use bit 1.)

2-7 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Communication Switch 1D - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1E - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1F - Not used (do not change the settings)

4.3.5 G3 SWITCHES

G3 Switch 00 [SP No. 1-105-001] No

0 1

FUNCTION Monitor speaker during

(0, 0): The monitor speaker is disabled all through

communication (tx and rx)

the communication.

Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = Disabled

(0, 1): The monitor speaker is on up to phase B in

Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = Up to Phase the T.30 protocol. B

(1, 0): Used for testing. The monitor speaker is on

Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = All the time

all through the communication. Make sure that you

Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = Not used

reset these bits after testing.

Monitor speaker during 2

memory transmission 0: Disabled 1: Enabled

3-5 Not used

SM

COMMENTS

1: The monitor speaker is enabled during memory transmission. Do not change the settings.

87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches G3 mode selection for direct 6

line

1: G3 communication through the direct line is

0: Off

enabled.

1:On 7

Do not change the settings.

Not used

G3 Switch 01 [SP No. 1-105-002] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0-1 Not used

Do not change the settings.

2-3 Not used

Do not change the settings. 1: The bytes in the DIS frame after the 4th byte will

4

DIS frame length

not be transmitted (set to 1 if there are

0: 10 bytes 1: 4 bytes

communication problems with PC-based faxes which cannot receive the extended DIS frames).

5

6

7

Not used

Do not change the setting.

Forbid CED/AMsam output

Do not change this setting (Default: 0: Off), unless

0: Off

communication problem is caused by a CED or

1: On (Forbid output)

ANSam transmission.

Not used

Do not change the setting.

G3 Switch 02 [SP No. 1-105-003] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS Change this bit to 1 only when the other end can

0

G3 protocol mode used

only communicate with machines that send

0: Standard and non-standard

T.30-standard frames only.

1: Standard only

1: Disables NSF/NSS signals (these are used in non-standard mode communication)

1-6 Not used

D432/D433

Do not change the settings.

88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 7

Short preamble

Refer to Appendix B in the Group 3 Facsimile

0: Disabled 1: Enabled

Manual for details about Short Preamble.

G3 Switch 03 [SP No. 1-105-004] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS 0: The machine will hang up if it receives the same

DIS detection number 0

DIS frame twice.

(Echo countermeasure)

1: Before sending DCS, the machine will wait for

0: 1

the second DIS which is caused by echo on the

1: 2 1

line. Do not change the settings.

Not Used

0: V.8/V.34 communications will not be possible. 2

V.8 protocol

Note:

0: Disabled

Do not set to 0 unless the line condition is always

1: Enabled

bad enough to slow down the data rate to 14.4 kbps or lower.

ECM frame size 3

0: 256 bytes

Keep this bit at “0” in most cases.

1: 64 bytes 0: When using ECM in non-standard (NSF/NSS) mode, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving a PPR, if the following condition is met in communications at 14.4, 12.0, CTC transmission conditions

9.6, and 7.2 kbps.

0: After one PPR signal 4

received 1: After four PPR signals

NTransmit- Number of transmitted frames

received (ITU-T standard)

NResend- Number of frames to be retransmitted 1: When using ECM, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving four PPRs. PPR, CTC: These are ECM protocol signals.

SM

89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches This bit is not effective in V.34 communications. Modem rate used for the next 5

page after receiving a negative code (RTN or PIN)

Do not change the settings

Not Used

This switch is used to prevent reverse polarity in

Select detection of reverse 7

before sending the next page if a negative code is received. This bit is ignored if ECM is being used.

0: No change 1: Fallback 6

1: The machine’s tx modem rate will fall back

ringing on the phone line (applied to PSTN-G3

polarity in ringing

ringing). Do not change this setting

0: Off

0: No detection

1: On

1: Detection

Outside Japan Inside Japan only

G3 Switch 04 [SP No. 1-105-005] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS 0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits

0-3

Training error detection

If the number of error bits in the received TCF is

threshold

below this threshold, the machine informs the sender that training has succeeded.

4-7 Not used

D432/D433

Do not change the settings.

90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches

G3 Switch 05 [SP No. 1-105-006] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Initial Tx modem rate Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0

0-3

bps

0

0

0

1

2.4k

0

0

1

0

4.8k

0

0

1

1

7.2k

0

1

0

0

9.6k

0

1

0

1

12.0k

0

1

1

0

14.4k

0

1

1

1

16.8k

1

0

0

0

19.2k

1

0

0

1

21.6k

1

0

1

0

24.0k

1

0

1

1

26.4k

1

1

0

0

28.8k

1

1

0

1

31.2k

1

1

1

0

33.6k

These bits set the initial starting modem rate for transmission. Use the dedicated transmission parameters if you need to change this for specific receivers. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually. Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2

Other settings - Not used Initial modem type for 9.6 k or 4-5

7.2 kbps.

These bits set the initial modem type for 9.6 and

Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0 = V.29

7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate is set at these

Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1 = V.17

speeds.

Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0 = V.34

SM

91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 = Not used 6-7

Do not change the settings.

Not used

G3 Switch 06 [SP No. 1-105-007] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Initial Rx modem rate Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0

0-3

bps

0

0

0

1

2.4k

0

0

1

0

4.8k

0

0

1

1

7.2k

0

1

0

0

9.6k

0

1

0

1

12.0k

0

1

1

0

14.4k

0

1

1

1

16.8k

1

0

0

0

19.2k

1

0

0

1

21.6k

ƒ

These bits set the initial starting modem rate for reception.

ƒ

Use a lower setting if high speeds pose problems during reception.

ƒ

If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually.

Cross reference: V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2

1

0

1

0

24.0k

1

0

1

1

26.4k

1

1

0

0

28.8k

1

1

0

1

31.2k

1

1

1

0

33.6k

Other settings - Not used 4-7

Modem types available for reception Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4

D432/D433

ƒ

The setting of these bits is used to inform the transmitting terminal of the

Setting

92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 0

0

0

1

V.27ter

0

0

1

0

V.27ter,V.29

0

0

1

1

available modem type for the machine

1

0

If V.34 is not selected, V.8 protocol must

Cross reference:

V.29, V.33

0

ƒ

be disabled manually.

V.27ter,

V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2

V.27ter, 0

in receive mode.

V.29, V.17/V.33 V.27ter,

0

1

0

1

V.29, V.17/V33, V.34

Other settings - Not used

G3 Switch 07 [SP No. 1-105-008] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange.

0-1

PSTN cable equalizer

Use the dedicated transmission parameters for

(tx mode: Internal)

specific receivers.

Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = None

Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of

Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = Low

the following symptoms occurs.

Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = Medium

Communication error

Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = High

Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34

ƒ

communications.

2-3

SM

PSTN cable equalizer

Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher

(rx mode: Internal)

frequencies because of the length of wire between

Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = None

the modem and the telephone exchange.

Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = Low

Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of

93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = Medium

the following symptoms occurs.

Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = High

Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc. Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34

ƒ

communications. PSTN cable equalizer 4

(V.8/V.17 rx mode: External) 0: Disabled

Keep this bit at “1”.

1: Enabled 5

Do not change the settings.

Not used

0: This uses the fixed table in the ROM for dial tone

6

Parameter selection for dial

detection.

tone detection

1: This uses the specific parameter adjusted with

0: Normal parameter

SRAM (69ECBEH - 69ECDEH). Select this if the

1: Specific parameter

dial tone cannot be detected when the "Normal parameter: 0" is selected.

7

Do not change the settings.

Not used

G3 Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)

G3 Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)

G3 Switch 0A [SP No. 1-105-011] No

0-1

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Maximum allowable carrier

These bits set the acceptable modem carrier drop

drop during image data

time.

reception

Try using a longer setting if error code 0-22 is

Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 200 (ms)

frequent.

D432/D433

94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = 400 (ms) Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = 800 (ms) Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = Not used Select cancellation of 2

high-speed RX if carrier

This switch setting determines if high-speed

signal lost while receiving

receiving ends if the carrier signal is lost when

0: Off

receiving during non-ECM mode

1: On 3

Do not change the settings

Not used

This bit set the maximum interval between EOL

Maximum allowable frame 4

(end-of-line) signals and the maximum interval

interval during image data

between ECM frames from the other end.

reception.

Try using a longer setting if error code 0-21 is

0: 5 s 1: 13 s 5

frequent. Do not change the settings.

Not used

When the sending terminal is controlled by a computer, there may be a delay in receiving page data after the local machine accepts set-up data Reconstruction time for the 6

first line in receive mode 0: 6 s 1: 12 s

and sends CFR. This is outside the T.30 recommendation. But, if this delay occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the sending machine more time to send data. Refer to error code 0-20. ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line should come within 5 s of CFR.

7

Not used

Do not change the settings.

G3 Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings). G3 Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) G3 Switch 0D - Not used (do not change the settings).

SM

95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches G3 Switch 0E [SP No 1-105-015] Set CNG send time interval Some machines on the receiving side may not be able to automatically switch the 3-second CNG interval. 0-7

3000-2250ms: 3000-50xNms

High order bit

3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) ≤ N ≤ FF (2250 ms) 00-0E(3000-3700ms: 3000+50xNms

Low order bit

3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) ≤ N ≤ 0F (3700 ms)

G3 Switch 0F [SP No. 1-105-016] No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Alarm when an error occurred 0

in Phase C or later

If the customer wants to hear an alarm after each

0: Disabled

error communication, change this bit to “1”.

1: Enabled Alarm when the handset is 1

off-hook at the end of

If the customer wants to hear an alarm if the

communication

handset is off-hook at the end of fax

0: Disabled

communication, change this bit to “1”.

1: Enabled 2

Not used Sidaa manual calibration

4

setting 0: Off 1: On

5-7 Not used

D432/D433

Do not change the settings. 1: manually calibrates for communication with a line, whose current change occurs such as an optical fiber line. Do not change the settings.

96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches

4.3.6 IP FAX SWITCHES

IP Fax Switch 00 [SP No. 1-111-001] No. 0 1

2

FUNCTION

COMMENTS Do not change this setting.

Not used IP Fax Transport

Selects TCP or UDP protocol for IP-Fax

0: TCP, 1: UDP IP Fax single port selection 0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)

Selects single data port.

IP Fax double ports (single data 3

port) selection

Selects whether IP-Fax uses a double port.

0: OFF, 1: ON (enable) 4

5

IP Fax Gatekeeper

Enables/disables the communication via the

0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)

gatekeeper for IP-Fax.

IP Fax T30 bit signal reverse 0: LSB first, 1: MSB first

Reverses the T30 bit signal. When "0" is selected, the max bit rate does

6

IP Fax max bit rate setting

not affect the value of the DIS/DCS.

0: Not affected, 1: Affected

When "1" is selected, the max bit rate affects the value of the DIS/DCS. When "0" is selected, fax data is received without checking the telephone number.

IP Fax received telephone number When "1" is selected, fax data is received 7

confirmation

only when confirming that the telephone

0: No confirmation, 1:

number from the sender matches the

Confirmation

registered telephone number in this machine. If this confirmation fails, the line is disconnected.

SM

97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches IP-Fax Switch 01 No.

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Select IP FAX Delay Level

0-3

Raise the level by selecting a higher setting

Bit3

Bit2

Bit1

Bit0

Setting

0

0

0

0

Level 0

0

0

0

1

Level 1

0

0

1

0

Level 2

0

0

1

1

Level 3

if too many transmission errors are occurring on the network. If TCP/UDP is enabled on the network, raise this setting on the T.30 machine. Increasing the delay time allows the recovery of more lost packets. If only UDP is enabled, increase the number of redundant packets. Level 1~2: 3 Redundant packets Level 3: 4 Redundant packets Selects the preamble wait time. [00 to 0f] There are 16 values in this 4-bit binary

4-7

IP Fax preamble wait time setting

switch combination. Waiting time: set value level x 100 ms Max: 0f (1500 ms) Min: 00 (No wait time) The default is "0000" (00H).

IP Fax Switch 02 [SP No. 1-111-003] No.

FUNCTION

COMMENTS When "0" is selected, the bit signal reverse

IP Fax bit signal reverse setting 0

0: Maker code setting 1: Internal bit switch setting

method is decided by the maker code. When "1" is selected, the bit signal reverse method is decided by the internal bit switch. When communicating between IP Fax devices, LSB first is selected.)

IP Fax transmission speed setting 1

0: Modem speed 1: No limitation

D432/D433

Selects the transmit speed for IP Fax communication.

98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches This bit switch sets the transport that has

SIP transport setting 2

priority for receiving IP Fax data.

0: TCP

This function is activated only when the

1: UDP

3

sender has both TCP and UDP.

CCM connection

When "1" is selected, only the connection

0: No CCM connection

call message with H.323 or no tunneled

1: CCM connection

H.245 is transmitted via CCM. 0: This answers the INVITE message from

4

Message reception selection from

the SIP server not registered for the

non-registered SIP server

machine.

0: Answer

1: This does not receive the INVITE

1: Not answer

message from the SIP server not registered for the machine and send a refusal message. 0: This does not limit the type of the image

ECM communication setting 5

0: No limit for image compression 1: Limit for image compression

compression with ECM communication. 1: When the other end machine is Ciscco, this permits the image compression other than JBIG or MMR with ECM communication.

6-7

Do not change these settings.

Not used

IP Fax Switch 03 [SP No. 1-111-004] No.

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Effective field limitation for G3 0

standard function information 0: OFF, 1: 4byte (DIS)

Limits the effective field for standard G3 function information.

Switching between G3 standard 1

and G3 non standard

Enables/disables switching between G3

0: Enable switching

standard and G3 non-standard.

1: G3 standard only 2

SM

Not used.

Do not change this setting.

99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches ECM frame size selection at 3

transmitting

Selects the ECM frame size for sending.

0: 256byte, 1: 64byte DIS detection times for echo 4

prevention

echoes.

0: 1 time, 1: 2 times CTC transmission selection 5

0: PPRx1

condition is decided by error frame numbers. condition is based on the ITU-T method.

Shift down setting at receiving negative code

Selects whether to shift down when negative codes are received.

0: OFF, 1: ON 7

When "0" is selected, the transmission When "1" is selected, the transmission

1: PPRx4

6

Sets the number of times for DIS to detect

Do not change this setting.

Not used

IP Fax Switch 04 [SP No. 1-111-005] No.

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0 1

Sets the TCF error threshold level. TCF error threshold

[00 to 0f]

2

The default is "1111" (0fH).

3 4-7

Do not change these settings.

Not used

IP Fax Switch 05 [SP No. 1-111-006] No. 0-3

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Modem bit rate setting for transmission Sets the modem bit rate for transmission. The default is "0110" (14.4K bps).

D432/D433

100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

0

0

0

1

2400 bps

0

0

1

1

4800 bps

0

0

1

1

7200 bps

0

1

0

0

9600 bps

0

1

0

1

12.0 Kbps

0

1

1

0

14.4 Kbps

Modem setting for transmission Sets the modem for transmission. The default is "00" (V29). 4-5

Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0 = V29 Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1 = V17 Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0 = V34* Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 = Not used *V34 is not supported for IP-Fax communication.

6-7

Do not change these settings.

Not used

IP Fax Switch 06 [SP No. 1-111-007] No. 0-3

SM

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Modem bit rate setting for reception Sets the modem bit rate for reception. The default is "0110" (14.4K bps). Bit 3

Bit 2

Bit 1

Bit 0

0

0

0

1

2400 bps

0

0

1

0

4800 bps

0

0

1

1

7200 bps

0

1

0

0

9600 bps

101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches 0

1

0

1

12.0 Kbps

0

1

1

0

14.4 Kbps

Modem setting for reception Sets the modem type for reception. The default is "0100" (V27ter, V29, V17). Bit 7

Bit 6

Bit 5

Bit 4

0

0

0

1

V27ter

0

0

1

0

V27ter, V29

0

0

1

1

0

1

0

0

0

1

0

1

4-7

V27ter, V29, V33 (invalid) V27ter, V29, V17 V27ter, V29, V17, V34*

*V34 is not supported for IP-Fax communication.

IP Fax Switch 07 [SP No. 1-111-008] No. 0

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

TSI information

Adds or does not add TSI information to

0: Not added, 1: Added

NSS(S).

DCN transmission setting at T1 1

timeout 0: Not transmitted, 1: Transmitted

2

Transmits or does not transmit DCN at T1 timeout. Do not change this setting.

Not used Hang up setting at DIS reception

3

disabled

Sets whether the machine disconnects after

0: No hang up

DIS reception.

1: Hang up after transmitting DCN

D432/D433

102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Bit Switches 4

5

6-7

Number of times for training

Selects the number of times training is done

0: 1 time, 1: 2 times

at the same bit rate.

Space CSI transmission setting at

When "0" is selected, frame data is enabled.

no CSI registration

When "1" is selected, the transmitted data is

0: Not transmitted, 1: Transmitted

all spaces.

Not used

Do not change these settings.

IP Fax Switch 08 [SP No. 1-111-009] No.

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

T1 timer adjustment Adjusts the T1 timer. The default is "00" (35 seconds). 0-1

-

Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 35 sec Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = 40 sec Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = 50 sec Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = 60 sec T4 timer adjustment Adjust the T4 timer. The default is "00" (3 seconds).

2-3

Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = 3 sec

-

Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = 3.5 sec Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = 4 sec Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = 5 sec T0 timer adjustment Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0 = 75 sec 4-5

Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1 = 120 sec Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0 = 180 sec Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 = 240 sec

6-7

SM

Not used

Adjusts the fail safe timer. This timer sets the interval between "setup" data transmission and T.38 phase decision. If your destination return is late on the network or G3 fax return is late, adjust the longer interval timer. The default is "00" (75 seconds). Do not change these settings.

103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Bit Switches IP Fax Switch 09 [SP No. 1-111-010] No.

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Network I/F setting for SIP 0

connection

Selects the connection type (IPV4 or IPV6)

0: IPv4

to connect to the SIP server.

1: IPv6. Network I/F setting for Fax communication 1

0: Same setting as SIP server connection 1: Automatic setting

Record-route setting 2

0: Disable 1: Enable

3-7

Not used

D432/D433

0: The I/F setting for fax communication follows the setting for SIP server connection. 1: The negotiation between the SIP server and the device decides whether IPv4 or IPv6 is used for the I/F setting for fax communication. 0: Disables the record-route function of the SIP server. 1: Enables the record-route function of the SIP server. Do not change these settings.

104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

NCU Parameters

4.4 NCU PARAMETERS The following tables give the RAM addresses and the parameter calculation units that the machine uses for ringing signal detection and automatic dialing. The factory settings for each country are also given. Most of these must be changed by RAM read/write (SP2-102), but some can be changed using NCU Parameter programming (SP2-103, 104 and 105); if SP2-103, 104 and 105 can be used, this will be indicated in the Remarks column. The RAM is programmed in hex code unless (BCD) is included in the Unit column. ƒ

The following addresses describe settings for the standard NCU.

ƒ

Change the fourth digit from “5” to “6” (e.g. 680500 to 680600) for the settings for the first optional G3 interface unit and from “5” to “7” (e.g. 680700) for the settings for the second optional G3 interface unit.

Address 680500

Function Country/Area code for NCU parameters Use the Hex value to program the country/area code directly into this address, or use the decimal value to program it using SP2-103-001 Country

Decimal

Hex

France

00

00

Germany

01

UK

Decimal

Hex

USA

17

11

01

Asia

18

12

02

02

Hong Kong

20

14

Italy

03

03

South Africa

21

15

Austria

04

04

Australia

22

16

Belgium

05

05

New Zealand

26

17

Denmark

06

06

Singapore

24

18

Finland

07

07

Malaysia

25

19

Ireland

08

08

China

26

1A

/Area

SM

Country /Area

105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters Address

Address

Function Norway

09

09

Taiwan

27

1B

Sweden

10

0A

Korea

28

1C

Switzerland

11

0B

Turkey

32

20

Portugal

12

0C

Greece

33

21

Holland

13

0D

Hungary

34

22

Spain

14

0E

Czech

35

23

Israel

15

0F

Poland

36

24

Function

680501

Line current detection time

680502

Line current wait time

680503

Line current drop detect time

680504

680505

680506

680507

Unit

Line current detection is disabled. 20 ms

Line current is not detected if 680501 contains FF.

PSTN dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

PSTN dial tone frequency upper

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

limit (low byte) PSTN dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

PSTN dial tone frequency lower

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

limit (low byte) 20 ms

680508

PSTN dial tone detection time

680509

PSTN dial tone reset time (LOW)

68050A

PSTN dial tone reset time (HIGH)

D432/D433

Remarks

106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

If 680508 contains FF(H), the machine pauses for the pause time (address 68050D /

SM

NCU Parameters Address 68050B

68050C

Function

68050E).

time

Italy: See Note 2.

PSTN dial tone permissible drop time PSTN wait interval (LOW)

68050E

PSTN wait interval (HIGH)

680510

Remarks

PSTN dial tone continuous tone

68050D

68050F

Unit

-

PSTN ring-back tone detection time PSTN ring-back tone off detection time

20 ms

Detection is disabled if this contains FF.

20 ms

-

20 ms

-

20 ms

-

PSTN detection time for silent 680511

period after ring-back tone detected (LOW) PSTN detection time for silent

680512

period after ring-back tone detected (HIGH)

680513

680514

680515

680516

680517 680518

SM

PSTN busy tone frequency upper limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

PSTN busy tone frequency upper

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

limit (low byte) PSTN busy tone frequency lower limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

PSTN busy tone frequency lower

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

limit (low byte) PABX dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

PABX dial tone frequency upper

107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters Address

Function

Unit

Remarks

limit (low byte) 680519

68051A

PABX dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte)

Hz (BCD)

PABX dial tone frequency lower

PABX dial tone detection time

68051C

PABX dial tone reset time (LOW)

68051D

PABX dial tone reset time (HIGH)

68051F

detection is disabled.

If 68051B contains FF, the machine pauses for the pause time (680520 /

PABX dial tone continuous tone 20 ms

time

680521).

PABX dial tone permissible drop time

680520

PABX wait interval (LOW)

680521

PABX wait interval (HIGH)

680522

PABX ringback tone detection time 20 ms

680523

contain FF(H), tone

limit (low byte)

68051B

68051E

If both addresses

-

PABX ringback tone off detection time

If both addresses contain FF(H), tone

20 ms

detection is disabled.

PABX detection time for silent 680524

period after ringback tone

20 ms

detected (LOW)

contain FF(H), tone

PABX detection time for silent 680525

If both addresses

period after ringback tone

detection is disabled. 20 ms

detected (HIGH) 680526 680527

D432/D433

PABX busy tone frequency upper limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

PABX busy tone frequency upper

108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

SM

NCU Parameters Address

Function

Unit

Remarks

limit (low byte) 680528

680529

PABX busy tone frequency lower limit (high byte)

Hz (BCD)

PABX busy tone frequency lower

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

limit (low byte)

68052A

Busy tone ON time: range 1

68052B

Busy tone OFF time: range 1

68052C

Busy tone ON time: range 2

68052D

Busy tone OFF time: range 2

68052E

Busy tone ON time: range 3

68052F

Busy tone OFF time: range 3

680530

Busy tone ON time: range 4

680531

Busy tone OFF time: range 4

680532

If both addresses

20 ms

-

20 ms

Busy tone continuous tone detection time Busy tone signal state time tolerance for all ranges, and number of cycles required for detection (a setting of 4 cycles means that ON-OFF-ON or OFF-ON-OFF must be detected twice). Tolerance (±)

680533

Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 75% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0. Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 50% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0. Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 25% Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 12.5% Bits 7, 6, 5, 4 - number of cycles required for cadence detection

680534 680535

SM

International dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

International dial tone frequency

109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters Address

Function

Unit

Remarks

upper limit (low byte) 680536

680537

680538

680539

68053A

68053B

68053C

68053D

68053E

68053F

680540

680541

680542

D432/D433

International dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz (BCD)

International dial tone frequency

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

lower limit (low byte) International dial tone detection time International dial tone reset time If 680538 contains FF,

(LOW)

the machine pauses for

International dial tone reset time

the pause time (68053D

(HIGH)

/ 68053E).

International dial tone continuous tone time

20 ms

Belgium: See Note 2.

International dial tone permissible drop time International dial wait interval (LOW)

-

International dial wait interval (HIGH) Country dial tone upper frequency

If both addresses

limit (HIGH)

contain FF(H), tone

Country dial tone upper frequency limit (LOW)

detection is disabled. Hz (BCD)

Country dial tone lower frequency limit (HIGH)

If both addresses contain FF(H), tone

Country dial tone lower frequency

detection is disabled.

limit (LOW)

110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

NCU Parameters Address 680543 680544

680545

680546

680547

Function

Unit

Country dial tone detection time If 680543 contains FF,

Country dial tone reset time 20 ms

(LOW)

the machine pauses for the pause time (680548 / 680549).

Country dial tone reset time (HIGH) Country dial tone continuous tone time

-

-

20 ms

-

Country dial tone permissible drop time

680548

Country dial wait interval (LOW)

680549

Country dial wait interval (HIGH) Time between opening or closing

68054A

Remarks

the DO relay and opening the

See Notes 3, 6 and 8. 1 ms

OHDI relay

SP2-103-012 (parameter 11). See Note 3.

68054B

Break time for pulse dialing

1 ms

SP2-103-013 (parameter 12). See Note 3.

68054C

Make time for pulse dialing

1 ms

SP2-103-014 (parameter 13). See Notes 3, 6 and 8. SP2-103-015

Time between final OHDI relay 68054D

closure and DO relay opening or

1 ms

(parameter 14). This parameter is only

closing

valid in Europe.

68054E

SM

Minimum pause between dialed digits (pulse dial mode)

See Note 3 and 8. 20 ms

SP2-103-016 (parameter 15).

111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters Address

68054F

680550

Function

Unit

SP2-103-017

Time waited when a pause is

(parameter 16). See

entered at the operation panel

Note 3. SP2-103-018

DTMF tone on time 1 ms

680551

680552

Remarks

(parameter 17). SP2-103-019

DTMF tone off time

(parameter 18).

Tone attenuation level of DTMF

-N x 0.5

signals while dialing

–3.5 dBm

SP2-103-020 (parameter 19). See Note 5. SP2-103-021 (parameter 20).

Tone attenuation value difference 680553

between high frequency tone and low frequency tone in DTMF

The setting must be less -dBm x 0.5

than –5dBm, and should not exceed the setting at

signals

680552h above. See Note 5.

680554

680556

680557

680558

680559

D432/D433

PSTN: DTMF tone attenuation

-N x 0.5

level after dialling

–3.5 dBm

Not used

-

SP2-103-022 (parameter 21). See Note 5. Do not change the settings.

Time between 68054Dh (NCU

This parameter takes

parameter 14) and 68054Eh (NCU 1 ms

effect when the country

parameter 15)

code is set to France.

Not used

-

Grounding time (ground start

20 ms

mode)

112 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Do not change the setting. The Gs relay is closed for this interval.

SM

NCU Parameters Address 68055A

68055B

68055C

Function

Unit

Break time (flash start mode)

1 ms

International dial access code

Remarks The OHDI relay is open for this interval.

For a code of 100:

(High)

BCD

International dial access code

68055B - F1 68055C - 00

(Low) This time is waited for each pause input after the PSTN access code. If this address contains

68055D

PSTN access pause time

20 ms

FF[H], the pause time stored in address 68054F is used. Do not set a number more than 7 in the UK.

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = -25.0 dBm Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = -35.0 dBm 68055E

Progress tone detection level, and

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = -30.0 dBm

cadence detection enable flags

Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = -40.0 dBm Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = -49.0 dBm Bits 2, 0 - See Note 2.

68055F To

Not used

-

Long distance call prefix (HIGH)

BCD

680564 680565

Do not change the settings. For a code of 0: 680565 – FF

680566

Long distance call prefix (LOW)

BCD

Not used

-

680567 to 680571

SM

113 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

680566 - FF Do not change the settings.

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters Address 680572

680573

680574

680575

Function

Unit

Remarks

Acceptable ringing signal

SP2-103-003

frequency: range 1, upper limit

(parameter 02).

Acceptable ringing signal

SP2-103-004

frequency: range 1, lower limit

1000/ N (Hz).

Acceptable ringing signal

(parameter 03). SP2-103-005

frequency: range 2, upper limit

(parameter 04).

Acceptable ringing signal

SP2-103-006

frequency: range 2, lower limit

(parameter 05). SP2-103-007

680576

Number of rings until a call is

1

detected

(parameter 06). The setting must not be zero.

680577

680578

680579

68057A

Minimum required length of the first ring

See Note 4. 20 ms

(parameter 07).

Minimum required length of the second and subsequent rings

20 ms

Ringing signal detection reset time (LOW)

SP2-103-009 (parameter 08). SP2-103-010

20 ms

(parameter 09).

Ringing signal detection reset time

SP2-103-011 (parameter

(HIGH)

10).

68057B to

SP2-103-008

-

Not used

680580

Do not change the settings.

Interval between dialing the last digit and switching the Oh relay 680581

20 ms

over to the external telephone

Factory setting: 500 ms

when dialing from the operation panel in handset mode.

D432/D433

114 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

NCU Parameters Address

Function

Unit

Remarks

Bits 0 and 1 - Handset off-hook detection time Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 0 = 200 ms Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 1 = 800 ms Other Not used 680582

Bits 2 and 3 - Handset on-hook detection time

-

Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = 200 ms Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = 800 ms Other Not used Bits 4 to 7 - Not used 680583 To

-

Not used

6805A0 6805A1

6805A2

6805A3

6805A4

6805A5

6805A6

6805A7

6805A8 6805A9

SM

Acceptable CED detection frequency upper limit (high byte)

Do not change the settings.

If both addresses BCD (Hz)

Acceptable CED detection

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CED detection frequency lower limit (high byte)

If both addresses BCD (Hz)

Acceptable CED detection

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

frequency lower limit (low byte) 20 ms ± 20

CED detection time

ms

Acceptable CNG detection frequency upper limit (high byte)

Factory setting: 200 ms

If both addresses BCD (Hz)

Acceptable CNG detection

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CNG detection

If both addresses

frequency lower limit (high byte)

BCD (Hz)

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

Acceptable CNG detection

115 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters Address

Function

Unit

Remarks

frequency lower limit (low byte) Do not change the

6805AA

Not used

-

6805AB

CNG on time

20 ms

Factory setting: 500 ms

6805AC

CNG off time

20 ms

Factory setting: 3000 ms

6805AD

6805AE

Number of CNG cycles required for detection

setting.

The data is coded in the -

same way as address 680533.

-

Not used

Do not change the settings.

Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805AF

(800Hz) detection frequency

If both addresses

upper limit (high byte)

Hz (BCD)

Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805B0

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

(800Hz) detection frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable AI short protocol tone

6805B1

(800Hz) detection frequency lower limit (high byte)

If both addresses Hz(BCD)

Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805B2

contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.

(800Hz) detection frequency lower limit (low byte)

6805B3

6805B4

6805B5

D432/D433

Detection time for 800 Hz AI short protocol tone

20 ms

Factory setting: 360 ms SP2-103-002

PSTN: Tx level from the modem

-N – 3 dBm

PSTN: 1100 Hz tone transmission

- N 6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B5 –3.5 (dB)

level

See Note 7.

116 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

(parameter 01).

SM

NCU Parameters Address 6805B6 6805B7 6805B8

6805B9

6805BD

Function

Unit

PSTN: 2100 Hz tone transmission

- N6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B6 –3 (dB)

level

See Note 7.

PABX: Tx level from the modem PABX: 1100 Hz tone transmission level PABX: 2100 Hz tone transmission level

- dBm - N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B8 (dB)

- N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B9 (dB)

Modem turn-on level (incoming

-37-0.5N

signal detection level)

(dBm)

Not used

-

6805BE to

Remarks

6805C6

Do not change the settings.

Bits 0 to 3 – Not used 6805C7

Bit 4 = V.34 protocol dump

0: Simple, 1: Detailed (default)

Bits 5 to 7 – Not used. 6805C8 to

Not used

-

T.30 T1 timer

1s

6805D9 6805DA

Do not change the settings.

1: Maximum wait time for post message (EOP/EOM/MPS) can 6805E0 bit Maximum wait time for post

0: 12 s

be changed to 30 s.

3

1: 30 s

Change this bit to “1” if

message

communication errors occur frequently during V.17 reception.

SM

117 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters Address

Function Voltage setting to detect off-hook

0: Auto

for voltage/DP detection for

1: Fixed V

anexternally connected line.

Here is a summary of the fixed voltage settings (1: Fixed) for an externally connected line.

6805E3

Bit 7

Bit 6

Bit 5

Bit 4

0

0

0

0

Not used

0

0

0

1

2.75 V

0

0

1

0

5.5 V

1

0

0

0

22 V

1

1

1

1

41.25 V

Bit 1

Bit 1 sets the level 6805E4

of the call signal, Bit 3 sets the call signal impedance

-

0

RT=0 (Low)

1

RT=1 (High)

0

RZ=0 (High)

Bit 3 1

6805E5

Bit 0 sets the ring

Bit 0

detection method, Bit 1 sets the ring detection method

Bit 1

when fixed.

Do not change these settings

-

RZ=1 (Composite)

0

Auto

1

Fixed

0

Use RDTP

1

Use RDTN

If any setting is changed, select a setting that is higher than the default setting.

Here is a summary of the voltages for the detection of off-hook for DP detection.

D432/D433

Bit 7

Bit 6

Bit 5

Bit 4

0

0

0

0

Not used

118 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

NCU Parameters Address

Function 0

0

0

1

2.75 V

0

0

1

0

5.5 V

1

0

0

0

22 V

1

1

1

1

41.25 V

NOTES 1.

If a setting is not required, store FF in the address.

2.

Italy and Belgium only RAM address 68055E: the lower four bits have the following meaning. Bit 2 - 1: International dial tone cadence detection enabled (Belgium) Bit 1 - Not used Bit 0 - 1: PSTN dial tone cadence detection enabled (Italy) If bit 0 or bit 2 is set to 1, the functions of the following RAM addresses are changed. 680508 (if bit 0 = 1) or 680538 (if bit 2 = 1): tolerance for on or off state duration (%), and number of cycles required for detection, coded as in address 680533. 68050B (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053B (if bit 2 = 1): on time, hex code (unit = 20 ms) 68050C (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053C (if bit 2 = 1): off time, hex code (unit = 20 ms)

3.

Pulse dial parameters (addresses 68054A to 68054F) are the values for 10 pps. If 20 pps is used, the machine automatically compensates.

4.

The first ring may not be detected until 1 to 2.5 wavelengths after the time specified by this parameter.

5.

The calculated level must be between 0 and 10. The attenuation levels calculated from RAM data are: High frequency tone: ƒ

– 0.5 x N680552/680554–3.5 dBm

ƒ

– 0.5 x N680555 dBm

Low frequency tone: ƒ

– 0.5 x (N680552/680554 + N680553) –3.5 dBm

ƒ

– 0.5 x (N680555 + N680553) dBm ƒ

SM

N680552, for example, means the value stored in address 680552(H) 119 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

NCU Parameters 6.

68054A: Europe - Between Ds opening and Di opening, France - Between Ds closing and Di opening 68054D: Europe - Between Ds closing and Di closing, France - Between Ds opening and Di closing

7.

Tone signals which frequency is lower than 1500Hz (e.g., 800Hz tone for AI short protocol) refer to the setting at 6805B5h. Tones which frequency is higher than 1500Hz refer to the setting at 6805B6h.

8.

68054A, 68054D, 68054E: The actual inter-digit pause (pulse dial mode) is the sum of the period specified by the RAM addresses 68054A, 68054D, and

D432/D433

120 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

68054E.

SM

Dedicated Transmission Parameters

4.5 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS There are two sets of transmission parameters: Fax and E-mail Each Quick Dial Key and Speed Dial Code has eight bytes of programmable parameters allocated to it. If transmissions to a particular machine often experience problems, store that terminal’s fax number as a Quick Dial or Speed Dial, and adjust the parameters allocated to that number. The programming procedure will be explained first. Then, the eight bytes will be described.

4.5.1 PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE 1.

Set the bit 0 of System Bit Switch 00 to 1.

2.

Enter Address Book Management mode ([User Tools]> System Settings> Key Operator> Address Book Management).

3.

Select the address book that you want to program.

4.

For the fax parameter, select "Fax Dest.", for the E-mail parameter, select "E-mail", then press “Start”. Make sure that the LED of the Start button lights green.

5.

The settings for the switch 00 are now displayed. Press the bit number that you wish to change.

6.

To scroll through the parameter switches, either:

7.

Select the next switch: press “Next” or Select the previous switch: “Prev.” until the correct switch is displayed. Then go back to step 6.

8.

After the setting is changed, press “OK”.

9.

After finishing, reset bit 0 of System Bit Switch 00 to 0.

4.5.2 PARAMETERS Fax Parameters The initial settings of the following fax parameters are all FF(H) - all the parameters are disabled.

Switch 00 FUNCTION AND COMMENTS ITU-T T1 time (for PSTN G3 mode) If the connection time to a particular terminal is longer than the NCU parameter setting, adjust this byte. The T1 time is the value stored in this byte (in hex code), multiplied by 1

SM

121 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Dedicated Transmission Parameters second. Range: 0 to 120 s (00h to 78h) FFh - The local NCU parameter factory setting is used. Do not program a value between 79h and FEh.

Switch 01 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Tx level Bit4

Bit3

Bit2

Bit1

Bit0

0

0

0

0

0

If communication with a particular 0

remote terminal often contains errors, the signal level may be

0-4

0

0

0

0

1

–1

0

0

0

1

0

–2

0

0

0

1

1

–3

0

0

1

0

0

–4













0

1

1

1

1

–15

1

1

1

1

1

Disabled

inappropriate. Adjust the Tx level for communications with that terminal until the results are better. If the setting is “Disabled”, the NCU parameter 01 setting is used. ƒ

Do not use settings other than listed on the left.

Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the

Cable equalizer

modem and the telephone exchange

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = None 5-7

when calling the number stored in

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = Low

this Quick/Speed Dial.

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = Medium

Also, try using the cable equalizer if

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = High

one or more of the following

Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = Disabled

symptoms occurs. Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc.

D432/D433

122 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Dedicated Transmission Parameters Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. ƒ

Do not use settings other than listed on the left.

If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.

Switch 02 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

0-3 Initial Tx modem rate

If training with a particular remote terminal

Bit3

Bit2

Bit1

Bit0

bps

0

0

0

0

Not used

0

0

0

1

2400

0

0

1

0

4800

0

0

1

1

7200

0

1

0

0

9600

0

1

0

1

12000

0

1

1

0

14400

0

1

1

1

16800

1

0

0

0

19200

1

0

0

1

21600

1

0

1

0

24000

1

0

1

1

26400

1

1

0

0

28800

1

1

0

1

31200

always takes too long, the initial modem rate may be too high. Reduce the initial Tx modem rate using these bits. For the settings 14.4 or kbps slower, Switch 04 bit 4 must be changed to 0. ƒ

Do not use settings other than listed on the left. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.

SM

123 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Dedicated Transmission Parameters 1

1

1

0

33600

1

1

1

1

Disabled

Other settings: Not used 4-7 Not used

Do not change the settings.

Switch 03 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Inch-mm conversion before tx Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = Inch-mm conversion 0-1 available Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = Inch only Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = Not used Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = Disabled DIS/NSF detection method Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = First DIS or NSF 2-3 Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = Second DIS or NSF Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = Not used Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = Disabled

The machine uses inch-based resolutions for scanning. If “inch only” is selected, the printed copy may be slightly distorted at the other end if that machine uses mm-based resolutions. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.

(0, 1): Use this setting if echoes on the line are interfering with the set-up protocol at the start of transmission. The machine will then wait for the second DIS or NSF before sending DCS or NSS. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used. If transmissions to a specific destination always

V.8 protocol 4

0: Off 1: Disabled

end at a lower modem rate (14,400 bps or lower), disable V.8 protocol so as not to use V.34 protocol. 0: V.34 communication will not be possible. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.

Compression modes available This bit determines the capabilities that are 5

in transmit mode

informed to the other terminal during transmission.

0: MH only

If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is

1: Disabled

used.

D432/D433

124 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Dedicated Transmission Parameters For example, if ECM is switched on but is not wanted when sending to a particular terminal, use ECM during transmission

the (0, 0) setting.

Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0 = Off 6-7 Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1 = On

ƒ

V.8/V.34 protocol and JBIG compression

Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0 = Not used

are automatically disabled if ECM is

Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1 = Disabled

disabled. ƒ

If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.

Switch 04 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)

E-mail Parameters The initial settings of the following e-mail parameters are all "0" (all parameters disabled).

Switch 00 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

MH Compression mode 0

for e-mail attachments

Switches MH compression on and off for files

0: Off

attached to e-mails for sending.

1: On MR Compression mode 1

for e-mail attachments

Switches MR compression on and off for files

0: Off

attached to e-mails for sending.

1: On

SM

125 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Dedicated Transmission Parameters MMR Compression mode 2

for e-mail attachments

Switches MMR compression on and off for files

0: Off

attached to e-mails for sending.

1: On 3-6

Do not change these settings.

Not used Designates the bits to reference for

7

The "0" selection (default) references the settings for

compression method of

Bits 00, 01, 02 above. The "1" selection ignores the

e-mail attachments

selections of Bits 00, 01, 02.

0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6) 1: No registration.

Switch 01 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Original width of e-mail 0

attachment: A4

Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as

0: Off

A4.

1: On Original width of e-mail 1

attachment: B4

Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as

0: Off

B4.

1: On Original width of e-mail 2

attachment: A3

Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as

0: Off

A3.

1: On 3-6

Do not change these settings.

Not used Designates the bits to

7

reference for original size of e-mail attachments 0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6)

D432/D433

The "0" selection (default) references the settings for Bits 00, 01, 02 above. The "1" selection ignores the selections of Bits 00, 01, 02.

126 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Dedicated Transmission Parameters 1: No registration.

Switch 02 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Line resolution of e-mail 0

attachment: 200 x 100

Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as

0: Off

200 x100.

1: On Line resolution of e-mail 1

attachment: 200 x 200

Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as

0: Off

200 x 200.

1: On Line resolution of e-mail 2

attachment: 200 x 400

Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as

0: Off

200 x 400.

1: On 3

Not used

Do not change these settings.

Line resolution of e-mail 4

attachment: 400 x 400

Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as

0: Off

400 x 400.

1: On 5-6

Not used

Do not change these settings.

Designates the bits to reference for original size The "0" selection (default) references the settings for 7

of e-mail attachments

Bits 00, 01, 02, 04 above. The "1" selection ignores

0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6)

the selections of Bits 00, 01, 02, 04.

1: No registration.

Switch 03 - Not used (do not change the settings)

SM

127 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Dedicated Transmission Parameters Switch 04 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS If the other ends have the addresses, which have

0

Full mode address

the full mode function flag ("0"), this machine

selection

determines them as full mode standard machines.

0: Full mode address

ƒ

This machine attaches the "demand of reception confirmation" to a message when transmitting.

1: No full mode (simple mode)

ƒ

This machine updates the reception capability to the address book when receiving.

1-7

Do not change these settings.

Not used

Switch 05 No

FUNCTION

COMMENTS

Directr transmission 0

selection to SMTP server

Allows or does not allow the direct transmission to

0: ON

SMTP server.

1: OFF 1-7

Not used

Do not change these settings.

Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)

D432/D433

128 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service RAM Addresses

4.6 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES ƒ

Do not change the settings which are marked as “Not used” or “Read only.”

680001 to 680004(H) - ROM version (Read only) 680001(H) - Revision number (BCD) 680002(H) - Year (BCD) 680003(H) - Month (BCD) 680004(H) - Day (BCD) 680006 to 680015(H) - Machine’s serial number (16 digits - ASCII) 680018(H) - Total program checksum (low) 680019(H) - Total program checksum (high) 680020 to 68003F(H) - System bit switches 680050 to 68005F(H) - Printer bit switches 680060 to 68007F(H) - Communication bit switches 680080 to 68008F(H) - G3 bit switches 680090 to 68009F(H) - G3-2 bit switches: Not used 6800A0 to 6800AF(H) - G3-3 bit switches: Not used 6800D0(H) - User parameter switch 00 (SWUER_00) : Not used 6800D1(H) - User parameter switch 01 (SWUSR_01) : Not used 6800D2(H) - User parameter switch 02 (SWUSR_02) Bit 0: Forwarding mark printing on forwarded messages

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

Bit 1: Center mark printing on received copies (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 2: Reception time printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 3: TSI print on received messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 4: Checkered mark printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 5: Not used Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Not used 6800D3(H) - User parameter switch 03 (SWUSR_03: Automatic report printout)

SM

129 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service RAM Addresses Bit 0: Transmission result report (memory transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Memory storage report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 3: Polling reserve report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 4: Polling result report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 5: Transmission result report (immediate transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Journal 0: Off, 1: On 6800D4(H) - User parameter switch 04 (SWUSR_04: Automatic report printout) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Automatic communication failure report and transfer result report output 0: Off, 1: On Bits 2 to 3: Not used Bit 4: Indicates the parties 0: Not indicated, 1: Indicated Bit 5: Include sender’s name on reports 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Inclusion of a sample image on reports

0: Off, 1: On

6800D5(H) - User parameter switch 05 (SWUSR_05) Bit 0: Substitute reception when the base copier is in an SC condition 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Bits 1 and 2: Condition for substitute rx when the machine cannot print messages (Paper end, toner end, jam, and during night mode) Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives all the fax messages. Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1 = The machine receives the fax messages with RTI or CSI. Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives the fax messages with the same ID code. Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 1 =

The machine does not receive anything.

Bit 3: Not used Bit 4: Not used Bit 5: Just size printing 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Add paper display when a cassette is empty 0: Off, 1: On 6800D6(H) - User parameter switch 06 (SWUSR_06): Not used 6800D7(H) - User parameter switch 07 (SWUSR_07) Bit 0 Ringing 0: Off, 1: On Bit1: Automatic answering message 0: Off, 1: On Bit 2: Parallel memory transmission 0: Off, 1: On Bits 3 and 4: Not used

D432/D433

130 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service RAM Addresses Bit 5: Remote control 0: Off, 1: On Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800D8(H) - User parameter switch 08 (SWUSR_08) Bits 0 and 1: Not used. Bit 2: Authorized reception 0: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are specified for this feature are accepted. 1: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are not specified for this feature are accepted. Bits 3 to 7: Not used. 6800D9(H) - User parameter switch 09 (SWUSR_09): Not used 6800DA(H) - User parameter switch 10 (SWUSR_0A) Bits 0 to 2: Not used Bit 3: Page reduction 0: Off, 1: On Bits 4 and 5: Not used Bit 6: Use both e-mail notification and printed reports to confirm the transmission results 0: Off, 1: On Bit 7: Not used 6800DB(H) - User parameter switch 11 (SWUSR_0B) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: White original detection 0: Off, 1: On (alarm and alert message on the LCD) Bit 3: Receive rejection for 1300 Hz transmission 0: Off (receive), 1: On (not receive) Bit 5: Not used Bit 6: Printout of messages received while acting as a forwarding station 0: Off, 1: On Bit 7: Not used 6800DC(H) - User parameter switch 12 (SWUSR_0C): Not used 6800DD(H) - User parameter switch 13 (SWUSR_0D): Not used 6800DE(H) - User parameter switch 14 (SWUSR_0E) Bit 0: Message printout while the machine is in Night Printing mode 0: On, 1: Off Bit 1: Maximum document length detection 0: Double letter, 1: Longer than double-letter (well log) – up to 1,200 mm Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: Fax mode settings, such as resolution, before a mode key (Copy/Fax/Printer/Scanner) is pressed 0: Not cleared, 1: Cleared Bits 4 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Not used 6800DF(H) - User parameter switch 15 (SWUSR_0F)

SM

131 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service RAM Addresses (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bits 0, 1 and 2: Cassette for fax printout Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = 1st paper feed station Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = 2nd paper feed station Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = 3rd paper feed station Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 4th paper feed station Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = LCT Other settings Not used Bits 3 and 4: Not used Bit 5: Using the cassette specified by bits 0, 1 and 2 above only 0: On, 1: Off Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E0(H) – User parameter switch 16 (SWUSR_10) (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: Paper size selection priority for an A4 size fax message when A4/LT size paper is not available. 0: A3 has priority, 1: B4 has priority Bits 3 to 7: Not used 6800E1(H) – User parameter switch 17 (SWUSR_11) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Inclusion of the “Add” button when a sequence of Quick/Speed dials is selected for broadcasting 0:Not needed, 1: Needed Bits 3 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Press “Start” key without an original when using the on hook dial or the external telephone, 0: displays “Cannot detect original size”. 1: Receives fax messages. 6800E2(H) - User parameter switch 18 (SWUSR_12) Bit 0: TTI date 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: TTI sender

0: Off, 1: On

Bit 2: TTI file number

0: Off, 1: On

Bit 3: TTI page number

0: Off, 1: On

Bits 4 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Japan only 6800E3(H) - User parameter switch 19 (SWUSR_13) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Journal format

D432/D433

132 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service RAM Addresses 0: The Journal is separated into transmissions and receptions 1: The Journal is separated into G3-1, G3-2, and G3-3 communications Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: 90° image rotation during B5 portrait Tx (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 4: Reduction of sample images on reports to 50% in the main scan and sub-scan directions. (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Technician adjustment (printer switch 0E bits 3 and 4), 1: 50% reduction Bit 5: Use of A5 size paper for reports (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E4(H) - User parameter switch 20 (SWUSR_14) Bit 0: Automatic printing of the LAN fax result report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Not used. Bits 2 to 5: Store documents in memory which could not be printed from PC fax (LAN fax) driver

Bit 5

Bit 4

Bit 3

Bit 2

Setting

0

0

0

0

0 min.

0

0

0

1

1 min.











1

1

1

0

14 min.

1

1

1

1

15 min.

Bits 6 and 7: Not used. 6800E5(H) - User parameter switch 21 (SWUSR_15) Bit 0: Print results of sending reception notice request message 0: Disabled (print only when error occurs), 1: Enabled Bit 1: Respond to e-mail reception acknowledgment request 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: File format for forwarded folders 0: TIFF, 1:PDF Bit 4: Transmit Journal by E-mail 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 5: Not used

SM

133 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service RAM Addresses Bit 6: Network error display 0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed Bit 7: Transmit error mail notification 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled 6800E6(H)

- User parameter switch 22 (SWUSR_16)

(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bit 0: Dial tone detection (PSTN 1) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bits 1 to 7: Not used 6800E7(H) – User parameter switch 23 (SWUSR_17): Not used 6800E8(H) - User parameter switch 24 (SWUSR_18): Not used 6800E9(H) - User parameter switch 25 (SWUSR_19) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Reception mode switch timer 0: Off, 1: On (switching Fax or Fax/Tel) Bit 2: Mode priority switch 0: Fax first, 1: Tel first Bit 3: Dial in function (Japan Only) Bit 4: RDS operation 0: Not acceptable, 1: Acceptable for the limit specified by system switch 03 ƒ

This bit is only effective when RDS operation can be selected by the user (see system switch 02).

Bits 5 to 7: Not used 6800EA(H) and 6800EB(H) - User parameter switches 26 and 27 (SWUSR_1A and 1B): Not used 6800EC(H) - User parameter switch 28(SWUSR_1C) Xxxxx 6800ED(H) - User parameter switch 29(SWUSR_1D) xxxxxx 6800EE(H) and 6800EF(H) - User parameter switches 30 and 31 (SWUSR_1E and 1F): Not used 6800F0(H) - User parameter switch 32 (SWUSR_20) Bit 0: Quotation priority for a destination when there is no destination of the specified type 0: Paper output priority = Priority order: 1. IP-fax destination, 2. Fax Number, 3. E-mail address, 4. Folder 1: Electric putout order = Priority order: 1. E-mail address, 2. Folder, 3. IP-fax destination, 4. Fax number Bits 1 to 7: Not used 6800F1(H) - User parameter switch 33 (SWUSR_21): Not used 6800F2(H) - User parameter switch 34 (SWUSR_22)

D432/D433

134 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service RAM Addresses Bit 0: Gatekeeper server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 1: SIP server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bits 2 to 7: Not used 680100 to 68010F(H) - G4 Parameter Switches – Not used 680110 to 68012F(H) - G4 Internal Switches – Not used 680130 to 68016F(H) - Service Switches 680170 to 68017F(H) - IFAX Switches 680180 to 68018F(H) - IP-FAX Switches 680190 to 6801AF(H) - Service station’s fax number (SP3-101) 6801B0 to 6801B9(H) - Own fax PABX extension number 6801BA to 6801C3(H) - Own fax number (PSTN) – Not used 6801C4 to 6801D7(H) - Own fax number (ISDN G4) – Not used 6801D8 to 6801E3(H) - The first subscriber number (ISDN G3) – Not used 6801E4 to 6801EF(H) - The second subscriber number (ISDN G3) – Not used 6801F0 to 6801FB(H) - The first subscriber number (ISDN G4) – Not used 6801FC to 680207(H) - The second subscriber number (ISDN G4) – Not used 680208 to 68021B(H) - PSTN-1 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 68021C to 68022F(H) - PSTN-2 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680230 to 680246(H) - PSTN-3 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680247 to 680286(H) - TTI 1 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 680287 to 6802C6(H) - TTI 2 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - Not used 6802C7 to 680306(H) - TTI 3 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680307 to 68031A(H) - PSTN-1 CSI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) 68031B to 68032E(H) - PSTN-2 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 68032F to 680342(H) - PSTN-3 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680343(H) - Number of PSTN-1 CSI characters (Hex) 680344(H) - Number of PSTN-2 CSI characters (Hex) - Not used 680345(H) Number of PSTN-3 CSI characters (Hex) - Not used ƒ

If the number of characters is less than the maximum (20 for RTI, 32 for TTI), add a stop code (00[H]) after the last character.

680380 to 680387(H) - Last power off time (Read only) 680380(H) - 01(H) - 24-hour clock, 00(H) - 12-hour clock (AM), 02(H) - 12-hour clock (PM) 680381(H) - Year (BCD) 680382(H) - Month (BCD) 680383(H) - Day (BCD)

SM

135 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service RAM Addresses 680384(H) – Hour 680385(H) – Minute 680386(H) – Second 680387(H) - 00: Monday, 01: Tuesday, 02: Wednesday, /// , 06: Sunday 680394(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings) Bit 0: Page Memory

0: Not installed, 1: Installed

Bit 1: SAF Memory

0: Not installed, 1: Installed

Bits 2 to 7; Not used 680395(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings) Bits 0 to 3: Not used Bit 4: G3-2 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 5: G3-3 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 6 and 7: Not used 680406 to 68040A – Option G3 board (G3-2) ROM information (Read only) 680406(H) - Suffix (BCD) 680407(H) - Version (BCD) 680408(H) - Year (BCD) 680409(H) - Month (BCD) 68040A(H) - Day (BCD) 68040B to 68040F – Option G3 board (G3-3) ROM information (Read only) 68040B(H) - Suffix (BCD) 68040C(H) - Version (BCD) 68040D(H) - Year (BCD) 68040E(H) - Month (BCD) 68040F(H) - Day (BCD) 680410(H) - G3-1 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680412(H) - G3-2 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680414(H) - G3-3 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680420(H) - Number of multiple sets print (Read only) 680476(H) - Time for economy transmission (hour in 24h clock format - BCD) 680477(H) - Time for economy transmission (minute - BCD) 680492(H) - Transmission monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680493(H) - Reception monitor volume 680494(H) - On-hook monitor volume 680495(H) - Dialing monitor volume 680496(H) - Buzzer volume

D432/D433

00 - 07(H) 00 - 07(H)

00 - 07(H)

00 - 07(H)

136 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Service RAM Addresses 680497(H) - Beeper volume

00 - 07(H)

6804A8(H) - Machine code (Check ram 4) 68918E(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68920E(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68928E(H) - Arias Number (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68930E(H) - SIP user name (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68938E(H) - SIP digest authentication password (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68940E(H) - Gateway address information (Max. 7100 characters - ASCII) 68AFCA(H) - Stand-by port number for H.232 connection 68AFCCH) - Stand-by port number for SIP connection 68AFCE(H) - RAS port number 68AFD0(H) - Gatekeeper port number 68AFD2(H) - Port number of data waiting for T.38 68AFD4(H) - Port number of SIP server 68AFD6(H) - Priority for SIP and H.323 68AFD7(H) - SIP function

0: H.323, 1: SIP

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

68AFD8(H) - H.323 function

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

68AFD9(H) - SIP digest authentication function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 68AFDA(H) - IP-Fax backup data 00 - 600 (H) - Not used 69ED6A(H) to 69ED92(H) - SIP server address (Read only) 69ED6A(H) - Proxy server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED72(H) - Proxy server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED7A(H) - Redirect server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED82(H) - Redirect server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED8A(H) - Registrar server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED92(H) - Registrar server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 6BEBFE(H) - 6BEC1E (H) - Dial tone detection parameter (Max. 11 x 3 lines) This initializes following order. [0x04, 0x40, 0x03, 0x60, 0x64, 0xf4, 0x01,0x64, 0x04, 0xc8, 0x00] 6BEBFE(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Upper limit (High) Defaults: NA: 06, EU: 06, ASIA: 06 6BEBFF(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Upper Limit (Low) Defaults: NA: 50, EU: 50, ASIA: 50 6BEC00(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Lower Limit (High) Defaults: NA: 03, EU: 02, ASIA: 02 6BEC01(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Lower Limit (Low)

SM

137 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

Service RAM Addresses Defaults: NA: 60, EU: 90, ASIA: 90 6BEC02(H) –Dial tone detection waiting time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 64, EU 64, ASIA: 64 6BEC03 to 6BEC04 – Dial tone detection monitoring time (20 ms) Defaults

Area

6BEC03

6BEC04

NA

F4

01

EU

F4

01

ASIA

F4

01

6BEC05(H) – Dial tone detect judge time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 64, EU: 1B, ASIA: 32 6BEC06(H) – Dial tone disconnect permission time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 11, EU: 0F, ASIA: 11

D432/D433

138 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

General Specifications

5. SPECIFICATIONS 5.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS 5.1.1 FCU

Type: Circuit: Connection:

Desktop type transceiver PSTN PABX Direct couple Book (Face down) Maximum Length: 432 mm [17 ins] Maximum Width: 297 mm [11.7 ins] ARDF (Face up)

Original Size:

(Single-sided document) Length: 128 - 1200 mm [5.0 - 47.2 ins] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch] (Double-sided document) Length: 128 - 432 mm [5.0 - 17 inch] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch]

Scanning Method:

Flat bed, with CCD G3 8 x 3.85 lines/mm (Standard) 8 x 7.7 lines/mm (Detail) 8 x 15.4 line/mm (Fine) See Note1

Resolution:

16 x15.4 line/mm (Super Fine) See Note 1 200 x 100 dpi (Standard) 200 x 200 dpi (Detail) 400 x 400 dpi (Super Fine) See Note 1 ƒ

SM

Optional Expansion Memory required

139 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

General Specifications G3: 3 s at 28800 bps; Measured with G3 ECM using memory for Transmission Time:

an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at standard resolution

Data Compression:

MH, MR, MMR, JBIG

Protocol:

Group 3 with ECM

Modulation:

V.34, V.33, V.17 (TCM), V.29 (QAM), V.27ter (PHM), V.8, V.21 (FSK) G3: 33600/31200/28800/26400/24000/21600/

Data Rate:

19200/16800/14400/12000/9600/7200/4800/2400 bps Automatic fallback

I/O Rate:

With ECM: 0 ms/line Without ECM: 2.5, 5, 10, 20, or 40 ms/line ECM: 128 KB SAF Standard: 4 MB

Memory Capacity:

With optional Expansion Memory: 28 MB Page Memory Standard: 8 MB (Print: 4 MB + Scanner: 4 MB) With optional Expansion Memory: 16 MB (Print 8 MB + Scanner: 8 MB)

5.1.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS The following table shows the capabilities of each programmable items.

Item

D432

D433

Total Destinations in Address Book

2000

150

Groups

100

10

Destination per Group

500

100

Destinations for All Files

500

300

D432/D433

140 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

General Specifications Programs

100

-

Special Senders

30

30

The following table shows how the capabilities of the document memory will change after the Expansion Memory are installed.

Without the Expansion

With the Expansion

Memory

Memory

D432

D433

D432

D433

Memory Transmission file

400

200

400

-

320

320

2240

-

Memory capacity for memory transmission (See the Note below)

ƒ

Measured using an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at standard resolution, auto image density mode, and Text mode.

SM

141 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

IFAX Specifications

5.2 IFAX SPECIFICATIONS

Local area network Connectivity:

Ethernet 100base-Tx/10base-T IEEE802.11a/g, g (wireless LAN), 1000 Base-T Main scan: 400 dpi, 200 dpi

Resolution:

Sub scan: 400 dpi, 200 dpi, 100 dpi ƒ

To use 400 dpi, IFAX SW01 Bit 4 must be set to “1”.

1 s (through a LAN to the server) Condition: ITU-T #1 test document (Selerexe Letter) MTF correction: OFF Transmission

TTI: None

Time:

Resolution: 200 x 100 dpi Communication speed: 10 Mbps Correspondent device: E-mail server Line conditions: No terminal access Maximum message width is A4/LT.

Document Size:

ƒ

To use B4 and A3 width, IFAX SW00 Bit 1 (B4) and/or Bit 2 (A3) must be set to “1”.

E-mail File Format:

Single/multi-part MIME conversion Image: TIFF-F (MH, MR, MMR) Transmission:

Protocol:

SMTP, TCP/IP Reception: POP3, SMTP, IMAP4, TCP/IP

Data Rate:

D432/D433

100 Mbps(100base-Tx) 10 Mbps (10base-T)

142 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

IFAX Specifications Authentication Method: Remark:

SMTP-AUTH POP before SMTP A-POP The machine must be set up as an e-mail client before installation. Any client PCs connected to the machine through a LAN must also be e-mail clients, or some features will not work (e.g. Autorouting).

SM

143 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

IP-FAX Specifications

5.3 IP-FAX SPECIFICATIONS

Local Area Network Network:

Ethernet/10base-T, 100base-TX IEEE802.11a/g, g (wireless LAN), 1000 Base-T 8 x 3.85 lines/mm, 200x100dpi (standard character), 8 x 7.7lines/mm, 200x200dpi (detail character),

Scan line density:

8 x 15.4lines/mm (fine character: optional expansion memory required), 16 x 15.4lines/mm, 400x400dpi (super fine character: optional expansion memory required)

Original size:

Maximum A3 or 11"x 17" (DLT)

Maximum scanning

Standard: A3, 297mm x 432mm

size:

Irregular: 297mm x 1200mm

Transmission

Recommended: T.38 Annex protocol, TCP, UDP/IP

protocol:

communication

Compatible machines:

IP-Fax compatible machines Specify IP address and send fax to an IP-Fax compatible fax

IP-Fax transmission

through a network.

function:

Also capable of sending fax from a G3 fax connected to the public telephone lines via a VoIP gateway. Receive a fax sent from an IP-Fax compatible fax through a

IP-Fax reception

network.

function:

Also capable of receiving fax from a G3 fax connected the public telephone lines via a VoIP gateway.

D432/D433

144 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

SM

Fax Unit Configuration

5.4 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION

Component

Code

MBU GWFCU

No.

Remarks

3 D432/ D433

Speaker

2

Included with the fax unit

1

Expansion Memory

G578

4

Optional only for D432

Handset Type 1018

B433

-

NA only. Also used with AT/AP-C2

SM

145 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

D432/D433

D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530

CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA

More Documents from "Manuel Flores"